OWNER'S MANUAL
Operation
Maintenance
Specifications
All information in this Owner's Manual is current at the time of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make changes at
any time so that our policy of continual product improvement may be
carried out.
This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment.
As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not apply
to your specific vehicle.
CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO
YOUR HYUNDAI
SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE
WARNING
Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way.
Such modifications may adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering the vehicle. Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations
established by the U.S. Department of
Transportation and other federal or state agencies.
This manual includes information titled as DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION and NOTICE.
These titles indicate the following:
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous situation
which, if not avoided, will result in death or
serious injury.
WARNING
TWO-WAY RADIO INSTALLATION
Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure
Monitoring System, Passenger Occupant
Classification System and other CAN bus systems. It is possible for an improperly
installed/adjusted high powered two-way radio to
adversely affect electronic systems. For this reason, we recommend that you carefully follow the
radio manufacturer’s instructions if you choose to
install one of these devices.
WARNING indicates a hazardous situation
which, if not avoided, could result in death
or serious injury.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation
which, if not avoided, could result in minor or
moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not
avoided, could result in vehicle damage.
F2
HYUNDAI VEHICLE OWNER PRIVACY POLICY
Your Hyundai vehicle may be equipped with technologies and services that use information collected,
generated, recorded or stored by the vehicle. Hyundai has created a Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy to explain
how these technologies and services collect use and share this information.
You may read our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy on the Hyundaiusa.com website at:
https://www.hyundaiusa.com/owner-privacy-policy.aspx
If you would like to receive a hard copy of our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy, please contact the Hyundai
Customer Care Center at:
Hyundai Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728
800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through Friday,
between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST and Saturday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Care assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are available Monday through Friday
between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
F3
INTRODUCTION
Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome you to the growing number of discerning people who drive HYUNDAIs. We are very proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of
each HYUNDAI we build.
Your Owner's Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new HYUNDAI. To become familiar with
your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it, read this Owner's Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle.
This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to familiarize you with your vehicle's controls and safety features so you can safely operate your vehicle.
This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe operation of the vehicle. It is recommended that all service and maintenance on your car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. HYUNDAI dealers are prepared to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance that may be required.
This Owner's Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and should be kept in the vehicle so you
can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with important operating, safety and maintenance information.
HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA
CAUTION
Severe vehicle damage may result from the use of poor quality lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications.You must always use high quality lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 8-6 in the
Vehicle Specifications section of the Owner's Manual.
Copyright 2022 HYUNDAI Motor America. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored
in any retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI
Motor America.
F4
GUIDE TO HYUNDAI GENUINE PARTS
1. What are HYUNDAI Genuine
Parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are the
same parts used by HYUNDAI
Motor Company to manufacture
vehicles. They are designed and
tested for the optimum safety, performance, and reliability for our
customers.
2. Why should you use genuine
parts?
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are
engineered and built to meet rigid
manufacturing
requirements.
Damage caused by using imitation, counterfeit or used salvage
parts is not covered under the
HYUNDAI New Vehicle Limited
Warranty or any other HYUNDAI
warranty.
In addition, any damage to or failure of HYUNDAI Genuine Parts
caused by the installation or failure of an imitation, counterfeit or
used salvage part is not covered
by any HYUNDAI Warranty.
3. How can you tell if you are purchasing HYUNDAI Genuine
Parts?
Look for the HYUNDAI Genuine
Parts Logo on the package (see
below).
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts exported to the U.S. are packaged with
labels written only in English.
HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are only
sold through authorized HYUNDAI
Dealerships.
F5
Introduction
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
SAFETY MESSAGES
We want to help you get the greatest
possible driving pleasure from your
vehicle. Your Owner's Manual can
assist you in many ways. To gain an
overview of the contents of your
Owner's Manual, use the Table of
Contents in the front of the manual.
The first page of each Chapter
includes a detailed Table of Contents
of the topics in that Chapter.
To quickly locate information about
your vehicle, use the Index in the
back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list of what is in this manual and
the page number where it can be
found.
For your convenience, we have
incorporated tabs on the right-hand
page edges. These tabs are coded
with the Chapter titles to assist you
with navigating through the manual.
Your safety, and the safety of others,
is very important. This Owner's
Manual provides you with many safety precautions and operating procedures. This information alerts you to
potential hazards that may hurt you
or others, as well as damage to your
vehicle.
Safety messages found on vehicle
labels and in this manual describe
these hazards and what to do to
avoid or reduce the risks.
Warnings and instructions contained
in this manual are for your safety.
Failure to follow safety warnings and
instructions can lead to serious injury
or death.
Throughout this manual DANGER,
WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and
the SAFETY ALERT SYMBOL will
be used.
This is the safety alert symbol. It is used to alert you to
potential physical injury hazards. Obey all safety messages that follow this symbol
to avoid possible injury or
death. The safety alert symbol precedes the signal words
DANGER, WARNING and
CAUTION.
DANGER
DANGER indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
will result in death or serious
injury.
WARNING
WARNING indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
could result in death or serious
injury.
F6
Introduction
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates a hazardous
situation which, if not avoided,
could result in minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
NOTICE indicates a situation
which, if not avoided, could result
in vehicle damage.
FUEL REQUIREMENTS
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS
For the optimal vehicle performance,
we recommend you to use the hydrogen fuel which complies with your
local regulatory agency standard
(purity, maximum concentration of
impurities, etc.).
• This vehicle should not be modified. Modification of your vehicle
could affect its performance, safety
or durability and may even violate
governmental safety and emissions regulations.
In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from any
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
• If you use unauthorized electronic
devices, it may cause the vehicle to
operate abnormally, wire damage,
battery discharge and fire. For your
safety, do not use unauthorized
electronic devices.
F7
Introduction
VEHICLE DATA COLLECTION AND EVENT DATA RECORDERS
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
Items contained in motor vehicles or emitted from them are
known to the State of California
to cause cancer and birth
defects or reproductive harm.
These include:
• Gasoline and its vapors
• Engine exhaust
• Used engine oil
• Interior passenger compartment components and materials
• Component parts which are
subject to heat and wear
In addition, battery posts, terminals and related accessories
contain lead, lead compounds
and other chemicals known to
the State of California to cause
cancer and reproductive harm.
F8
This vehicle is equipped with an
event data recorder (EDR). The
main purpose of an EDR is to
record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an
air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist
in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is
designed to record data related to
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time,
typically 30 seconds or less. The
EDR in this vehicle is designed to
record such data as:
• How various systems in your
vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and
passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was
depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and
injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only
if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by
the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data
(e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded.
However, other parties, such as
law enforcement, could combine
the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely
acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR,
special equipment is required, and
access to the vehicle or the EDR is
needed. In addition to the vehicle
manufacturer, other parties, such
as law enforcement, that have the
special equipment, can read the
information if they have access to
the vehicle or the EDR.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Your Vehicle at a Glance
1
Safety System of Your Vehicle
2
Convenience Features of Your Vehicle
3
Infotainment System
4
Driving Your Vehicle
5
What to Do in an Emergency
6
Maintenance
7
Specifications, Consumer Information and
Reporting Safety Defects
8
Index
I
FCEV Vehicle System Overview
FCEV : Fuel Cell Electric Vehicle
Introduction of FCEV .........................................................H2
The components of FCEV..................................................H3
Fuel cell stack ...................................................................................H4
FCEV system module .......................................................................H4
High pressure hydrogen storage tanks......................................H5
Battery system..................................................................................H5
Features of FCEV .............................................................H10
How to Start the Vehicle..............................................................H10
How to Stop the Vehicle ..............................................................H11
Virtual Engine Sound System......................................................H11
Fuel filler door ................................................................................H12
Warning and indicator lights .......................................................H15
LCD Display Messages ..................................................................H16
FCEV mode.......................................................................................H21
When the high voltage battery is weak...................................H25
If the 12 volt battery is discharged...........................................H25
Emergency while driving ..............................................................H26
Customer Q&A Guide .......................................................H30
INTRODUCTION OF FCEV
An FCEV is an electric vehicle which is driven using the electricity generated from the fuel cell.
The power system of the FCEV is composed of the following:
- The fuel cell stack which generates the electricity
- The device which controls the heat generated after supplying the hydrogen and air for chemical reaction of the stack
- The inverter which converts the DC created from the stack to AC
- The traction motor which generates propelling power using the supplied AC
- Air processing system
- Fuel processing system
The hydrogen tanks that stores the hydrogen supplied to the fuel cell can be fueled at 70 MPa.
❈ FCEV is Fuel Cell Electric Vehicle
H2
THE COMPONENTS OF FCEV
(1) Fuel Cell system
(2) Traction motor system
1
2
3
4
(3) Hydrogen Tanks
(4) Battery System
OFEQ018001N/OFEQ018002/OFEQ018003/OFEQ018004/OFEQ018005
H3
THE COMPONENTS OF FCEV (CONT.)
1. Fuel cell stack
2. FCEV powertrain
OFEQ018006N
A fuel cell stack is a device that converts the chemical energy into electricity thorough a chemical reaction
with hydrogen and oxygen. Fuel cell
is different from battery in that it
requires hydrogen and oxygen constantly in order to operate. And it can
produce electricity continually for as
long as hydrogen and oxygen are
supplied. A fuel cell stack is composed of many unit cells to obtain the
desired power for a vehicle.
4. Reduction gear
5. Air compressor
OFEQ018007N
WARNING
OFEQ018008
1. High voltage junction box
2. Fuel cell stack
3. Traction motor
H4
The main components of FCEV are
Fuel cell stack, air processing system, fuel processing system, thermal
management system, hydrogen storage tanks, high voltage battery, DCDC converter, inverter and traction
motor, gear differential unit.
The Air compressor supplies air to fuel
cell system and the hydrogen storage
tanks supplies hydrogen fuel to fuel
cell system. Then the electric energy
comes from the fuel cell system.
The electric energy delivered to the
motor inverter. The energy finally
moves to motor operating.
If you assemble or disassemble
the stack and fuel cell system,
hydrogen may leak resulting in
fire and this may lead to accidents. Never assemble or disassemble the stack and fuel cell
system.
3. High pressure hydrogen
storage tanks
High voltage cables
4. Battery system
The electric energy which is generated from fuel cell system or high voltage battery module is distributed to
the various components. Most of the
cables are located in the inside or bottom of the components. These cables
use orange colored cover to distinguish from other lines. It is required to
handle the cables carefully with isolation gloves.
OFEQ018005
OFEQ018004
Compressed hydrogen tank system
is composed of three tanks which
are filled with hydrogen gas in a gas
station. Each tank is made of plastic
liner for blocking the hydrogen permeation and carbon fiber layer sustain high pressures.
There are main parts to supply
hydrogen stably and to enable safety
such as magnetic valves, pressure
regulator, pressure sensors, pressure relief valve, excess flow valve
and so on. The hydrogen in the tanks
comes into the pressure regulator
which has a pressure sensor.
A 12 V battery integrated with the low
and high voltage batteries is installed
in the vehicle. The battery supplies
the electricity required for driving the
vehicle and stores the energy generated from the regenerative braking.
When the vehicle accelerates the
auxiliary power of the fuel cell supplies the energy. The vehicle can
drive about 2 miles (3 km) in EV
mode until the high voltage battery is
discharged.
H5
THE COMPONENTS OF FCEV (CONT.)
Disconnecting negative (-)
battery cable
OFEQ018009
1. Fold up the luggage board of the
liftgate.
2. Disconnect the negative (-) connector.
H6
Hydrogen gas detection
sensors
They detect a hydrogen leak and
informs a warning of hydrogen leak
to a driver. As informing a warning,
the sensors automatically shut off
hydrogen. Sensors are installed
around the hydrogen storage tanks
and FCEV system module.
These sensors prevent a hydrogen
leak in an emergency. Even if the
hydrogen leak occurs, the Fuel cell
electric operating does not active.
The system operating is changed to
EV (Electric vehicle) mode and you
may drive the vehicle about 2 miles
(3 km). However, we recommend
that you stop the vehicle to the safety place and contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Never touch orange or high
voltage labeled components
including wires, cables, and
connections.
If the insulators or covers are
damaged or removed, severe
injury or death from electrocution may occur.
WARNING
In the fuel cell system, the battery uses high voltage to operate the motor and other components.
This high voltage battery system can be very dangerous.
Never touch the system. If you
touch the battery system, serious injury or death may occur.
WARNING
OFEQ018010
WARNING
• Do not disassemble or assemble the high voltage battery
system. Doing so may result
in electric shock causing
death or serious injury.
• If you disassemble or assemble
system
components
improperly, it may damage the
performance and reliability of
your vehicle.
• If coolant and electrolyte
come in contact with your
body, clothes or eyes, immediately flush with a large quantity of fresh tap water. Have
your eyes examined by a doctor as soon as possible.
Never assemble or disassemble
the high voltage battery system.
• If you assemble or disassemble the high voltage battery
system, the durability and
performance of the vehicle
may be damaged.
• When you want to check the
high voltage battery system,
contact
an
authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not touch the high voltage
battery and high voltage cable
connected to motor (orange
color). Severe burns and electric shock may occur. For your
safety, do not touch the cover
of electronic components and
electronic cable. Do not
remove the cover of electronic components and electronic
cable. In particular, never
touch the high voltage battery
system when the FCEV system is operating. It may result
in death or serious injury.
WARNING
• Never use the package modules (high voltage battery,
inverter, converter) for any
other purpose.
• Do not use an after-market
battery charger to charge the
high voltage battery. Doing so
may result in death or serious
injury.
• Never get near or put a high
voltage battery system in a
fire. Doing so may result in
serious burns.
• Never drill into, strike or otherwise damage the package
modules. An electric shock
may occur resulting in serious injury or death.
H7
THE COMPONENTS OF FCEV (CONT.)
CAUTION
• When the vehicle is paint
baked, do not pass 30 minutes in 158°F (70°C) or 20 minutes in 176°F (80°C) degree.
• When you clean the fuel cell
power module compartment,
do not wash using water.
Water may cause an electric
shock to occur and damage
electronic parts and components.
WARNING
This vehicle uses the high voltage battery system to generate
high voltage.
High voltage in the battery system is very dangerous and can
cause severe burns and electric
shock. This may result in serious injury or death.
H8
• For your safety, never touch,
replace, dismantle or remove
the high voltage battery system including components,
cables and connectors.
Severe burns or electric
shock may result in serious
injury or death if you do not
follow this warning.
• When the high voltage battery
system operates, the battery
system can be hot. Always be
careful because burns or electric shock may be caused by
high voltage.
• Do not drop water or liquid on
to Fuel cell power module
compartment. The system
components are covered. If
you drop water or liquid on to
system components, it may
result in electric shock.
WARNING
• Do not assemble or disassemble the hydrogen tanks.
Improper work may damage
the performance and reliability and unexpected problem
may occur. For hydrogen
tanks work, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Never drill into, strike or otherwise damage the hydrogen
tanks. Unexpected problem
may occur resulting in serious injury and death.
• Never get near or put a hydrogen tanks in a fire. Doing so
may result in big injury.
• Never use the hydrogen tank
for any other purpose.
Service plug
CAUTION
OFEQ018011
WARNING
Never touch the service plug
under the rear seat.
The service plug is attached to
the high voltage battery system.
Touching the service plug will
result in death or serious injury.
Service personnel should follow procedures in service manual.
The FCEV system contains
many electronic components.
High voltage components like
cables and other parts may emit
electromagnetic waves. Even if
the electromagnetic cover
blocks electromagnetic emissions, electromagnetic waves
may have an effect on electronic appliances. If you park the
vehicle for a long time, the high
voltage battery or 12V battery
will discharge.You need to drive
the vehicle several times per
month. We recommend driving
at least 10 minutes or 2 miles (3
km) when you drive the vehicle.
If the high voltage battery is discharged and if it is impossible
to jump start the vehicle contact
your HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
• When you start the FCEV system in the "P" or "N" gear
position, the "Ready (
)"
indicator is illuminated in the
cluster. The driver can drive
the vehicle.
• When you leave the vehicle,
you should turn off the system or shift into the "P" position. If you depress the accelerator pedal by mistake and
the vehicle is not in the "P"
position, the vehicle will move
abruptly. This may result in
serious injury or death.
H9
FEATURES OF FCEV
i Information
How to Start the Vehicle
1. Holding the smart key, sit in the
driver's seat.
2. Fasten the seat belt before starting the vehicle.
3. Make sure to engage the parking
brake.
4. Turn OFF all electrical devices.
5. Make sure to depress and hold
the brake pedal.
6. While depressing the brake pedal,
shift to P (Park).
7. Depress and hold the brake pedal
while pressing the POWER button.
H10
While the charging cable is connected,
the gear cannot be shift from P (Park)
to any other gear for safety reasons.
10. Release the parking brake and
slowly release the brake pedal.
Check if the vehicle slowly moves
forward, then depress the accelerator pedal.
OFE051462N
8. When the "
" indicator is ON,
you can drive the vehicle.
When the "
" indicator is OFF,
you cannot drive the vehicle. Start
the vehicle again.
9. Depress and hold the brake pedal
and shift to the desired position.
How to Stop the Vehicle
Virtual Engine Sound System
1. Hold down the brake pedal while
the vehicle is parked.
2. While depressing the brake pedal,
shift to P (Park).
3. While depressing the brake pedal,
engage the parking brake.
4. While depressing the brake pedal,
press the Power button and turn
off the vehicle.
5. Check if the "
" indicator is
turned OFF on the instrument
cluster.
When the "
" indicator is ON
and the gear is in a position other
than P (Park), the driver can accidently depress the accelerator
pedal, causing the vehicle to move
unexpectedly.
The Virtual Engine Sound System
generates engine sound for pedestrians to hear vehicle sound because
there is no sound while the FCEV
vehicle is operating.
• If the vehicle is in the ready (
)
mode and the gear is not in P
(Park),
• When the gear is shifted to R
(Reverse), an additional warning
sound will be heard.
CAUTION
• The vehicle is much quieter
while driving than a conventional gasoline-powered vehicle. Be aware of your surroundings and always drive
safely.
• After you park the vehicle or
while you are waiting at a traffic light, check whether there
are children or obstacles
around the vehicle.
• Check if there is something
behind the vehicle when driving in reverse. Pedestrians
may not hear the sound of the
vehicle.
H11
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
Fuel filler door
Opening the fuel filler door
OFE039063L
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Push the fuel filler door opener
button.
H12
NOTICE
• The fuel filler door does not
open if the vehicle is not off.
• The fuel filler door may open
after several seconds from turning off the vehicle. However, in
cold weather, the fuel door may
not open for about 45 seconds
until the cluster message
"Powering down..." disappears.
This is for protecting the fuel
cell system.
OFEQ018015N
3. Pull the fuel filler door (1) out to
fully open.
4. Pull the fuel filler cap (2).
5. Place the cap on the fuel filler door.
i Information
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break
the ice and release the door. Do not
pry on the door. If necessary, spray
around the door with an approved deicer fluid (do not use radiator antifreeze) or move the vehicle to a warm
place and allow the ice to melt.
WARNING
• According to the hydrogen
fueling station condition the
hydrogen may not be filled
fully and the driving distance
may change accordingly. The
hydrogen may not be charged
fully if the fueling station does
not satisfy the fueling method
specified in the fueling. standard (SAE J2601) or if the
hydrogen is not enough in the
station, the fueling facility
has failure, etc.
• Depending on the remaining
hydrogen in the vehicle and
ambient temperature, the time
required for fueling may vary.
More time may be required for
fueling if the remaining hydrogen level is low and the
weather is hot. Also, required
time may be longer if the
hydrogen cooling temperature of the fueling station is
high.
• The distance to empty may
vary depending on the driving
environment (weather, traffic,
etc.) and driving method
(rapid acceleration, heating
and air conditioning, etc.).
Closing the fuel filler door
1. Cover the fuel filler with the cap.
2. Close the fuel filler door until it is
latched securely.
WARNING
• If the fuel filler cap requires
replacement, use parts for
replacement from an authorized Hyundai dealer. An incorrect fuel filler cap can result in
a serious malfunction of the
fuel system. Contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer
for replacement.
• If the fuel filler door is not
completely closed, the vehicle
is not turned on. Close the
fuel filler door and turn on the
vehicle.
H13
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
WARNING
Refueling dangers
Automotive fuels are flammable
materials. When refueling,
please note the following guidelines carefully. Failure to follow
these guidelines may result in
severe personal injury, severe
burns or death by fire or explosion.
• Read and follow all warning
posted at the gas station facility.
• Before touching the fuel nozzle, you should eliminate
potentially dangerous static
electricity discharge by touching another metal part of the
vehicle, a safe distance away
from the fuel filler neck, nozzle, or other gas source.
H14
• Do not get back into a vehicle
• When refueling, always shut
once you have begun refueling since you can generate
static electricity by touching,
rubbing or sliding against any
item or fabric (polyester, satin,
nylon, etc.) capable of producing static electricity. Static
electricity discharge can
ignite fuel vapors resulting in
rapid burning. If you must reenter the vehicle, you should
once again eliminate potentially dangerous static electricity discharge by touching a
metal part of the vehicle, away
from the fuel filler neck, nozzle or other gasoline source.
• Do not use cellular phones
while refueling. Electric current and/or electronic interference from cellular phones can
potentially ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire.
the power off. Once refueling
is complete, check to make
sure the fuel filler cap and fuel
filler door are securely closed,
before starting the vehicle.
• DO NOT use matches or a
lighter and DO NOT SMOKE or
leave a lit cigarette in your
vehicle while at a gas station
especially during refueling.
Automotive fuel is highly
flammable and can, when
ignited, result in fire.
• If a fire breaks out during refueling, leave the vicinity of the
vehicle, and immediately contact the manager of the gas
station and then contact the
local fire department. Follow
any safety instructions they
provide.
Warning and indicator lights
1. Power gauge
2. Speedometer
3. Fuel cell stack temperature gauge
4. Fuel gauge
5. Warning and indicator lights
6. Odometer/LCD display/Trip computer
OFE041480N
Yellow
Air bag warning
Charging system warning
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) OFF indicator
Seat belt warning
Low fuel level warning
Immobilizer Indicator
Parking brake &
brake fluid warning
Low tire pressure warning
Turn Signal Indicator
EPB (EPB) warning
Regenerative brake
warning
Service warning
High Beam Indicator
AUTO
AUTO HOLD Indicator
HOLD
Anti-lock brake system
(ABS) warning
Power down warning
Light ON Indicator
Master Warning
Hydrogen gas leak
warning (Red)
Ready indicator
LED Headlight warning
Hydrogen leak sensor
warning (Yellow)
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system indicator
Electronic Brake force
Distribution (EBD) warning
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) warning
Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA)
system warning
Electronic Parking Brake
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) indicator
❈ For more details, refer to the ‘Instrument cluster’ in Chapter 3.
H15
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
CAUTION
▲
Check FCEV System
This warning message is displayed
and the warning light illuminates
when the FCEV system is not working properly.
In this case,have the vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Replace fuel cell coolant and
filter
This warning message is displayed
when the fuel cell coolant and filter
need to be checked.
In this case, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Refill electric components
coolant
This warning message is displayed
when the electronic device's coolant
level in the tanks is low.
In this case, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer and refill the coolant.
▲
H16
▲
▲
Power limited due to high
coolant temperature
This warning message is displayed
when the FCEV's stack is overheated and the power supply to the
FCEV system is limited.
If the warning light stays on when in
"Ready (
)" state or while driving
the vehicle, this indicates that the
fuel cell stack may have failure. In
this case, we recommend you to
drive safely and have your vehicle
inspected
by
an
authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not drive on uphill or accelerate suddenly when the power
down warning light is on. The
power is limited and may result
in dangerous situation or vehicle damage.
▲
LCD Display Messages
Stop vehicle and check power
supply
This warning message is displayed
when any serious malfunction of the
vehicle is detected.
In this case, drive the vehicle immediately to a safe area and turn off the
vehicle. Then turn the vehicle on
again.
If the message is displayed again,
have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Small hydrogen leak possible
This warning message is displayed
when the minor hydrogen leakage is
detected in the vehicle. In this case,
have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the vehicle has to be stopped due
to the leakage, hydrogen gas leak
warning light (red) will illuminate and
'Hydrogen leak detected. Stop safely
immediately.' message is displayed.
▲
▲
Hydrogen tank temperature
out of range! Stop safely
immediately
This warning message is displayed
to protect the hydrogen tank system
when the temperature of the hydrogen tank is too high or too low.
Turn off the vehicle and stop to let
the temperature of the hydrogen tank
go down.
WARNING
▲
Hydrogen tank overfilled due
to hydrogen station error
This warning message is displayed
when the hydrogen tank is over-refueled with the hydrogen due to a problem of the fueling station.
Turn off the vehicle and then turn on
the vehicle. If the message is displayed again, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
▲
▲
Close fuel door before turning
vehicle On
This warning message is displayed
when you turn on the vehicle with
the fuel filler door open. Close the
fuel filler door and turn on the vehicle
again.
Power limited due to low
hydrogen tank temperature
This warning message is displayed
to protect the battery and fuel cell
system when the temperature of the
hydrogen tanks is low.
If this message is still displayed after
the ambient temperature has
increased enough, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
If this message is still displayed
after the vehicle is turned off
and stopped for a sufficient
time, we recommend you to
stop driving and have your vehicle immediately inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H17
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
H18
Replace
hydrogen
tank.
Maximum number of refill
cycles exceeded
This warning message is displayed
when the number of times refueling
the vehicle exceeds the predefined
number (4,995 times). The fuel cell
system stops operation for safety
even if the vehicle is refueled enough
and when there is no problem with
the vehicle. In this case, have the
hydrogen storage system replaced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
▲
▲
Refueling…
This warning message is displayed
while refueling the vehicle. Do not
turn on the vehicle and wait until the
refueling is complete.
▲
▲
Open fuel door after turning
vehicle Off
This warning message is displayed
when you try to open the fuel filler
door while the vehicle is turned on.
Turn of the vehicle and open the fuel
filler door. If the message is still displayed after a while, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
▲
▲
Check fuel door sensor
This warning message is displayed
when there is a malfunction with the
sensor located below the fueling inlet
which is used for communicating
with the fueling station. Check and
remove if there is any foreign substance around the fueling inlet.
If this message is still displayed after
the foreign substance is removed,
have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check hydrogen leak sensor
This warning message is displayed
and the light showing the malfunction
of the hydrogen leakage detection
sensor illuminates when there is a
malfunction with the hydrogen leakage detection sensor. In this case,
have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
▲
Hydrogen leak detected. Stop
safely immediately
This warning message is displayed
and the hydrogen gas leak warning
light (red) illuminates when the
hydrogen leakage is detected in the
vehicle. In this case, we recommend
you to stop driving and stop the vehicle immediately at a safe area. Then
turn off the vehicle and have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Power limited due to fuel cell
system error
This warning message is displayed
when there is a malfunction with the
fuel cell system and the power supply to the fuel cell system is limited.
If the warning light stays on when in
"Ready (
)" state or while driving
the vehicle, this indicates that the
fuel cell system may have failure. In
this case, have the vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check 12V battery. Stop safely
and engage parking brake
This warning message is displayed
when the voltage of the auxiliary battery is low. Stop the vehicle at a safe
area and turn off the vehicle. Then
turn on the vehicle after a while. If the
message is displayed again, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
▲
Check FCEV System! Stop and
turn vehicle Off
This warning message is displayed
when there is a temporary malfunction with the FCEV system. Stop the
vehicle at a safe area and turn off the
vehicle. Then turn on the vehicle
after a while. If the message is displayed again, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
▲
Unable to start vehicle.
Hydrogen too low
This warning message is displayed
when the fuel is empty and the vehicle is not turned on. The vehicle will
not turn on and we recommend that
you have your vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
▲
▲
Unable to start vehicle! Check
high voltage system
This warning message is displayed
when there is a malfunction with the
high voltage system.
If the vehicle will not turn on, have
the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
▲
▲
Check fuel cell system! Stop
safely immediately
This warning message is displayed
when any serious malfunction of the
fuel cell system is detected.
In this case, immediately park the
vehicle at a safe area and turn off the
vehicle. Then turn the vehicle on
again.
If the message is displayed again,
have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Low fuel
This warning message is displayed
when you need to refuel the vehicle.
Refuel the vehicle immediately at a
nearby fueling station.
H19
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
▲
Air filter blocked. Check filter
or see owner's manual
This warning message is displayed
when
- the snow may block the air cleaner
filter after driving the vehicle in
heavy snow when the ambient
temperature is below 50°C (10°F)
or
- the exhaust pipe may be frozen
and clogged when the vehicle is
parked for a long time with the
vehicle ON below 50°C (10°F).
In this case, remove the snow from
the inside of the air cleaner filter and
turn on and off the vehicle. If the
warning message is displayed again,
the exhaust pipe may be blocked.
Then, move your vehicle indoors and
leave it inside more than one day to
defrost the exhaust pipe.
If the warning message is displayed
again, have the vehicle checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H20
OFE078009
OFE078010
FCEV mode
Entering FCEV Mode
FCEV Mode Menu Screen
OFEQ018017N
OFEQ018018N
If you select the "FCEV" menu in the Infotainment system
home screen or the "FCEV" in the menu, you can enter
the FCEV mode.
For details on FCEV Mode, refer to the navigation manual that is provided separately.
OFEQ018019N
1. Reachable Range: It shows the reachable range on the
map.
2. Fuel cell monitoring: It shows the battery information
and the power transmission flow between the components.
3. ECO Driving: It shows the fuel efficiency information
and environmental contribution.
4. Management : It shows the status of hydrogen tank
(warning alert) and 'FCEV Route' setting.
H21
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
Reachable Range
Fuel cell monitoring
OFEQ018020N
You can check the reachable range on the screen
H22
OFEQ018021L
You can check the FCEV's Start-up status, battery information and power transmission flow between the components.
Hydrogen fuel economy
ECO contribution
OFEQ018022L
OFEQ018023N
1. Fuel Efficiency Graph: It shows fuel efficiency information of the last 45 minutes.
2. Average Fuel Efficiency (MPGe): It shows the average
fuel efficiency.
3. Initialization: It initializes the fuel efficiency graph information.
You can check the amount of purified air and CO2 reduction rate.
- Air purification
It shows the amount of air that adult(s) breathe(s) per
day is purified
- CO2 reduction
It shows that the same amount of CO2 exhausted by an
equal class gasoline vehicle is reduced.
H23
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
Management
OFEQ018024N
OFEQ018025N
OFEQ018026N
H24
1. Hydrogen Tank : It shows the temperature, pressure
and status of the hydrogen tank while driving.
2. Warning [Destination unreachable warning]
You can set to have the warning pop up when the vehicle cannot reach the destination with the current
remaining hydrogen fuel.
3. FCEV Route [Display FCEV Route Bar on Map]
You can set to indicate the FCEV route and reachable
range on the map screen.
When the high voltage battery
is weak
If the 12 volt battery is discharged
When the high voltage battery is
weak due to driving on a hill for a
long time or accelerating and decelerating the vehicle repeatedly, the
acceleration performance may be
lower than usual. In this case, be
cautious not to overtake other vehicles.
This vehicle does not have a regular
12V battery that needs periodic
replacement. It is lithium ion polymer
type integrated into the high voltage
battery. The vehicle has a 12V battery protection system that cuts 12V
battery from vehicle draw to prevent
full discharge.
If the 12V battery is discharged, you
should try charging it by pressing the
"12V BATT RESET" button.
Using the 12V battery reset
switch
OFEQ019028L
1. Press the 12V Battery Reset
switch to reconnect the 12V battery.
2. Start the vehicle within 15 seconds of pressing the 12V Battery
Reset switch.
3. After starting vehicle (
indicator on), move the vehicle outside
and keep the vehicle ready (
)
mode more than 30 minutes safely to charge the 12V battery.
H25
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
If you do not start the vehicle immediately after pressing the 12V Battery
Reset switch, the power of 12V battery is automatically disconnected
after few seconds to save the 12V
battery from additional discharge. If
the 12V battery is disconnected prior
to starting the vehicle, press the 12V
Battery Reset switch again and then
immediately start the vehicle as
explained.
Repeated use of the 12V Battery
Reset switch without a sufficient ON
cycle (30 Min+) may cause over discharge of the 12V battery, which will
prevent the vehicle from starting. If
the 12V battery is over discharged to
a point that the reset does not work,
try to jump-start the vehicle.
H26
i Information
After starting the vehicle (
indicator on), the 12V battery is being
charged whether the accelerator pedal
is depressed or not.
❈ For more details regarding the
jump start, refer to the 'Jump staring' in Owner's manual Chapter 6.
Emergency while driving
If an accident occurs
1. Stop the vehicle, put the gear into
the P (Park) position, set the parking brake, and turn the vehicle off
to prevent the hydrogen and current from leaking.
The flow of hydrogen into the fuel
cell stack will be shut off to prevent
the current from being generated.
2. Evacuate to the safety place.
3. Call emergency services for help
and let them know the vehicle is a
Fuel Cell Electric Vehicle.
If a fire occurs
1. Stop the vehicle, put the gear into
the P(Park) position, set the parking brake, and turn the vehicle off
to prevent the hydrogen and current from leaking.
The flow of hydrogen into the fuel
cell stack will be shut off to prevent
the current from being generated.
2. If the fire is small, which can be
extinguished with fire extinguisher,
use carbon dioxide extinguisher.
You can also extinguish the fire
with water when the vehicle power
is turned off.
WARNING
Do not use water to extinguish a
fire when the vehicle power is
turned on. Serious electric
shock may result.
If the fire is too big to be extinguished
with the fire extinguisher, evacuate
from the vehicle, call the fire department, and let them know the vehicle
is a Fuel Cell Electric Vehicle. Do not
come close to the vehicle until the
fire is totally extinguished.
Emergency venting of hydrogen
gas
If the temperature near the safety
valve located at the rear under vehicle is over 110°C caused by a fire or
other reasons, the safety valve will
open to vent hydrogen gas. Venting
the hydrogen gas makes a loud
noise because the venting speed is
very fast. Stay well away from the
vehicle. This jet stream of hydrogen
gas could ignite.
If a submersion in water occurs
If your vehicle was flooded and has
soaked carpeting or water on the
flooring, you should not try to start
the vehicle by pressing the POWER
button.
Call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
H27
FEATURES OF FCEV (CONT.)
If you have a flat tire while driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
1. Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow
down while driving straight ahead.
Do not apply the brakes immediately or attempt to pull off the road
as this may cause a loss of control. When the vehicle has slowed
to such a speed that it is safe to do
so, brake carefully and pull off the
road. Drive off the road as far as
possible and park on firm, level
ground. If you are on a divided
highway, do not park in the median
area between the two traffic lanes.
2. When the vehicle is stopped, turn
on your emergency hazard flashers, set the parking brake and put
the gear into the P (Park) position.
3. Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on
the side of the vehicle that is away
from traffic.
H28
If the vehicle stalls while driving
Exhaust pipe
1. Reduce your speed gradually,
keeping a straight line. Move cautiously off the road to a safe place.
2. Turn on your emergency flashers.
3. Try to start the vehicle again. If
your vehicle will not start, contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The FCEV is driven by electricity
which is generated when the oxygen
in the air and the hydrogen in the
vehicle is combined. The principle is
the opposite of the electrolysis of
water; the decomposition of water
making hydrogen and oxygen.
The FCEV is emission-free and
water is created when the hydrogen
and oxygen reacts in the process of
making the electricity. Some water
may be discharged through the
exhaust pipe when the vehicle is
turned off after driving. This is normal
but be careful in winter as the puddle
made by the exhausted water may
freeze resulting in accident.
Also, take cautious as the exhausted
steam may reach the vehicle parked
in the back when you turn off the
vehicle in winter.
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or
crossing, set the gear in the N
(Neutral) position and then push the
vehicle to a safe place.
Hydrogen station
You can search the hydrogen fueling
station and set the station as the
destination in the Infotainment system screen. Select 'Menu-Nearby
POI' in the map screen and select
'Fuel stations' to see the list of stations. Set the nearest station as the
destination. Check the station operation status and opening hours before
visiting the station.
Fully refueling the vehicle may be
impossible depending on the station
condition and the reachable range
may change accordingly.
Also, the refueling time may vary
depending on the hydrogen fueling
pressure and ambient temperature.
The reachable range may change
according to the driving environment
(weather, traffic, etc.) and driving
method (sudden acceleration, heating and air conditioning, etc.).
* Refueling the hydrogen gas must
be done by the person who has
completed the certification course
and training related to the highpressure gas. Self-refueling is prohibited.
H29
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE
Category
Questions
Answers
1. Does a Hydrogen Fuel Cell Electric
FCEV performance characteristics are generally equivalent to stanVehicle (FCEV) have similar performance
dard vehicles, but with better noise control.
to standard, non-electric vehicles?
Every component housed in the fuel cell power module compart2. If water floods the fuel cell power module ment is designed to be waterproof through evaluation which meets
compartment, due to heavy rain or flood- the IP69K standard, so you don't have to worry about any potential
ing for example, will it have any effect on faults or safety problems if water contacts the fuel cell. However, if
the vehicle?
the vehicle is fully flooded, have the vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Vehicle
overview
(10 items)
3. When starting or stopping the vehicle,
there's a noise. Is this noise cause for
concern?
In most instances, the vehicle can get startup in cold weather without any problems. However, the vehicle may not start if the vehicle is
parked with the ignition off for over a week in cold temperatures. In
this case, turn on the vehicle 2-3 times repeatedly. If you will not be
turning on the ignition for more than a week in cold weather, it is
recommended that you park the vehicle inside a building, if possible.
4. Is there a possibility that extremely cold
weather can prevent vehicle startup?
H30
The sound you hear is normal. The noise emanates from the blower
motor starting up to remove any residual water vapor in the fuel cell
system. Also, when you turn on the vehicle you may hear a brief operation sound from the hydrogen storage system which is located on the
back of the vehicle. This is a normal sound which is occurred when the
system tries to balance the pressure between the hydrogen tanks.
Notice)
In particular, make sure to park the vehicle indoor when the temperature is below -30°C. If the vehicle is parked outside for over 12
hours under such weather fuel cell components may be damaged.
Also, avoid driving under such weather to prevent damaging the fuel
cell components.
Category
Questions
Answers
The noise is generated from the air compressor and cooling pump
5. Why is there an engine noise at low
working to supply air to the fuel cell or it's from Virtual Engine
speeds, even though there is no engine?
Sound System (VESS).
When you turn on the vehicle or turn off the vehicle in cold weather,
6. When turning on and off the vehicle in
the air compressor removes the generated water inside the fuel cell
cold weather, there's a loud noise. Is this system and the noise is generated during this process, which is nornoise cause for concern?
mal. In this case, certain amount of water may drain through the
vehicle bottom and exhaust pipe.
Vehicle
overview
(10 items)
7. Why does a noise emanate when the
vehicle moves in reverse?
Normally, the noise is a result of the Virtual Engine Sound System
(VESS) working when the FCEV runs at low velocity (1~12 mph
(1~20 km/h)) after shifting to D or N. However, when shifting to R,
the VESS operates immediately, regardless of vehicle speed. In
addition, a separate warning chime will sound to have the pedestrian aware of the approaching vehicle.
The transmission of standard vehicles delivers power as conditions
8. The FCEV is equipped with a reduction require via multiple transmission gears. However, the reduction gear
gear but no transmission. What makes it of the FCEV is designed to deliver power by reducing the motor's
different from standard vehicles?
RPM as operating conditions dictate, or to move backwards by
reversing the rotational direction of the shaft.
H31
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Questions
Answers
The high voltage battery and hydrogen tank are unlikely to be damaged
under normal driving conditions. However, if the system begins to mal9. Can driving on test roads or over speed function due to a direct and serious vehicular impact, you are informed
bumps damage the high voltage battery of those system errors via warning lights on and the LCD display.
and hydrogen tank?
• Service warning light :
Vehicle
overview
(10 items)
Water or vapor discharged is generated from electrochemical reactions in the fuel cell stack, and is not harmful to humans. However,
10. A water-like liquid is being discharged liquids generated from the reactions can be somewhat acidic, so DO
from the muffler and bottom of the vehi- NOT touch or ingest the liquid!
cle. Is it harmful to humans?
Also, the water discharged when parking the vehicle indoors may
make a puddle on the ground. Be careful as such puddle can freeze
and result in accident during winter.
H32
Category
Questions
Answers
Every component housed in the fuel cell power module compartment is designed to be waterproof like those found in standard vehicles. Therefore, a short circuit of the FCEV cannot happen while
11. Can I wash my FCEV with pressurized washing the car. However, your FCEV works by utilizing high-voltage
water? What if water flows into the fuel electric power, so it is recommended that you avoid high-pressure car
washes. If the insulation resistance of the FCEV deteriorates due to
cell power module compartment?
car wash, a High voltage warning light may turn on the cluster.
• Service warning light :
Vehicle
Management
(12 items)
12. When washing the fuel cell power module compartment, is there any potential
risk of electric shock resulting from a
high-voltage short circuit?
The FCEV is designed to be a waterproof structure, but please
avoid washing the inside of the compartment if possible. Because
there are many high voltage parts in the power module compartment.
The FCEV is designed to be a waterproof structure, but please
13. Can I wash the bottom of the vehicle? If
avoid washing the botttom of the vehicle if possible. Because there
yes, what should I be aware of?
are high voltage cables in the under cover.
14. Can driving with a tire chain affect the
drive motor?
Driving with a tire chain causes no direct damage to the drive motor.
15. How should I jump start the vehicle?
Try charging it by pressing the "12V BATT RESET" button first.
Refer to the "If the 12 volt battery is discharged" in this guide book.
It it doesn't work, refer to the "Jump starting" in the Owner's manual
chapter 6.
H33
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Answers
Stack cooling coolant is an exclusive coolant for the fuel cell, which
is characterized by its use of a non-ionic anti-corrosion agent (an
additive) and very low electric conductivity. In comparison, the
16. Does the FCEV use a different coolant device cooling coolant is a coolant similar to that used in standard
vehicles and has a very high electric conductivity.
type from that of standard vehicles?
(Difference between Stack cooling
If the stack cooling coolant is used with the electrical cooling syscoolant and Device cooling coolant.)
tem, it will corrode the electrical system parts. If the device cooling
coolant is used with the fuel cell cooling system, it will damage the
system insulation resistor due to high electric conductivity. This carries the additional risk of shocking the driver (electric shock).
17. What should I be aware of when parking the vehicle? Can I park the FCEV in Hydrogen gas supply is cutoff after Power-OFF to prevent the hydroan enclosed underground parking lot? gen gas from leaking.
Vehicle
(Risk of hydrogen gas leak.)
Management
(12 items)
For long-term parking situations, a high-voltage battery will gradually
lose its charge [low SOC(State Of Charge)], potentially causing ignition failure.
1. In order to minimize the discharge of the high-voltage battery, turn
off the power using the POWER button and disconnect the (-) terminal of the auxiliary battery (12 V) from the vehicle.
18. If the FCEV will be parked for a long
period, what should I do?
2. To recharge the high-voltage battery, it is recommended that you
drive your FCEV two or three times a month, for no less than 10
minutes or 2 miles (3 km) during each session.
3. If the vehicle does not startup, press the "12V BATT RESET" button or jump start the vehicle. Otherwise contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
H34
Questions
Category
Questions
Answers
DIY Check: Device cooling coolant, Stack cooling coolant, Brake
19. What are the do-it-yourself (DIY) main- Fluid, Tire and Wheels
tenance items for the FCEV?
DIY Maintenance: Washer fluid, Air cleaner, Climate control air filter,
Wiper blades, Fuse, Light bulb
20. What should I be aware of when doing Be careful not to touch the high-voltage cable (orange color),
DIY maintenance work?
coolant, and ion filter.
21. Tell me what the potential effects are of
parking long-term in a cold area (-4 °F
Vehicle
(-20 °C)) for the FCEV, and whether or
Management
not the vehicle can startup under such
(12 items)
conditions.
In most instances, the vehicle can be started in cold weather without
any problems. However, the vehicle may not start if it is parked with
the power off for over a week in cold temperatures. In this case, If
you will not be turning on the vehicle for more than a week in cold
weather, it is recommended that you park the vehicle inside a building, if possible.
High-voltage cable (orange color), ion filter, parts with a high voltage
warning sticker.
22. What parts must I not touch with
hands? For example, high-voltage
cable, ion filter, etc.?
Also, never touch the hydrogen storage system under the liftgate,
the hydrogen supply pipe under the vehicle and the hydrogen supply
system components on the right side (based on the driver’s position)
of the hood.
H35
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Questions
Answers
23. What shall I do if the hydrogen gas leak If the hydrogen gas leak warning light turns on during "READY" status or in driving mode, this indicates a hydrogen gas leak inside the
warning light turns on on the cluster?
vehicle. DO NOT lose your composure. Park your vehicle and turn
OFF the vehicle. Then, we recommend that you contact an author(Red)
ized HYUNDAI dealer for service.
24. Can I keep driving the vehicle even if
the hydrogen gas leak warning light
turns on on the cluster?
(Red)
Cluster/
25. While driving to a service center after
Warning Lamp
the hydrogen gas leak warning light
(9 items)
turns on on the cluster, is it possible
that the vehicle catch fire if there is
something nearby to ignite the leaking
gas (cigarette butt, etc.)?
The fuel cell stops working if hydrogen is no longer available. However,
the FCEV can run for an additional distance (About 2 miles (3 km)) in
EV mode where the vehicle runs only on battery power. Mileage in EV
mode can vary depending on the "state of charge" (SOC) of the high
voltage battery, so move your vehicle to the nearest shoulder on the
road. Then, we recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for service.
As soon as the hydrogen gas leak warning light appears, the fuel
cell operation is disabled immediately to cut the supply of hydrogen.
This prevents the possibility of a fire occurring.
(Red)
26. What should I do if a power down warn- If the power down warning light turns on during "READY" status or
in driving mode, power supply to the fuel cell system is cut off. If the
ing light turns on?
warning light turns on repeatedly when restarting the vehicle after
parking your car on the safe place, we recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for service.
H36
Category
Questions
Answers
27. What should I do if the service warning If the service warning light turns on during "READY" status or in
light turns on?
driving mode, it may indicate a malfunction in operation with any fuel
cell system. We recommend that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for service.
28. What should I do if the master warning If the service warning light turns on when there is a malfuction in
light turns on?
operation in any of the vehicle systems. Please look at the LCD display for details and we recommend that you contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for service if needed.
29. How much farther (roughly) can I drive
You can continue driving for an additional 40~55 miles (70~90 km).
my FCEV when the fuel warning light
It may depend on driving mode.
turns on? (Remaining mileage)
Cluster/
"
Warning Lamp 30. When restarting the vehicle, the "
indicator turns on on the cluster. What
(9 items)
does this mean?
31. Why does the vehicle’s hydrogen tank
have a life expectancy?
It means that the fuel cell system is working in good order and your
car is ready to drive.
The hydrogen tank is frequently refueled with the high pressure
hydrogen gas and the number of times refueling the vehicle is limited to 5,000 times (or 15 years). The hydrogen storage system
counts the number of times the vehicle is refueled and turns on the
warning light when the vehicle is refueled for over 4,995 times.
Every time the vehicle is turned on the warning message "Replace
hydrogen tank. Maximum number of refill cycles exceeded" is displayed on the cluster. The vehicle can be driven about 1-3 million
kilometers until the vehicle is refueled 5,000 times, meaning that the
hydrogen tank is used semi-permanently under common driving
condition.
H37
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Questions
Answers
The fuel cell stops working if hydrogen is no longer available.
However, the FCEV can run for an additional distance (About 2
miles (3 km)) in EV mode where the vehicle runs only on battery
32. What happens if hydrogen in the hydropower. Mileage in EV mode can vary depending on the "status of
gen tank is completely consumed?
charge" (SOC) of the high voltage battery, so move your vehicle to
the nearest shoulder on the road. Then, we recommend that you
contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for service.
Hydrogen
System
(7 items)
33. If the hydrogen gas tank is fully refueled, how much farther can the FCEV
run?
It can travel as far as 300~370 miles (500~600 km) at a constant
vehicle speed of 50 mph(80 kph). Realistically though, this travel
distance is shorter due to normal acceleration and deceleration
when driving.
The tank is refueled by utilizing the difference in hydrogen pressure
between the refueling station and the vehicle. When refueling, the
hydrogen gas pressure of the refueling station is higher than that of
34. Which mechanism allows for the hydro- the vehicle. The act of refueling can be stopped as desired.
gen gas tank to be refueled, and is it
Normally, the gas tank is not fully refueled with hydrogen if the stapossible to refuel the tank as much as tion's hydrogen pressure is not sufficiently high, or if the station sysyou need? Is it possible that the tank
tem cannot communicate with the vehicle.
may not be fully refueled?
❈ System and the vehicle communicates the temperature and pressure of hydrogen gas via wireless network.
H38
Category
Questions
Answers
Hydrogen
System
(7 items)
35. In the beginning, when driving the new
vehicle, I hear hissing sounds regularly
from the hood while the vehicle is
stopped. Is this noise cause for concern?
In the beginning, the purity of hydrogen in the hydrogen tank of the
new vehicle may be somewhat low. It is a normal noise which
occurs when the system discharges the hydrogen more frequently
compensating the low hydrogen purity. The fuel efficiency of the new
vehicle may be low in the beginning due to the frequent hydrogen
discharge. However, this is a normal condition. In general, the hydrogen purity returns to normal range after refueling 3-4 times.
H39
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Hydrogen
System
(7 items)
H40
Questions
Answers
* Close the fuel cap and fuel filler door firmly.
* The gas tank may not be fully filled depending on the conditions of
the hydrogen station.
* Carefully read any precautions about refueling at hydrogen gas
stations.
* Be careful not to cause static electricity when touching the fuel
filler with your hand. (To avoid static electricity, be sure to touch
your bare hand on something metallic as far from the fuel filler as
possible.)
36. How should I refuel the tank with hydro* DO NOT get out of, or go into, your car while the gas tank is being
gen gas? And what should I take care
refueled.
of?
* DO NOT use any mobile device. Fire may occur due to electric
current / radio wave from the mobile device.
* Make sure that the fuel cell system stops working before refueling
the gas tank.
* DO NOT smoke a cigarette or strike a lighter while refueling the
gas tank.
* If you need assistance with refueling the gas tank after completely
consuming all the available fuel in the vehicle, we recommend that
you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Category
Hydrogen
System
(7 items)
Questions
Answers
37. Is it possible that water, oil, etc. may be
Normally, water and oil cannot flow into the hydrogen tank via the
introduced to the hydrogen gas tank via
fuel filler, but it can flow in while refueling. Be careful not to introthe fuel filler? If yes, what do I need to
duce any contaminants via the fuel filler.
do to prevent this?
The hydrogen gas is in high pressure (70 MPa) condition when refueled to the vehicle's storage tank. Therefore, you will hear the sound
38. While refueling the hydrogen, I hear
of the gas flowing in the beginning. Abnormal noise is occurred due
irregular abnormal noises. Is this noise
to the gas flow because of the difference in refueling pressure, etc.
cause for concern?
depending on the gas pressure condition at the refueling station and
this is very normal.
H41
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Questions
39. What happens if hydrogen gas leaks
from the fuel cell stack?
(Red)
Fuel Cell
Stack/High
Voltage
Battery
(4 items)
Answers
If hydrogen gas leaks beyond what's tolerable from the fuel cell stack,
a hydrogen sensor installed in the system detects the leak and in
response, turns ON the hydrogen gas leak warning light in the cluster.
40. Can the fuel cell stack explode or burn The fuel cell stack passed a high temperature test and is deemed
out due to overheating?
safe, so it is unlikely to explode.
41. Which symptoms occur if the fuel cell
system malfunctions?
If the fuel cell system malfunctions, warning lights specific to the
actual problem appear on the LCD display. When this happens, the
vehicle speed may be limited, or the fuel cell system may shut
down. DO NOT lose your composure if this happens. Park your vehicle and turn OFF the vehicle. Then, we recommend that you contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for service.
Like any vehicle component, the high voltage battery will decrease
42. Is the recharge performance of the high
in performance as it ages over time. However, the high voltage batvoltage battery reduced depending on
tery of the FCEV is durable enough to work at peak performance
its length of use?
beyond the warranty period.
H42
Category
Questions
Answers
The FCEV is designed to detect impact events during a collision or
accident so that the hydrogen gas supply is immediately cutoff. Also,
43. Is there a risk of electric shock from the
the high-voltage relay is activated to cutoff the supply of electric power
high-voltage parts in the event of a collito the fuel cell stack and high-voltage battery. Moreover, the FCEV
sion or accident?
satisfies international electrical safety standards for collisions and
accidents.
Vehicle
Accidents/
Towing
(5 items)
Despite the uniqueness of the hydrogen FCEV, you do not have to
take any special safety precautions in the event of a minor collision or
accident. In the event of a minor accident, turn off the vehicle to cutoff
the supply of electric power and hydrogen gas. Also, the FCEV is
44. Should I take any special safety precauequipped with collision sensors at the front and rear of the vehicle so
tions in the event of a collision or accithose sensors are activated during an actual collision to automatically
dent?
cutoff the supply of power and hydrogen to ensure driver and passenger safety. For other situations, follow the same procedures as you
would with a standard vehicle. Depending on the severity of the collision or accident, take appropriate measures.
45. Is a high-voltage battery designed to
Our battery packs are designed to prevent any explosion due to
ensure occupant safety? Can it explode physical impact or damage, and they fully satisfy international safety
from a collision?
standards.
H43
CUSTOMER Q&A GUIDE (CONT.)
Category
Questions
Answers
46. Is a hydrogen tank designed to ensure
The hydrogen tank is designed to prevent any risk of explosion. It is
occupant safety? Can it explode from a
completely safe.
collision?
Vehicle
Accidents/
Towing
(5 items)
H44
47. How should the FCEV be towed, and
what precautions should be taken?
The FCEV can be towed in the same manner as standard vehicles. If
you need emergency towing, it is recommended that you contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. To avoid damage to the vehicle, you
need to follow proper pulling and towing procedures. The FCEV is
equipped with a front wheel drive (FWD) motor, so use a flatbed or
wheel dolly to tow the vehicle. If the front wheels touch the road surface while being towed, they will rotate and this can cause the FWD
motor to generate electricity. This can cause unwanted failure of the
FCEV.
Category
Questions
48. What should I do if the FCEV catches
fire?
Answers
1. Stop driving the car. Move the shift to P (Park), then step on the
brake to turn OFF the vehicle. The fuel cell stack is shut down,
which cuts off the supply of hydrogen fuel.
2. If possible, open the windows to ventilate the air.
3. If the fire is small enough to get under your own control, use the fire
extinguisher to put it out.
If the fire is much larger, get out of your car and contact the local
fire station to report your FECV is on fire. DO NOT get close to your
car before the fire is completely extinguished.
In the event your FCEV catches fire with the power system OFF, the
power source of the high-voltage system is cut off, so you are unlikely
49. In case of vehicle fire, should I use the to get shocked while you put out the fire using water. (Even when the
Explosion or
vehicle is submerged in water, there is no risk of getting shocked.)
fire extinguisher? Can I use water to
Fire (5 items)
extinguish the fire?
However, if your car catches fire with the ignition ON, you MUST use
the fire extinguisher. Any attempt to extinguish the fire with water may
cause electric shock.
50. What kind of fire extinguisher should I
use?
51. Can the hydrogen tank explode if it
overheats in very hot weather?
It is recommended that you use a dedicated fire extinguisher (CO2)
for an electrical fire of the high-voltage system.
The hydrogen tank passed a high temperature test and is deemed
safe, so it is unlikely to explode.
In case of vehicle fire, a heat-sensitive safety valve is activated to
exhaust the hydrogen gas downward from the tank by force.
52. In case of vehicle fire, is it possible that
Therefore, the hydrogen tank is unlikely to explode. However, addithe hydrogen tank will explode?
tional flames can flare up from the forced exhaustion of the gas, so
please evacuate to a safe place far away from the vehicle.
H45
Your vehicle at a glance
1
Your vehicle at a glance
Exterior Overview ..................................................1-2
Interior Overview ...................................................1-4
Instrument Panel Overview ..................................1-5
Fuel Cell Power Module Compartment ...............1-6
Your vehicle at a glance
EXTERIOR OVERVIEW
■ Front view
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
1. Hood......................................................3-42
5. Side view mirror ....................................3-31
2. Headlight ..............................................7-58
6. Sunroof..................................................3-37
3. Turn signal/daytime running lamp/
position lamp ........................................7-58
7. Front windshield wiper ..............3-103, 7-24
8. Windows ................................................3-33
4. Tires and wheels ............................7-29, 8-4
OFE018001N
1-2
■ Rear view
1
Your vehicle at a glance
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
1. Doors ....................................................3-11
6. High mounted stop lamp ......................7-59
2. Fuel filler door ......................................3-55
7. Rear window defroster ........................3-163
3. Rear lamps ............................................7-59
8. Rear view monitor ..............................3-111
4. Backup lamp..........................................7-59
9. Antenna ..................................................4-2
5. Liftgate ..................................................3-43
10. Rear window wiper ..................3-106, 7-26
OFE018002N
1-3
Your vehicle at a glance
INTERIOR OVERVIEW
1. Inside door handle ................................3-14
2. Side view mirror folding switch ..............3-32
3. Side view mirror control switch ..............3-31
4. Central door lock switch ........................3-15
5. Power window lock switch......................3-36
6. Power window switches ........................3-33
7. Instrument panel illumination
control switch ........................................3-59
8. ESC OFF button ....................................5-31
9. H2O OUT ..............................................3-89
10. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system ....5-79
11. Blind-spot Collision-avoidance
Assist (BCA) system ............................5-53
12. Power liftgate button ............................3-45
13. 12V battery reset button ........................6-5
14. Steering wheel tilt/telescope lever ......3-21
15. Steering wheel ....................................3-20
16. Seat........................................................2-4
17. Hood release lever ..............................3-42
18. Power outlet, USB charger ....3-168, 3-171
19. Fuel filler door opener button ..............3-55
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OFE019003L
1-4
INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW
1
2. Horn ........................................................3-21
3. Driver's front air bag ................................2-49
4. POWER button ..........................................5-6
5. Light control ............................................3-91
6. Wiper/Washer ........................................3-103
7. Navigation system ....................................4-4
8. Hazard warning flasher ............................6-2
9. Climate control system ..........................3-149
10. Passenger's front air bag ......................2-49
11. Glove box ............................................3-165
12. USB and iPod® port ................................4-2
13. Reduction gear (Shift button) ................5-11
14. Drive mode button ................................5-37
15. Surround view monitor ........................3-112
16. Parking Distance Warning button ........3-108
17. Remote Smart Parking Assist (RSPA)
button ..................................................3-115
18. DIS controller ......................................3-125
19. Cup holder ..........................................3-166
20. Steering wheel audio controls ................4-3
21. Trip computer/ ........................................3-85
Smart cruise controls/ ..........................5-99
The actual shape may differ from the illustration.
OFE018004
1-5
Your vehicle at a glance
1. Instrument cluster....................................3-58
Your vehicle at a glance
FUEL CELL POWER MODULE COMPARTMENT
1. Brake fluid reservoir..........................7-19
2. Air cleaner.........................................7-20
3. Fuse box ...........................................7-53
4. Windshield washer fluid reservoir .....7-20
5. Device cooling coolant reservoir.......7-13
6. Device cooling radiator cap ..............7-14
7. Stack cooling coolant reservoir.........7-17
8. Stack cooling radiator cap ................7-17
The actual Fuel cell power module compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
1-6
OFE071001N
Safety system of your vehicle
This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect yourself and your passengers.
It explains how to properly use your seats and seat belts, and how your air bags work.
Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.
2
Important Safety Precautions..............................2-2
Child Restraint System (CRS).............................2-36
Always Wear Your Seat Belt ..........................................2-2
Restrain All Children .........................................................2-2
Air Bag Hazards.................................................................2-2
Driver Distraction ..............................................................2-2
Control Your Speed...........................................................2-3
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition............................2-3
Children Always in the Rear.........................................2-36
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) .................2-37
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)..................2-39
Seats ........................................................................2-4
Safety Precautions ...........................................................2-5
Front Seats .........................................................................2-6
Rear Seats.........................................................................2-10
Head Restraints ...............................................................2-13
Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats...................2-17
Seat Belts ..............................................................2-21
Seat Belt Safety Precautions.......................................2-21
Seat Belt Warning Light ................................................2-22
Seat Belt Restraint System...........................................2-24
Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions...................2-32
Care of Seat Belts...........................................................2-35
Air Bag
- Advanced Supplemental Restraint System ...2-47
Where Are the Air Bags?..............................................2-49
How Does the Air Bag System Operate?..................2-52
What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates................2-57
Occupant Classification System (OCS).......................2-58
Why Didn't My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? ........2-60
SRS Care............................................................................2-60
Additional Safety Precautions .....................................2-60
Air Bag Warning Labels.................................................2-60
Why Didn't My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? ........2-63
SRS Care............................................................................2-68
Additional Safety Precautions .....................................2-69
Air Bag Warning Labels.................................................2-69
Active Hood Lift System .....................................2-70
System activation ............................................................2-70
System limitation .............................................................2-71
System malfunction........................................................2-72
Safety system of your vehicle
IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
You will find many safety precautions
and recommendations throughout
this section, and throughout this
manual. The safety precautions in
this section are among the most
important.
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
A seat belt is your best protection in
all types of accidents. Air bags are
designed to supplement seat belts,
not replace them. So even though
your vehicle is equipped with air
bags, ALWAYS make sure you and
your passengers wear your seat
belts, and wear them properly.
2-2
Restrain All Children
Driver Distraction
All children under age 13 should ride
in your vehicle properly restrained in
a rear seat, not the front seat. Infants
and small children should be
restrained in an appropriate child
restraint. Larger children should use
a booster seat with the lap/shoulder
belt until they can use the seat belt
properly without a booster seat.
Driver distraction presents a serious
and potentially deadly danger, especially for inexperienced drivers.
Safety should be the first concern
when behind the wheel and drivers
need to be aware of the wide array of
potential distractions, such as
drowsiness, reaching for objects,
eating, personal grooming, other
passengers, and using cellular
phones.
Drivers can become distracted when
they take their eyes and attention off
the road or their hands off the wheel
to focus on activities other than driving. To reduce your risk of distraction
or getting into an accident:
• ALWAYS set up your mobile
devices (for example, MP3 players,
phones, navigation units, etc.)
when your vehicle is parked or
safely stopped.
Air Bag Hazards
While air bags can save lives, they
can also cause serious or fatal
injuries to occupants who sit too
close to them, or who are not properly restrained. Infants, young children, and shorter adults are at the
greatest risk of being injured by an
inflating air bag. Follow all instructions and warnings in this manual.
Control Your Speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in
crash injuries and deaths. Generally,
the higher the speed, the greater the
risk, but serious injuries can also
occur at lower speeds. Never drive
faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
• ONLY use your mobile device
when allowed by laws and when
conditions permit safe use. NEVER
text or email while driving. Most
states have laws prohibiting drivers
from texting. Some states and
cities also prohibit drivers from
using handheld phones.
• NEVER let the use of a mobile
device distract you from driving.
You have a responsibility to your
passengers and others on the road
to always drive safely, with your
hands on the wheel as well as your
eyes and attention on the road.
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe
Condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous. To reduce the possibility of
such problems, check your tire pressures and condition frequently, and
perform all regularly scheduled
maintenance.
2-3
Safety system of your vehicle
SEATS
Front seats
(1) Seat sliding forward or rearward
(2) Seatback angle adjustment
(3) Seat cushion angle adjustment
(4) Lumbar support adjustment
(Driver’s seat)*
(5) Seat warmer / Air ventilation seat*
(6) Head restraint
Rear seats
(7) Armrest
(8) Seatback angle and folding adjustment
(9) Head restraint
(10) Seat warmer*
* : If equipped
OFE038001
2-4
Air bags
Adjusting the seats so that you are
sitting in a safe, comfortable position
plays an important role in driver and
passenger safety together with the
seat belts and air bags in an accident.
You can take steps to reduce the risk
of being injured by an inflating air
bag. Sitting too close to an air bag
greatly increases the risk of injury in
the event the air bag inflates.
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) recommends that drivers allow at least 10
inches (25 cm) between the center of
the steering wheel and their chest.
WARNING
Do not use a cushion that
reduces friction between the
seat and the passenger. The
passenger's hips may slide
under the lap portion of the seat
belt during an accident or a
sudden stop. Serious or fatal
internal injuries could result
because the seat belt cannot
operate properly.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
air bag, take the following precautions:
• Adjust the driver's seat as far
to the rear as possible while
maintaining the ability to
maintain full control of the
vehicle.
• Adjust the front passenger
seat as far to the rear as possible.
• Hold the steering wheel by the
rim with your hands at the 9
o'clock and 3 o'clock positions to minimize the risk of
injuries to your hands and
arms.
• NEVER place anything or anyone between the steering
wheel and the air bag.
• Do not allow the front passenger to place feet or legs on the
dashboard to minimize the
risk of leg injuries.
Seat belts
Always fasten your seat belt before
starting any trip.
At all times, passengers should sit
upright and be properly restrained.
Infants and small children must be
restrained in appropriate child
restraint systems. Adults and children who have outgrown a booster
seat must be restrained using the
seat belts.
2-5
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Safety Precautions
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when adjusting your seat belt:
• NEVER use one seat belt for
more than one occupant.
• Always position the seatback
upright with the lap portion of
the seat belt snug and low
across the hips.
• NEVER allow children or
small infants to ride on a passenger's lap.
• Do not route the seat belt
across your neck, across
sharp edges, or reroute the
shoulder strap away from
your body.
• Do not allow the seat belt to
become caught or jammed.
2-6
Front Seats
• Use extreme caution when
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when adjusting your seat:
• NEVER attempt to adjust the
seat while the vehicle is moving. The seat could respond
with unexpected movement
and may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
• Do not place anything under
the front seats. Loose objects
in the driver's foot area could
interfere with the operation of
the foot pedals, causing an
accident.
• Do not allow anything to interfere with the normal position
and proper locking of the seatback.
• Do not place a cigarette lighter
on the floor or seat. When you
operate the seat, gas may exit
out of the lighter causing a fire.
picking up small objects
trapped under the seats or
between the seat and the center console. Your hands might
be cut or injured by the sharp
edges of the seat mechanism.
CAUTION
To prevent injury:
• Do not adjust your seat while
wearing your seat belt.
Moving the seat cushion forward may cause strong pressure on your abdomen.
• Do not allow your hands or
fingers to get caught in the
seat mechanisms while the
seat is moving.
Power adjustment
WARNING
NEVER allow children in the
vehicle unattended. The power
seats are operable when the
vehicle is turned off.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seats:
• Always stop adjusting the seats
when the seat has moved as far
forward or rearward as possible.
• Do not adjust the seats for
longer than necessary when the
vehicle is turned off. This may
result in unnecessary battery
drain.
• Do not operate two or more
seats at the same time. This may
result in an electrical malfunction.
2
OFE038002
Forward and rearward adjustment
To move the seat forward or rearward:
1. Push the control switch forward or
rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
2-7
Safety system of your vehicle
The front seat can be adjusted by
using the control switches located on
the outside of the seat cushion. Before
driving, adjust the seat to the proper
position so that you can easily control
the steering wheel, foot pedals and
controls on the instrument panel.
Safety system of your vehicle
Reclining seatback
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the
protection of your restraint system
(seat belts and air bags) is greatly
reduced by reclining your seatback.
WARNING
OFE038003
Seatback angle
To adjust the seatback:
1. Rotate the top of control switch
forward or rearward.
2. Release the switch once the seatback reaches the desired position.
2-8
NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving.
Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious
or fatal injuries in the event of a
collision or sudden stop.
Driver and passengers should
ALWAYS sit well back in their
seats, seats with the seatbacks
upright and should be belted
properly.
Seat belts must be snug against your
hips and chest to work properly.
When the seatback is reclined, the
shoulder belt cannot do its job
because it will not be snug against
your chest. Instead, it will be in front
of you. During an accident, you could
be thrown into the seat belt, causing
neck or other injuries.
The more the seatback is reclined,
the greater chance the passenger’s
hips will slide under the lap belt or
the passenger's neck will strike the
shoulder belt.
Seat height
To change the height of the seat :
Push the rear portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower
the height of the seat.
Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
2
OFE038005
Lumbar support (for driver's seat)
The lumbar support can be adjusted
by pressing the lumbar support
switch.
• Press the front portion of the
switch (1) to increase support or
the rear portion of the switch (2) to
decrease support.
2-9
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038004
Seat cushion tilt
To change the angle of the front part
of the seat cushion:
Push the front portion of the control
switch up to raise or down to lower
the front part of the seat cushion.
Release the switch once the seat
reaches the desired position.
Safety system of your vehicle
Seatback pocket
CAUTION
Rear Seats
Rear seat adjustment
Do not put heavy or sharp
objects in the seatback pockets.
In an accident they could come
loose from the pocket and
injure occupants.
OFE038012
The seatback pocket is provided on
the back of the front passenger's
seatback.
WARNING
To prevent the Occupant
Classification System from malfunctioning:
Do not hang onto the front passenger's seatback.
2-10
OFE038016N
Seatback angle
To recline the seatback:
1. Pull up the seatback recline lever.
2. Hold the lever and adjust the seatback of the seat to the position
you desire.
3. Release the lever and make sure
the seatback is locked in place.
(The lever MUST return to its original
position for the seatback to lock.)
Folding the rear seat
The rear seatbacks can be folded to
facilitate carrying long items or to
increase the luggage capacity of the
vehicle.
To fold down the rear seatback:
1. Set the front seatback to the
upright position and if necessary,
slide the front seat forward.
2
• Never allow passengers to sit
on top of the folded down
seatback while the vehicle is
moving. This is not a proper
seating position and no seat
belts are available for use.
This could result in serious
injury or death in case of an
accident or sudden stop.
• Objects carried on the folded
down seatback should not
extend higher than the top of
the front seatbacks. This
could allow cargo to slide forward and cause injury or damage during sudden stops.
OFE038015
OFE038014
3. Locate the seatbelt toward the
outboard position before folding
down the seatback. If not, the
seatbelt system may be interfered
by the seatback.
2. Lower the rear head restraints to
the lowest position by pushing and
holding the release button (1) and
pushing down on the headrest (2).
2-11
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
OFE038016
OFE038018N
5. To use the rear seat, lift and unfold
the seatback to the upright position by pulling up the recline lever.
Push the seatback firmly until it
clicks into place. Make sure the
seatback is locked in place.
6. Return the rear seat belt to the
proper position. Insert the belt in
the guide located on the side of
the rear head restraints.
OFE038017
4. Put out the belt from guide (1) and
pull up the seatback folding lever
(2), then fold the seat toward the
front of the vehicle.
2-12
When returning the rear seatback from a folded to an upright
position, hold the seatback and
return it slowly. Ensure that the
seatback is completely locked
into its upright position by
pushing on the top of the seatback. In an accident or sudden
stop, the unlocked seatback
could allow cargo to move forward with great force and enter
the passenger compartment,
which could result in serious
injury or death.
WARNING
Do not place objects in the rear
seats, since they cannot be
properly secured and may hit
vehicle occupants in a collision
causing serious injury or death.
WARNING
Armrest
Head Restraints
CAUTION
• Be careful when loading
cargo through the rear passenger seats to prevent damage to the vehicle interior.
• When cargo is loaded through
the rear passenger seats,
ensure the cargo is properly
secured to prevent it from
moving while driving.
• Unsecured cargo in the passenger compartment can
cause damage to the vehicle
or injury to it's occupants.
WARNING
OFE038019
The armrest is located in the center
of the rear seat. Use the strap in the
center of the armrest to pull it down.
To help reduce the risk of serious injury or death in an accident, take the following precautions when adjusting your head
restraints:
• Always properly adjust the
head restraints for all passengers BEFORE starting the
vehicle.
• NEVER let anyone ride in a
seat with the head restraints
removed or reversed.
2-13
2
Safety system of your vehicle
The vehicle's front and rear seats
have adjustable head restraints. The
head restraints provide comfort for
passengers, but more importantly
they are designed to help protect
passengers from whiplash and other
neck and spinal injuries during an
accident, especially in a rear impact
collision.
Make sure the vehicle is off,
shifted to P(Park), and the parking brake is securely applied
whenever loading or unloading
cargo. Failure to take these steps
may allow the vehicle to move if
the shift lever is inadvertently
moved to another position.
Safety system of your vehicle
Front seat head restraints
NOTICE
•
To prevent damage, NEVER hit or
pull on the head restraints.
CAUTION
OLF034072N
Adjust the head restraints so
the middle of the head
restraint is at the same height
as the height of the top of the
eyes.
• NEVER adjust the head
restraint position of the driver's seat when the vehicle is
in motion.
• Adjust the head restraint as
close to the passenger's head
as possible. Do not use a seat
cushion that holds the body
away from the seatback.
• Make sure the head restraint
locks into position after
adjusting it.
2-14
When there is no occupant in
the rear seats, adjust the height
of the headrest to the lowest
position. The rear seat headrest
can reduce the visibility of the
rear area.
OOSEV038012L
The vehicle's front and passenger's
seats are equipped with adjustable
head restraints for the passengers
safety and comfort.
NOTICE
2
OFE038008
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the head restraint:
1. Recline the seatback (2) rearward
using the seatback angle lever/
switch (1).
2. Raise the head restraint as far as
it can go.
3. Press the head restraint release
button (3) while pulling the head
restraint up (4).
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button
(2) on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
OLF034015
If you recline the seatback towards
the front with the head restraint
and seat cushion raised, the head
restraint may come in contact with
the sunvisor or other parts of the
vehicle.
2-15
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038006
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position
(1).
Safety system of your vehicle
Rear seat head restraints
CAUTION
• Adjust the headrests so the
middle of the head restraints
is at the same height as the
height of the top of the eyes.
OFE038009
To reinstall the head restraint:
1. Put the head restraint poles (2) into
the holes while pressing the
release button (1).
2. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
3. Adjust the seatback (4) forward
using the seatback angle lever/
switch (3).
2-16
OOSEV038030L
The rear seats are equipped with
head restraints in all the seating
positions for the passenger's safety
and comfort.
• When seated in the rear seat,
do not adjust the height of the
head restraint to the lowest
position.
Seat Warmers and Air
Ventilation Seats
Front seat warmers (if equipped)
Seat warmers are provided to warm
the seats during cold weather.
OFE038013
Adjusting the height up and down
To raise the head restraint:
1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).
To lower the head restraint:
1. Push and hold the release button
(2) on the head restraint support.
2. Lower the head restraint to the
desired position (3).
OFE038055L
Removal/Reinstallation
To remove the head restraint:
1. Raise the head restraint as far as
it can go.
2. Press the head restraint release
button (1) while pulling the head
restraint up (2).
To reinstall the head restraint:
1. Put the head restraint poles into
the holes (3) while pressing the
release button (1).
2. Adjust the head restraint to the
appropriate height.
The seat warmers can cause a
SERIOUS BURN, even at low
temperatures and especially if
used for long periods of time.
Passengers must be able to feel
if the seat is becoming too warm
so they can turn it off, if needed.
People who cannot detect temperature change or pain to the
skin should use extreme caution, especially the following
types of passengers:
• Infants, children, elderly or
disabled persons, or hospital
outpatients.
• People with sensitive skin or
who burn easily.
• Fatigued individuals.
• Intoxicated individuals.
2-17
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
2
Safety system of your vehicle
During mild weather or under conditions where the operation of the seat
warmer is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
• Each time you push the switch, the
temperature setting of the seat is
changed as follows :
■ Type A
can cause drowsiness or
sleepiness.
WARNING
LOW (
OFE038010
■ Type B
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the seat
warmers and seats:
• Never use a solvent such as
paint thinner, benzene, alcohol
or gasoline to clean the seats.
• Do not place heavy or sharp
objects on seats equipped with
seat warmers.
• Do not change the seat cover. It
may damage the seat warmer.
2-18
→
HIGH (
→
OFF
)
→
NEVER place anything on the
seat that insulates against heat
when the seat warmer is in operation, such as a blanket or seat
cushion. This may cause the
seat warmer to overheat, causing a burn or damage to the seat.
)
→
• People taking medication that
MEDIUM (
)
• When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the seat
warmer operating, the seat warmer
will turn OFF.
• The seat warmer defaults to the
OFF position each time the
POWER button is turned to the ON
position.
i Information
OFE038051
While the vehicle is ON, push either
of the switches to warm the driver's
seat or front passenger's seat.
With the seat warmer switch in the
ON position, the heating system in the
seat turns off or on automatically
depending on the seat temperature.
Front air ventilation seat
(if equipped)
• Each time you push the switch, the
airflow changes as follows:
→
HIGH (
MEDIUM (
)
• When pressing the switch for more
than 1.5 seconds with the air ventilation seat operating, the operation
will turn OFF.
• The air ventilation seats defaults to
the OFF position each time the
POWER button is placed to the ON
position.
To prevent damage to the air ventilation seat:
• Use the air ventilation seat ONLY
when the climate control system
is on. Using the air ventilation
seat for prolonged periods of
time with the climate control
system off could cause the air
ventilation seat to malfunction.
• Never use a solvent such as
paint thinner, benzene, alcohol
or gasoline to clean the seats.
• Avoid spilling liquids on the surface of the front seats and seatbacks; this may cause the air
vent holes to become blocked
and not work properly.
• Do not place materials such as
plastic bags or newspapers
under the seats. They may block
the air intake causing the air
vents to not work properly.
2-19
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038011
The air ventilation seats are provided
to cool the front seats by blowing air
through small vent holes on the surface of the seat cushions and seatbacks.
When the operation of the air ventilation seat is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
While the vehicle is ON, push the
switch to cool the driver's seat or the
front passenger's seat.
)
→
LOW (
)
→
→
OFF
NOTICE
Safety system of your vehicle
Rear seat warmers (For CANADA)
Each time you push the switch,
thetemperature setting of the seat
ischanged as follows :
OFF → HIGH (
) → LOW (
)
→
• Do not change the seat covers. It
may damage the air ventilation
seat.
• If the air vents do not operate,
restart the vehicle. If there is no
change, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
The seat warmer defaults to the OFF
position whenever the POWER button is placed to the ON position.
i Information
OFE038056L
While the vehicle is ON, pusheither
of the switches to warm the rearseat.
During mild weather or under conditions where the operation of the seatwarmer is not needed, keep the
switches in the OFF position.
2-20
With the seat warmer switch in the
ON position, the heating system in
theseat turns off oron automaticallydepending on the seat temperature.
SEAT BELTS
This section describes how to use the
seat belts properly. It also describes
some of the things to avoid when
using seat belts.
• Do not use a seat belt if the
in the front passenger seat. If
a child age 13 or older must be
seated in the front seat, move
the seat as far back as possible. And the child must always
be restrained in the seat properly.
NEVER allow an infant or child
to be carried on an occupant’s
lap.
NEVER ride with the seatback
reclined when the vehicle is
moving.
Do not allow children to share
a seat or seat belt.
Do not wear the shoulder belt
under your arm or behind your
back.
Always wear both the shoulder portion and lap portion of
the lap/shoulder belt.
Do not use the seat belt if it is
twisted. A twisted seat belt
will not protect you properly
in an accident.
webbing or hardware is damaged.
Do not latch the seat belt into
the buckles of other seats.
NEVER unfasten the seat belt
while driving. This may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Make sure there is nothing in
the buckle interfering with the
seat belt latch mechanism.
This may prevent the seat belt
from fastening securely.
No modifications or additions
should be made by the user
which will either prevent the
seat belt adjusting devices
from operating to remove
slack, or prevent the seat belt
assembly from being adjusted
to remove slack.
Seat Belt Safety Precautions
Always fasten your seat belt and
make sure all passengers have fastened their seat belts before starting
any trip. Air bags are designed to
supplement the seat belt as an additional safety device, but they are not a
substitute. Most states require all
occupants of a vehicle to wear seat
belts.
WARNING
Seat belts must be used by ALL
passengers whenever the vehicle is moving. Take the following
precautions when adjusting and
wearing seat belts:
• ALWAYS properly restrain
children under age 13 in the
rear seats.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
2-21
2
Safety system of your vehicle
• NEVER allow children to ride
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
Damaged seat belts and seat
belt assemblies will not operate
properly. Always replace:
• Frayed, contaminated, or damaged webbing
• Damaged hardware
• The entire seat belt assembly
after it has been worn in an
accident, even if damage to
webbing or assembly is not
apparent
Seat Belt Warning Light
Seat belt warning light
OLMB033022
Driver's seat belt warning
As a reminder to the driver, the seat
belt warning light will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds each time
the POWER button is turned ON
regardless of belt fastening. At this
time, if the seat belt is not fastened a
warning chime will sound for 6 seconds.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 6 mph
(9 km/h), the warning light will stay
illuminated.
2-22
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 12 mph
(20 km/h) the seat belt warning chime
will sound for approximately 100 seconds and the corresponding warning
light will blink.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving under 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning light will illuminate
until the seat belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
i Information
• Although the front passenger seat is
not occupied, the seat belt warning
light will blink or illuminate for 6
seconds.
Also, when the front passenger gets
out of the vehicle while the warning
is activating, the warning may continue for 6 seconds even after the
passenger gets off.
• The front passenger's seat belt
warning light may not properly
operate if the front passenger does
not sit properly in the seat.
• The front passenger's seat belt
warning may operate when luggage,
electronic device, etc., are placed on
the front passenger seat.
2-23
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038020N
Front passenger's seat belt warning
As a reminder to the front passenger,
the front passenger's seat belt warning lights will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds each time the
POWER button is turned ON position
regardless of belt fastening.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 6 mph
(9 km/h), the warning light will stay
illuminated.
If you continue not to fasten the seat
belt and you drive over 12 mph
(20 km/h) the seat belt warning chime
will sound for approximately 100 seconds and the corresponding warning
light will blink.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving under 12 mph (20 km/h) the
seat belt warning light will illuminate
until the seat belt is fastened.
If you unfasten the seat belt while
driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the
seat belt warning chime will sound for
approximately 100 seconds and the
corresponding warning light will blink.
Safety system of your vehicle
Seat Belt Restraint System
WARNING
Improperly positioned seat belts
may increase the risk of serious
injury in an accident. Take the following precautions when adjusting the seat belt:
• Position the lap portion of the
seat belt as low as possible
across your hips, not on your
waist, so that it fits snugly.
• Position one arm under the
shoulder belt and the other over
the belt, as shown in the illustration.
• Always position the shoulder
belt anchor into the locked
position at the appropriate
height.
• Never position the shoulder
belt across your neck or face.
2-24
Seat Belt-Driver's 3-point system with emergency locking
retractor
OHSS038102L
OHSS038101
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor
and insert the metal tab (1) into the
buckle (2). There will be an audible
"click" when the tab locks into the
buckle.
You should place the lap belt (1) portion across your hips and the shoulder belt (2) portion across your
chest.
The seat belt automatically adjusts to
the proper length after the lap belt
portion is adjusted manually so that it
fits snugly around your hips. If you
lean forward in a slow, easy motion,
the belt will extend and move with
you.
If there is a sudden stop or impact,
the belt will lock into position. It will
also lock if you try to lean forward too
quickly.
NOTICE
If you are not able to smoothly pull
enough of the seat belt out from
the retractor, firmly pull the seat
belt out and release it. After
release, you will be able to pull the
belt out smoothly.
OFE038021
OHSS038103
To adjust the height of the seat belt
anchor, lower or raise the height
adjuster into an appropriate position.
To raise the height adjuster, pull it up
(1). To lower it, push it down (3) while
pressing the height adjuster button
(2).
Release the button to lock the
anchor into position. Try sliding the
height adjuster to make sure that it
has locked into position.
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the
locking buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen,
check the belt to be sure it is not
twisted, then try again.
2-25
Safety system of your vehicle
Height adjustment
You can adjust the height of the
shoulder belt anchor to one of the
three different positions for maximum
comfort and safety.
The shoulder portion should be
adjusted so it lies across your chest
and midway over your shoulder nearest the door, not over your neck.
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Rear Seat Belt – Passenger's 3point system with convertible
locking retractor
This type of seat belt combines the
features of both an emergency locking
retractor seat belt and an automatic
locking retractor seat belt. Convertible
retractor type seat belts are installed in
the rear seat positions to help accommodate the installation of child
restraint systems. Although a convertible retractor is also installed in the
front passenger seat position, NEVER
place any infant/child restraint system
in the front seat of the vehicle.
2-26
To fasten your seat belt:
Pull the seat belt out of the retractor
and insert the metal tab into the buckle. There will be an audible "click"
when the tab locks into the buckle.
When not securing a child restraint,
the seat belt operates in the same way
as the driver's seat belt (Emergency
Locking Retractor Type). It automatically adjusts to the proper length only
after the lap belt portion of the seat
belt is adjusted manually so that it fits
snugly across your hips.
When the seat belt is fully extended
from the retractor to allow the installation of a child restraint system, the
seat belt operation changes to allow
the belt to retract, but not to extend
(Automatic Locking Retractor Type).
Refer to the "Using a Child Restraint
System" section in this chapter.
NOTICE
Although the seat belt retractor
provides the same level of protection for seated passengers in
either emergency or automatic
locking modes, the emergency
locking mode allows seated passengers to move freely in their
seat while keeping some tension
on the belt. During a collision or
sudden stop, the retractor automatically locks the belt to help
restrain your body.
To deactivate the automatic locking mode, unbuckle the seat belt
and allow the belt to fully retract.
To fasten the rear center seat
belt
OHSS038103
To release your seat belt:
Press the release button (1) in the
locking buckle.
When it is released, the belt should
automatically draw back into the
retractor. If this does not happen,
check the belt to be sure it is not
twisted, then try again.
OTLE035079
OFE038059L
1. Extract the small tongue plate (A)
from the slot on the belt assembly
pocket located in the headliner.
2-27
2
Safety system of your vehicle
2. Insert the small tongue plate (A)
into the primary buckle (A') located on the right hand (passenger)
side of the center seat. Insert the
buckle until an audible "click" is
heard, indicating that the latch is
locked. Make sure the belt is not
twisted.
Safety system of your vehicle
4. Pull the large tongue plate and
insert it into the seat belt buckle
(B') located on the left hand (driver) side of the center seat. Insert
the buckle until an audible "click"
is heard, indicating that the latch is
locked. Make sure the belt is not
twisted.
OFE038060L
When using the rear center seat belt,
the buckle with the "CENTER" mark
must be used.
i Information
If you are not able to pull out the safety belt from the retractor, firmly pull
the belt out and release it. After
release, you will be able to pull the belt
out smoothly.
OTLE035028
3. Slip the large tongue plate (B) out
of the pocket (C) located on the
belt assembly.
2-28
To release the rear center seatbelt
OTL035031
1. Press the release button on the
rear center seat belt buckle (B')
located on the left hand (driver)
side of the center seat and
remove the large tongue plate (B).
2
OTLE035078
4. Insert the small tongue plate (A)
into the slot on the belt assembly
pocket located in the headliner.
OFE038062N
2-29
Safety system of your vehicle
OTLE035032
2. To release and retract the rear
center seatbelt assembly, insert a
small tool or key into the primary
buckle release hole (A') located on
the right hand (passenger) side of
the center seat. You can also
insert the large buckle (B) into the
release hole to release the seat
belt assembly.
Pull up on the seat belt webbing
and allow the webbing to retract
automatically.
3. Slip the large tongue plate (B) into
the pocket (C) located on the belt
assembly.
Safety system of your vehicle
Pre-tensioner seat belt
(Driver and front passenger)
OTL035053
Your vehicle is equipped with driver's
and front passenger's Pre-tensioner
Seat Belts (Retractor Pretensioner
and Emergency Fastening Device
System). The purpose of the pre-tensioner is to make sure the seat belts
fit tightly against the occupant's body
in certain frontal or side collision(s).
The Emergency Fastening Device
System may be activated in certain
crashes where the frontal collision(s)
is severe enough, together with the air
bags.
2-30
When the vehicle stops suddenly, or
if the occupant tries to lean forward
too quickly, the seat belt retractor will
lock into position. In certain frontal or
side collision(s), the pre-tensioner
will activate and pull the seat belt into
tighter contact against the occupant's body.
(1) Retractor Pretensioner
The purpose of the retractor pretensioner is to make sure that the
shoulder belts fit in tightly against
the occupant's upper body in certain frontal or side collision(s).
(2) Emergency Fastening Device
System
The purpose of the Emergency
Fastening Device System is to
make sure that the pelvis belts fit
in tightly against the occupant’s
lower body in certain frontal collision(s).
If the system senses excessive tension on the driver or passenger's
seat belt when the pre-tensioner system activates, the load limiter inside
the retractor pre-tensioner will
release some of the pressure on the
affected seat belt.
WARNING
• Always wear your seat belt and
sit properly in your seat.
• Do not use the seat belt if it is
•
•
•
•
loose or twisted. A loose or
twisted seat belt will not protect you properly in an accident.
Do not place anything near the
buckle. This may adversely
affect the buckle and cause it
to function improperly.
Always replace your pre-tensioners after activation or an
accident.
NEVER inspect, service, repair
or replace the pre-tensioners
by yourself. This must be done
by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Do not hit the seat belt assemblies.
NOTICE
WARNING
OLMB033040/Q
The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System
consists mainly of the following components. Their locations are shown in
the illustration above:
1. SRS air bag warning light
2. Retractor pre-tensioner
3. SRS control module
4. Emergency fastening device
The sensor that activates the SRS
air bag is connected with the
pre–tensioner seat belts. The SRS
air bag warning light on the instrument panel will illuminate for
approximately 6 seconds after the
POWER button is placed to the ON
position, and then it should turn
off.
If the pre-tensioner is not working
properly, the warning light will illuminate even if the SRS air bag is
not malfunctioning. If the warning
light does not illuminate, stays
illuminated or illuminates when
the vehicle is being driven, have
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
inspect the pre-tensioner seat
belts and SRS air bags as soon as
possible.
2-31
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Do not touch the pre-tensioner
seat belt assemblies for several
minutes after they have been
activated. When the pre-tensioner seat belt mechanism
deploys during a collision, the
pre-tensioners become hot and
can burn you.
Safety system of your vehicle
NOTICE
• Both the driver's and front passenger's pre-tensioner seat
belts may be activated in certain
frontal or side collisions or
rollovers.
• When the pre-tensioner seat
belts are activated, a loud noise
may be heard and fine dust,
which may appear to be smoke,
may be visible in the passenger
compartment. These are normal
operating conditions and are not
hazardous.
• Although it is non-toxic, the fine
dust may cause skin irritation
and should not be inhaled for
prolonged periods. Wash all
exposed skin areas thoroughly
after an accident in which the
pre-tensioner seat belts were
activated.
2-32
Additional Seat Belt Safety
Precautions
Seat belt use during pregnancy
The seat belt should always be used
during pregnancy. The best way to
protect your unborn child is to protect
yourself by always wearing the seat
belt.
Pregnant women should always wear
a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the
shoulder belt across your chest, routed between your breasts and away
from your neck. Place the lap belt line
so that it fits snugly and as low as possible across the hips, not across the
abdomen.
WARNING
• Fasten your seat belt while
sitting properly in an upright
position to maximize the
effectiveness of the pre-tensioner seat belt system.
• A pre-tensioner seat belt system is designed to activate
only once. Replace the pretensioner seat belt system, if it
was activated in an accident.
WARNING
• Pregnant women and patients
are more vulnerable to any
impacts on the abdomen during an abrupt stop or accident. If you are in an accident
while pregnant, we recommend you consult your doctor.
• To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death to an unborn
child during an accident,
pregnant women should
NEVER place the lap portion
of the seat belt above or over
the area of the abdomen
where the unborn child is
located.
Seat belt use and children
Infant and small children
ALWAYS properly restrain infants
and small children in a child
restraint appropriate for the
child's height and weight.
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death to a child and
other passengers, NEVER hold a
child in your lap or arms when
the vehicle is moving.The violent
forces created during an accident will tear the child from your
arms and throw the child against
the interior of the vehicle.
Small children are best protected
from injury in an accident when properly restrained in the rear seat by a
child restraint system that meets the
requirements of the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards. Before
buying any child restraint system,
make sure that it has a label certifying that it meets Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard FMVSS 213.
The restraint must be appropriate for
your child’s height and weight. Check
the label on the child restraint for this
information. Refer to the "Child
Restraint Systems" section in this
chapter.
2-33
2
Safety system of your vehicle
All 50 states have child restraint laws
which require children to travel in
approved child restraint devices,
including booster seats. The age at
which seat belts can be used instead
of child restraints differs among
states, so you should be aware of the
specific requirements in your state,
and where you are travelling. Infant
and child restraints must be properly
placed and installed in a rear seat.
For more information refer to the
"Child Restraint Systems" section in
this chapter.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
Larger children
Children under age 13 and who are
too large for a booster seat must
always occupy the rear seat and use
the available lap/shoulder belts. A
seat belt should lie across the upper
thighs and be snug across the shoulder and chest to restrain the child
safely. Check belt fit periodically.
Children are afforded the most safety in the event of an accident when
they are restrained by a proper
restraint system and/or seat belts in
the rear seat. Always have the
LATCH system inspected by your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer after an
accident. An accident can damage
the LATCH system and may not
properly secure the child restraint.
If a larger child over age 13 must be
seated in the front seat, the child
must be securely restrained by the
available lap/shoulder belt and the
seat should be placed in the rearmost position.
2-34
If the shoulder belt portion slightly
touches the child's neck or face, try
placing the child closer to the center
of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still
touches their face or neck they need
to be returned to an appropriate
booster seat in the rear seat.
WARNING
• Always make sure children
are wearing their seat belts
and that they are properly
adjusted before driving.
• NEVER allow the shoulder
belt to contact the child’s
neck or face.
• Do not allow more than one
child to use a single seat belt.
Transporting an injured person
A seat belt should be used when an
injured person is being transported.
Consult a physician for specific recommendations.
One person per belt
Two people (including children) should
never attempt to use a single seat belt.
This could increase the severity of
injuries in case of an accident.
Do not lie down
Sitting in a reclined position when
the vehicle is in motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up, the
protections of your restraint system
(seat belts and air bags) is greatly
reduced by reclining your seatback.
To reduce the chance of injuries in the
event of an accident and to achieve
the maximum effectiveness of the
restraint system, all passengers
should be sitting up and the front and
rear seats should be in an upright
position when the car is moving.
A seat belt cannot provide proper
protection if the person is lying down
in the rear seat or if the front or rear
seats are in a reclined position.
WARNING
• NEVER ride with a reclined
When to replace seat belts
Seat belt systems should never be
disassembled or modified. In addition, care should be taken to assure
that seat belts and belt hardware are
not damaged by seat hinges, doors
or other abuse.
The entire seat belt assembly or
assemblies should be replaced if the
vehicle has been involved in an accident. This should be done even if no
damage is visible. Additional questions concerning seat belt operation
should be directed to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Periodic inspection
All seat belts should be inspected
periodically for wear or damage of
any kind. Any damaged parts should
be replaced as soon as possible by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Keep belts clean and dry
Seat belts should be kept clean and
dry. If belts become dirty, they can be
cleaned by using a mild soap solution and warm water. Bleach, dye,
strong detergents or abrasives
should not be used because they
may damage and weaken the fabric.
2-35
2
Safety system of your vehicle
seatback when the vehicle is
moving.
• Riding with a reclined seatback
increases your chance of serious or fatal injuries in the event
of a collision or sudden stop.
• Drivers and passengers should
always sit well back in their
seats, properly belted, and with
the seatbacks upright.
Care of Seat Belts
Safety system of your vehicle
CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (CRS)
Children Always in the Rear
WARNING
Always properly restrain children in the rear seats of the
vehicle.
Children of all ages are safer
when restrained in the rear seat.
A child riding in the front passenger seat can be forcefully
struck by an inflating air bag
resulting in SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH.
2-36
Children under age 13 must always
ride in the rear seats and must
always be properly restrained to minimize the risk of injury in an accident,
sudden stop or sudden maneuver.
According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly
restrained in the rear seats than in
the front seat. Even with air bags,
children can be seriously injured
or killed. Children too large for a
child restraint must use the seat belts
provided.
All 50 states have child restraint laws
which require children to travel in
approved child restraint devices. The
laws governing the age or height/
weight restrictions at which seat
belts can be used instead of child
restraints differs among states, so
you should be aware of the specific
requirements in your state, and
where you are travelling.
Child restraint systems must be properly placed and installed in the rear
seat. You must use a commercially
available child restraint system that
meets the requirements of the Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
(FMVSS 213).
Child restraint systems are generally
designed to be secured in a vehicle
seat by lap belt portion of a
lap/shoulder belt, or by a LATCH system in the rear seats of the vehicle.
Child restraint system (CRS)
WARNING
An improperly secured child
restraint can increase the risk
of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH
in an accident. Always take the
following precautions when
using a child restraint system:
• NEVER install a child or infant
restraint in the front passenger's seat.
• Always properly secure the
child restraint to a rear seat of
the vehicle.
• Always follow the child
restraint system manufacturer's instructions for installation and use.
child in the child restraint.
• If the vehicle head restraint
prevents proper installation of
a child seat (as described in
the child restraint system
manual), the head restraint of
the respective seating position shall be readjusted or
entirely removed.
• Do not use an infant carrier or
a child safety seat that
"hooks" over a seatback, it
may not provide adequate
protection in an accident.
• After an accident, have a
HYUNDAI dealer check the
child restraint system, seat
belts, tether anchors and
lower anchors.
Selecting a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
When selecting a CRS for your child,
always:
• Make sure the CRS has a label
certifying that it meets applicable
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards (FMVSS 213).
• Select a child restraint based on
your child's height and weight. The
required label or the instructions
for use typically provide this information.
• Select a child restraint that fits the
vehicle seating position where it
will be used.
• Read and comply with the warnings and instructions for installation
and use provided with the child
restraint system.
2-37
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Infants and younger children must be
restrained in an appropriate rear-facing or forward-facing CRS that has
first been properly secured to the
rear seat of the vehicle. Read and
comply with the instructions for
installation and use provided by the
manufacturer of the child restraint.
• Always properly restrain your
Safety system of your vehicle
Child restraint system types
Continue to use a rearward-facing
child seat for as long as your child
will fit within the height and weight
limits allowed by the child seat manufacturer. It's the best way to keep
them safe. Once your child has outgrown the rearward-facing child
restraint, your child is ready for a forward-facing child restraint with a harness.
There are three main types of child
restraint systems: rearward-facing
seats, forward-facing seats, and
booster seats. They are classified
according to the child's age, height
and weight.
Rearward-facing child seats
WARNING
NEVER install a child or infant
restraint in the front passenger's seat.
Placing a rearward-facing child
restraint in the front seat can
result in SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH if the child restraint is
struck by an inflating air bag.
2-38
OFE038023
A rearward-facing child seat provides
restraint with the seating surface
against the back of the child. The harness system holds the child in place,
and in an accident, acts to keep the
child positioned in the seat and
reduce the stress to the neck and
spinal cord.
All children under age one must
always ride in a rearward-facing infant
child restraint.
Convertible and 3-in-1 child seats typically have higher height and weight
limits for the rearward-facing position,
allowing you to keep your child rearward-facing for a longer period of
time.
Installing a Child Restraint
System (CRS)
WARNING
2
Before installing your child
restraint system always:
• Read and follow the instructions provided by the manufacturer of the child restraint.
• Read and follow the instructions regarding child restraint
systems in this manual.
Failure to follow all warnings
and instructions could increase
the risk of the SERIOUS INJURY
or DEATH if an accident occurs.
WARNING
If the vehicle headrest prevents
proper installation of a child
seat (as described in the child
seat system manual) the headrest of the respective seating
position shall be readjusted or
entirely removed.
2-39
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE028004
Forward-facing child restraints
A forward-facing child seat provides
restraint for the child's body with a
harness. Keep children in a forwardfacing child seat with a harness until
they reach the top height or weight
limit allowed by your child restraint’s
manufacturer.
Once your child outgrows the forwardfacing child restraint, your child is
ready for a booster seat.
Booster seats
A booster seat is a restraint designed
to improve the fit of the vehicle's seat
belt system. A booster seat positions
the seat belt so that it fits properly
over the lap of your child.
Keep your child in a booster seat until
they are big enough to sit in the seat
without a booster and still have the
seat belt fit properly. For a seat belt to
fit properly, the lap belt must lie snugly across the upper thighs, not the
stomach. The shoulder belt should lie
snug across the shoulder and chest
and not across the neck or face.
Children under age 13 must always
ride in the rear seats and must always
be properly restrained to minimize the
risk of injury.
Safety system of your vehicle
After selecting a proper child seat for
your child, check to make sure it fits
properly in your vehicle. Follow the
instructions provided by the manufacturer when installing the child
seat. Note these general steps when
installing the seat to your vehicle:
• Properly secure the child
restraint to the vehicle. All child
restraints must be secured to the
vehicle with the lap part of a
lap/shoulder belt or with the
LATCH system. If using the
lap/shoulder belt for your child
restraint, the convertible locking
retractor should be pulled all the
way out to engage the "automatic
locking" mode. (See page 2-43.)
• Make sure the child restraint is
firmly secured. After installing a
child restraint to the vehicle, push
and pull the seat forward-and-back
and side-to-side to verify that it is
securely attached to the seat. A
child restraint secured with a seat
belt should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, some side-toside movement can be expected.
2-40
• Secure the child in the child
restraint. Make sure the child is
properly strapped in the child
restraint according to the manufacturer instructions.
CAUTION
A child restraint in a closed
vehicle can become very hot. To
prevent burns, check the seating surface and buckles before
placing your child in the child
restraint.
Lower Anchors and Tether for
Children (LATCH System)
The LATCH system holds a child
restraint during driving and in an accident. This system is designed to
make installation of the child restraint
easier and reduce the possibility of
improperly installing your child
restraint. The LATCH system uses
anchors in the vehicle and attachments on the child restraint. The
LATCH system eliminates the need
to use seat belts to secure the child
restraint to the rear seats.
Lower anchors are metal bars built
into the vehicle. There are two lower
anchors for each LATCH seating
position that will accommodate a
child restraint with lower attachments.
To use the LATCH system in your
vehicle, you must have a child
restraint with LATCH attachments.
The child seat manufacturer will provide you with instructions on how to
use the child seat with its attachments
for the LATCH lower anchors.
WARNING
2
OFE038027N
[1] : Lower Anchor Position Indicator,
[2] : Lower Anchor
The lower anchor position indicator
symbols are located on the left and
right rear seat backs to identify the
position of the lower anchors in your
vehicle (see arrows in illustration).
The LATCH anchors are located
between the seatback and the seat
cushion of the rear seat left and right
outboard seating positions.
2-41
Safety system of your vehicle
OOSEV038012
LATCH anchors have been provided
in the left and right outboard rear
seating positions. Their locations are
shown in the illustration. There are no
LATCH anchors provided for the center rear seating position.
Do not attempt to install a child
restraint system using LATCH
anchors in the rear center seating position.There are no LATCH
anchors provided for this seat.
Using the outboard seat anchors
can damage the anchors which
may break or fail in a collision
resulting in serious injury or
death.
Safety system of your vehicle
Securing a child restraint with
the LATCH anchors system
To install a LATCH-compatible child
restraint in either of the rear outboard
seating positions:
1. Move the seat belt buckle away
from the lower anchors.
2. Move any other objects away from
the anchors that could prevent a
secure connection between the
child restraint and the lower
anchors.
3. Place the child restraint on the
vehicle seat, then attach the seat
to the lower anchors according to
the instructions provided by the
child restraint manufacturer.
4. Follow the child restraint instructions for properly adjusting and
tightening the lower attachments
on the child restraint to the lower
anchors.
2-42
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the LATCH system:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with
your child restraint system.
• To prevent the child from
reaching and taking hold of
unretracted seat belts, buckle
all unused rear seat belts and
retract the seat belt webbing
behind the child. Children can
be strangled if a shoulder belt
becomes wrapped around
their neck and the seat belt
tightens.
• NEVER attach more than one
child restraint to a single
anchor. This could cause the
anchor or attachment to come
loose or break.
• Always have the LATCH system inspected by your authorized HYUNDAI dealer after an
accident. An accident can
damage the LATCH system
and may not properly secure
the child restraint.
NOTICE
The recommended weight for the
LATCH system is under 65 lb (30
kg).
How to determine an appropriate
child restraint weight:
Child weight + Child restraint
weight < 65 lb (30kg)
Securing a child restraint seat
with "Tether Anchor" system
Take the following precautions
when installing the tether strap:
• Read and follow all installation
instructions provided with
your child restraint system.
• NEVER attach more than one
child restraint to a single tether anchor. This could cause
the anchor or attachment to
come loose or break.
• Do not attach the tether strap
to anything other than the correct tether anchor. It may not
work properly if attached to
something else.
• Do not use the tether anchors
for adult seat belts or harnesses, or for attaching other items
or equipment to the vehicle.
2
OFE038026
To install the tether anchor:
1. Route the child restraint tether
strap over the child restraint seatback. Route the tether strap under
the head restraint and between
the head restraint posts, or route
the tether strap over the top of the
vehicle seatback. Make sure the
strap is not twisted.
2. Connect the tether strap hook to the
tether anchor, then tighten the tether strap according to the child seat
manufacturer's instructions to firmly
secure the child restraint to the seat.
3. Check that the child restraint is
securely attached to the seat by
pushing and pulling the seat forward-and-back and side-to-side.
2-43
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038025
First secure the child restraint with
the LATCH lower anchors or the seat
belt. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that the top tether
strap be attached, attach and tighten
the top tether strap to the top tether
strap anchor.
Child restraint hook holders are
located on the rear of the seatbacks.
WARNING
Safety system of your vehicle
Securing a child restraint with
lap/shoulder belt
When not using the LATCH system,
all child restraints must be secured to
a vehicle rear seat with the lap part
of a lap/shoulder belt.
WARNING
ALWAYS place a rear-facing
child restraint in the rear seat of
the vehicle.
Placing a rear-facing child
restraint in the front seat can
result in serious injury or death
if the child restraint is struck by
an inflating air bag.
OLMB033044
OFE038024
Automatic locking mode
2-44
Since all passenger seat belts move
freely under normal conditions and
only lock under extreme or emergency conditions (emergency locking
mode), you must manually pull the
seat belt all the way out to shift the
retractor to the "Automatic Locking"
mode to secure a child restraint.
The "Automatic Locking" mode will
help prevent the normal movement
of the child in the vehicle from causing the seat belt to loosen and compromise the child restraint system. To
secure a child restraint system, use
the following procedure.
To install a child restraint system on
the rear seats, do the following:
1. Place the child restraint system on
a rear seat and route the lap/ shoulder belt around or through the child
restraint, following the restraint
manufacturer's instructions.
Be sure the seat belt webbing is
not twisted. Make sure to insert
the belt into the guide(1).
2
OLMB033097
3. Pull the shoulder portion of the seat
belt all the way out. When the shoulder portion of the seat belt is fully
extended, it will shift the retractor to
the "Automatic Locking" (child
restraint) mode.
When using the rear center seat
belt, you should also refer to the
"Rear Seat Belt – Passenger's 3point system" section in this
chapter.
i Information
Position the release button so that it is
easy to access in case of an emergency.
2-45
Safety system of your vehicle
OLMB033045
2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch
into the buckle. Listen for the distinct "click" sound.
NOTICE
Safety system of your vehicle
OLMB033098
4. Slowly allow the shoulder portion
of the seat belt to retract and listen
for an audible "clicking" or "ratcheting" sound. This indicates that
the retractor is in the "Automatic
Locking" mode. If no distinct
sound is heard, repeat steps 3
and 4.
5. Remove as much slack from the
belt as possible by pushing down
on the child restraint system while
feeding the shoulder belt back into
the retractor.
6. Push and pull on the child restraint
system to confirm that the seat
belt is holding it firmly in place. If it
is not, release the seat belt and
repeat steps 2 through 6.
7. Double check that the retractor is
in the "Automatic Locking" mode
by attempting to pull more of the
seat belt out of the retractor. If you
cannot, the retractor is in the
"Automatic Locking" mode.
If your CRS manufacturer instructs or
recommends you to use a tether
anchor with the lap/shoulder belt,
refer to the previous pages for more
information.
NOTICE
When the seat belt is allowed to
retract to its fully stowed position,
the retractor will automatically
switch from the "Automatic
Locking" mode to the emergency
lock mode for normal adult usage.
WARNING
If the retractor is not in the
"Automatic Locking" mode, the
child restraint can move when
your vehicle turns or stops suddenly. A child can be seriously
injured or killed if the child
restraint is not properly anchored
in the car, including manually
pulling the seat belt all the way
out to shift the rectractor to the
"Automatic Locking" mode.
To remove the child restraint, press
the release button on the buckle and
then pull the lap/shoulder belt out of
the restraint and allow the seat belt
to retract fully.
2-46
AIR BAG - ADVANCED SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
2
Safety system of your vehicle
1. Driver's front air bag
2. Passenger's front air bag
3. Side air bag
4. Curtain air bag
The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OFE038028
2-47
Safety system of your vehicle
This vehicle is equipped with an
Advanced Supplemental Air Bag
System for the driver's seat and front
passenger's seats.
The front air bags are designed to
supplement the three-point seat
belts. For these air bags to provide
protection, the seat belts must be
worn at all times when driving.
You can be severely injured or killed
in an accident if you are not wearing
a seat belt. Air bags are designed to
supplement seat belts, but do not
replace them. Also, air bags are not
designed to deploy in every collision.
In some accidents, the seat belts are
the only restraint protecting you.
2-48
WARNING
AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
ALWAYS use seat belts and child restraints - every trip, every time,
everyone! Even with air bags, you can be seriously injured or killed in
a collision if you are improperly belted or not wearing your seat belt
when the air bag inflates.
NEVER place a child in any child restraint or booster seat in the front
passenger seat. An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant
or child causing serious or fatal injuries.
ABC - Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the
safest place for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older
must be seated in the front seat, he or she must be properly belted
and the seat should be moved as far back as possible.
All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright position, centered on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their feet on the floor until the vehicle is parked
and is turned off. If an occupant is out of position during an accident,
the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully contact the occupant
causing serious or fatal injuries.
You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily
close to the air bags or lean against the door or center console.
Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still
maintaining control of the vehicle. The U.S. National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration (NHTSA) recommends that drivers allow at
least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and
the chest.
Where Are the Air Bags?
Driver's and passenger's front
air bags
OFE038029
The advanced SRS offers the ability
to control the air bag inflation within
two levels. A first stage level is provided for moderate-severity impacts.
A second stage level is provided for
more severe impacts.
According to the impact severity, the
SRS Control Module (SRSCM) controls the air bag inflation. Failure to
properly wear seat belts can
increase the risk or severity of injury
in an accident.
■ Passenger’s front air bag
WARNING
OFE038031
The purpose of the SRS is to provide
the vehicle's driver and front passengers with additional protection than
that offered by the seat belt system
alone.
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
front air bags, take the following
precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all
times to help keep occupants
positioned properly.
• Move your seat as far back as
possible from front air bags,
while still maintaining control
of the vehicle.
• Never lean against the door or
center console.
2-49
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Your vehicle is equipped with a
Advanced Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS) and lap/shoulder belts
at both the driver and passenger
seating positions.
The SRS consists of air bags which
are located in the center of the steering wheel, and the passenger's side
front panel pad above the glove box.
The air bags are labeled with the letters "AIR BAG" embossed on the
pad covers.
■ Driver’s front air bag
Safety system of your vehicle
• Do not allow the front passenger to place their feet or legs
on the dashboard.
• No objects (such as crash pad
cover, cellular phone holder,
cup holder, air fresheners or
stickers) should be placed
over or near the air bag modules on the steering wheel,
instrument panel, windshield
glass, and the front passenger's panel above the glove
box. Such objects could
cause harm if the vehicle is in
a crash severe enough to
cause the air bags to deploy.
Side air bags
The side air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity.
The side and curtain air bags on
both sides of the vehicle may deploy
if a rollover or possible rollover is
detected.
The side air bags are not designed to
deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
OFE038032
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
side air bag, take the following
precautions:
• Seat belts must be worn at all
times to help keep occupants
positioned properly.
OFE038033
2-50
WARNING
Your vehicle is equipped with a side
air bag in each front seat. The purpose of the air bag is to provide the
vehicle's driver and the front passenger with additional protection than
that offered by the seat belt alone.
• Do not install any accessories
lean their heads or bodies
onto doors, put their arms on
the doors, stretch their arms
out of the window, or place
objects between the doors
and seats.
Hold the steering wheel at the
9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions, to minimize the risk of
injuries to your hands and
arms.
Do not use any accessory
seat covers. This could reduce
or prevent the effectiveness
of the system.
Do not place any objects over
the air bag or between the air
bag and yourself. Also, do not
attach any objects around the
area the air bag inflates such
as the door, side door glass,
front and rear pillar.
Do not place any objects
between the door and the
seat. They may become dangerous projectiles if the side
air bag inflates.
on the side or near the side air
bags.
• Do not put any objects
between the side airbag label
and seat cushion. It could
cause harm if the vehicle is in
a crash severe enough to
cause the air bags to deploy.
• Do not cause impact to the
doors when the POWER button is placed to the ON position as this may cause the
side air bags to inflate.
• If the seat or seat cover is
damaged, have the vehicle
checked and repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
•
•
•
•
Curtain air bags
2
OFE038035
OFE038034
Curtain air bags are located along
both sides of the roof rails above the
front and rear doors.
2-51
Safety system of your vehicle
• Do not allow passengers to
Safety system of your vehicle
They are designed to help protect the
heads of the front seat occupants
and the rear outboard seat occupants
in certain side impact collisions.
The curtain air bags are designed to
deploy during certain side impact
collisions, depending on the crash
severity.
The side and curtain air bags on
both sides of the vehicle may deploy
if a rollover or possible rollover is
detected.
The curtain air bags are not designed
to deploy in all side impact or rollover
situations.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
curtain air bag, take the following precautions:
• All seat occupants must wear
seat belts at all times to help
keep occupants positioned
properly.
2-52
• Properly
•
•
•
•
secure
child
restraints as far away from the
door as possible.
Do not place any objects over
the air bag. Also, do not attach
any objects around the area
the air bag inflates such as the
door, side door glass, front
and rear pillar, roof side rail.
Do not hang other objects
except clothes, especially
hard or breakable objects. In
an accident, it may cause
vehicle damage or personal
injury.
Do not allow passengers to
lean their heads or bodies onto
doors, put their arms on the
doors, stretch their arms out of
the window, or place objects
between the doors and seats.
Do not attempt to open or
repair the side curtain air an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
How Does the Air Bag System
Operate?
OFE038053N
The SRS consists of the following
components:
1. Driver's front air bag module
2. Passenger's front air bag module
3. Side air bag modules
4. Curtain air bag modules
5. Retractor pre-tensioner
6. Air bag warning light
7. SRS control module (SRSCM)/
Rollover sensor
8. Front impact sensors
9. Side impact sensors
10. Side pressure sensors
11. Seat belt buckle sensor
12. Emergency Fastening Device
System
13. Occupant classification system
The SRS (Supplement Restraint
System) air bag warning light on the
instrument panel displays the air bag
symbol depicted in the illustration.
The system checks the air bag electrical system for malfunctions. The
light indicates that there is a potential
malfunction with your air bag system,
which could include your side and
curtain air bags used for rollover protection.
WARNING
If your SRS malfunctions, the air
bag may not inflate properly during an accident, increasing the
risk of serious injury or death.
If any of the following conditions occur, your SRS is malfunctioning:
• The light does not turn on for
approximately six seconds
when the POWER button is in
the ON position.
• The light stays on after illuminating for approximately six
seconds.
• The light comes on when the
vehicle is ON.
• The light blinks when the
vehicle is ON.
Have an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer inspect the SRS as soon
as possible if any of these conditions occur.
2-53
2
Safety system of your vehicle
The SRSCM (Supplemental Restraint
System Control Module) continually
monitors all SRS components while
the POWER button is placed to the
ON position to determine if a crash
impact is severe enough to require air
bag deployment or pre-tensioner seat
belt deployment.
SRS warning light
Safety system of your vehicle
During a frontal collision, sensors will
detect the vehicle's deceleration. If
the rate of deceleration is high
enough, the control unit will inflate
the front air bags.
The front air bags help protect the
driver and front passenger by
responding to frontal impacts in
which seat belts alone cannot provide adequate restraint. When needed, the side air bags help provide
protection in the event of a side
impact or rollover.
• Air bags are activated (able to
inflate if necessary) only when the
POWER button is placed to the ON
position.
• Air bags inflate in the event of certain frontal or side collisions to help
protect the occupants from serious
physical injury.
• Generally, air bags are designed to
inflate based upon the severity of a
collision, its direction, etc. These
two factors determine whether the
sensors produce an electronic
deployment/inflation signal.
2-54
• The front air bags will completely
inflate and deflate in an instant. It is
virtually impossible for you to see
the air bags inflate during an accident. It is much more likely that you
will simply see the deflated air bags
hanging out of their storage compartments after the collision.
• In addition to inflating in certain
side collisions, vehicles equipped
with a rollover sensor, side and
curtain air bags will inflate if the
sensing system detects a rollover.
When a rollover is detected, side
and curtain air bags will remain
inflated longer to help provide protection from ejection, especially
when used in conjunction with the
seat belts.
• To help provide protection, the air
bags must inflate rapidly. The speed
of air bag inflation is a consequence
of extremely short time in which to
inflate the air bag between the
occupant and the vehicle structures
before the occupant impacts those
structures. This speed of inflation
reduces the risk of serious or lifethreatening injuries and is thus a
necessary part of air bag design.
However, the rapid air bag inflation
can also cause injuries which can
include facial abrasions, bruises
and broken bones because the
inflation speed also causes the air
bags to expand with a great deal of
force.
• There are even circumstances
under which contact with the air
bag can cause fatal injuries, especially if the occupant is positioned
excessively close to the air bag.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death from an inflating
air bag, take the following precautions:
• NEVER place a child restraint
in the front passenger seat.
Always properly restrain children under age 13 in the rear
seats of the vehicle.
• Adjust the front passenger’s
and driver's seats as far to the
rear as possible while maintaining you to maintain full
control of the vehicle.
• Hold the steering wheel with
hands at the 9 o'clock and 3
o'clock positions.
• Never place anything or anyone between the air bag and
the seat occupant.
• Do not allow the front passenger to place their feet or legs
on the dashboard.
■ Driver's front air bag (1)
2
OTLA035107
When the SRSCM detects a sufficiently severe impact to the front of
the vehicle, it will automatically
deploy the front air bags.
2-55
Safety system of your vehicle
You can take steps to help reduce
the risk of being injured by an inflating air bag. The greatest risk is sitting
too close to the air bag. An air bag
needs about 10 inches (25 cm) of
space to inflate. NHTSA recommends that drivers allow at least 10
inches (25 cm) between the center of
the steering wheel and the chest.
Safety system of your vehicle
■ Driver's front air bag (2)
■ Driver's front air bag (3)
OTLA035108
Upon deployment, tear seams molded directly into the pad covers will
separate under pressure from the
expansion of the air bags. Further
opening of the covers allows full
inflation of the air bags.
A fully inflated air bag, in combination with a properly worn seat belt,
slows the driver or the front passenger forward motion, reducing the risk
of head and chest injury.
WARNING
OTLA035109
■ Passenger's front air bag
OLMB033057
After complete inflation, the air bag
immediately starts deflating, enabling
the driver to maintain forward visibility and the ability to steer or operate
other controls.
2-56
To prevent objects from becoming dangerous projectiles when
the passenger's air bag inflates:
• Do not install or place any
objects (drink holder, CD
holder, stickers, etc.) on the
front passenger's panel above
the glove box where the passenger's air bag is located.
• Do not install a container of
liquid air freshener near the
instrument cluster or on the
instrument panel surface.
What to Expect After an Air
Bag Inflates
WARNING
After an air bag inflates, take
the following precautions:
• Open your windows and doors
as soon as possible after
impact to reduce prolonged
exposure to the smoke and
powder released by the inflating air bag.
• Do not touch the air bag storage area's internal components immediately after an air
bag has inflated. The parts
that come into contact with an
inflating air bag may be very
hot.
areas thoroughly with cold
and mild soap.
• Always have an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer replace the
air bag immediately after
deployment. Air bags are
designed to be used only
once.
Noise and smoke from inflating
air bag
When the air bags inflate, they make
a loud noise and may produce
smoke and powder in the air inside of
the vehicle. This is normal and is a
result of the ignition of the air bag
inflator. After the air bag inflates, you
may feel substantial discomfort in
breathing because of the contact of
your chest with both the seat belt and
the air bag, as well as from breathing
the smoke and powder. The powder
may aggravate asthma for some
people. If you experience breathing
problems after an air bag deployment, seek medical attention immediately.
Though the smoke and powder are
nontoxic, they may cause irritation to
the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If
this is the case, wash and rinse with
cold water immediately and seek
medical attention if the symptoms
persist.
2-57
2
Safety system of your vehicle
After a frontal or side air bag inflates,
it will deflate very quickly. Air bag
inflation will not prevent the driver
from seeing out of the windshield or
being able to steer. Curtain air bags
may remain partially inflated for
some time after they deploy.
• Always wash exposed skin
Safety system of your vehicle
Occupant Classification
System (OCS)
OFE038054N
Your vehicle is equipped with an
Occupant Classification System
(OCS) in the front passenger's seat.
Main components of the
Occupant Classification System
• A detection device located within
the front passenger seat cushion.
• Electronic system to help determine whether the passenger air
bag systems should be activated
or deactivated.
• An indicator light located on the
overhead console which illuminates the words "PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF" indicating the front
passenger air bag system is deactivated.
• The overhead console air bag indicator light is interconnected with
the OCS.
The OCS is designed to help detect
the presence of a properly-seated
front passenger and determine if the
passenger's front air bag should be
enabled (may inflate) or not.
The purpose is to help reduce the
risk of injury or death from an inflating air bag to certain front passenger
seat occupants, such as children, by
requiring the air bag to be automatically turned OFF.
2-58
For example, if a child restraint of the
type specified in the regulations is on
the seat, the occupant classification
sensor can detect it and cause the
air bag to turn OFF.
Front passenger seat adult occupants who are properly seated and
wearing the seat belt properly,
should not cause the passenger air
bag to be automatically turned OFF.
For small adults it may be turned
OFF, however, if the occupant does
not sit in the seat properly (for example, by not sitting upright, by sitting
on the edge of the seat, or by otherwise being out of position), this could
cause the sensor to turn the air bag
OFF.
You will find the "PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF" indicator on the center
fascia panel. This system detects the
conditions 1-4 in the following table
and activates or deactivates the front
passenger air bag based on these
conditions.
Condition and operation in the front passenger Occupant Classification System
Indicator/Warning light
Condition detected by the
occupant classification system
Devices
"PASSENGER
Front passenger
SRS
AIR BAG OFF"
warning light
air bag
indicator light
1. Adult *1
Off
Off
Activated
2. Infant *2 or child restraint
system with 12 months old *3 *4
On
Off
Deactivated
3. Unoccupied
On
Off
Deactivated
4. Malfunction in the system
Off
On
Activated
* The system judges a person of adult size as an adult. When a smaller adult sits in the front
passenger seat, the system may recognize him/her as a child depending on his/her physique
and posture.
*2 Do not allow children to ride in the front passenger seat. When a larger child who has outgrown a child restraint system sits in the front passenger seat, the system may recognize
him/her as an adult depending upon his/her physique or sitting position.
*3 Never install a child restraint system on the front passenger seat.
*4 The PASSENGER AIR BAG "OFF" indicator may turn on or off when a child above 12 months
to 12 years old (with or without child restraint system) sits in the front passenger seat. This is
a normal condition.
1
2-59
2
Safety system of your vehicle
Always be sure that you and all vehicle occupants are seated properly
and wearing the seat belt properly for
the most effective protection by the
air bag and the seat belt.
The OCS may not function properly if
the passenger takes actions which
can affect the classification system.
These include:
• Failing to sit in an upright position.
• Leaning against the door or center
console.
• Sitting towards the sides of the
front of the seat.
• Putting their legs on the dashboard
or resting them on other locations
which reduce the passenger
weight on the front seat.
• Wearing the seat belt improperly.
• Reclining the seatback.
• Wearing a thick cloth like ski wear
or hip protection wear.
• Putting an additional thick cushion
on the seat.
• Putting electrical devices (for
example, notebook, satellite radio)
on the seat with inverter charging.
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
Riding in an improper position or placing weight on the front passenger’s seat when it is unoccupied by a
passenger adversely affects the OCS. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death:
• NEVER put a heavy load in
• NEVER ride with the seat-
the front seat or seatback
pocket, or hang any items
on the front passenger
seat.
back reclined when the
vehicle is moving.
OLMB033103
OVQ036013NB
• NEVER place your feet or
• NEVER place your feet on
legs on the dashboard.
the front passenger seatback.
OLMB033100
OLMB033102
• NEVER lean on the door or
• NEVER sit with your hips
center console or sit on
one side of the front passenger seat.
shifted towards the front
of the seat.
OLMB033101
2-60
OLMB033104
• Do not place electronic
ger seat wearing heavily
padded clothes such as
ski wear and hip protector.
devices such as laptops,
DVD player, or conductive
materials such as water
bottles on the passenger
seat.
• Do not use electronic
devices such as laptops
and satellite radios which
use inverter chargers.
ODH035900K
OTM038054
• If large quantity of liquid
• Do not use car seat
accessories such as thick
blankets and cushions
which cover up the car
seat surface.
ODH035901K
OTM038055
has been spilled on the
passenger seat, the air
bag warning light may
illuminate or malfunction.
Therefore, make sure the
seat has been completely
dried before driving the
vehicle.
• Do not place sharp objects on the front passenger seat. These may damage the occupant detection system, if they puncture the seat cushion.
• Do not place any items under the front passenger seat.
• When changing or replacing the seat or seat cover, use original items only. The OCS has been developed based on using original HYUNDAI car seats only. Altering or changing the authentic parts may
result in system malfunction and increase risk of injury when in collision. Any of the above could interfere with the proper operation of the OCS sensor thereby increasing the risk of an injury in an accident.
2-61
2
Safety system of your vehicle
• Do not sit on the passen-
Safety system of your vehicle
WARNING
B990A01O
Proper seated position for OCS
If the "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"
indicator is on when an adult is seated in the front passenger seat, place
the POWER button in the OFF position and ask the passenger to sit
properly (sitting upright with the seat
back in an upright position, centered
on the seat cushion with their seat
belt on, legs comfortably extended
and their feet on the floor). Restart
the vehicle and have the person
remain in that position. This will allow
the system to detect the person and
to enable the passenger air bag. If
the "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"
indicator is still on, ask the passenger to move to the rear seat.
2-62
Never allow an adult passenger
to ride in the front passenger
seat when the "PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF" indicator is illuminated. During a collision, the air bag
will not inflate if the indicator is
illuminated. Have your passenger reposition himself in the
seat. If the "PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF" indicator remains illuminated after the passenger
repositions himself properly and
the vehicle is restarted, have the
passenger move to the rear seat
because the air bag will not
inflate.
NOTICE
The "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"
indicator illuminates for approximately 4 seconds after the
POWER button is in the ON position or after the vehicle is started.
If the front passenger seat is
occupied, the OCS will then classify the front passenger after several more seconds.
Do Not Install a Child Restraint
in the Front Passenger's Seat
1JBH3051
Even though your vehicle is equipped
with the OCS, never install a child
restraint in the front passenger's seat.
An inflating air bag can forcefully
strike a child or child restraint resulting in serious or fatal injury.
WARNING
• NEVER place a rear-facing or
Air bags are not designed to inflate in
every collision. There are certain
types of accidents in which the air bag
would not be expected to provide
additional protection. These include
rear impacts, second or third collisions in multiple impact accidents, as
well as low speed impacts. Damage
to the vehicle indicates collision energy absorption, and is not an indicator
of whether or not an air bag should
have inflated.
Air bag collision sensors
WARNING
To reduce the risk of an air bag
deploying unexpectedly and
causing serious injury or death:
• Do not hit or allow any objects
to impact the locations where air
bags or sensors are installed.
• Do not perform maintenance
on or around the air bag sensors. If the location or angle of
the sensors is altered, the air
bags may deploy when they
should not or may not deploy
when they should.
• Do not install bumper guards
or replace the bumper with a
non-genuine HYUNDAI parts.
This may adversely affect the
collision and air bag deployment performance.
• Place the POWER button to
the OFF position when the
vehicle is being towed to prevent inadvertent air bag
deployment.
• Have all air bag repairs performed by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
2-63
2
Safety system of your vehicle
front-facing child restraint in
the front passenger's seat of
the vehicle.
• An inflating frontal air bag
could forcefully strike a child
resulting in serious injury or
death.
• Always properly restrain children in an appropriate child
restraint in the rear seat of the
vehicle.
Why Didn't My Air Bag Go Off
in a Collision?
Safety system of your vehicle
1. SRS control module/Rollover sensor
2. Front impact sensor
3. Side pressure sensor
4. Side impact sensor
5. Side impact sensor
OFE038036N/OFE038037/OFE038038N/OFE038039/OFE038040/OFE038071N
2-64
Air bag inflation conditions
OFE038042
Front air bags
Front air bags are designed to inflate
in some frontal collisions depending
on the severity of impact of the front
collision.
OFE038033
Side and curtain air bags
Side and curtain air bags are
designed to inflate when an impact is
detected by side collision sensors
depending on the severity of impact
resulting from a side impact collision.
2-65
2
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038041N
Although the driver's and front passenger's air bags are designed to
inflate only in frontal collisions, they
also may inflate in other types of collisions if the front impact sensors
detect a sufficient impact. Side and
curtain air bags are designed to
inflate only in side impact collisions
or rollover situations, but they may
inflate in other collisions if the side
impact sensors detect a sufficient
impact.
If the vehicle chassis is impacted by
bumps or objects on unimproved
roads, the air bags may deploy. Drive
carefully on unimproved roads or on
surfaces not designed for vehicle
traffic to prevent unintended air bag
deployment.
Safety system of your vehicle
Air bag non-inflation conditions
OFE038043
In certain low-speed collisions the air
bags may not deploy. The air bags
are designed not to deploy in such
cases because they may not provide
benefits beyond the protection of the
seat belts.
2-66
OFE038044
OFE038045N
Front air bags are not designed to
inflate in rear collisions, because
occupants are moved backward by
the force of the impact. In this case,
inflated air bags would not provide
any additional benefit.
Front air bags may not inflate in side
impact collisions, because occupants
move in the direction of the collision,
and thus in side impacts, front air bag
deployment would not provide additional occupant protection.
However, side and curtain air bags
may inflate depending on the severity of impact.
2
OFE038046
OTL035068
Just before impact, drivers often
brake heavily. Such heavy braking
lowers the front portion of the vehicle
causing it to "ride" under a vehicle
with a higher ground clearance. Air
bags may not inflate in this "underride" situation because deceleration
forces that are detected by sensors
may be significantly reduced by such
"underride" collisions.
Front air bags may not inflate in
rollover accidents because air bag
deployment could not provide protection to the occupants.
However, side and curtain air bags
may inflate when the vehicle is rolled
over by a side impact collision.
2-67
Safety system of your vehicle
OTM038090
In an angled collision, the force of
impact may direct the occupants in a
direction where the air bags would
not be able to provide any additional
benefit, and thus the sensors may
not deploy any air bags.
Safety system of your vehicle
SRS Care
OFE038047
Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle
collides with objects such as utility
poles or trees, where the point of
impact is concentrated and the collision energy is absorbed by the vehicle structure.
2-68
The SRS is virtually maintenancefree and there are no parts you can
safely service by yourself. If the SRS
air bag warning light does not illuminate when the POWER button is in
the ON position, or continuously
remains on, have your vehicle immediately inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Any work on the SRS system, such
as removing, installing, repairing, or
any work on the steering wheel, the
front passenger's panel, front seats
and roof rails must be performed by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Improper handling of the SRS system
may result in serious personal injury.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, take the following precautions:
• Do not attempt to modify or
disconnect the SRS components or wiring, including the
addition of any kind of badges
to the pad covers or modifications to the body structure.
• Do not place objects over or
near the air bag modules on
the steering wheel, instrument
panel, or the front passenger’s panel above the glove
box.
• Clean the air bag pad covers
with a soft cloth moistened
with plain water. Solvents or
cleaners could adversely
affect the air bag covers and
proper deployment of the system.
• Always have inflated air bags
replaced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If components of the air bag
Additional Safety Precautions
Passengers should not move out
of or change seats while the vehicle is moving. A passenger who is
not wearing a seat belt during a
crash or emergency stop can be
thrown against the inside of the vehicle, against other occupants, or be
ejected from the vehicle.
Do not use any accessories on
seat belts. Devices claiming to
improve occupant comfort or reposition the seat belt can reduce the protection provided by the seat belt and
increase the chance of serious injury
in a crash.
Air Bag Warning Labels
2
OFE038049N
Air bag warning labels, required by
the U.S. National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration (NHTSA), are
attached to alert the driver and passengers of potential risks of the air
bag system. Be sure to read all of the
information about the air bags that
are installed on your vehicle in this
Owners Manual.
Adding equipment to or modifying your air bag equipped vehicle
If you modify your vehicle by changing your vehicle's frame, bumper system, front end or side sheet metal or
ride height, this may affect the operation of your vehicle's air bag system.
2-69
Safety system of your vehicle
system must be discarded, or if
the vehicle must be scrapped,
certain safety precautions
must be observed. Consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
the necessary information.
Failure to follow these precautions could increase the risk of
personal injury.
Do not modify the front seats.
Modification of the front seats could
interfere with the operation of the
supplemental restraint system sensing components or side air bags.
Do not place items under the front
seats. Placing items under the front
seats could interfere with the operation of the supplemental restraint
system sensing components and
wiring harnesses.
Do not cause impact to the doors.
Impact to the doors when the
POWER button is in the ON position
may cause the air bags to inflate.
Modifications to accommodate
disabilities. If you require modification to your vehicle to accommodate
a disability, contact the HYUNDAI
Customer Connect Center at 800633-5151.
Safety system of your vehicle
ACTIVE HOOD LIFT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
The active hood lift system can help
reduce risk of injury to pedestrians
by raising the hood in certain accident situations. The active hood lift
system has the additional deformation space under the hood, which is
made available for subsequent head
impact.
System activation
Prerequisite for activation
The POWER button is in the START
position and the vehicle speed is
between about 15.5 mph (25 km/h)
and 31 mph (50 km/h).
i Information
- Active hood lift system
repair
• If the active hood lift system has been
activated, do not place the hood back
by yourself. Have the system repaired
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If you change or repair the front
bumper, have the system checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
2-70
System activation
The active hood lift system is
designed to work in a frontal collision
depending on the intensity, speed or
angles of impact of the front collision.
The system will activate when:
• There is a frontal collision with a
pedestrian, an animal, an obstacle
or a vehicle and certain operation
conditions (intensity, speed, angle
of impact, etc.) are met.
System limitation
2
OFE038066
OFE038067N
OFE038068N
OFE038069
The system will not activate when:
• On side collisions, rear collision,
and rollover accident. The vehicle
can detect only frontal collision.
• The front bumper is damaged or
modified.
• The vehicle is in an angled frontal
collision with pedestrians.
• A pedestrian is laying on the road.
• A pedestrian has an object to
absorb the shock such as a suit
case, buggy or cart.
2-71
Safety system of your vehicle
OFE038065
Safety system of your vehicle
i Information
System malfunction
OIK037067L
If there is a problem with the system
a message will appear on the cluster
LCD display.
This warning message means that
the protection of pedestrians by the
active hood lift system is not working
properly.
If the warning message is displayed,
have the system checked as soon as
possible by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
2-72
• Do not remove or change the components and the wiring of the active
hood system.
• Do not change the front bumper or
the body structure.
• Do not install or assemble any aftermarket accessory on the front
bumper or cover.
• When replacing tires, make sure
they are the same size as your original tires. If you drive with different
tire or wheel sizes, the active hood
lift system may not work normally.
The above situations may cause a
malfunction of the active hood lift system.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Accessing Your Vehicle .........................................3-3
Sunroof Open Warning..................................................3-41
Smart Key............................................................................3-3
Immobilizer System.........................................................3-10
Exterior Features.................................................3-42
Door Locks............................................................3-11
Door unlocking from outside the vehicle .................3-11
Door locking from outside the vehicle ......................3-14
Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle .......3-14
Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features .............3-17
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks ...............................3-18
Theft-Alarm System............................................3-19
Steering Wheel .....................................................3-20
Motor Driven Power Steering (MDPS) ......................3-20
Tilt Steering/Telescope Steering.................................3-21
Horn....................................................................................3-22
Heated Steering Wheel..................................................3-22
Hood ...................................................................................3-42
Non-Powered Liftgate...................................................3-43
Power Liftgate .................................................................3-45
Smart Liftgate ..................................................................3-51
Fuel Filler Door................................................................3-55
Emergency Fuel Filler Door Release..........................3-57
Instrument Cluster ...............................................3-58
Instrument Cluster Control............................................3-59
Gauges and Meters ........................................................3-59
Warning and Indicator Lights.......................................3-65
LCD Display Messages ...................................................3-76
LCD Display ...........................................................3-81
Mirrors...................................................................3-23
LCD Display Control........................................................3-81
LCD Display Modes.........................................................3-82
Inside Rearview Mirror ..................................................3-23
Side View Mirrors ...........................................................3-31
Trip Computer .......................................................3-85
H2O OUT ................................................................3-89
Windows ................................................................3-33
CSD (Cold Shut-Down)...................................................3-90
Power Windows ...............................................................3-34
Lighting..................................................................3-91
Sunroof..................................................................3-37
Exterior Lights .................................................................3-91
Welcome System ...........................................................3-101
Sunshade...........................................................................3-37
Tilt Open/Close ................................................................3-38
Slide open/close..............................................................3-39
Automatic Reversal ........................................................3-39
Resetting the sunroof....................................................3-41
Wipers and Washers..........................................3-103
Front Windshield Wipers.............................................3-103
Front Windshield Washers..........................................3-105
Rear Window Wiper and Washer..............................3-106
3
3
Driver Assist System .........................................3-107
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging............3-160
Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/Forward)
System .............................................................................3-107
Rear View Monitor .......................................................3-111
Surround View Monitoring .........................................3-112
Auto Defogging System (Additional Feature with
Automatic Temperature Control System)................3-162
Rear Window Defroster ..............................................3-163
Remote Smart Parking Assist (RSPA) .............3-115
Operating Condition......................................................3-116
Non-operating Condition ............................................3-117
Limitations of the System...........................................3-118
How the System Works (Smart Parking) ................3-122
How the System Works (Remote Smart Parking)..3-129
How the System Works (Smart Exit) .......................3-133
How the System Works (Remote Moving Forward/
Backward) .......................................................................3-140
Additional Instructions (Messages) ..........................3-145
Turn signal Showing Vehicle Status while System
in Activation....................................................................3-146
Smart Key Showing Vehicle Status while System
in Activation....................................................................3-147
Link with other Systems .............................................3-148
Automatic Climate Control System..................3-149
Automatic Temperature Control Mode ....................3-150
Manual Temperature Control Mode .........................3-150
System Operation .........................................................3-156
System Maintenance....................................................3-158
Climate Control Additional Features ...............3-164
Automatic Ventilation...................................................3-164
Sunroof Inside Air Recirculation ...............................3-164
Storage Compartment .......................................3-165
Center Console Storage ..............................................3-165
Glove Box........................................................................3-165
Interior Features ................................................3-166
Cup Holder ......................................................................3-166
Sunvisor...........................................................................3-167
Power Outlet ..................................................................3-168
AC Inverter......................................................................3-169
USB Charger...................................................................3-171
Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System..............3-171
Clock.................................................................................3-173
Coat Hook .......................................................................3-174
Floor Mat Anchor(s).....................................................3-174
Luggage Net Holder .....................................................3-175
Cargo Security Screen.................................................3-176
Exterior Features...............................................3-178
Roof Side Rails ..............................................................3-178
ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Door Lock
Door Unlock
Liftgate Unlock
Panic
Remote Smart Parking Assist
(if equipped)
6. Remote Start (if equipped)
Smart Key
■ Type A
OFE048006N
Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key,
which you can use to lock or unlock
the driver and passenger doors or
the rear liftgate.
3
OFE048003
To lock your vehicle using the door
handle button or the Smart Key:
1. Make sure all doors, the hood and
the liftgate are closed.
2. Make sure you have the smart key
in your possession.
3. Press either the button on the
door handle or the Door Lock button (1) on the smart key. The
chime will sound once and the
hazard warning lights will blink.
4. Make sure the doors are locked by
checking the position of the door
lock button inside the vehicle.
3-3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048005
■ Type B
Locking your vehicle
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
Unlocking your vehicle
The door handle button will only
operate when the smart key is within
28~40 inches (0.7~1 m) from the outside door handle.
Note that you cannot lock your vehicle using the door handle button if
any of the following occur:
• The Smart Key is in the vehicle.
• The POWER button is in ACC or
ON position.
• Any of the doors are open except
for the liftgate.
WARNING
Do not leave the Smart Key in
your vehicle with unsupervised
children. Unattended children
could press the POWER button
and may operate power windows or other controls, or even
make the vehicle move, which
could result in serious injury or
death.
3-4
OFE048004
To unlock your vehicle:
1. Make sure you have the smart key
in your possession.
2. Press either the button on the
door handle or the Door Unock
button (2) on the smart key. The
driver's door will unlock and the
hazard warning lights will blink two
times.
Two Press Unlock Feature
The priority for unlocking the driver
door only, or unlocking all the doors
with one press may be adjusted in
the User Settings mode in the
Infotainment system LCD display.
The Two Press Unlock feature, when
enabled, will require the user to
press the door unlock button once for
driver door only and twice for unlocking all the doors within 4 seconds.
Select or Deselect the Two Press
Unlock feature in the User Settings
mode in the Infotainment system
LCD display. The option can be
found under the following menu:
Vehicle Settings mode ➞ Door/Liftgate
➞ Two Press Unlock
i Information
• The door handle buttons will only
operate when the smart key is within 28-40 inches (0.7~1m) from the
outside door handle
• Either the driver or front passenger
door can be opened with the door
handle button when the smart key is
within this range
• If you press the front passenger outside door handle with the smart key
in your possession, all the doors will
unlock
Opening the liftgate
Non-power liftgate
To unlock and open the liftgate:
1. Make sure you have the smart key
in your possession.
2. Press either the liftgate handle
release switch on the vehicle or
press and hold the Liftgate Unlock
button on the smart key for more
than one second. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times
and the liftgate latch will unlock.
3. Once the liftgate is opened and
then closed, the liftgate will automatically re-lock after 30 seconds.
i Information
• The liftgate handle switch will only
operate when the smart key is within 28 inches (0.7 m) from the liftgate
handle.
• The Liftgate Unlock button (3) will
only unlock the liftgate. It will not
release the latch and open the liftgate automatically. If the Liftgate
Unlock button is used, someone
must still press the liftgate handle
switch to open the liftgate.
Power liftgate
To unlock and open the liftgate:
1. Make sure you have the smart key
in your possession.
2. Press either the liftgate handle
release switch on the vehicle or
press and hold the Liftgate Unlock
button on the smart key for more
than one second. The hazard
warning lights will blink two times
and the liftgate latch will open.
3. Once the liftgate is opened and
then closed, the liftgate will automatically re-lock after 30 seconds.
i Information
The liftgate handle switch will only
operate when the smart key is within
28 inches (0.7 m) from the liftgate
handle.
3-5
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The Two Press Unlock feature can
also be enabled or disabled by
pressing the door lock and unlock
buttons simultaneously on the Key
FOB:
Press and hold both the Door Lock
button and the Door Unlock button
simultaneously until the hazard
warning lights blink.
This will enable or disable the Two
Press Unlock feature. Repeat this
procedure to enable/disable the
mode again.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Panic button
Remote start (if equipped)
Press and hold the Panic button (4)
for more than one second. The horn
sounds and hazard warning lights
blink for about 30 seconds. To cancel
the panic mode, press any button on
the Smart Key.
You can start the vehicle using the
remote start button (6) of the smart
key.
Start-up
You can start the vehicle without
inserting the key.
For information, refer to the
"POWER button" section in chapter 5.
NOTICE
To prevent damaging the smart
key:
• Keep the smart key in a cool, dry
place to avoid damage or malfunction. Exposure to moisture
or high temperature may cause
the internal circuit of the smart
key to malfunction which may
not be covered under warranty.
• Avoid dropping or throwing the
smart key.
• Protect the smart key from
extreme temperatures.
3-6
To start the vehicle remotely :
- Lock the doors by pressing the
door lock button (1) within 32 ft (10
m) distance from the vehicle.
- Press the remote start button for
over 2 seconds within 4 seconds
after locking the doors.
Press the remote start button once to
turn off the vehicle.
Air conditioner/heater system maintains the status before turning off the
vehicle.
If no further action for operating/driving the vehicle is taken, the vehicle
will be turned off 10 minutes after
starting the vehicle remotely.
CAUTION
• Laws in your country may
restrict the use of remote start.
You should check country regulations before using this
remote starting system.
• It is only possible to start the
vehicle remotely when shifted
to P (Park).
• If the hood or the liftgate is
opened, you cannot start the
vehicle remotely.
• The Remote start function
works the same as Blue Link
remote start. For further caution information, refer to the
separately supplied "Blue
Link (Infotainment system)
manual".
Remote Smart Parking Assist
(RSPA) (if equipped)
If the Smart Key does not operate
normally, you can lock or unlock the
driver's door by using the mechanical
key.
To reinstall the mechanical key into
the FOB, insert the key in the top of
the key FOB and push inward until a
click sound is heard.
Loss of a smart key
A maximum of two Smart Keys can
be registered to a single vehicle. If
you happen to lose your smart key,
you should immediately take the
vehicle and remaining keys to your
authorized HYUNDAI dealer or tow
the vehicle, if necessary.
OFE048007
To remove the mechanical key from
the smart key FOB, slide the release
lever in the direction of the arrow (1)
and then pull the mechanical key (2)
outward.
To unlock the vehicle using the
mechanical key. insert the mechanical key into the key hole in the driver
door (Refer to "DOOR LOCKS" in
this chapter.)
3-7
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The Remote Smart Parking Assist
(RSPA) system helps the drivers
park their vehicle by using sensors to
measure parking spaces and control
the steering wheel, gear shift and
vehicle speed to semi-automatically
park the vehicle and provide instruction on the Infotainment system
screen to help through parking.
The driver can activate the RSPA
system after measuring the parking
spaces or using the smart key.
It is also possible to move the vehicle
forward or backward using the buttons (5) on the smart key.
For more details, refer to "Remote
Smart Parking Assist (RSPA)" in this
chapter.
Mechanical key
Convenience features of your vehicle
Smart key precautions
The smart key may not work if any of
the following occur:
• The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station
or an airport which can interfere
with normal operation of the transmitter.
• The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular
phone.
• Another vehicle's smart key is being
operated close to your vehicle.
If the smart key does not work correctly, open and close the door with
the mechanical key. If you have a
problem with the smart key, contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If the smart key is in close proximity
to your mobile phone, the signal
could be blocked by your mobile
phone's normal operational signals.
This is specifically relevant when the
phone is active such as making and
receiving calls, text messaging,
and/or sending/receiving emails.
When possible, avoid keeping the
remote key and your mobile phone in
the same location such as a pants or
jacket pocket in order to avoid interference between the two devices.
NOTICE
Keep the smart key away from
electromagnetic materials that
blocks electromagnetic waves to
the key surface.
NOTICE
Always have the smart key with
you when leaving the vehicle. If
the smart key is left near the vehicle, the vehicle battery may be discharged.
3-8
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user's authority to operate
the device.
Battery replacement
OFE048009
If you suspect your smart key might
have sustained some damage, or
you feel your smart key is not working correctly, contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A
BUTTON BATTERY.
If swallowed, a lithium button
battery can cause severe or
fatal injuries within 2 hours.
Keep batteries out of reach of
children. If you think batteries
may have been swallowed or
placed inside any part of the
body, seek immediate medical
attention.
i Information
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s)
or regulations.
OFE048008
If the Smart Key is not working properly, try replacing the battery with a
new one.
3-9
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Battery Type: CR2032
To replace the battery:
1. Remove the mechanical key.
2. Use a slim tool to pry open the
rear cover of the smart key.
3. Remove the old battery and insert
the new battery. Make sure the
battery position is correct.
4. Reinstall the rear cover of the
smart key.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system protects
your vehicle from theft. If an improperly coded key (or other device) is
used, the power system is disabled.
When the POWER button is placed
in the ON position, the immobilizer
system indicator should come on
briefly, then go off. If the indicator
starts to blink, the system does not
recognize the coding of the key.
Place the POWER button to the OFF
position, then place the POWER button to the ON position again.
In some circumstances, the vehicle
may not recognize your smart key if
another smart key device is nearby
or a metal object such as a key chain
is causing interference with the
smart key.
If this occurs, your vehicle may not
start. Remove any metal objects or
additional keys near the smart key
before attempting to start the vehicle
again.
3-10
If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of the key, it is
recommended that you contact your
HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle inoperable.
WARNING
In order to prevent theft of your
vehicle, do not leave spare keys
anywhere in your vehicle. Your
immobilizer password is a customer unique password and
should be kept confidential.
NOTICE
The transponder in your key is an
important part of the immobilizer
system. It is designed to give
years of trouble-free service, however you should avoid exposure to
moisture, static electricity and
rough handling. Immobilizer system malfunction could occur.
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user's authority to operate
the device.
DOOR LOCKS
Door unlocking from outside
the vehicle
Smart key
Approach unlock system
The outside door handle will slide out
and the doors will unlock when the
driver approaches the vehicle possessing the smart key.
OFE048002
FE-TAG-13
• When the "Approach unlock" is
activated :
- If you approach (within 40 in.(1
m)) the driver or front passenger's door handle possessing the
smart key, the outside door handles slide out and the doors are
unlocked. In this case, Hazard
Warning Flasher blinks twice and
chime also sounds twice.
- After first approach, the vehicle
tries detecting the smart key
every 5 seconds and if the key is
not detected, the doors will lock
automatically and the handles will
slide in.
FE-TAG-10
3-11
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The driver can activate/deactivate
the "Approach unlock" system on the
Infotainment system screen.
Go to "Vehicle settings → Door/
Tailgate → Approach unlock".
• When the "Approach unlock" is
deactivated :
- The handle does not slide out
even when you approach with the
smart key in possession. The
doors are unlocked if you press
the outside handle as the handles
slide out.
• The doors will lock automatically
and the handles will slide in after
30 seconds unless a door is
opened.
• Unlock the door and pull the outside handle to open the door.
• Push the door to close.
Convenience features of your vehicle
NOTICE
• If the door is locked/unlocked
multiple times in rapid succession with the smart key, door
lock button or door lock switch,
the system may stop operating
temporarily in order to protect
the circuit. Also, the "Approach
unlock" system may not operate. Try operation after a sufficient time in case the system
does not operate due to multiple
operations.
• "Approach unlock" system is
not operated continuously.
Retry after a certain period of
time when all the doors are
closed.
Mechanical key
FE-TAG-7
FE-TAG-8
1. Push the front side of the door
handle.
2. Pull the rear side of the handle
while holding it.
FE-TAG-3
3. Open the plug by using the
mechanical key.
3-12
NOTICE
Excessive force applied on the
door and door handle may result
in damage.
WARNING
• Close the door tightly or door
FE-TAG-6
4. Put the key in and turn it clockwise.
FE-TAG-4
5. Pull the handle.
body parts are not caught
between the doors when
opening/closing the doors.
• Make sure the fingers or other
body parts are caught inside
the handle while the handle is
pulled. The door may not fully
close if the handle is back to
its normal position due to any
foreign material.
3-13
Convenience features of your vehicle
may reopen.
• Make sure the fingers or other
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Door locking from outside the
vehicle
Smart key
Operating Door Locks from
Inside the Vehicle
With the door lock button
FE-TAG-12
FE-TAG-11
FE-TAG-9/OFE048436L
3-14
• To lock the doors, press the button
on the outside door handle while
carrying the smart key with you.
The handle will slide in as it's
locked. In this case, Hazard
Warning Flasher blinks and chime
also sounds once.
OFE048011
• To unlock a door, push the door
lock button (1) to the "Unlock" position. The red mark (2) on the door
lock button will be visible.
• To lock a door, push the door lock
button (1) to the "Lock" position. If
the door is locked properly, the red
mark (2) on the door lock button
will not be visible.
• To open a door, pull the door handle (3) outward.
• If the inner door handle of either
the driver door or passenger door
is pulled when the door lock button
is in the lock position, the button is
unlocked and the door will open.
• The doors cannot be locked if the
smart key is inside the vehicle and
any of the doors are open.
i Information
When the vehicle's battery run out
and you leave the vehicle, make sure
all the doors are locked. You can lock
the driver's door with a key and the
rest of the doors with the lock button
above the door inside handle.
With the central door lock
switch
■ Driver's door
■ Passenger's door
3
OFE048012N
The driver side and front passenger
side door armrest is equipped with a
central door lock switch. The lock
button is indicated by a ( ) symbol.
The unlock button is indicated by a
( ) symbol.
When the lock button (1) is pressed,
all the vehicle doors will lock.
When the unlock button (2) is
pressed, all the vehicle doors will
unlock.
If the smart key is in the vehicle and
any door is open, the doors will not
lock even though the lock button (1)
is pressed.
3-15
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
If a power door lock ever fails to function while you are in the vehicle try
one or more of the following techniques to exit:
• Operate the door unlock feature
repeatedly (both electronic and
manual) while simultaneously
pulling on the door handle.
• Operate the other door locks and
handles, front and rear.
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
• The doors should always be
fully closed and locked while
the vehicle is in motion. If the
doors are unlocked, the risk of
being thrown from the vehicle
in a crash is increased.
• Do not pull the inner door
handle of the driver's or passenger's door while the vehicle is moving.
3-16
WARNING
Do not leave the elderly, children or animals unattended in
your vehicle. An enclosed vehicle can become extremely hot,
causing death or serious injury
to the elderly, unattended children or animals who cannot
escape from the vehicle.
Children might operate features
of the vehicle that could injure
them, or they could encounter
other harm, possibly from someone gaining entry to the vehicle.
WARNING
Always secure your vehicle.
Leaving your vehicle unlocked
increases the potential risk to
you or others from someone
hiding in your vehicle.
To secure your vehicle, while
depressing the brake, move the
shift lever to the P (Park) position, engage the parking brake,
and place the POWER button in
the LOCK/OFF position, close
all windows, lock all doors, and
always take the key with you.
CAUTION
WARNING
If you stay in the vehicle for a
long time while the weather is
very hot or cold, there are risks
of injuries or danger to life. Do
not lock the vehicle from the
outside when someone is in the
vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with features that will automatically lock or
unlock your vehicle based on settings you select in the Infotainment
system LCD display.
Auto LOCK - Enable on Speed
When this feature is set in the
Infotainment system LCD display, all
the doors will be locked automatically when the vehicle exceeds 9 mph
(15 kph).
Auto LOCK - Enable on Shift
When this feature is set in the
Infotainment system LCD display, all
the doors will be locked automatically when the vehicle is shifted out of P
(Park) while the vehicle is ON.
Auto UNLOCK - On shift to P
When this feature is set in the
Infotainment system LCD display, all
the doors will be unlocked automatically when the vehicle is shifted back
into P (Park).
For more information on these
features, refer to the LCD Display
section later in this chapter.
Auto UNLOCK – On vehicle Off
When this feature is set in the
Infotainment system LCD display, all
the doors will be unlocked automatically when the vehicle is off.
Additional Unlock Safety
Feature - Air Bag Deployment
As an additional safety feature, all
doors will be automatically unlocked
when an impact causes the air bags
to deploy.
3-17
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Opening a door when something
is approaching may cause damage or injury. Be careful when
opening doors and watch for
vehicles, motorcycles, bicycles
or pedestrians approaching the
vehicle in the path of the door.
Automatic Door Lock and
Unlock Features
Convenience features of your vehicle
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks
To allow a rear door to be opened
from inside the vehicle, unlock the
child safety lock.
WARNING
OFE048013N
The child safety lock is provided to
help prevent children seated in the
rear from accidentally opening the
rear doors. The rear door safety locks
should be used whenever children
are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock is located on
the edge of each rear door. When the
child safety lock is in the lock position, the rear door will not open if the
inner door handle is pulled.
To lock the child safety lock, insert a
small flat blade tool (like a screwdriver or similar) (1) into the slot and turn
it to the lock position as shown.
3-18
If children accidently open the
rear doors while the vehicle is
in motion, they could fall out of
the vehicle. The rear door safety
locks should always be used
whenever children are in the
vehicle.
THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM
Once the security system is set,
opening any door, the liftgate, or the
hood without using the smart key will
cause the alarm to activate.
The Theft Alarm System will not set if
the hood, the liftgate, or any door is
not fully closed. If the system will not
set, check the hood, the liftgate, or
the doors are fully closed.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it.
i Information
• Do not lock the doors until all passengers have left the vehicle. If the
remaining passenger leaves the
vehicle when the system is armed,
the alarm will be activated.
• If the vehicle is not disarmed with the
smart key, open the doors by using
the mechanical key and start the
vehicle (
indicator ON) by
directly pressing the POWER button
with the smart key.
• When the system is disarmed but a
door or liftgate is not opened within
30 seconds, the system will be
rearmed.
3-19
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
This system helps to protect your
vehicle and valuables. The horn will
sound and the hazard warning lights
will blink continuously if any of the
following occurs:
- A door is opened without using the
smart key.
- The liftgate is opened without
using the smart key.
- The hood is opened.
The alarm continues for 30 seconds,
then the system resets. To turn off
the alarm, unlock the doors with the
smart key.
The Theft Alarm System automatically sets 30 seconds after you lock
the doors and the liftgate. For the
system to activate, you must lock the
doors and the liftgate from outside
the vehicle with the smart key or by
pressing the button on the outside of
the door handles with the smart key
in your possession.
The hazard warning lights will blink
and the chime will sound once to
indicate the system is armed.
Convenience features of your vehicle
STEERING WHEEL
Motor Driven Power Steering
(MDPS)
The system assists you with steering
the vehicle. If the vehicle is turned off
or if the power steering system
becomes inoperative, you may still
steer the vehicle, but it will require
increased steering effort.
Should you notice any change in the
effort required to steer during normal
vehicle operation, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
CAUTION
If the Motor Driven Power
Steering System does not operate normally, the warning light
(
) will illuminate on the
instrument cluster. You may
steer the vehicle, but it will
require increased steering
efforts. Take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked as
soon as possible.
3-20
i Information
The following symptoms may occur
during normal vehicle operation:
• The steering effort may be high
immediately after placing the
POWER button in the ON position.
This happens as the system performs
the MDPS system diagnostics. When
the diagnostics is completed, the
steering wheel will return to its normal condition.
• When the battery voltage is low, you
might have to put more steering
effort. However, it is a temporary
condition so that it will return to normal condition after charging the battery.
• A click noise may be heard from the
MDPS relay after the POWER button is in the ON or OFF position.
• Motor noise may be heard when the
vehicle is at a stop or at a low driving
speed.
• When you operate the steering wheel
in low temperature, abnormal noise
may occur. If temperature rises, the
noise will disappear. This is a normal
condition.
• When an error is detected from the
MDPS, the assistant function of
steering effort will not be activated in
order to prevent fatal accidents.
Instrument cluster warning lights
may be on or the steering effort may
be high. When the following symptoms occur, immediately drive the
vehicle to a safe area and check it.
Tilt Steering / Telescope Steering
CAUTION
Adjust the steering wheel so it points
toward your chest, not toward your
face. Make sure you can see the
instrument cluster warning lights and
gauges. After adjusting, push the
steering wheel both up and down to
be certain it is locked in position.
Always adjust the position of the
steering wheel before driving.
NEVER adjust the steering
wheel while driving. This may
cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident.
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
While adjusting the steering
wheel height, please do not
push or pull it hard since the fixture can be damaged.
OFE048014
To change the steering wheel angle
and height:
1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1).
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the
desired angle (2) and height (3).
3. Pull up the lock-release lever to
lock the steering wheel in place.
i Information
After adjustment, sometimes the lock
release lever may not lock the steering
wheel. It is not a malfunction. This
occurs when two gears are not
engaged correctly. In this case, adjust
the steering wheel again and then lock
the steering wheel.
3-21
Convenience features of your vehicle
Horn
Heated Steering Wheel
(if equipped)
NOTICE
Do not install any cover or accessory on the steering wheel. The
cover or accessory could cause
damage to the heated steering
wheel system.
OFE048016
To sound the horn, press the area
indicated by the horn symbol on your
steering wheel (see illustration). The
horn will operate only when this area
is pressed.
NOTICE
Do not strike the horn severely to
operate it, or hit it with your fist.
Do not press on the horn with a
sharp-pointed object.
3-22
OFE048015
When the POWER button is in the
ON position or when the vehicle is in
the ready (
) mode, press the
heated steering wheel button to
warm the steering wheel. The indicator on the button will illuminate.
To turn the heated steering wheel off,
press the button again. The indicator
on the button will turn off.
The heated steering wheel will automatically turn off after approximately
30 minutes.
MIRRORS
Inside Rearview Mirror
Before driving your vehicle, check to
see that your inside rearview mirror
is properly positioned. Adjust the
rearview mirror so that the view
through the rear window is properly
centered.
Make sure your line of sight is
not obstructed. Do not place
objects in the rear seat, cargo
area, or behind the rear headrests which could interfere with
your vision through the rear
window.
NEVER adjust the mirror while
driving. This may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
NOTICE
When cleaning the mirror, use a
paper towel or similar material
dampened with glass cleaner. Do
not spray glass cleaner directly on
the mirror as this may cause the
liquid cleaner to enter the mirror
housing.
Electric chromic mirror (ECM)
with compass and HomeLink®
system
Your vehicle may be equipped with a
Gentex Automatic-Dimming Mirror
with a Z-Nav™ Electronic Compass
Display and an Integrated HomeLink®
Wireless Control System.
During nighttime driving, this feature
will automatically detect and reduce
rearview mirror glare while the compass indicates the direction the vehicle is pointed. The HomeLink®
Universal Transceiver allows you to
activate your garage door(s), electric
gate, home lighting, etc.
WARNING
To prevent serious injury during
an accident or deployment of
the air bag, do not modify the
rearview mirror and do not
install a wide mirror.
3-23
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
WARNING
Convenience features of your vehicle
Automatic-Dimming Night Vision
Safety™ (NVS®) Mirror
(if equipped)
The NVS® Mirror automatically
reduces glare by monitoring light levels in the front and the rear of the
vehicle. Any object that obstructs
either light sensor will degrade the
automatic dimming control feature.
OFE048018N
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Channel 1 button
Channel 2 button
Status indicator LED
Channel 3 button
Rear light sensor
Dimming ON/OFF button
Compass control button
Compass display
3-24
For more information regarding
NVS® mirrors and other applications, please refer to the Gentex
website:
www.gentex.com
The auto-dimming function can be
controlled by pressing the ON/OFF
button:
1. Pressing the button turns the autodimming function OFF which is
indicated by the green Status
Indicator LED turning off.
2. Pressing the button again turns
the auto-dimming function ON
which is indicated by the green
Status Indicator LED turning on.
The mirror defaults to the ON position each time the vehicle is started.
Z-Nav™ Compass Display
The NVS™ Mirror in your vehicle is
also equipped with a Z-Nav™
Compass that shows the vehicle
Compass heading in the Display
Window using the 8 basic cardinal
headings (N, NE, E, SE, etc.).
Compass function
The Compass can be turned ON and
OFF and will remember the last state
when the ignition is cycled. To turn
the display feature ON/OFF:
1. Press and release the
button to
turn the display feature OFF.
2. Press and release the
button
again to turn the display back ON.
Additional options can be set with
press and hold sequences of the button and are detailed below.
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
There is a difference between magnetic north and true north. To compensate for this difference you will
need to adjust the Zone setting
based on where you live.
B520C05NF
3-25
Convenience features of your vehicle
To adjust the Zone setting:
1. Determine the desired Zone
Number based upon your current
location on the Zone Map.
2. Press and hold the
button for
more than 3 but less than 6 seconds, the current Zone Number
will appear on the display.
3. Pressing and holding the
button
again will cause the numbers to
increment (Note: they will repeat
…13, 14, 15, 1, 2, …). Releasing
the button when the desired Zone
Number appears on the display
will set the new Zone.
4. Within about 5 seconds the compass will start displaying a compass heading again.
There are some conditions that can
cause changes to the vehicle magnets, such as installing a ski rack or
a CB antenna. Body repair work on
the vehicle can also cause changes
to the vehicle's magnetic field. In
these situations, the compass will
need to be re-calibrated to quickly
correct these changes.
3-26
If you need to recalibrate the compass:
1. Press and hold the
button for
more than 6 seconds. When the
compass memory is cleared a "C"
will appear in the display.
2. Drive the vehicle in 2 complete circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
Integrated HomeLink® Wireless
Control System
The HomeLink® Wireless Control
System can replace up to three handheld radio-frequency (RF) transmitters with a single built-in device. This
innovative feature will learn the radio
frequency codes of most current
transmitters to operate devices such
as gate operators, garage door openers, entry door locks, security systems, even home lighting. Both standard and rolling code-equipped transmitters can be programmed by following the outlined procedures.
Additional HomeLink® information
can be found at: www.homelink.com
or by calling 1-800-355-3515.
Retain the original transmitter of the
RF device you are programming for
use in other vehicles as well as for
future HomeLink® programming. It is
also suggested that upon the sale of
the vehicle, the programmed
HomeLink® buttons be erased for
security purposes.
WARNING
Rolling code programming
Rolling code devices which are
"code-protected" and manufactured
after 1996 may be determined by the
following:
• Reference the device owner’s
manual for verification.
• The handheld transmitter appears
to program the HomeLink®
Universal Transceiver but does not
activate the device.
• Press and hold the trained
HomeLink button. The device has
the rolling code feature if the indicator light flashes rapidly and then
turns solid after 2 seconds.
3-27
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Before programming HomeLink®
to a garage door opener or gate
operator, make sure people and
objects are out of the way of the
device to prevent potential harm
or damage. Do not use the
HomeLink® with any garage door
opener that lacks the safety stop
and reverse features required by
U.S. federal safety standards (this
includes any garage door opener
model manufactured before April
1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object - signaling
the door to stop and reverse does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. Using a
garage door opener without
these features increases the risk
of serious injury or death.
Programming HomeLink®
Please note the following:
• When programming a garage door
opener, it is advised to park the
vehicle outside of the garage.
• It is recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held
transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink® for quicker
training and accurate transmission
of the radio-frequency signal.
• Some vehicles may require the
POWER button to be placed in the
ACC (or "Accessories") position for
programming and/or operation of
HomeLink®.
• In the event that there are still programming difficulties or questions
after following the programming
steps listed below, contact
HomeLink® at: www.homelink.com
or by calling 1-800-355-3515.
Convenience features of your vehicle
To train rolling code devices, follow
these instructions:
1. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage,
locate the "learn" or "smart" button. This can usually be found
where the hanging antenna wire is
attached to the motor-head unit.
Exact location and color of the button may vary by garage door
opener brand. If there is difficulty
locating the training button, reference the device owner’s manual or
please visit our Web site at
www.homelink.com.
2. Firmly press and release the
"learn" or "smart" button (which
activates the "training light"). You
will have 30 seconds to initiate
step 3.
3-28
3. Return to the vehicle and firmly
press, hold for two seconds and
then
release
the
desired
HomeLink® button. Repeat the
"press/hold/release" sequence a
second time to complete the programming. (Some devices may
require you to repeat this
sequence a third time to complete
the programming.)
4. Press and hold the just-trained
HomeLink® button and observe
the red Status Indicator LED. If the
indicator light stays on constantly,
programming is complete and
your device should activate.
5. To program the remaining two
HomeLink® buttons, follow either
steps 1 through 4 above for other
Rolling Code devices or steps 2
through 5 in Standard Programming
for standard devices.
Standard programming
To train most devices, follow these
instructions:
1. For first-time programming, press
and hold the two outside buttons,
HomeLink® Channel 1 and
Channel 3 Buttons, until the indicator light begins to flash (after 20
seconds). Release both buttons.
Do not hold the buttons for longer
than 30 seconds.
2. Position the end of your hand-held
transmitter 1-3 inches (2-8 cm)
away from the HomeLink® buttons
while keeping the indicator light in
view.
3. Simultaneously press and hold
both the HomeLink® and handheld transmitter button. DO NOT
release the buttons until step 4
has been completed.
4. While continuing to hold the buttons the red Indicator Status LED
will flash slowly and then rapidly
after HomeLink® successfully
trains to the frequency signal from
the hand-held transmitter. Release
both buttons.
Gate operator & Canadian programming
During programming, your handheld
transmitter may automatically stop
transmitting. Continue to press the
Integrated HomeLink® Wireless
Control System button (note
steps 2 through 4 in the Standard
Programming portion of this document) while you press and re-press
("cycle") your handheld transmitter
every two seconds until the frequency signal has been learned. The indicator light will flash slowly and then
rapidly after several seconds upon
successful training.
Operating HomeLink®
To operate, simply press and release
the programmed HomeLink® button.
Activation will now occur for the
trained device (for example, garage
door opener, gate operator, security
system, entry door lock, home/office
lighting, etc.). For convenience, the
hand-held transmitter of the device
may also be used at any time.
Reprogramming a single
HomeLink® button
To program a new device to a previously trained HomeLink® button, follow these steps:
1. Press and hold the desired
HomeLink® button. Do NOT
release until step 4 has been completed.
2. When the indicator light begins to
flash slowly (after 20 seconds),
position the handheld transmitter 1
to 3 inches away from the
HomeLink® surface.
3. Press and hold the handheld
transmitter button. The HomeLink®
indicator light will flash, first slowly
and then rapidly.
4. When the indicator light begins to
flash rapidly, release both buttons.
5. Press and hold the just-trained
HomeLink® button and observe
the red Status Indicator LED. If the
indicator light stays on constantly,
programming is complete and
your new device should activate.
3-29
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
5. Press and hold the just-trained
HomeLink® button and observe
the red Status Indicator LED. If the
indicator light stays on constantly,
programming is complete and
your device should activate when
the HomeLink® button is pressed
and released.
6. To program the remaining two
HomeLink® buttons, follow steps 2
through 5.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Erasing HomeLink® buttons
Individual buttons cannot be erased.
However, to erase all three programmed buttons:
1. Press and hold the two outer
HomeLink® buttons until the indicator light begins to flash-after 20
seconds.
2. Release both buttons. Do not hold
for longer than 30 seconds.
The Integrated HomeLink® Wireless
Control System is now in the training
(learn) mode and can be programmed at any time following the
appropriate steps in the Programming
chapters above.
NVS® is a registered trademark and
Z-Nav™ is a trademark of the Gentex
Corporation, Zeeland, Michigan.
HomeLink® is a registered trademark
owned by Johnson Controls,
Incorporated, Milwaukee, Wisconsin.
FCC ID : NZLHFCHL4
IC : 4112A-HFCHL4
3-30
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. The transceiver has been tested and
complies with FCC and Industry
Canada rules. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by
the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority
to operate the device.
i Information
FOR CANADA
This device complies with Industry
Canada Standard RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. The transceiver has been tested and
complies with FCC and Industry
Canada rules. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by
the party responsible for compliance could void the user's authority
to operate the device.
Side View Mirrors
Use the inside rear view mirror or
look back directly to determine the
actual distance of other vehicles
prior to changing lanes.
Side view mirror adjustment
WARNING
3
OFE048019
Make sure to adjust the side view
mirrors to your desired position
before you begin driving.
Your vehicle is equipped with both
left-hand and right-hand side view
mirrors. The mirrors can be adjusted
remotely with the remote switch. The
side view mirrors can be folded to
help prevent damage when going
through an automatic car wash or
when passing through a narrow
street.
The right side view mirror is convex.
Objects seen in the mirror are closer
than they appear.
NOTICE
• Do not scrape ice off the mirror
face; this may damage the surface of the glass.
• If the mirror is jammed with ice,
do not adjust the mirror by
force. Use an approved de-icer
(not radiator antifreeze) spray, or
a sponge or soft cloth with very
warm water, or move the vehicle
to a warm place and allow the
ice to melt.
OFE048430L
Adjusting the side view mirrors:
1. Press either the L (driver's side) or
R (passenger's side) button (1) to
select the side view mirror you
would like to adjust.
2. Use the mirror adjustment control
switch (2) to position the selected
mirror up, down, left or right.
NOTICE
Do not clean the mirror with harsh
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum
based cleaning products.
3-31
Convenience features of your vehicle
Do not adjust or fold the side
view mirrors while driving. This
may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Convenience features of your vehicle
NOTICE
Folding the side view mirror
• The mirrors stop moving when
they reach the maximum adjusting angles, but the motor continues to operate while the switch
is pressed. Do not press the
switch longer than necessary,
because this can damage the
motor.
• Do not attempt to adjust the side
view mirrors by hand, because
this can damage the motor.
• If 'Convenience → Welcome mirror/
light → On door unlock' and
'Convenience → Welcome mirror/
light → On driver approach' is
selected in the vehicle Settings
mode on the Infotainment system
screen, the side view mirror will
unfold automatically when you
approach the vehicle (all doors
closed and locked) with a smart key
in possession.
NOTICE
OFE048021
The side view mirror can be folded or
unfolded by pressing the switch.
• If 'Convenience → Welcome mirror/
light → On door unlock' is selected
in the vehicle Settings mode on the
Infotainment system screen, the
side view mirror will fold or unfold
automatically as follows:
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the smart key.
- The mirror will fold or unfold when
the door is locked or unlocked by
the button on the outside door
handle.
3-32
The electric type side view mirror
operates even though the POWER
button is in the OFF position.
However, to prevent unnecessary
battery discharge, do not adjust
the mirrors longer than necessary
while the vehicle is not in the
ready (
) mode.
NOTICE
Do not fold the electric type side
view mirror by hand. It could
cause motor failure.
WINDOWS
OFE048023N
3-33
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
(1) Driver's door power window
switch
(2) Front passenger's door power
window switch
(3) Rear door (left) power window
switch
(4) Rear door (right) power window
switch
(5) Window opening and closing
(6) Automatic power window
(if equipped)
(7) Power window lock switch
Convenience features of your vehicle
Power Windows
The POWER button must be in the
ON position to be able to raise or
lower the windows. Each door has a
Power Window switch to control that
door's window. The driver has a
Power Window Lock switch which
can block the operation of rear passenger windows. The power windows
will operate for approximately 10
minutes after the POWER button is
placed in the ACC or OFF position.
However, if the front doors are
opened, the Power Windows will not
operate even within the 10 minutes
period.
WARNING
To avoid serious injury or death,
do not extend your head, arms
or body outside the windows
while driving.
3-34
i Information
• In cold and wet climates, power windows may not work properly due to
freezing conditions.
• While driving with the rear windows down or with the sunroof (if
equipped) opened (or partially
opened), your vehicle may demonstrate a wind buffeting or pulsation
noise. This noise is normal and can
be reduced or eliminated by taking
the following actions. If the noise
occurs with one or both of the rear
windows down, partially lower both
front windows approximately one
inch. If you experience the noise
with the sunroof open, slightly close
the sunroof.
Window opening and closing
OFE048024
To open:
Press the window switch down to the
first detent position (5). Release the
switch when you want the window to
stop.
To close:
Pull the window switch up to the first
detent position (5). Release the window switch when you want the window to stop.
Auto up/down window
(if equipped)
If the power windows do not operate
normally, the automatic power window system must be reset as follows:
1. Place the POWER button to the
ON position.
2. Close the window and continue
pulling up on the power window
switch for at least one second.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, have the
system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
The automatic reverse feature
doesn't activate while resetting
the power window system. Make
sure body parts or other objects
are safely out of the way before
closing the windows to avoid
injuries or vehicle damage.
Automatic reverse (if equipped)
3
OLF044032
If a window senses any obstacle while
it is closing automatically, it will stop
and lower approximately 12 inches (30
cm) to allow the object to be cleared.
If the window detects the resistance
while the power window switch is
pulled up continuously, the window
will stop upward movement then
lower approximately 1 inch (2.5 cm).
If the power window switch is pulled
up continuously again within 5 seconds after the window is lowered by
the automatic window reverse feature, the automatic window reverse
will not operate.
3-35
Convenience features of your vehicle
Pressing or pulling up the power window switch momentarily to the second detent position (6) completely
lowers or lifts the window even when
the switch is released. To stop the
window at the desired position while
the window is in operation, pull up or
press down and release the switch.
To reset the power windows
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
Power window lock switch
The automatic reverse feature is only
active when the "Auto Up" feature is
used by fully pulling up the switch to
the second detent.
Do not allow children to play
with the power windows. Keep
the driver's door power window
lock switch in the LOCK position. Serious injury or death can
result from unintentional window operation by a child.
WARNING
Make sure body parts or other
objects are safely out of the way
before closing the windows to
avoid injuries or vehicle damage.
Objects less than 0.16 inch
(4 mm) in diameter caught
between the window glass and
the upper window channel may
not be detected by the automatic
reverse window and the window
will not stop and reverse direction.
NOTICE
Do not install any accessories on
the windows.The automatic reverse
feature may not operate.
3-36
WARNING
NOTICE
OFE048025
The driver can disable the power
window switches on the rear passenger doors by pressing the power window lock switch.
When the power window lock switch
is pressed:
• The rear passenger control will not
be able to operate the rear passenger power window
• Note that the front passenger control is still able to operate the front
passenger window, and that the
driver master control can still operate all the power windows.
• To prevent possible damage to
the power window system, do
not open or close two windows
or more at the same time. This
will also ensure the longevity of
the fuse.
• Never try to operate the main
switch on the driver's door and
the individual door window
switch in opposite directions at
the same time. If this is done, the
window will stop and cannot be
opened or closed.
SUNROOF (IF EQUIPPED)
If your vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, you can slide or tilt your
sunroof with the sunroof switch
located on the overhead console.
The sunroof can only be operated
when the Engine Start/Stop button
is in the ON or START position.
The sunroof can be operated for
approximately 10 minutes after the
Engine Start/Stop button is in the
ACC or OFF position.
Sunshade
• Never adjust the sunroof or
sunshade while driving. This
could result in loss of control
and an accident that may
cause injury, or property damage.
• Do not leave the engine running and the key in your vehicle with unsupervised children. Unattended children
could operate the sunroof,
which could result in serious
injury.
• Do not sit on the top of the
vehicle. It may cause injury or
vehicle damage.
3
OIK047091
Use the sunshade to block direct
sunlight coming through the sunroof
glass.
Open or close the sunshade by
hand.
NOTICE
Do not operate the sunroof when
roof bars are installed on the vehicle or when there is luggage on
the roof.
3-37
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048026N
WARNING
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
i Information
Tilt Open/Close
The sunshade opens automatically
when the sunroof glass is opened, but
the sunshade does not close automatically when the sunroof glass is closed.
Also, only the sunshade cannot be
closed when the sunroof glass is
opened.
The sunroof glass cannot slide open
and tilt open at the same time. You
cannot tilt the sunroof glass open
while the sunroof glass is slide open.
Also, you cannot slide the sunroof
glass open while the sunroof is tilt
open. Slide open or tilt open with the
sunroof glass when the sunroof glass is
completely closed.
NOTICE
Do not pull the sunshade up or
down, or apply excessive force as
such action may damage the sunshade or cause it to malfunction.
OFE042028L
1. Tilt open
2. Tilt close
• Push the sunroof switch upward,
the sunroof glass tilts open.
• Push the sunroof switch forward
when the sunroof glass is tilt
opened, the sunroof glass closes.
To stop the sunroof movement at any
point, push the sunroof switch in any
direction.
3-38
Slide open/close
• Push the sunroof switch rearward,
the sunshade and sunroof glass
slide open.
Push the sunroof switch forward,
only the sunroof glass closes.
• Push the sunroof switch forward or
rearward to the first detent position, the sunroof glass moves until
the switch is released.
i Information
To reduce wind noise while driving,
we recommend that you drive at the
recommended position before the
maximum slide open position.
Automatic Reversal
3
ODH043039
If the sunroof glass senses any
obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will reverse direction then
stop at a certain position.
The auto reverse function may not
work if an object thin or soft is caught
between the sliding sunroof glass
and sunroof sash.
3-39
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE042027L
• Push the sunroof switch forward or
rearward to the second detent
position, the sunroof glass operates automatically (auto slide feature). To stop the sunroof movement at any point, push the sunroof switch in any direction.
• The sunroof glass stops halfway
(first detent position) before it is
fully opened. To fully open the sunroof glass, push the sunroof switch
rearward once more. At this time,
the sunroof glass opens only while
the switch is pushed.
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
Make sure heads, hands, arms
or any other body parts or
objects are out of the way
before operating the sunroof.
Body parts or objects may get
caught causing injuries or vehicle damage.
Never deliberately use your
body parts to test the automatic
reversal function. The sunroof
glass may reverse direction, but
there is a risk of injury.
3-40
NOTICE
• Do not continue to push the
sunroof switch after the sunroof
is fully opened, closed, or tilted.
Damage to the sunroof motor
could occur.
• Continuous operations such as
slide open/close, tilt open/close,
etc. may cause the motor or sunroof system to malfunction.
• Regularly remove any accumulated dust on the sunroof rail.
• Dust accumulated between the
sunroof and roof panel can
make noise. Open the sunroof
and remove dust regularly using
a clean cloth.
• Do not try to open the sunroof
when the temperature is below
freezing or when the sunroof is
covered with snow or ice. The
sunroof may not work properly
and may break if opened by
force.
• Do not open or drive with the
sunroof glass open immediately
after rain or washing the vehicle.
Water may wet the interior of the
vehicle.
• Do not extend any luggage outside the sunroof while driving.
Vehicle damage may occur if the
vehicle suddenly stops.
WARNING
Do not extend your head, arms,
body parts or objects outside
the sunroof while driving.
Injuries may occur if the vehicle
suddenly stops.
Resetting the sunroof
Sunroof resetting procedure:
1. It is recommended to perform the
reset procedure with the vehicle
engine running. Start the vehicle in
P (Park).
2. Make sure the sunroof glass is in
the fully closed position. If the sunroof glass is open, push the switch
forward until the sunroof glass is
fully closed.
3. Release the switch when the sunroof glass is fully closed.
4. Push the switch forward until the
sunroof glass moves slightly. Then
release the switch.
Sunroof Open Warning
3
i Information
If the sunroof is not reset when the
vehicle battery is disconnected or discharged, or the sunroof fuse is blown,
the sunroof may not operate normally.
OFE040111
If the driver turns off the engine when
the sunroof is not fully closed, the
warning chime will sound for several
seconds and the sunroof open warning will appear on the cluster LCD
display. Close the sunroof securely
when leaving your vehicle.
CAUTION
Make sure the sunroof is closed
fully when leaving your vehicle.
If the sunroof is left open, rain or
snow may wet the interior of the
vehicle. Also, leaving the sunroof open when the vehicle is
unattended may invite theft.
3-41
Convenience features of your vehicle
In some circumstances resetting the
sunroof operation may need to be
performed. Some instances where
resetting the sunroof may be
required include:
• When the 12-volt battery is either
disconnected or discharged
• When the sunroof fuse is replaced
• If the sunroof one-touch AUTO
OPEN/CLOSE operation is not
functioning properly
5. Once again push and hold the
sunroof switch forward until the
sunroof glass slides open and
close. Do not release the switch
until the operation is completed. If
you release the switch during
operation, start the procedure
again from step 2.
Convenience features of your vehicle
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Closing the hood
Hood
Opening the hood
OFE048030N
OFE048029
1. Park the vehicle and set the parking brake.
2. Pull the release lever to unlatch
the hood. The hood should pop
open slightly.
3-42
3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise
the hood slightly, push up the secondary latch (1) inside of the hood
center and lift the hood (2). After it
has been raised about halfway, it
will raise completely by itself.
1. Before closing the hood, check the
following:
• All filler caps in fuel cell power
module compartment must be
correctly installed.
• Gloves, rags or any other combustible material must be
removed from the fuel cell power
module compartment.
2. Lower the hood halfway (lifted
approximately 12 inches (30 cm)
from the closed position) and push
down to securely lock in place.
Then double check to be sure the
hood is secure. If the hood can be
raised slightly, it is not securely
locked. Open it again and close it
with more force.
WARNING
• Before closing the hood,
3. With the Smart Key in your possession, press the liftgate handle
switch and open the liftgate.
Closing the liftgate
3
OFE048032
Before attempting to open the liftgate, make sure the vehicle is in P
(Park). To open the liftgate, perform
one the following:
1. Unlock all doors with the Door
Unlock button on your smart key.
From outside press the liftgate handle switch and open the liftgate.
2. Press and hold the Liftgate Unlock
button on the smart key. From outside press the liftgate handle
switch and open the liftgate.
OFE048033
Lower the liftgate lid and press down
until it locks. To be sure the liftgate lid
is securely fastened, always check
by trying to pull it up again without
pressing the liftgate handle switch.
i Information
In cold and wet climates, door lock
and door mechanisms may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
3-43
Convenience features of your vehicle
ensure all obstructions are
removed from around the
hood opening.
• Always double check to be
sure that the hood is firmly
latched before driving away.
Check there is no hood open
warning light or message displayed on the instrument cluster. Driving with the hood
opened may cause a total loss
of visibility, which might
result in an accident.
• Do not move the vehicle with
the hood in the raised position, as vision is obstructed,
which might result in an accident, and the hood could fall
or be damaged.
Non-Powered Liftgate
(if equipped)
Opening the liftgate
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
Emergency liftgate safety
release
WARNING
The liftgate swings upward.
Make sure no objects or people
are near the rear of the vehicle
when opening the liftgate.
NOTICE
Make certain that you close the
liftgate before driving your vehicle. Possible damage may occur
to the liftgate struts and mounting
hinges if the liftgate is not closed
prior to driving.
WARNING
Always keep the liftgate completely closed while the vehicle
is in motion. If it is left open or
ajar, poisonous exhaust gases
containing carbon monoxide
(CO) may enter the vehicle and
serious illness or death may
result.
3-44
OFE048035
OFE048034
Do not hold on to or try to pull
on the liftgate strut. Be aware
that the deformation of the liftgate strut may cause vehicle
damage and risk of injury.
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emergency liftgate safety release
lever located on the bottom of the liftgate inside the vehicle.
To unlock and open the liftgate manually from inside the luggage compartment, perform the following
steps:
1. Remove the cover.
2. Push the release lever to the right.
3. Push the liftgate outward and
upward.
WARNING
Power Liftgate (if equipped)
Power liftgate button
• Be aware of the location of the
OFE048471L
Power liftgate setting
When the POWER button is in the
ON position and the shift button is in
P (Park), the power liftgate can be
opened by using the console button
on the dash.
Before using the power liftgate, make
sure the power liftgate option is
selected in the Vehicle Setting
modes in the Infotainment system
LCD display.
'Vehicle Settings → Door/Liftgate →
Power Liftgate'
For more details, refer to the separately supplied Navigation manual.
i Information
The power liftgate operates only when
the shift button is in P (Park).
3-45
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
emergency liftgate safety
release lever in your vehicle
and know how to open the liftgate using the safety release
lever.
• No one should be allowed to
occupy the luggage compartment of the vehicle at any time.
The luggage compartment is a
very dangerous location in the
event of a crash.
• Use the release lever for emergencies only. Use extreme caution, especially while the vehicle is in motion.
Also, the speed of the power liftgate
can be adjusted in the Vehicle Settings
mode in the Infotainment system LCD
display.
'Vehicle Settings → Door/Liftgate →
Power Liftgate Speed → Fast/Slow'
- If the power liftgate function turns
off or the liftgate is not fully closed,
you cannot adjust the power liftgate speed.
- Initial speed of power liftgate is set
as "Fast".
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
Never leave children unattended
in your vehicle. Children might
operate the power liftgate.
Doing so could result in injury
to themselves or others, and
could damage the vehicle.
Opening the liftgate
The power liftgate will open automatically by doing one of the following:
WARNING
OFE048037
Make sure there are no people
or objects around the liftgate
before operating the power liftgate. Wait until the liftgate is
opened fully and stopped before
loading or unloading cargo or
passengers from the vehicle.
NOTICE
Do not close or open the power
liftgate manually. This may cause
damage to the power liftgate. If it
is necessary to close or open the
power liftgate manually when the
battery is discharged or disconnected, do not apply excessive
force.
3-46
OFE048036
Smart key liftgate unlock button
Press and hold the liftgate unlock
button on the smart key.
Power liftgate handle switch
Press the liftgate outside handle
switch while having the smart key
with you.
Closing the liftgate
The power liftgate will close automatically by doing one of the following:
3
OFE048040
Power liftgate inner button
Press the power liftgate inner button
for approximately 1 second. The liftgate will close and lock automatically.
In order to suddenly stop the movement of the liftgate while it is operating, quickly press the power liftgate
button.
OFE048036
Smart key liftgate unlock button
Press and hold the liftgate unlock
button on the smart key when the liftgate is opened. The liftgate will close
and lock automatically.
3-47
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048471L
Power liftgate button
Press the power liftgate button for
approximately one second.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Power liftgate non-opening conditions
The power liftgate does not open
when the vehicle is in motion.
WARNING
OFE048471L
Power liftgate button
Press the power liftgate button for
approximately one second. In order
to suddenly stop the movement of
the liftgate while it is operating,
quickly press the power liftgate button.
In order to suddenly stop the movement of the liftgate while it is operating, quickly press the power liftgate
button.
3-48
The chime will sound if you
drive with the liftgate opened.
Stop your vehicle immediately
at a safe place and check if your
liftgate is opened.
CAUTION
Operating the power liftgate
more than 5 times continuously
could cause damage to the operating motor. In this case, the
power liftgate system enters into
thermal protection mode to prevent the motor from overheating.
In thermal protection mode the
power liftgate will not operate. If
any of the power liftgate buttons
are pressed to try to open the
liftgate, the chime will sound 3
times but the liftgate will remain
closed.
Allow the power liftgate system
to cool for about 1 minute before
operating the system again.
NOTICE
If the automatic reversal feature
operates more than 2 times while
attempting to open or close the liftgate, the power liftgate may stop at
that position. If this occurs, carefully
close the liftgate manually, and then
try to operate the power liftgate automatically again.
WARNING
OFE048039
During power opening and closing if
the power liftgate is blocked by an
object or part of the body, the power
liftgate will detect the resistance.
If resistance is detected while opening or closing the power liftgate, the
liftgate will stop and move in the
opposite direction.
However, in some instances the
automatic reversal system may not
detect the object if it is too soft or is
very thin, or if the liftgate is almost
fully closed near the latched position.
Caution should be taken to prevent
any objects from obstructing the liftgate opeining.
Never intentionally place any
object or part of your body in
the path of the power liftgate to
make sure the automatic reversal operates.
CAUTION
Do not put heavy objects on the
power liftgate before you operate the power liftgate feature.
Additional weight may damage
the operation of the system.
3-49
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• The power liftgate can be operated when the vehicle is not running. However, the power liftgate
operation consumes a large
amount of electic power.
To prevent the battery from
being discharged, do not operate it excessively (e.g. more than
5 times repeatedly).
• To prevent the battery from
being discharged, do not leave
the power liftgate in the open
position for a long time.
• Do not modify or repair any part
of the power liftgate by yourself.
This must be done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• When jacking up the vehicle to
change a tire or repair the vehicle, do not operate the power
liftgate. This could cause the
power liftgate to operate
improperly.
• In cold and wet climates, the
power liftgate may not work
properly due to freezing conditions.
Automatic reversal
Convenience features of your vehicle
How to reset the power liftgate
If the battery has been discharged or
disconnected, or if the power liftgate
fuse has been replaced or removed,
reset the power liftgate by performing
the following procedure:
1. Put the shift button in P (Park).
2. Press the power liftgate inner button and the power liftgate outer
handle button simultaneously for
more than 3 seconds. The chime
will sound.
3. Close the liftgate manually.
If the power liftgate does not work
properly after the above procedure,
have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
When operating the power liftgate,
the gear shift button must be in
the (P) park position in order to
operate normally.
i Information
If the liftgate is stopped before the
tailgate is fully open, resetting will not
proceed. Wait until the tailgate is fully
open.
3-50
Power liftgate opening height
user setting
WARNING
Always keep the liftgate completely closed while the vehicle
is in motion. If it is left open or
ajar, poisonous exhaust gases
containing carbon monoxide
(CO) may enter the vehicle and
serious illness or death may
result.
WARNING
OFE048040
Follow the instructions below to set
the fully open height of the power liftgate:
1. Position the liftgate manually to
the height you prefer.
2. Press the power liftgate inner button for more than 3 seconds.
3. Close the liftgate manually after
hearing the buzzer sound.
The liftgate will open to the manually
adjusted height that was set.
Rear cargo area
Occupants should never ride in
the rear cargo area where no
restraints are available. To avoid
injury in the event of an accident or sudden stops, occupants should always be properly restrained.
Emergency liftgate safety
release
WARNING
Smart Liftgate (if equipped)
• Be aware of the location of the
Your vehicle is equipped with an
emergency liftgate safety release
lever located on the bottom of the liftgate inside the vehicle.
To unlock and open the liftgate manually from inside the luggage compartment, perform the following
steps:
1. Remove the cover.
2. Push the release lever to the right.
3. Push the liftgate outward and
upward.
3
OFE048041
On vehicles equipped with a smart
key, the liftgate can be opened with
hands-free activation using the
Smart Liftgate system.
3-51
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048034
emergency liftgate safety
release lever in your vehicle
and know how to open the liftgate using the safety release
lever.
• No one should be allowed to
occupy the luggage compartment of the vehicle at any time.
The luggage compartment is a
very dangerous location in the
event of a crash.
• Use the release lever for emergencies only. Use extreme caution, especially while the vehicle is in motion.
Convenience features of your vehicle
How to use the Smart Liftgate
The hands-free smart liftgate system
can be opened automatically when
the following conditions are met:
• The Smart Liftgate option is
enabled in the User Settings in the
Infotainment system screen.
• The Smart Liftgate is activated and
ready 15 seconds after all the
doors are closed and locked
• The Smart Liftgate will open when
the smart key is detected in the
area behind the vehicle for 3 seconds
i Information
The Smart Liftgate will NOT operate
when:
• Any door is open, or all doors are
closed but not locked
• The smart key is detected within 15
seconds from when the doors were
closed and locked
• For vehicles equipped with illuminated exterior front door handles, if
the smart key is detected within 15
seconds from when the doors were
closed and locked or if the smart key
is within 60 inches (1.5m) from the
front door handles
• The smart key is in the vehicle.
1. Setting
To activate the Smart Liftgate, go to
"Vehicle settings → Door/Tailgate"
and select Smart Tailgate (Liftgate)
on the Infotainment system screen.
For more information refer to the
separately supplied Navigation
manual.
2.Detect and Alert
The Smart Liftgate detecting area
extends approximately 20-40 in (50100 cm) behind the vehicle. If you
are positioned in the detecting area
and are carrying the smart key, the
hazard warning lights will blink and
the chime will sound to alert you that
the smart liftgate will open.
i Information
Do not approach the detecting area if
you do not want the liftgate to open. If
you have unintentionally entered the
detecting area and the hazard warning lights and chime starts to operate,
move away from the area behind the
vehicle with the smart key. The liftgate will remain closed.
3-52
3. Automatic opening
After the hazard warning lights blink
and the chime sounds 6 times, the
power liftgate will open.
WARNING
• The key should be kept out of
reach of children. Children
may inadvertently open the
Smart Liftgate while playing
around the rear area of the
vehicle.
How to deactivate the Smart
Liftgate function using the
smart key
3
• Make certain that you close
OFE048005
1. Door lock
2. Door unlock
3. Liftgate open
4. Panic
If you press any button on the smart
key during the Detect and Alert
stage, the Smart Liftgate function will
be deactivated.
Make sure to be aware of how to
deactivate the Smart Liftgate function for emergency situations.
3-53
Convenience features of your vehicle
the liftgate before driving your
vehicle.
• Make sure there are no people
or objects around the liftgate
before opening or closing the
liftgate.
• Make sure objects in the rear
cargo area do not come out
when opening the liftgate,
especially if the vehicle is
parked on a grade or incline.
• If you keep your vehicle
parked and locked on your
driveway, you may want to
temporarily deactivate the
Smart
Liftgate
system.
Otherwise, standing at the
rear of the vehicle with the
smart key may cause the liftgate to open unintentionally.
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
• If you press the door unlock button
(2), the Smart Liftgate function will
be deactivated temporarily. But, if
you do not open any door for 30 seconds, the Smart Liftgate function
will be activated again.
• If you press the liftgate open button
(3) for more than 1 second, the liftgate opens.
• The Smart Liftgate function will
still be activated if you press the
door lock button (1) or liftgate open
button (3) on the smart key as long
as the Smart Liftgate is not already
in the Detect and Alert stage.
• In case you have deactivated the
Smart Liftgate function by pressing
the smart key button and opened a
door, the Smart Liftgate function
can be activated again by closing
and locking all doors.
3-54
Detecting area
i Information
OFE048042N
• The Smart Liftgate detecting area
extends approximately 20-40 in
(50-100 cm) behind the vehicle. If
you are positioned in the detecting
area and are carrying the smart
key, the hazard warning lights will
blink and the chime will sound for
about 3 seconds to alert you that
the smart liftgate will open.
• The alert stops once the smart key
is moved outside of the detecting
area within the 3 second period.
• The Smart Liftgate function may
not operate properly if any of the
following instances occur:
- The smart key is close to a radio
transmitter such as a radio station
or an airport which can interfere
with normal operation of the
transmitter.
- The smart key is near a mobile two
way radio system or a cellular
phone.
- Another vehicle's smart key is
being operated close to your vehicle.
• The Smart Liftgate detecting area
may change when:
- The vehicle is parked on an incline
or slope
- One side of the vehicle is raised or
lowered relative to the opposite
side
Closing the fuel filler door
Fuel Filler Door
Opening the fuel filler door
1. Cover the fuel filler with the cap.
2. Close the fuel filler door until it is
latched securely.
WARNING
• If the fuel filler cap requires
OFE039063L
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Push the fuel filler door opener
button.
NOTICE
• The fuel filler door does not
open if the vehicle is not off.
• The fuel filler door may open after
several seconds from turning off
the vehicle. However, in cold
weather, the fuel door may not
open for about 45 seconds until
the cluster message "Powering
down..." disappears. This is for
protecting the fuel cell system.
i Information
If the fuel filler door does not open
because ice has formed around it, tap
lightly or push on the door to break
the ice and release the door. Do not
pry on the door. If necessary, spray
around the door with an approved deicer fluid (do not use radiator antifreeze) or move the vehicle to a warm
place and allow the ice to melt.
3-55
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFEQ018015N
3. Pull the fuel filler door (1) outward
to access the fuel filler cap.
4. Pull the fuel filler cap (2).
replacement, you should use
parts for replacement from an
authorized Hyundai dealer. An
incorrect fuel filler cap can
result in a serious malfunction of the fuel system or
emission control system. you
should contact your HYUNDAI
dealer for replacement.
• If the fuel filler door is not
completely closed, the vehicle
is not turned on. Close the
fuel filler door and turn on the
vehicle.
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
Refueling dangers
Automotive fuels are flammable
materials. When refueling, please
note the following guidelines
carefully. Failure to follow these
guidelines may result in severe
personal injury, severe burns or
death by fire or explosion.
• Read and follow all warning
posted at the gas station facility.
• Before touching the fuel nozzle, you should eliminate
potentially dangerous static
electricity discharge by touching another metal part of the
vehicle, a safe distance away
from the fuel filler neck, nozzle, or other gas source.
3-56
• Do not get back into a vehicle
• When refueling, always shut
once you have begun refueling
since you can generate static
electricity by touching, rubbing
or sliding against any item or
fabric (polyester, satin, nylon,
etc.) capable of producing static electricity. Static electricity
discharge can ignite fuel
vapors resulting in rapid burning. If you must reenter the
vehicle, you should once again
eliminate potentially dangerous static electricity discharge
by touching a metal part of the
vehicle, away from the fuel filler
neck, nozzle or other gasoline
source.
• Do not use cellular phones
while refueling. Electric current
and/or electronic interference
from cellular phones can
potentially ignite fuel vapors
causing a fire.
the power off. Once refueling
is complete, check to make
sure the filler cap and filler
door are securely closed,
before starting the vehicle.
• DO NOT use matches or a
lighter and DO NOT SMOKE or
leave a lit cigarette in your
vehicle while at a gas station
especially during refueling.
Automotive fuel is highly
flammable and can, when
ignited, result in fire.
• If a fire breaks out during refueling, leave the vicinity of the
vehicle, and immediately contact the manager of the gas
station and then contact the
local fire department. Follow
any safety instructions they
provide.
Emergency Fuel Filler Door
Release
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048419
If the fuel filler door does not open
due to the battery discharge and failure of the electrical wiring, open the
liftgate and lightly pull the handle
towards the arrow direction to open
the lid.
i Information
Do not pull the handle excessively,
otherwise the luggage area trim or
release handle may be damaged.
3-57
Convenience features of your vehicle
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
1. Power gauge
2. Speedometer
3. Fuel cell stack temperature gauge
4. Fuel gauge
5. Warning and indicator lights
6. Odometer/LCD display/Trip computer
The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ
from the illustration.
For more details, refer to the "Gauges and
Meters" in this chapter.
OFE041480N
3-58
Instrument Cluster Control
Adjusting instrument cluster
illumination
When the vehicle's position lights or
headlights are on, press the illumination control button to adjust the
brightness of the instrument panel
illumination.
When pressing the illumination control button, the interior switch illumination intensity is also adjusted.
Gauges and Meters
Speedometer
Never adjust the instrument
cluster while driving. Doing so
could lead to driver distraction
which may cause an accident
and lead to vehicle damage,
serious injury, or death.
• The brightness of the instrument
panel illumination is displayed.
• If the brightness reaches the maximum or minimum level, a chime
will sound.
3
OFE041481N
The speedometer indicates the
speed of the vehicle and is calibrated
in miles per hour (MPH) and/or kilometers per hour (km/h).
3-59
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE049043L
WARNING
Convenience features of your vehicle
Power gauge
• POWER : It shows the energy consumption rate of the vehicle when
driving uphill or accelerating. The
more electric energy is used, the
higher the gauge level.
Fuel cell stack temperature
gauge
OFE041102N
The power gauge shows the energy
consumption rate of the traction
motor.
• CHARGE : It shows the charging
status of the battery when it is
being charged by the regenerative
brakes (decelerating or driving on
a downhill road).
The more electric energy is
charged, the lower the gauge level.
• ECO : It shows the energy consumption rate during normal driving condition.
3-60
OFE041103N
This gauge shows the temperature
of the fuel cell stack coolant when
the POWER button is ON.
Do not continue driving with an overheated fuel cell stack. If your vehicle
overheats, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE - Fuel Cell Stack
Hydrogen fuel gauge
WARNING
Overheats
If the gauge pointer moves
beyond the normal range area
toward the "H" position, it indicates overheating that may damage the fuel cell stack.
Running Out of Fuel
WARNING
Radiator Cap
Never remove the radiator cap
when the fuel cell power module is hot. Otherwise the fuel
cell stack coolant may be under
pressure and cause severe
burns. Wait until the fuel cell
power module is cool before
adding coolant to the reservoir.
OFE041133N
This gauge indicates the approximate amount of fuel remaining in the
fuel tank (The fuel tank capacity is
given in chapter 8). The fuel gauge is
supplemented by a low fuel warning
light which will illuminate when the
fuel tank is nearly empty.
i Information - Hydrogen
Fueling Station
According to the hydrogen fueling station condition, the hydrogen fuel may
not filled fully.
3-61
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Running out of fuel can expose
vehicle occupants to danger.
You must stop and obtain additional fuel as soon as possible
after the warning light comes
on or when the gauge indicator
comes close to the ''E'' (Empty)
level.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Outside temperature gauge
The temperature unit (from °C to °F
or from °F to °C) can be changed by:
- Press the AUTO button while
pressing the OFF button on the climate control unit for 3 seconds
- Go to General settings mode →
Unit → Temperature in the
Infotainment system display.
Both the temperature unit on the
cluster LCD display and climate control screen will change.
Odometer
OFE041104N
OFE041106N
This gauge indicates the current outside air temperature by 1 degrees F
(1 degrees C).
- Temperature range : -40°F ~ 140°F
(-40°C ~ 60°C)
Note that the temperature indicated
on the LCD display may not change
as quickly as the outside temperature (there may be a slight delay
before the temperature changes.)
The odometer indicates the total distance that the vehicle has been driven and should be used to determine
when periodic maintenance should
be performed.
3-62
Range
i Information
• The range is the estimated distance the vehicle can be driven
with the remaining fuel.
• If the estimated distance is below
1 mi. (1 km), the trip computer will
display "---" as range.
• If the hydrogen supply line is empty,
the gauge may indicate that the
hydrogen is not in the hydrogen
tank.
3
OCN7040013N
This indicator displays which gear is
selected.
3-63
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE041482N
• If the vehicle is not on level ground
or the battery power has been interrupted, the range function may not
operate correctly.
• The range may differ from the actual driving distance as it is only an
estimate of the available driving
range for the vehicle and driving
conditions.
• The range may vary significantly
based on driving conditions, driving
habits, and condition of the vehicle.
Gear shift indicator
Convenience features of your vehicle
Regenerative braking rate indicator
Icy road warning light
(if equipped)
i Information
If the icy road warning light appears
while driving, you should drive more
attentively and safely refraining from
over-speeding, rapid acceleration,
sudden braking or sharp turning, etc.
OFE051018N
OFE041149N
While using the regenerative brakes,
you may select the regenerative
braking rate from 0 to 3 by pulling the
paddle shifter.
For more details, refer to
"Regenerative Braking System" in
chapter 5.
This warning light is to warn the driver the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside temperature gauge is approximately below 40°F (4°C), the Icy
Road Warning Light and Outside
Temperature Gauge blinks, and then
illuminates. Also, the warning chime
is sound.
3-64
Warning and Indicator lights
Service Warning Light
Power Down Warning
Light
This warning light illuminates :
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a problem with related parts of the fuel cell electric
vehicle control system, such as
sensors, etc.
This warning light illuminates :
• When the vehicle power should be
limited due to a malfunction with
fuel cell stack.
If the warning light continuously
remains on when the vehicle is in
"READY" state, or comes on during driving, this indicates that there
may be a malfunction with the fuel
cell stack. If this occurs, we recommend that you have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
Make sure that all warning lights are
OFF after starting the vehicle. If any
light is still ON, this indicates a situation that needs attention.
This indicator illuminates :
When the vehicle is ready to be driven.
- ON : Normal driving is possible.
- OFF : Normal driving is not possible,
or a problem has occurred.
- Blinking : Emergency driving.
When the ready indicator goes OFF
or blinks, there is a problem with the
system. In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
When the warning light illuminates
while driving, or does not go OFF
after starting the vehicle, have your
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the warning light turns on again
when restarting the vehicle after
parking your vehicle on an incline.
3-65
Convenience features of your vehicle
Ready Indicator
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Icy Road Warning Light
(if equipped)
Hydrogen Gas Leak
Warning Light
Low Fuel Level
Warning Light
This warning light is to warn the driver
the road may be icy.
When the temperature on the outside temperature gauge is approximately below 40°F (4°C), the Icy
Road Warning Light and Outside
Temperature Gauge blinks and then
illuminates. Also, the warning chime
sounds 1 time.
The Icy Road Warning function can
be activated or deactivated from the
Vehicle Settings mode in the
Infotainment system screen.
This warning light illuminates:
• [Red] When the hydrogen leakage
is detected in the vehicle.
• [Yellow] When there is a malfunction with the hydrogen leakage
detection sensor.
This warning light illuminates:
When the fuel tank is nearly empty.
i Information
If the icy road warning light appears
while driving, you should drive more
attentively and safely, refraining from
over-speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden braking or sharp turning, etc.
3-66
If the warning light continuously
remains on when the vehicle is in
"READY" state, or comes on during
driving, this indicates that there may
be hydrogen leakage or a malfunction with the hydrogen leakage
detection sensor. If this occurs, stop
the vehicle and have the hydrogen
system inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
If the fuel tank is nearly empty:
Add fuel as soon as possible.
Supplemental Restraint
System Warning Light
Seat Belt Warning Light
Regenerative Brake
Warning Light
(yellow)
This warning light informs the driver
that the seat belt is not fastened.
For more details, refer to the "Seat
Belts" in chapter 2.
This warning light illuminates :
When the regenerative brake does
not operate and the brake does not
perform well. This causes the Brake
Warning light (red) and Regenerative
Brake Warning Light (yellow) to illuminate simultaneously.
In this case, drive safely and have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The operation of the brake pedal may
be more difficult than normal and the
braking distance can increase.
3-67
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 6
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the SRS.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Parking Brake & Brake
Fluid Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds.
- It remains on if the parking brake
is applied.
• When the parking brake is applied.
• When the brake fluid level in the
reservoir is low.
- If the warning light illuminates
with the parking brake released, it
indicates the brake fluid level in
reservoir is low.
3-68
If the brake fluid level in the reservoir is low:
1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe
location and stop your vehicle.
2. With the vehicle turned off, check
the brake fluid level immediately
and add fluid as required (For more
details, refer to "Brake Fluid" in
chapter 7). After adding brake fluid,
check all brake components for fluid
leaks. If a brake fluid leak is found,
or if the warning light remains on, or
if the brakes do not operate properly, do not drive the vehicle. Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Dual-diagonal braking system
Your vehicle is equipped with dualdiagonal braking systems. This
means you still have braking on two
wheels even if one of the dual systems should fail.
With only one of the dual systems
working, more than normal pedal
travel and greater pedal pressure is
required to stop the vehicle.
Also, the vehicle will not stop in as
short a distance with only a portion
of the brake system working.
WARNING
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
Warning Light
Driving the vehicle with a warning light ON is dangerous. If the
Parking Brake & Brake Fluid
Warning Light illuminates with
the parking brake released, it
indicates that the brake fluid
level is low.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Electronic
Brake Force
Distribution
(EBD) System Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the ABS (The normal braking system will still be operational without
the assistance of the anti-lock
brake system).
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
These two warning lights illuminate
at the same time while driving:
When the ABS and regular brake system may not work normally.
In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
i Information - Electronic
Brake Force Distribution
(EBD) System Warning Light
When the ABS Warning Light is on or
both ABS and Parking Brake & Brake
Fluid Warning Lights are on, the
speedometer, odometer, or tripmeter
may not work. Also, the MDPS
Warning Light may illuminate and
the steering effort may increase or
decrease.
In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD) System
Warning Light
When both ABS and Parking
Brake & Brake Fluid Warning
Lights are on, the brake system
will not work normally and you
may experience an unexpected
and dangerous situation during
sudden braking.
In this case, avoid high speed
driving and abrupt braking.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
3-69
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Warning Light
Convenience features of your vehicle
Motor Driven Power
Steering (MDPS)
Warning Light
Charging System
Warning Light
(for 12-volt battery)
Low Tire Pressure
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the MDPS.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
• When the 12-volt battery level is
low or a failure occurs on the
charging system such as LDC.
• If the warning light turns on while
driving, move the vehicle to a safe
location, turn off and turn on the
vehicle again, and check if the
warning light turns off. If the warning light remains on, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Even if the warning light turns off,
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
If you drive the vehicle while the
warning light is on, vehicle speed
may be limited and the 12-volt battery may be discharged.
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When one or more of your tires are
significantly underinflated (The
location of each underinflated tire
is displayed on the LCD display).
❈ LDC : Low voltage DC-DC Converter.
3-70
For more details, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
This warning light remains ON
after blinking for approximately 60
seconds, or repeatedly blinks ON
and OFF in 3 second intervals:
When there is a malfunction with the
TPMS.
In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Safe Stopping
• The TPMS cannot alert you to
severe and sudden tire damage
caused by external factors.
• If you notice any vehicle instability, immediately take your
foot off the accelerator pedal,
apply the brakes gradually with
light force, and slowly move to
a safe position off the road.
EPB
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the EPB.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
The Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
Warning Light may illuminate when
the Electronic Stability control (ESC)
Indicator Light comes on to indicate
that the ESC is not working properly
(This does not indicate malfunction of
the EPB).
AUTO HOLD Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates:
• [White] When you activate the auto
hold system by pressing the AUTO
HOLD switch.
• [Green] When you stop the vehicle
completely by depressing the
brake pedal with the auto hold system activated.
• [Yellow] When there is a malfunction with the auto hold system.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Auto
Hold" in chapter 5.
3-71
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
For more details, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) Warning
Light
Convenience features of your vehicle
Forward Collision
Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system warning light
(if equipped)
This warning light illuminates :
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When the FCA system is turned off.
• When the radar sensor or cover is
blocked with dirt or snow. Check
the sensor and cover and clean
them by using a soft cloth.
• When there is a malfunction with
FCA. In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system indicator
light (if equipped)
LED Headlight Warning
Light (if equipped)
This indicator light illuminates:
• [Green] When the system operating conditions are satisfied for
LKA.
• [White] When system operating
conditions are not satisfied or
when the sensor does not detect
the lane line.
• [Yellow] When there is a malfunction with the Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
This warning light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the LED headlight.
In this case, have the vehicle inspected by an an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
For more details, refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA) system" in
chapter 5.
This warning light blinks:
When there is a malfunction with a
LED headlight related part.
In this case, have the vehicle
inspected by an an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
Continuous driving with the LED
Headlight Warning Light on or
blinking can reduce LED headlight
life.
3-72
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) Indicator
Light
Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) OFF
Indicator Light
This warning light illuminates:
When there is a malfunction in operation in any of the following systems:
- Forward
Collision-Avoidance
Assist malfunction (if equipped)
- Forward
Collision-Avoidance
Assist radar blocked (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning malfunction (if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar
blocked (if equipped)
- LED headlamp malfunction (if
equipped)
- High Beam Assist malfunction (if
equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control malfunction
(if equipped)
- Smart Cruise Control radar
blocked (if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) malfunction
To identify the details of the warning,
look at the LCD display.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When there is a malfunction with
the ESC system.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the POWER button is in the
ON position.
- It illuminates for approximately 3
seconds and then goes off.
• When you deactivate the ESC system by pressing the ESC OFF button.
For more details, refer to
"Electronic Stability Control (ESC)"
in chapter 5.
This indicator light blinks:
While the ESC is operating.
For more details, refer to
"Electronic Stability Control (ESC)"
in chapter 5.
3-73
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Master Warning Light
Convenience features of your vehicle
Immobilizer Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates for
up to 30 seconds:
When the vehicle detects the smart
key in the vehicle with the POWER
button in the ACC or ON position.
- At this time, you can start the vehicle.
- The indicator light goes off after
starting the vehicle.
This indicator light blinks for a few
seconds:
When the smart key is not in the
vehicle.
- At this time, you cannot start the
vehicle.
3-74
This indicator light illuminates for
2 seconds and goes off:
If the smart key is in the vehicle and
the POWER button is ON, but the
vehicle cannot detect the smart key.
In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Turn Signal Indicator
Light
This indicator light blinks:
• When the battery voltage of the
smart key is low.
- At this time, you can not start the
vehicle. However, you can start the
if you press the POWER button
with the smart key. (For more
details, refer to "Starting the
vehicle" in chapter 5).
• When there is a malfunction with
the immobilizer system.
In this case, have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
If any of the following occurs, there
may be a malfunction with the turn
signal system.
- The turn signal indicator light illuminates but does not blink
- The turn signal indicator light
blinks rapidly
- The turn signal indicator light
does not illuminate at all
If either of these conditions occur,
have your vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
This indicator light blinks:
When you operate the turn signal
indicator.
Light ON Indicator
Light
ECO Mode Indicator
Light
This indicator light illuminates:
• When the headlights are on and in
the high beam position.
• When the turn signal lever is pulled
into the Flash-to-Pass position.
This indicator light illuminates:
When the tail lights or headlights are
on.
This indicator light illuminates :
When you select "ECO" mode as
drive mode.
For more details, refer to "Drive
Mode Integrated Control System"
in this chapter.
3-75
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
High Beam Indicator
Light
Convenience features of your vehicle
LCD Display Messages
Shift to P
Press POWER button while
turning wheel
This warning message is displayed if
you try to turn off the vehicle with the
gear in the N (Neutral) position.
At this time, the POWER button
changes to the ACC position (If you
press the POWER button once more,
it will turn to the ON position).
This warning message is displayed if
the steering wheel does not unlock
normally when the POWER button is
pressed.
You should press the POWER button
while turning the steering wheel right
and left.
Low Key Battery
Check Steering Wheel Lock
System
Press brake pedal to start vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
the POWER button changes to the
ACC position twice by pressing the
button repeatedly without depressing
the brake pedal.
You can start the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal.
Key not in vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
the battery of the smart key is discharged while changing the POWER
button to the OFF position.
3-76
This warning message is displayed if
the steering wheel does not lock normally while the POWER button
changes to the OFF position.
This warning message is displayed if
the smart key is not in the vehicle
when you press the POWER button.
When attempting to start the vehicle,
always have the smart key with you.
Key not detected
Press POWER button with key
This warning message is displayed if
the smart key is not detected when
you press the POWER button.
This warning message is displayed if
you press the POWER button while
the warning message "Key not
detected" is displayed.
At this time, the immobilizer indicator
light blinks.
Press POWER button again
3
Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse
This warning message is displayed if
the brake switch fuse is disconnected.
You need to replace the fuse with a
new one before starting the vehicle.
If that is not possible, you can start the
vehicle by pressing the POWER button for 10 seconds in the ACC position.
Shift to P to start vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
you try to start the vehicle without
shifting to the P (Park) position.
OFE040110
This warning is displayed indicating
which door, or the hood, or the liftgate is open.
CAUTION
Before driving the vehicle, you
should confirm that the door/
hood/liftgate is fully closed.
Also, check there is no door/
hood/liftgate open warning light
or message displayed on the
instrument cluster.
3-77
Convenience features of your vehicle
This message is displayed if you
were unable to start the vehicle when
the POWER button was pressed.
If this occurs, attempt to start the
vehicle by pressing the POWER button again.
If the warning message appears
each time you press the POWER
button, have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Door / Hood / Liftgate open
Convenience features of your vehicle
Sunroof open
Low Pressure
Check headlight (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
the headlights are not operating
properly. The headlight bulb may
need to be replaced.
i Information
Make sure to replace the burned out
bulb with a new one of the same
wattage rating.
OFE040111
OTM040022L
This warning is displayed if you turn
off the vehicle when the sunroof is
open.
This warning message is displayed if
the tire pressure is low. The corresponding tire on the vehicle will be
illuminated.
For more details, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
3-78
For more details, refer to "Bulb
Wattage" in chapter 8.
Check headlight LED
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the LED
headlight. Have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check headlight FAN
(if equipped)
Check Virtual Engine Sound
System
Check High Beam Assist (HBA)
system (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the High Beam
Assist (HBA) system. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Lights Mode
For more details, refer to "High
Beam Assist (HBA) system" in
chapter 3.
This indicator displays which exterior
light is selected using the lighting
control.
Wiper
This indicator displays which wiper
speed is selected using the wiper
control.
OFE041153N
This message is displayed when
there is a problem with the Virtual
Engine Sound System (VESS).
In this case, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Check Forward Collision
Avoidance Assist system
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system. Have the vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA)
system" in chapter 5.
3-79
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with headlight fan.
Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Check Blind-Spot Collision
Warning (BCW) system
(if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the BlindSpot Collision Warning system. Have
the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "BlindSpot Collision Warning/Blind-Spot
Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)
or Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW)/Rear CrossTraffic Collision-Avoidance Assist
(RCCA)" (BCW) System in chapter
5.
Check Smart Cruise Control
System (if equipped)
Check Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the Smart
Cruise Control system. Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the Check
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system.
Have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Smart
Cruise Control with Stop & Go" in
chapter 5.
For more details, refer to "Check
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system" in chapter 5.
Check Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system (if equipped)
This warning message is displayed if
there is a problem with the Driver
Attention Warning (DAW). Have the
vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to "Driver
Attention Warning (DAW)" in chapter 5.
3-80
LCD DISPLAY
LCD Display Control
The LCD display modes can be
changed by using the control buttons.
(1)
OFE048431L
3-81
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
: MODE button for changing
modes
(2)
,
: MOVE switch for
changing items
(3) OK : SELECT/RESET button for
setting or resetting the
selected item
Convenience features of your vehicle
LCD Display Modes
Menu
Trip Computer
TBT
Consumption Info
Route Guidance
Accumulated Info
Destination Info
Assist
Master warning
The Master Warning mode
Driver Attention Warning displays warning messages
related to the vehicle when
one or more systems is not
Tire Pressure
operating normally.
Drive Info
Up/Down
Digital Speedometer
The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.
3-82
Trip computer mode
Turn By Turn (TBT) mode
Information mode
3
OIK047147N
OFE041121N
The trip computer mode displays
information related to vehicle driving
parameters including fuel economy,
tripmeter information and vehicle
speed.
This mode displays the state of the
navigation.
Tire Pressure
This mode displays information related to Tire Pressure.
For more details, refer to "Trip
Computer" in this chapter.
For more details, refer to "Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)" in chapter 6.
3-83
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE041528N
Convenience features of your vehicle
Warning mode
OIG059288L
Driver Attention Warning
This mode displays information related to Driver Attention Warning (DAW).
For more details, refer to "Driver
Attention Warning (DAW)" in chapter 5.
3-84
If one of followings occurs, warning
messages will be displayed on the
LCD display for several seconds.
- Exterior lamp malfunction
(if equipped)
- Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW)
system malfunction (if equipped)
- Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)
- High Beam Assist (HBA) malfunction (if equipped)
- Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
(FCA) malfunction (if equipped)
TRIP COMPUTER
The trip computer is a microcomputer-controlled driver information system that displays information related
to driving.
i Information
Fuel Economy
• Average Fuel Economy
• Instant Fuel Economy
3
Accumulated Info
• Tripmeter
• Fuel Economy
• Timer
OFE048431L
To change the trip mode, toggle the
"
,
" switch on the steering
wheel.
Drive Info
• Tripmeter
• Fuel Economy
• Timer
Digital Speedometer
Energy Flow
3-85
Convenience features of your vehicle
Some driving information stored in the
trip computer (for example Average
Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is
disconnected.
Trip modes
Convenience features of your vehicle
Average fuel economy/
Instant fuel economy
Manual reset
To clear the average fuel economy
manually, press the OK button on the
steering wheel for more than 1 second when the average fuel economy
is displayed.
Automatic reset
OFE041529N
Average Fuel Economy (1)
• The average fuel economy is calculated by the total driving distance
and fuel consumption since the last
average fuel economy reset.
• The average fuel economy can be
reset both manually and automatically.
To automatically reset the average
fuel economy, select between "After
Ignition" or "After Refueling" in the
Vehicle Settings mode in the
Infotainment system screen.
- After ignition: When the vehicle has
been OFF for 4 hours or longer the
average fuel economy will reset
automatically.
- After refueling: The average fuel
economy will reset automatically
after refueling.
i Information
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
average fuel economy will be recalculated.
3-86
Instant Fuel Economy (2)
• The instantaneous fuel economy is
displayed according to the bar
graph in the LCD display while
driving.
Accumulated Info display
The accumulated driving information
will continue to be counted while the
vehicle is still running (for example,
when the vehicle is in traffic or
stopped at a stop light).
Drive Info display
i Information
3
OJK041043N
OJK041039N
This display shows the accumulated
trip distance (1), the average fuel
economy (2), and the total driving
time (3).
The information is accumulated starting from the last reset.
To reset the details, press and hold
the OK button when viewing the
Accumulated driving info. The trip
distance, the average fuel economy,
and total driving time will reset simultaneously.
This display shows the trip distance
(1), the average fuel economy (2),
and the total driving time (3).
The information is combined for each
ignition cycle. However, when the
vehicle has been OFF for 4 hours or
longer the Drive Info screen will reset.
To reset the details, press and hold
the OK button when viewing the Drive
Info. The trip distance, the average
fuel economy, and total driving time
will reset simultaneously.
3-87
Convenience features of your vehicle
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since
the last ignition key cycle before the
average fuel economy will be recalculated.
Convenience features of your vehicle
The driving information will continue to
be counted while the vehicle is in the
ready (
) mode. (for example, when
the vehicle is in traffic or stopped at a
stop light).
Digital speedometer
Energy Flow
i Information
The vehicle must be driven for a minimum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the
last ignition key cycle before the average
fuel economy will be recalculated.
OIK047151N
OFE041131N
This digital speedometer display
shows the speed of the vehicle.
The fuel cell vehicle system informs
the drivers its energy flow in various
operating modes. While driving, the
current energy flow is specified in 3
modes.
For more details, refer to "Energy
Flow" in the fuel cell Vehicle Guide
provided in front of the owner's
manual.
3-88
H2O OUT
Water release
Water complete
3
OFE050192L
OFE050191L
This message displays when releasing
accumulated water.
This message displays when water
release completed.
3-89
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFEQ019014
Press the H2O OUT button to discharge accumulated water from the
exhaust. The vehicle must be ON for
the blower to operate.
It prevents floor contamination /
freezing due to discharge of accumulated water at the lower part of the
vehicle or the muffler during the
operation. (for example, Garage,
etc.)
Please pre-drain remain water prior
to sea shipping to cryogenic areas or
long-term storage (When starting
vehicle in winter after starting off in
fall) to prevent freezing.
H2O OUT cannot operate when engine
is off.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Water release condition
CSD (Cold Shut-Down)
OFE050190L
This message displays when the
H2O OUT button will not activate the
blower.
3-90
CSD (Cold Shut-Down) will automatically discharge accumulated water
after turning off the vehicle to prevent
accumulated water from getting
frozen in the fuel cell systems during
the winter.
When CSD activates, the amount of
discharged water varies depending
on driving time, driving mode, and
last time the accumulated water was
manually discharge with the H2O
OUT button.
NOTICE
• If the H2O OUT button is operated
while driving or stopping before
entering the garage or underground parking lot, the amount of
discharging water after turning
off the key in CSD mode will be
insignificant.
• It is not necessary to press the
H2O OUT button, but having it
available allows you to control
when water is purged from the
system.
LIGHTING
Exterior Lights
Lighting control
To operate the lights, turn the knob at
the end of the control lever to one of
the following positions:
Daytime running light (DRL)
The Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
can make it easier for others to see
the front of your vehicle during the
day, especially after dawn and before
sunset.
OOS047404N
1. OFF
2. AUTO headlight
3. Parking lamp
4. Headlight
3
OFE048061
AUTO headlight (if equipped)
The parking lamp and headlight will
be turned ON or OFF automatically
depending on the amount of daylight
as measured by the ambient light
sensor (1) on the crash pad.
Even with the AUTO headlight feature in operation, it is recommended
to manually turn ON the headlights
when driving at night or in a fog, driving in the rain, or when you enter
dark areas, such as tunnels and
parking facilities.
3-91
Convenience features of your vehicle
The DRL system will turn the dedicated lamp OFF when :
• The headlights are ON.
• The parking lamps are ON.
• The vehicle is turned off.
• The parking brake is engaged.
Convenience features of your vehicle
NOTICE
• Do not cover or spill anything on
the sensor (1) located in front of
the instrument panel.
• Do not clean the sensor using a
window cleaner, the cleanser may
leave a light film which could
interfere with sensor operation.
• If your vehicle has window tint
or other types of metallic coating on the front windshield, the
AUTO headlight system may not
work properly.
OOS047405N
OOS047406N
Parking lamp (
)
The parking lamp, license plate lamp
and instrument panel lamp are turned
ON.
Headlight ( )
The headlight, parking lamp, license
plate lamp and instrument panel lamp
are turned ON.
i Information
The POWER button must be in the
ON position to turn on the headlight.
3-92
High beam operation
High Beam Assist (HBA)
3
OOS047407N
To turn on the high beam headlight,
push the lever away from you. The
lever will return to its original position.
The high beam indicator will light
when the headlight high beams are
switched on.
To turn off the high beam headlight,
pull the lever towards you. The low
beams will turn on.
WARNING
Do not use high beam when there
are other vehicles approaching
you. Using high beam could
obstruct the other driver's vision.
OOS047409N
The High Beam Assist (HBA) is a
system that automatically adjusts the
headlight range (switches between
high beam and low beam) according
to the brightness of other vehicles
and road conditions.
Operating condition
1. Place the headlight switch in the
AUTO position.
2. Turn on the high beam by pushing
the lever away from you.
The High Beam Assist (HBA) ( )
indicator will illuminate.
3-93
Convenience features of your vehicle
OOS047408N
To flash the high beam headlight, pull
the lever towards you, then release
the lever. The high beams will remain
ON as long as you hold the lever
towards you.
Convenience features of your vehicle
3. The High Beam Assist (HBA) will
turn on when vehicle speed is
above 25 mph (40 km/h).
• If the headlight switch is pushed
away when the High Beam
Assist (HBA) is operating, the
High Beam Assist (HBA) will turn
off and the high beam will be on
continuously.
• If the headlight switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam
is off, the high beam will turn on
without the High Beam Assist
(HBA) canceled. When you let
go of the light switch, the lever
will move to the middle and the
high beam will turn off.
• If the headlight switch is pulled
towards you when the high beam
is on by the High Beam Assist
(HBA), the low beam will be on
and the High Beam Assist (HBA)
will turn off.
• If the headlight switch is placed
to the headlight ON position, the
High Beam Assist (HBA) will turn
off and the low beam will be on
continuously.
3-94
When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is
operating, the high beam switches to
low beam if any of the following conditions occur :
- When the headlight of an on-coming vehicle is detected.
- When the tail lamp of a vehicle in
front is detected.
- When the headlight or tail lamp of
a motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.
- When the surrounding ambient light
is bright enough that high beams
are not required.
- When streetlights or other lights
are detected.
- When the headlight switch is not in
the AUTO position.
- When the High Beam Assist (HBA)
is off.
- When vehicle speed is below 22
mph (35 km/h).
OTM050218N
Warning light and message
When the High Beam Assist (HBA) is
not working properly, the Check High
Beam Assist warning message will
come on for a few second. After the
message disappears, the master
warning light (
) will illuminate.
Take your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the system checked.
WARNING
• When the front window is cov-
a narrow curved road or rough
road.
When the vehicle is driven on
an uphill road or downhill
road.
When only part of the vehicle in
front is visible on a crossroad
or curved road.
When there is a traffic light,
reflecting sign, flashing sign or
mirror.
When the road conditions are
bad such as being wet or covered with snow.
When a vehicle suddenly
appears from a curve.
When the vehicle is tilted from
a flat tire or being towed.
When the Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system warning light
illuminates.
When the light from the oncoming or front vehicle is not
detected because of exhaust
fume, smoke, fog, snow, etc.
ered with foreign matters such
as ice, dust, fog, or is damaged.
3) When the forward visibility is
poor. Such examples may
include:
• When the headlights of an oncoming vehicle or a vehicle in
front is not detected due to
poor outside visibility (smog,
smoke, dust, fog, heavy rain,
snow, etc.).
• When the windshield visibility
is poor.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
3-95
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The system may not operate normally if any of the following conditions should occur:
1) When the illumination from
an on-coming vehicle or a
vehicle in front is dim. Such
examples may include:
• When the headlights of an oncoming vehicle or the tail
lamps of a vehicle in front is
covered with dust, snow, or
water.
• When the headlights on an oncoming vehicle are OFF, but the
fog lamps are ON.
2) When the High Beam Assist
camera is adversely affected
by an external condition.
Such examples may include:
• When the vehicle's headlights
have been damaged or not
repaired properly.
• When the vehicle headlights
are not aimed properly.
• When the vehicle is driven on
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
• Do not attempt to disassemble the front view camera
without the assistance of an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer
technician. If camera is
removed for any reason, the
system may need to be re-calibrated. Have the system
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the windshield of your vehicle is replaced, most likely the
front view camera will need to
be re-calibrated. If this occurs,
have your vehicle inspected
and have the system re-calibrated by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Be careful that water doesn't
get into the High Beam Assist
(HBA) unit and do not remove
or damage related parts of the
High Beam Assist (HBA) system.
3-96
• Do not place objects on the
crash pad that reflect light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. The system may malfunction if sunlight is reflected.
• At times, the High Beam
Assist (HBA) may not work
properly. The system is for
your convenience only. It is
the responsibility of the driver
for safe driving practices and
always check the road conditions for your safety.
• When the system does not
operate normally, change the
headlight position manually
between the high beam and
low beam.
Turn signals and lane change
signals
OOS047410N
To signal a turn, push down on the
lever for a left turn or up for a right
turn in position (A).
If the direction change is completed,
the operation is automatically canceled. However, if the operation is
not canceled automatically, set the
lever to the center.
If an indicator stays on and does not
flash or if it flashes abnormally, one of
the turn signal bulbs may be burned
out and will require replacement.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied Navigation manual.
Battery saver function
The purpose of this feature is to prevent the battery from being discharged. The system automatically
turns off the parking lamp when the
driver turns the vehicle off and opens
the driver-side door.
With this feature, the parking lamps
will turn off automatically if the driver
parks on the side of road at night.
However, the position lamps stay ON
even when the driver-side door is
opened if the headlight switch is
turned to the position lamp or AUTO
(if equipped) position after the engine
is turned off.
If necessary, to keep the lamps on
turn the position lamps OFF and ON
again using the headlight switch on
the steering column after the engine
is turned off.
Headlight time-out function
(if equipped)
If the POWER button is placed in the
ACC position or the OFF position
with the headlights ON, the headlights (and/or parking lamps) remain
on for about 5 minutes. However, if
the driver's door is opened and
closed, the headlights are turned off
after 15 seconds. Also, with the vehicle off if the driver's door is opened
and closed, the headlights (and/or
parking lamps) are turned off after 15
seconds.
The headlights (and/or parking
lamps) can be turned off by pressing
the lock button on the smart key
twice or turning the light switch to the
OFF or AUTO position.
You can activate or deactivate the
Headlight Delay function from the
Vehicle Settings mode (Light) on the
Infotainment system screen.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied Navigation manual.
3-97
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
One-touch turn signal function
To activate the One Touch Turn
Signal function, push the turn signal
lever up or down to position (B) and
then release it.
The lane change signals will blink 3,
5 or 7 times.
You can activate or deactivate the
One Touch Turn Signal function or
choose the number of blinks (3, 5, or
7) from the Vehicle Settings mode in
the Infotainment system screen.
Convenience features of your vehicle
NOTICE
If the driver gets out of the vehicle
through other doors (except driver’s door), the battery saver function does not operate and the
headlight delay function does not
turn off automatically. Therefore, It
causes the battery to be discharged. In this case, make sure
to turn off the lamp before getting
out of the vehicle.
Interior Lights
WARNING
Do not use the interior lights
when driving in the dark. The
interior lights may obscure your
view and cause an accident.
NOTICE
Do not use the interior lights for
extended periods when the vehicle is turned off or the battery will
discharge.
Interior lamp AUTO cut
The interior lamps will automatically
go off approximately 20 minutes after
the vehicle is turned off and the
doors are closed. If a door is opened,
the lamp will go off 40 minutes after
the vehicle is turned off. If the doors
are locked by the remote key or
smart key and the vehicle enters the
armed stage of the theft alarm system, the lamps will go off five seconds later.
3-98
Front lamps
OFE048063
Front Map Lamp (1) :
Press either lenses (Type A) or
switches (
, Type B) to turn
the map lamp on or off. This light produces a spot beam for convenient
use as a map lamp at night or as a
personal lamp for the driver and the
front passenger.
Front Room Lamp (2) (
):
Press the button to turn the front and
rear room lamps on or off.
Luggage compartment lamp
■ Type A
3
OAEE046421
■ Type B
OFE048065L
The luggage compartment lamp
comes on when the liftgate is opened.
If the liftgate is continuously opened,
the luggage compartment lamp will
turn off after 20 minutes.
OFE048064
Rear Room Lamp (
):
Press this switch to turn the rear
room lamp on and off.
3-99
Convenience features of your vehicle
Front Door Lamp (3) (
):
The front or rear room lamps come
on when the front or rear doors are
opened. When doors are unlocked by
the smart key, the front and rear
lamps come on for approximately 30
seconds as long as any door is not
opened. The front and rear room
lamps go out gradually after approximately 30 seconds if the door is
closed. However, if the POWER button is in the ON position or all doors
are locked, the front and rear lamps
will turn off. If a door is opened with
the POWER button in the ACC position or the OFF position, the front
and rear lamps stay on for about 20
minutes.
Rear lamp
Convenience features of your vehicle
Vanity mirror lamp
Glove box lamp
Puddle lamp (if equipped)
OOS047055
OFE048433L
OFE048066
Push the switch to turn the light on or
off.
•
: The lamp will turn on if this
button is pressed.
•
: The lamp will turn off if this
button is pressed.
The glove box lamp comes on when
the glove box is opened.
If the glove box is not closed, the
lamp will turn off after 20 minutes.
Welcome light
When all doors (and liftgate) are
closed and locked, the puddle lamp
will come on for 15 seconds if the
door is unlocked by the remote key
or smart key or outside door handle
button.
NOTICE
Always have the switch in the off
position when the vanity mirror
lamp is not in use. If the sunvisor
is closed without the lamp off, it
may discharge the battery or damage the sunvisor.
3-100
NOTICE
To prevent unnecessary charging
system drain, close the glove box
securely after using the glove box.
For more details, refer to "Welcome
System" in this chapter.
Welcome System (if equipped)
Welcome light
OFE048062N
Puddle lamp
With all the doors (and liftgate)
closed and locked, the puddle lamp
will come on for about 15 seconds if
any of the below is performed.
1. If 'Convenience → Welcome mirror/light → On door unlock' is
selected in the vehicle Settings
mode on the Infotainment system
screen,
• the lamps will turn on when the
door lock button is pressed on
the smart key.
• the lamp will turn on when the
button of the outside door handle
is pressed with the smart key in
possession.
2. If both 'Convenience → Welcome
mirror/light → On door unlock' and
'Convenience → Welcome mirror/
light → On driver approach' is
selected in the vehicle Settings
mode on the Infotainment system
screen, the lamp will turn on when
the vehicle is approached with the
smart key in possession.
You can activate or deactivate
Welcome Light function from the
vehicle Settings mode on the
Infotainment system screen.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied "Navigation manual".
3-101
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Escort light
When the vehicle is turned OFF and
the driver's door is opened, the puddle lamp will come on for 30 seconds. If the driver's door is closed
within the 30 seconds, the puddle
lamp will turn off after 15 seconds. If
the driver's door is closed and
locked, the puddle lamp will turn off
immediately.
The Puddle Lamp Escort Light will
turn on only the first time the driver's
door is opened after the vehicle is
turned off.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Headlight and parking lamp
When the headlight (lamp switch in
the headlight or AUTO position) is on
and all doors (and liftgate) are locked
and closed, the parking lamp and
headlight will come on for 15 seconds
when the door unlock button is
pressed on the remote key or smart
key.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button, the parking lamp and
headlight will turn off immediately.
3-102
Interior lamp
When the interior lamp switch is in
the DOOR position and all doors (and
liftgate) are closed and locked, the
room lamp will come on for 30 seconds if any of the below is performed.
• When the door unlock button is
pressed on the remote key or
smart key.
• When the button of the outside
door handle is pressed with the
smart key in possession.
At this time, if you press the door lock
or unlock button on the smart key the
room lamp will turn off immediately.
WIPERS AND WASHERS
A : Wiper speed control
· MIST – Single wipe
· OFF – Off
· INT – Intermittent wipe
· LO – Low wiper speed
· HI – High wiper speed
■ Front windshield wiper/washer
OPD047454L
■ Rear window wiper/washer
C : Wash with brief wipes
(pull lever towards you)
D : Rear wiper/washer control
· HI – High wiper speed
· LO – Low wiper speed
· OFF – Off
E : Wash with brief wipes (rear)
(push lever away from you)
Operates as follows when the
POWER button is in the ON position.
MIST : For a single wiping cycle,
push the lever upward and
release. The wipers will operate continuously if the lever is
held in this position.
OFF : Wiper is not in operation.
INT : Wiper operates intermittently at
the same wiping intervals. To
vary the speed setting, move
the speed control lever. The top
most setting will run the wipers
most frequently (for more rain).
The bottom setting will run the
wipers the least frequently (for
less rain).
LO : The wiper runs at a lower speed.
HI : The wiper runs at a higher speed.
OTLA045318
3-103
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
B : Intermittent control wipe time
adjustment
Front Windshield Wipers
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
If there is heavy accumulation of snow
or ice on the windshield, defrost the
windshield for about 10 minutes, or
until the snow and/or ice is removed
before using the windshield wipers to
ensure proper operation.
If you do not remove the snow and/or
ice before using the wiper and washer,
it may damage the wiper and washer
system.
3-104
AUTO - Automatic Wiper Control
(if equipped)
A rain sensor located near the windshield detects moisture accumulation and controls the wiping cycle
automatically. This mode is designed
to operate the wiper at an appropriate speed depending on the amount
of rainfall. The sensitivity can be varied by turning the adjustment control
(B) located on the wiper stalk. If the
wiper switch is set in AUTO mode
when the ignition switch is in the ON
position, the wiper will operate once
to perform a self-check of the system. Set the wiper control to the OFF
position when the windshield wipers
are not required.
WARNING
To avoid personal injury from
the windshield wipers, when the
engine is running and the windshield wiper switch is placed in
the AUTO mode:
• Do not touch the upper end of
the windshield glass facing
the rain sensor.
• Do not wipe the upper end of
the windshield glass with a
damp or wet cloth.
• Do not put pressure on the
windshield glass.
NOTICE
WARNING
When the outside temperature
is below freezing, ALWAYS
warm the windshield using the
defroster to help prevent the
washer fluid from freezing on
the windshield and obscuring
your vision which could result
in an accident and serious
injury or death.
OTLE045164
In the OFF position, pull the lever
gently toward you to spray washer
fluid on the windshield and to run the
wipers 1-3 cycles. The spray and
wiper operation will continue until
you release the lever. If the washer
does not work, you may need to add
washer fluid to the washer fluid
reservoir.
3-105
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• When washing the vehicle, set
the wiper switch in the OFF position to stop the auto wiper operation. The wiper may operate
and be damaged if the switch is
set in the AUTO mode while
washing the vehicle.
• Do not remove the sensor cover.
Damage to system parts could
occur and may not be covered
by your vehicle warranty.
• Because of using a photo sensor, temporary malfunction
could occur according to sudden ambient light change while
driving.
Front Windshield Washers
Convenience features of your vehicle
NOTICE
• To prevent possible damage to
the washer pump, do not operate the washer when the fluid
reservoir is empty.
• To prevent possible damage to
the wipers or windshield, do not
operate the wipers when the
windshield is dry.
• To prevent damage to the wiper
arms and other components, do
not attempt to move the wipers
manually.
• To prevent possible damage to
the wipers and washer system,
use anti-freezing washer fluids
in the winter season or cold
weather.
3-106
Rear Window Wiper and Washer
OTLE045166
OTLE045165
The rear window wiper and washer
switch is located at the end of the
wiper and washer switch lever. Turn
the switch to the desired position to
operate the rear wiper and washer.
HI – High wiper speed
LO – Low wiper speed
OFF – Off
Push the lever away from you to
spray rear washer fluid and to run the
rear wipers 1~3 cycles. The spray
and wiper operation will continue
until you release the lever.
Auto rear wiper
The rear wiper will operate while the
vehicle is in reverse with the front
wiper ON by selecting the function on
the Infotainment system screen.
Go to 'Vehicle Settings → Convenience
→ Auto Rear Wiper (in R)'.
DRIVER ASSIST SYSTEM
Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) System
(if equipped)
WARNING
• ALWAYS look around your
vehicle to make sure there are
no objects or obstacles
before moving the vehicle in
any direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention
when the vehicle is driven
close to objects, particularly
pedestrians, and especially
children.
• Be aware that some objects
may not be visible on the
screen or be detected by the
sensors, due to the objects
distance, size or material, all
of which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor.
OFE048047N
[A] : Front Sensor, [B] : Rear Sensor
3-107
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048046N
The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system assists
the driver during movement of the
vehicle by chiming if any object is
sensed within the distance of 39
inches (100 cm) in front and 47 inches (120 cm) behind the vehicle.
This system is a supplemental system that senses objects within the
range and location of the sensors, it
cannot detect objects in other areas
where sensors are not installed.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Operation of the Parking
Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) System
OFE048048
Operating condition
• This system will activate when the
Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/
Forward) system button is pressed
with the POWER button in the ON
position.
• Sensing distance when backing up
is approximately 47 in (120 cm)
when you are driving less than
6 mph (10 km/h).
3-108
• Sensing distance when moving forward is approximately 39 in (100
cm) when you are driving less than
6 mph (10 km/h).
• The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system button
turns on automatically and activates the Parking Distance
Warning (Reverse/Forward) system when the gear is in the R
(Reverse) position.
• However, if vehicle speed exceeds
6 mph (10 km/h), the system will
not warn you even though objects
are detected.
And if vehicle speed exceeds 12
mph (20 km/h, without RSPA) or 18
mph (30 km/h, with RSPA), the
system will turn off automatically.
* RSPA : Remote Smart Parking
Assist
• To turn on the system, press the
Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/
Forward) system button.
• When more than two objects are
sensed at the same time, the closest one will be recognized first.
Types of warning sound and indicator
inches (cm)
Distance
from object
Front
24 ~ 47
(61 ~ 120)
Rear
12 ~ 24
(31 ~ 60)
12
(30)
-
-
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
intermittently
Buzzer beeps
frequently
Buzzer sounds
continuously
Front
Rear
Warning sound
Buzzer beeps
frequently
Front
Rear
When driving
rearward
-
Buzzer sounds
continuously
i Information
• The indicator may differ from the illustration depending on objects or sensors
status. If the indicator blinks, have your vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the audible warning does not sound or if the buzzer sounds intermittently
when shifting into R (Reverse) position, this may indicate a malfunction with
the Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/Forward) system. If this occurs, have
your vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Moisture is frozen to the sensor.
• Sensor is covered with foreign matter, such as snow or water, or the
sensor cover is blocked.
The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system may
experience a malfunction when the
following occurs:
• Driving on uneven road surfaces
such as unpaved roads, gravel,
bumps, or gradient.
• Objects generating excessive noise
such as vehicle horns, loud motorcycle engines, or truck air brakes
can interfere with the sensor.
• Heavy rain or water spray is present.
• Wireless transmitters or mobile
phones are present near the sensor.
• The sensor is covered with snow.
3-109
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
24 ~ 39
(61 ~ 100)
Warning indicator
When driving
forward
Non-operational conditions of
Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system
The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system may not
operate normally when any of the
following occur:
Convenience features of your vehicle
• Any non-factory equipment or
accessories have been installed, or
if the vehicle bumper height or sensor installation has been modified.
Detecting range may decrease when:
• Outside air temperature is
extremely hot or cold.
• Undetectable objects smaller than
40 inches (1 m) and narrower than
6 inches (14 cm) in diameter.
The following objects may not be
recognized by the sensor:
• Sharp or slim objects such as
ropes, chains or small poles.
• Objects, which tend to absorb sensor frequency such as clothes,
spongy material or snow.
3-110
Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system precautions
• The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system may not
operate consistently in some circumstances depending on the
speed of the vehicle and the
shapes of the objects detected.
• The Parking Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system may
malfunction if the vehicle bumper
height or sensor installation has
been modified or damaged. Any
non-factory installed equipment or
accessories may also interfere with
the sensor performance.
• The sensor may not recognize
objects less than 15 in. (40 cm)
from the sensor, or it may sense an
incorrect distance. Use caution.
• When the sensor is blocked with
snow, dirt, debris, or ice, the system may be inoperative until the
snow or ice melts, or the debris is
removed. Use a soft cloth to wipe
debris away from the sensor.
• Do not push, scratch or strike the
sensor with any hard objects that
could damage the surface of the
sensor. Sensor damage could occur.
• Do not spray the sensors or its surrounding area directly with a high
pressure washer. Doing so may
cause the sensors to fail to operate
normally.
WARNING
Your new vehicle warranty does
not cover any accidents or damage to the vehicle or injuries to
its occupants related to a
Parking
Distance Warning
(Reverse/Forward) system.
Always drive safely and cautiously.
Rear View Monitor
(if equipped)
The Rear View Monitor will activate
when the vehicle is in the ready ( )
mode and the gear is in the R
(Reverse) position.
This is a supplemental system that
helps provide a view of the area
behind the vehicle through the
Infotainment system screen while the
vehicle is in the R (Reverse) position.
OFE042049
The Rear view monitor is not a
safety device. It only serves to
assist the driver in identifying
objects directly behind the middle of the vehicle. The camera
does NOT cover the complete
area behind the vehicle.
• Never rely solely on the rear
camera display when backingup.
• ALWAYS look around your
vehicle to make sure there are
no objects or obstacles before
moving the vehicle in any
direction to prevent a collision.
• Always pay close attention
when the vehicle is driven
close to objects, particularly
pedestrians, and especially
children.
NOTICE
Always keep the camera lens
clean. The camera may not work
normally if the lens is covered
with dirt, water or snow.
OFE048050
3-111
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
WARNING
Convenience features of your vehicle
Surround View Monitoring
(if equipped)
The system is activated when:
• The POWER button is in the ON
position
• The gear is in D (Drive), N
(Neutral) or R (Reverse)
• Vehicle speed is under 10 mph (15
km/h)
The system is deactivated when:
• You press the button (1) again
• Vehicle speed is over 10 mph (15
km/h)
OFE048051
The Surround View Monitoring
(SVM) system can assist in parking
by allowing the driver to see around
the vehicle.
Push the button (1, indicator ON) to
operate the system. To cancel the
system, push the button again (1,
indicator OFF).
3-112
i Information
• When vehicle speed is over 10 mph
(15 km/h), the system will turn off.
The system will not automatically
turn on again, even though vehicle
speed gets below 10 mph (15 km/h).
Push the button (1, indicator ON)
again, to turn on the system.
• When the vehicle is backing up, the
system will turn ON regardless of
vehicle speed or button status.
However, if vehicle speed is over 10
mph (15 km/h) when driving forward, the SVM system will turn off.
• A warning appears on the system
when:
- The liftgate is opened
- The driver's door is opened
- The passenger's door is opened
- The outer side view mirror is folded
• If the system is not operating normally, the system should be checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied manual with your
vehicle.
CAUTION
Driving Rear view Monitor
(DRM) (if equipped)
ODH047435
OFE048051
The system is deactivated when:
• You press the SVM button (1, indicator OFF) again
• You press any other view mode
buttons (3) on the screen again.
• You press the Infotainment system
button (4)
NOTICE
Always keep the camera lens
clean. The camera may not work
normally if the lens is covered
with foreign material.
OFE048052L
3-113
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The system is activated when:
• The POWER button is in the ON
position and the gear is in the N
(Neutral) or D (Drive) position.
• The vehicle's speed is over 10 mph
(15 km/h) and you press the SVM
button (1, indicator ON)
• The vehicle's speed is under 10
mph (15 km/h) and you press the
(2) on the screen
(1) Front camera
(2) Left/Right camera
(3) Rear camera
Surround View Monitor system
only serves to assist the driver
in parking. ALWAYS look
around your vehicle to make
sure there are no objects or
obstacles before moving the
vehicle.
You may check the rear view through
the screen while driving.
Convenience features of your vehicle
i Information
• If vehicle speed is over 10 mph (15
km/h)
- the DRM image stays ON when the
rear view was on the screen
- screen (top, front wide, front right
and front left) of other modes of
SVM system turns OFF and
switches
to
the
original
Infotainment system screen when
other modes were on the screen
• If the SVM system is ON and the
vehicle speed is under 10 mph (15
km/h)
- the rear image stays ON when the
rear view was on the screen
- a pop-up for selecting the SVM
mode (top, front wide, front right
and front left) appears when pressing any other view mode buttons
(3) than
(2) on the screen.
3-114
• When the vehicle is backing up, the
rear image will appear on the screen
automatically regardless of vehicle
speed or SVM button (1) status.
- If the rear image was ON, the
screen switches to the parking
assist screen.
- If the screen (top, front wide, front
right and front left) of other modes
of SVM system was ON, the screen
for setting the initial rear view
mode appears.
- When the shift gear is moved from
R (Reverse) to D (Drive), the
screen of the previous mode is displayed.
• A warning appears on the system
when:
- The liftgate is opened
- The driver's door is opened
- The passenger's door is opened
- The outer side view mirror is folded
• If the system is not operating normally, the system should be checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied manual with your
vehicle.
REMOTE SMART PARKING ASSIST (RSPA) (IF EQUIPPED)
REMOTE SMART PARKING ASSIST
(RSPA) system helps drivers park
their vehicle by using sensors to
detect parking spaces, control the
steering wheel, shift the gear and
adjust vehicle speed automatically
with instructions through sound and
Infotainment system screen.
Assistance
provided
Parking Distance Warning button
Relevant function
■ Reverse parking
OTM048058
Smart Parking
O
Remote
Smart Parking
O
Smart Parking
O
Remote
Smart Parking
O
Smart Exit
O
Remote
Smart Exit
X
Remote Moving
Forward/
Backward
O
■ Parallel parking
OFE048420
■ Parallel exit
OFE048421
Remote Smart Parking Assist
button
Deactivate the system and park/exit
your vehicle manually, when the situation requires parking manually.
The Parking Distance Warning system's front and rear warning sound
and Surround View Monitor (SVM)
system activate while RSPA is activated.
The system will be canceled if the
Parking Distance Warning system is
cancelled by pressing the button to
the OFF position.
For operation of the Parking
Distance Warning system and the
SVM system, refer to the relevant
description in this manual.
■ Forward/Backward
OFE048054
❈ O : Available, X : Unavailable
3-115
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Applicable RSPA modes :
• Smart Parking/Remote Smart
Parking: The system provides assistance for reverse parking (perpendicular parking) and parallel parking.
• Smart Exit : The system provides
assistance for forward parallel exit.
• Remote Moving Forward/Backward:
The system provides assistance for
forward/backward movement in the
parking space with driver outside
the vehicle.
The system does not work if there is
no car parked in front of the parking
space you are planning to park or if it
is a diagonal parking space.
After parking your vehicle using the
system, the vehicle may not be parked
at the exact spot you have wished.
To prevent frequency interference, the
heater and air conditioner may be
turned off when the system is activated.
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
• The RSPA system should only
be considered as a supplementary function. The driver
must check the front and rear
view for objects. The operational function of the system
can be affected by many factors and conditions of the surroundings, so the responsibility rests always with the driver.
• The system may not operate
normally if the vehicle needs
wheel alignment adjustment.
Have the vehicle checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If you use a different tire or
wheel size rather than the size
recommended by the HYUNDAI
dealer, the system may not
work properly. Always use the
same size tire and wheel.
3-116
WARNING
• Do not use the system when
in drunken state.
• The system may not operate
properly depending on the
surrounding environment and
other conditions.
• The system may not recognize the object too close to
the vehicle.
• When operating the system,
be careful of the objects located above or below the sensor
position. Such object may
damage the vehicle or other
objects.
• Do not let children or other
person to use the smart key.
Operating Condition
Use the system when all the below
conditions are met.
• When the parking space is a
straight line
• When there is a parked vehicle
next to the space where you want
to park
• When there is enough space to
move the vehicle
• When you choose "Confirm" on
Infotainment system booting.
■ Right side
- Reverse parking
OFE048097
■ Left side
- Parallel parking
OFE048096
■ Left side
- Parallel exit
■ Right side
- Parallel exit
OFE048098
■ Remote forward/backward
OFE048054
Non-operating Condition
In the following conditions, the RSPA
system may not operate properly or
be cancelled. Drive the vehicle manually in the below conditions.
• Curved parking space
• Inclined roads
• A vehicle loaded with longer or
wider cargo compared to the vehicle
• Diagonal parking space
• Heavy snow or rain
• Near a circular pillar or narrow pillar, or a pillar surrounded by objects
such as fire extinguisher, etc.
• The sensor is positioned incorrectly
by an impact to the bumper
• Bumpy roads
• A vehicle equipped with a snow
chain or spare tire
• Tire pressure lower or higher than
the standard tire pressure
• A trailer connected to the vehicle
• Slippery or uneven road
3-117
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
■ Right side
- Parallel parking
■ Left side
- Reverse parking
Convenience features of your vehicle
• If a nearby vehicle has a tow hitch
receiver that protrudes beyond the
bumper, the RSPA may not recognize it. Use caution and monitor the
clearance to the receiver.
• Big vehicles such as buses or
trucks parked
• Sensor covered with foreign matter, such as snow or water
• An obstacle such as a trash can,
bicycle, shopping cart, etc., is near
• Heavy wind
• Wheel changed to an unauthorized
size
• A problem with the wheel alignment
• Vehicle leaned severely to one side
• Front or rear distance sensors are
malfunction or not working properly.
(Refer to the Parking Distance
Warning system in chapter 3.)
• Low level of the smart key that
requires battery replacement
3-118
Limitations of the System
• When the vehicle has been
parked/stopped for a long time in a
cold environment, the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward may be
delayed depending on the vehicle
condition when the vehicle is
turned on remotely.
• The RSPA system may suddenly
apply brake to avoid collision
against stationary or moving
object.
• The system may be cancelled
unexpectedly when a person or
animal passes by near the vehicle.
• The performance of the system
may be degraded and frequently
stop when driving in strong electric
field area.
• Right after the parking place
search complete and beep sound
is generated, the search complete
may be cancelled according to the
surrounding environment
• Even while the system is in activation, the vehicle may collide with
the object existing within the blindspot area of the sensor.
• When there is any obstacle within
the blind-spot area, drive out of the
parking space manually.
• The system may not recognize the
object that appears suddenly.
• The system does not work if there
is no car parked in front of the
parking space you are planning to
park.
• Your vehicle is loaded with cargo
longer or wider than your vehicle or
a trailer or hitch mounted carrier is
connected to your vehicle.
WARNING
2. Parking in snow
3. Parking in narrow space
Do not use the RSPA system in
the following conditions for
unexpected results may occur
and cause a serious accident.
1. Parking on inclines
3
Snow may interfere with sensor
operation or the system may
cancel if the road is slippery
while parking.
OTM048062
The system may not search for
parking spaces if the space is
too narrow. Even if the system
is operating, always be careful.
OFE048400
Park and exit manually when
you park on inclines.
3-119
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048401
Convenience features of your vehicle
4. Parking diagonal
5. Parking in uneven road
OTM048063
The system is not a supplemental for diagonal parking. Even if
the vehicle is able to enter the
space, do not operate the
System.
3-120
OFE048402
The system may cancel when
the vehicle slips or the vehicle
couldn't move due to road condition.
6. Parking behind a truck
OFE048403
An accident may occur when
parking behind a vehicle higher
than yours. For example, bus,
truck, etc.
Do not solely rely on the
Parking Assist system.
7. Obstacle in parking space
8. Using a Smart Exit in wall
proximity conditions
9. Parking in an empty parking
place
3
When detecting for a parking
space next to pillar, the parking
performance may be degraded.
OTM048062
OFE048424
When using a Smart Exit in narrow and near a wall, the system
may not work properly.
The system does not work if
there is no car parked in front of
the parking space you are planning to park. Park the vehicle
manually.
3-121
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048059N
Convenience features of your vehicle
How the System Works
(Smart Parking)
Smart Parking is available with the
driver on board. Make sure the conditions available before activating the
Smart parking function.
1. Select Smart Parking:
Press the RSPA button with the
shift lever placed in D (Drive) or N
(Neutral) position.
❈ However, the Smart Exit is
selected if you press the RSPA
button when the gear is in N
(Neutral) position after the initial
startup.
2. Search for parking space: Slowly
move forward below 12 mph (20
km/h)
3. Search complete: Automatic
search by sensor.
However, check the actual parking
environment before parking the
vehicle.
4. Select parking type: Reverse
(left/right), parallel (left/right)
5. Operating instructions: Smart
Parking/Remote Smart Parking
3-122
CAUTION
1. Selecting Parking mode
• Always check for obstacles
around your vehicle before
driving.
• The function may be cancelled if you attach something
(cover, etc.) to the steering
wheel.
6. Smart Parking assist: Steering
wheel, gear shift and vehicle
speed control (reverse parking).
7. Parking complete: Smart Parking
complete after reaching the parking position
❈ After the parking is complete,
arrange the vehicle position manually, if necessary.
❈ You can use Smart Parking after
navigation or home screen display
on Infotainment system (You cannot use Smart Parking if you don't
choose "Confirm" on Infotainment
system booting)
OFE048414
Remote Smart Parking Assist
button
Parking Distance Warning button
• Press the Remote Smart Parking
Assist button and the button indicator will illuminate.
• The Parking Distance Warning button will illuminate and the
Infotainment system screen will
display the instruction screen.
A warning sound will be heard if an
obstacle is detected.
2. Searching for parking space
❈ The parking performance may be
degraded if a regular distance
from the parked vehicle is not
maintained.
• If the vehicle speed is over 19 mph
(30 km/h), the system will be cancelled.
• The search for a parking space will
be completed only when there is
enough space for the vehicle to
move to park.
OFE048134L
• Slowly drive forward maintaining
the distance of approximately 20 in
~60 in (0.5 ~1.5 m) with the parked
vehicles.
• If the vehicle speed is over 12 mph
(20 km/h), a message will appear
to notify you to reduce the speed.
• To deactivate the parking function,
press the RSPA button, the
'Cancel' button on the screen or
the Parking Distance Warning button.
3-123
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• To deactivate the system:
1. Press the RSPA button again (until
the "Selecting parking mode"
stage).
2. Shift the gear to R (Reverse) position before the operation of the
Smart Parking assist.
3. Press the 'Cancel' button on the
Infotainment system screen while
the Smart Parking is in activation.
4. Press the Parking Distance
Warning button while the Smart
Parking is in activation.
Convenience features of your vehicle
CAUTION
CAUTION
• When searching for a parking
space, the system may not be
able to find a parking space if
there is no vehicle parked, a
parking space is available after
driving by or a parking space is
available before driving by.
• The system may not operate
normally in the following conditions:
(1) When the sensors are
frozen
(2) When the sensors are dirty
(3) When it snows or rains
heavily
(4) When a pillar or object is
near
(5) Parked vehicle is abnormally parked
In above cases, the system may
not search the parking space
although the parking space
exists. And the system may
search the parking space
although the parking space is
not proper to park.
3-124
20 ~ 60 in.
OFE048474N
CAUTION
Slowly drive forward maintaining
the distance of approximately 40
in. (100 cm) with the parked vehicles. If the distance is below 20
in. (50 cm) or over 60 in. (150
cm), the system may not be able
to search for a parking space.
After searching for a parking
space is completed, continue
using the system after checking
the surrounding area.
Especially, check the distance
of the outside rearview mirror
and objects while using the system to prevent careless accidents.
3. Search complete
4. Selecting parking type
• If the search is complete, the above
message will appear with a dingdong sound.
• The search complete sound is generated every time a parking space
is searched. Icons indicating the
selectable parking type and direction are activated on the screen.
• To deactivate parking function,
press the RSPA button, the 'Cancel'
button on the screen or the Parking
Distance Warning button.
• Keep driving forward to go back to
the previous stage for searching
the parking space.
❈ If the Smart Parking is deactivated
when the driver presses the RSPA
button by mistake before selecting
the parking type, press the RSPA
button while the vehicle is stopped
to return to the stage for selecting
the parking type.
OFE048404L
• With the vehicle stopped, select
the icon for the desired parking
type. To select the parking type,
touch the Infotainment system
screen or operate the DIS central
controller to select and press the
icon.
3-125
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048136L
OFE048135L
• To deactivate the parking function,
press the RSPA button or the
'Cancel' on the screen or the
Parking Distance Warning button.
• Keep driving forward to go back to
the previous stage for searching
the parking space.
Convenience features of your vehicle
5. Operating instructions
❈ To see the instruction for the
Remote Smart Parking, refer to
the relevant part of the manual.
❈ Depress the brake pedal when
selecting the operation mode. The
function will be deactivated when
the vehicle moves.
OFE048138L
OFE048137L
• After selecting the parking type,
the driver can select the operation
mode between the Smart Parking
and Remote Smart Parking. Follow
the instruction on the screen and
press and hold the RSPA button to
select the Smart Parking. To select
the Remote Smart Parking put the
shift gear in P (Park) position and
follow the instruction.
• To deactivate the parking assist
function, press the 'Cancel' button
on the screen or the Parking
Distance Warning button.
3-126
❈ If the Remote Smart Parking is
unavailable, the message is
shown on the screen when selecting the parking type.
WARNING
Always be careful while parking
for other vehicles or pedestrians.
6. Smart parking assist
• The parking function will not operate if the door is open or the driver's seatbelt is unfastened.
• If the driver releases the RSPA button while the Smart Parking is in
activation, the assist will stop temporarily.
OFE048166N
• With the vehicle stopped, press
and hold the RSPA button and then
the steering wheel, gear shift and
vehicle speed are controlled automatically.
3
OFE048141L
Complete parking your vehicle
according to the instructions on the
Infotainment system screen. If
required, manually control the steering wheel and complete parking your
vehicle.
When the parking is complete:
• The gear P (Park) and Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB) are engaged
automatically.
• Release the RSPA button.
❈ The parking may complete bumping on the stopper.
❈ When parking is complete, check
the surrounding conditions.
3-127
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048165N
❈ The Infotainment system screen
will display the rear camera view
when the vehicle is moving forward (if equipped with the Rear
View Camera).
❈ Depress the brake pedal to control
the vehicle speed. The accelerator
pedal will not activate. The system
will be cancelled when the vehicle
speed exceeds 3 mph (5 km/h).
7. Smart parking complete
Convenience features of your vehicle
CAUTION
If the Parking Distance Warning
system warning sound (distance
from object is within 12 in. (30
cm): continuous beep) occurs,
check the surrounding.
To cancel the Smart Parking while
in operation
(1) Press the RSPA button before
selecting the operation mode.
(2) Shift the gear to to R (Reverse)
position before the operation of
the "Smart Parking assist" stage.
(3) Press the Parking Distance
Warning
button
or
the
'Cancel'button
on
the
Infotainment system screen.
(4) Driver controls the vehicle during
the system assist
When the driver shifts the gear after
depressing the brake pedal to stop
the vehicle, the gear shifts and the
Smart Parking is deactivated. In this
case, the Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB) is not engaged.
3-128
The Smart Parking assist will stop
temporarily when:
(1) An obstacle at the direction the
vehicle is heading is detected.
(2) The door or liftgate is open.
(3) The driver’s seatbelt is unfastened.
(4) The Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
is activated while reversing.
(5) The driver releases the RSPA
button.
(6) The drivers stops the vehicle by
depressing the brake pedal.
❈ The vehicle stops when the Smart
Parking assist will stop temporarily and the Smart Parking assist
will resume when the above condition is cleared.
(12) The steering, shifting gear and
drive assist are impossible
(13) The suspended status lasts for
over 1 minute
(14) The driver continuously presses
and releases the RSPA button
over 10 times
(15) The vehicle is unable to enter
the parking space while the
Smart Parking assist is in activation
(16) The Traction Control System
(TCS) is activated while the
vehicle speed is controlled
❈ When the Smart Parking assist is
cancelled, gear P (Park) and
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)
are engaged automatically.
How the System Works
(Remote Smart Parking)
Remote smart Parking is available
with the driver outside the vehicle.
Make sure the conditions available
before activation the Remote smart
parking function.
1. Select Remote Smart Parking:
Press the RSPA button with the
shift lever placed in D (Drive) or N
(Neutral) position.
However, the Smart Exit is selected if you press the RSPA button
when the vehicle is in N (Neutral)
position after the initial startup.
2. Search for parking space: Slowly
move forward below 12 mph (20
km/h).
3. Search complete: Automatic
search by sensor.
However, check the actual parking
environment before parking the
vehicle.
4. Select parking type: Reverse
(left/right), parallel (left/right)
5. Operating instructions: Smart
Parking/Remote Smart Parking
6. Remote Smart Parking assist:
Steering wheel, gear shift and
vehicle speed control (reverse
parking)
7. Remote Smart Parking complete
3-129
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The Smart Parking assist is cancelled while in operation when:
(1) The driver holds the steering
wheel while the steering wheel is
controlled
(2) The gear is shifted or the
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) is
activated
(3) The hood opens
(4) The vehicle speed exceeds 3
mph (5 km/h)
(5) The vehicle accelerates suddenly
(6) The vehicle slips back while the
vehicle speed is controlled
(7) The wheel is stuck and the vehicle is unable to move
(8) The obstacles are at the front and
back of the vehicle at the same
time
(9) About 3 minutes and 50 seconds
have passed after the Smart
Parking assist is activated
(10) The door opens while the driver’s
seatbelt is unfastened
(11) The gradient of the road
exceeds the range supported by
the Smart Parking assist
Convenience features of your vehicle
Remote Smart Parking Assist
button
6. Remote smart parking assist
Parking Distance Warning button
Remote start button
Moving forward button
Moving backward button
OFE048414
OFE048142L
OFE048422
❈ You cannot use Smart Parking if
you didn't press "Confirm" on the
Infotainment screen when the
vehicle was started.
3-130
Put the shift gear in P (Park) position.
Exit the vehicle possessing the
smart key and check whether all the
doors are closed. The Remote Smart
Parking assist will operate only if the
driver presses the smart key button
within about 13 ft. (4 m) from the
vehicle. Press and hold the moving
forward or backward button on the
smart key and then the steering
wheel, gear shift and vehicle speed
are controlled automatically.
❈ The driver should release the seat
belt before getting off.
❈ While Remote smart parking assist
is operating, the air conditioning
system turns off temporarily.
7. Remote smart parking complete
When the parking is complete, the
message is displayed on the
Infotainment system screen and the
vehicle is automatically turned off.
Drivers always should check whether
the door, window and sunroof are
closed and the door is locked.
• When parking is complete:
- The parking complete sound (frequent beep) is generated.
- The gear P (Park) and Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB) are engaged
automatically.
❈ Release the moving forward/backward button on the smart key.
❈ The parking may complete bumping on the stopper.
❈ When parking is complete, check
the surrounding conditions.
CAUTION
• Always check for obstacles
•
•
•
•
•
around your vehicle before
driving.
The function may be cancelled if you attach something
(cover, etc.) to the steering
wheel.
Make sure all the passengers
exit the vehicle when the
Remote Smart Parking is
assisted.
Make sure all the smart keys
are outside the vehicle.
The smart key detection
range from the vehicle may
vary depending on the surrounding
environment
(indoor/outdoor, strong electric field area).
The smart key detection
range may change as the
vehicle moves. Maintain an
appropriate distance from the
vehicle.
3-131
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• If the driver releases the button the
vehicle will stop and the assist will
stop temporarily. Press and hold
the button again to resume the
operation.
❈ You will hear frequent beep
sounds if the driver gets off the
vehicle after setting the Remote
Parking mode.
❈ Press the moving forward or backward button again after checking
the distance (within about 10 ~ 16
ft. (3~5 m)) from the vehicles if the
vehicle didn’t move after pressing
and holding the smart key button
for about 5 seconds.
Convenience features of your vehicle
To cancel the Remote Smart
Parking while in operation
(1) Press the RSPA button at the
"Searching for parking space"
stage or the "Selecting parking
type" stage.
(2) Shift the gear to R (Reverse)
position before the operation of
the Remote Smart Parking
assist.
(3) Press the Parking Distance
Warning button or the 'Cancel'
button on the Infotainment system screen.
(4) Driver controls the vehicle during
the system assist.
• The Remote Smart Parking is
immediately cancelled and the
vehicle turns off when the remote
start button on the smart key is
pressed.
• The function is cancelled but the
vehicle stays on when the driver
enters the vehicle with the smart
key and all the doors are closed or
the driver depresses the brake
pedal.
3-132
The Remote Smart Parking assist
will stop temporarily when:
(1) An obstacle at the direction the
vehicle is heading is detected.
(2) The door or liftgate is open.
(3) The moving forward/backward
button on the smart key is
released.
(4) Multiple buttons on the smart key
are pressed at the same time.
(5) The distance between the smart
key and vehicle is over 13 ft (4m).
(6) A button on the other smart key is
pressed.
(7) Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist system is activated while reversing.
❈ The vehicle stops when the
Remote Smart Parking assist will
stop temporarily and the Remote
Smart Parking assist will resume
when the above condition is
cleared.
The Remote Smart Parking assist is
cancelled while in operation when:
(1) The driver holds the steering
wheel while the steering wheel is
controlled
(2) The gear is shifted or the
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) is
activated
(3) The hood opens
(4) The vehicle speed exceeds 3
mph (5 km/h)
(5) The vehicle accelerates suddenly
(6) The vehicle slips back while controlling the vehicle speed
(7) The wheel is stuck and the vehicle is unable to move
(8) Obstacles are at the front and
back of the vehicle at the same
time
(9) Approximately 3 minutes and 50
seconds have past after Remote
Forward/Backward function has
started to operate
(10) The gradient of the road
exceeds the range supported by
the Remote Smart Parking
assist
• When the Remote Smart Parking
assist is cancelled, gear P (Park)
and Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB) are engaged automatically.
After engaged, the vehicle is automatically turned off.
• Frequent beep sounds will generate to alert the deactivation of the
Remote Smart Parking Assist.
How the System Works
(Smart Exit)
Smart exit is available with the driver
on board. Make sure the conditions
available before activation the Smart
parking function.
1. Select Smart Exit:
Press the RSPA button with the
shift lever placed in P (Park) or N
(Neutral) position without driving
the vehicle after the initial startup.
*N (Neutral): Press RSPA button
after starting the vehicle and without driving the vehicle. The Smart
Exit is selected. Then the Parking
mode is automatically selected
after driving.
*P (Park): After driving the vehicle
press RSPA button and Remote
Moving Forward/Backward is
automatically selected.
2. Search for smart exit space:
Automatic searching by sensor at
stop
However, check the actual environment before using Smart exit
function.
3-133
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
(11) The steering wheel, gearshift,
braking, and drive controls are
not working normally
(12) The suspended status lasts for
over 1 minute
(13) The driver continuously presses
and releases the smart key’s
moving forward/backward button over 10 times
(14) The vehicle is unable to enter
the parking space
(15) The Traction Control System
(TCS) is activated while controlling the vehicle speed
(16) The smart key has failure
(17) The accelerator/brake pedal is
depressed while all the doors
are closed
(18) The brake pedal is depressed
while the driver’s door is open
and the smart key is outside the
vehicle
(19) The theft alarm system is activated
Convenience features of your vehicle
3. Select smart exit direction: Parallel
(left/right)
4. Smart Exit assist: Steering wheel,
gear shift and vehicle speed control (parallel exit)
5. Smart Exit complete
WARNING
Always be careful while exiting
for other vehicles or pedestrians.
After the Smart Exit is complete,
make sure to check the surrounding
road conditions.
However, the Exit mode is activated
when below conditions are met:
• The vehicle speed is kept under 3
mph (5 km/h) after the vehicle is
turned on.
• The parallel parking by the Remote
Smart Parking assist is complete.
1. Searching for smart exit
space
OFE048143L
• With vehicle stopped, the Parking
Distance Warning system sensors
detect the distance from/to the
objects in front/back of the vehicle
to search for an exit space.
• Also, the sensors at the vehicle
side-front checks for the obstacle
in the direction of exit.
• To deactivate the exit function,
press the RSPA button, the
‘Cancel’ button on the screen or
the Parking Distance Warning button.
3-134
CAUTION
• When checking surroundings,
if the front or rear vehicle (or
object) is too near, the system
may not work properly.
• The system may not operate
normally in the following conditions:
(1) When the sensors are
frozen
(2) When the sensors are dirty
(3) When it snows or rains
heavily
(4) When a pillar or object is
near
(5) Parked vehicle is abnormally parked
In above cases, the system
may not search the exit space
although the exit space
exists. And the system may
search
the
exit
space
although the exit space is not
proper to Smart exit.
• When exiting the parking
space if an obstacle is detected that may cause an accident, the system may cancel.
However, objects in the blind
spot may not be recognized.
Be sure to check it before
using function.
• If the space is too small to
exit, the system may cancel.
3-135
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
❈ The system searches for the exit
space again when the system
enters the Smart Exit mode by
pressing the RSPA button after the
deactivation.
❈ The system still searches for the
exit space when the gear is shifted
to the other positions than R
(Reverse). However, the function
will be deactivated when the vehicle moves.
Convenience features of your vehicle
CAUTION
2. Selecting smart exit direction
• If searching surroundings is
completed, continue using the
system after checking the surround in garea.
• The Exit mode may be activated unintentionally, when the
shift gear is in P (Park) or N
(Neutral) and the Parking
Assist system button is
pressed.
OFE048144L
• With the vehicle stopped, select
the icon of the direction you wish to
exit. To select the exit direction,
touch the Infotainment system
screen or operate the DIS central
controller to select and press the
icon.
• To deactivate the exit function,
press the RSPA button, the
'Cancel' button on the screen or
the Parking Distance Warning button.
3-136
❈ The system searches for the exit
space again when the system
enters the Smart Exit mode by
pressing the RSPA button after the
deactivation.
❈ The system still searches for the
exit space when the gear is shifted
to the other positions than R
(Reverse). However, the function
will be deactivated when the vehicle moves.
3. Smart exit instructions
CAUTION
4. Smart exit assist
• Always check the surrounding
• Follow the instructions on the
screen and press and hold the
RSPA button to select the Smart
Exit.
• To deactivate the Smart Exit, press
the ‘Cancel’ button on the screen or
the Parking Distance Warning button.
3
OFE048165N
OFE048166N
❈ The system still searches for the
exit space when the gear is shifted
to the other positions than R
(Reverse). However, the function
will be deactivated when the vehicle moves.
• With the vehicle stopped, press
and hold the RSPA button and then
the steering wheel, gear shift and
vehicle speed are controlled automatically.
3-137
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048145L
before driving your vehicle if
the Parking Distance Warning
sound (distance from object
is within 12 in. (30 cm): continuous beep) is heard for the
object is close to your vehicle.
• The function may be cancelled if you attach something
(cover, etc.) to the steering
wheel.
• The function can be cancelled for safety reasons if the
vehicle is parked at a small
space near a wall.
Convenience features of your vehicle
• The exit function will not operate if
the door is open or the driver’s
seatbelt is unfastened.
• If the driver releases the RSPA button while the Smart Exit assist is in
activation, the assist will stop temporarily.
❈ The Infotainment system screen
will display the rear camera view
when the vehicle is moving forward (if equipped with the Rear
View Camera).
❈ Depress the brake pedal to control
the vehicle speed. The accelerator
pedal will not activate.
3-138
5. Smart exit complete
• When exit is complete:
- The vehicle stays in stopped condition for 4 seconds and waits for
the driver' to operate manually
(depress brake/accelerator pedal.)
- If the driver does not operate
manually after 4 seconds, the
system stays in the stopped condition by applying the safety
measure (engage gear P (Park)
and Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB)).
OFE048146L
When the exit is complete, the message is displayed on the Infotainment
system screen. Turn the steering
wheel to the direction of exit as much
as possible and exit manually after
checking the road condition.
❈ Release the RSPA button after the
exit is complete.
❈ If the Smart Exit has been completed while depressing the accelerator pedal, take your foot off the
pedal and depress again for manual operation.
❈ If the Smart Exit has been completed while depressing the brake
pedal, the gear D (Drive) is maintained.
The Smart Exit assist will stop temporarily when:
(1) An obstacle at the direction the
vehicle is heading is detected.
(2) The door or liftgate is open.
(3) The driver's seatbelt is unfastened.
(4) The Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
is activated while reversing.
(5) The driver releases the RSPA
button.
(6) The driver stops the vehicle by
depressing the brake pedal.
The function is deactivated when the
driver stops the vehicle by depressing the brake pedal and shifts the
gear. In this case, the Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB) is not engaged.
❈ The vehicle stops when the Smart
Exit assist will stop temporarily
and the Smart Exit assist will
resume when the above condition
is cleared.
The Smart Exit assist is cancelled
while in operation when:
(1) The driver holds the steering
wheel while the steering wheel is
controlled
(2) The gear is shifted or the
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) is
activated
(3) The hood opens
(4) The vehicle speed exceeds 3
mph (5 km/h)
(5) The vehicle accelerates suddenly
(6) The vehicle slips back while controlling the vehicle speed
(7) The wheel is stuck and the vehicle is unable to move
(8) Obstacles are at the front and
back of the vehicle at the same
time
(9) About 3 minutes and 50 seconds
have passed after the Smart Exit
assist
(10) The door opens while the driver's seatbelt is unfastened
(11) The gradient of the road
exceeds the range supported by
Smart Exit assist
3-139
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
To cancel the Smart Exit while in
operation
(1) Press the RSPA button at the
"Searching for smart exit space"
stage or the "Selecting for smart
exit direction" stage.
(2) Shift the gear to R (Reverse)
position before the operation of
the Smart Exit assist.
(3) Press the Parking Distance
Warning button or the 'Cancel'
button on the Infotainment system screen.
(4) Driver controls the vehicle during
the system assist
Convenience features of your vehicle
(12) The steering, shifting gear and
drive assist are impossible
(13) The suspended status lasts for
over 1 minute
(14) The driver continuously presses
and releases the RSPA button
over 10 times
(15) The Traction Control System
(TCS) is activated while controlling the vehicle speed
(16) The vehicle's heading degree
(A) exceeds a certain amount of
degree compare to the degree
at the point when the Smart Exit
assist started
OFE048405
❈ When the Smart Exit assist is cancelled, gear P (Park) and Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB) are engaged
automatically.
How the System Works
(Remote Moving Forward/
Backward)
3-140
Remote moving forward/backward is
available with the driver outside the
vehicle. Make sure the conditions
available before activation the
Remote moving forward/backward
function.
1. Remote
Moving
Forward/
Backward ready:
(1) With the vehicle off: Remotely
turn on the vehicle.
(2) With the vehicle on: Put the
gear shift in P (Park) position
and press the RSPA button.
Then exit the vehicle possessing the smart key.
❈ To use this function,
- the vehicle must have
been driven over 3 mph (5
km/h) and
- the vehicle is not turned
off before activating the
function.
2. Remote Moving Forward/Backward
assist: Press and hold the moving
forward/backward button of the
smart key to provide the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward assist
through steering wheel, gear shift
and vehicle speed control.
3. Remote Moving Forward/Backward
complete: When the vehicle reaches the desired position, release the
smart key button. Then complete
the Remote Moving Forward/
Backward by entering the vehicle
possessing the smart key or by
pressing the remote start button of
the smart key.
Remote Smart Parking Assist
button
Parking Distance Warning button
Remote start button
Moving forward button
OFE048414
You can activate the Remote Moving
Forward/Backward in 2 ways.
(1) With the vehicle turned off, press
the door lock button of the smart
key and then within 4 seconds
press the remote start button for
over 2 seconds.
❈ For the details of remote start
up, refer to 'Remote start' in
chapter 3.
(2) Park the vehicle in front of the
space where you desire to use
the Remote Moving Forward/
Backward. Press the RSPA button and select the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward. Exit
the vehicle possessing the smart
key and check whether all the
doors are closed.
OFE048422
3-141
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Moving backward button
1. Remote moving ready
Convenience features of your vehicle
2. Remote moving forward/backward assist
OFE048142L
❈ When the Remote Moving
Forward/Backward is ready by the
above No. (2) method. You can use
Smart Parking after navigation or
home
screen
display
on
Infotainment system (You cannot
use Smart Parking if you don't
choose "Confirm" on Infotainment
system booting)
❈ You will hear frequent beep sounds
if the driver gets off the vehicle after
the Remote Moving Forward/
Backward is ready.
❈ The driver should release the seat
belt before getting off.
3-142
OFE048409
• With the vehicle stopped, press
and hold one of the moving forward/backward button and then the
steering wheel, gear shift and vehicle speed are controlled automatically.
• If the driver releases the moving forward/backward button while the
Remote Moving Forward/Backward
is in activation, the control will stop
temporarily. Press the button again
to resume the control.
• For your safety, the assist is activated only when the smart key is
within about 10~16 ft. (3~5 m) from
the vehicle.
• The vehicle can travel up to 23 ft.
(7 m) per move. Press the moving
forward/backward button to make
additional movement.
❈ Press the moving forward/backward button again after checking
the distance from the vehicles if
the vehicle didn't move after
pressing and holding the smart
key button for about 5 seconds.
❈ Under cold weather, take enough
time before pressing the moving
forward/backward button of the
smart key after turning on the
vehicle remotely. It may take more
time until the vehicle moves.
❈ While Remote moving forward/
backward assist is operating, the
air conditioning system turns off
temporarily
3. Remote moving forward/backward complete
WARNING
Always be careful of unexpected
approach of the other vehicles or
pedestrians.
• Always check for obstacles
OFE048410L
The Remote Moving Forward/
Backward is complete after the driver enters the vehicle possessing the
smart key, when the vehicle reaches
the desired position. In this case, the
vehicle stays on.
❈ When Remote Moving Forward/
Backward assist is complete, the
gear P (Park) and Electronic
Parking Brake (EPB) are engaged
automatically.
❈ The parking complete sound (frequent beep) is generated.
around your vehicle before
driving.
• The function may be cancelled if you attach something
(cover, etc.) to the steering
wheel.
• Make sure all the passengers
exit the vehicle when the
Remote Moving Forward/
Backward is in activation.
• Make sure all the smart keys
are outside the vehicle when
the Remote Moving Forward/
Backward assist is in activation.
3-143
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
CAUTION
To cancel the Remote Moving
Forward/Backward while in
operation
(1) Press the remote start button on
the smart key.
(2) Shift the gear to to R (Reverse)
position while the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward is
instructed.
(3) Press the Parking Distance
Warning button or the 'Cancel'
button on the Infotainment system screen while the Remote
Moving Forward/ Backward is
instructed.
(4) Driver controls the vehicle during
the system assist
• The Remote Moving Forward/
Backward is immediately cancelled
and the vehicle turns off when the
remote start button on the smart
key is pressed
• The function is cancelled but the
vehicle stays on when the driver
enters the vehicle with the smart
key and all the doors are closed or
the driver depresses the brake
pedal.
Convenience features of your vehicle
The Remote Moving Forward/
Backward assist will stop temporarily when:
(1) An obstacle at the direction the
vehicle is heading is detected.
(2) The door or liftgate is open.
(3) The moving forward/backward button on the smart key is released.
(4) Multiple buttons on the smart key
are pressed at the same time.
(5) The distance between the smart
key and vehicle is over 13 ft. (4 m).
(6) A button on the other smart key is
pressed.
(7) Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
is activated while reversing.
(8) The vehicle moves 23 ft. (7m)
(maximum travel distance per
move) with the Remote Moving
Forward/Backward while the
smart key is pressed.
❈ The vehicle stops when the Remote
Smart Parking assist will stop temporarily and the Remote Smart
Parking assist will resume when the
above condition is cleared.
3-144
The Remote Moving Forward/
Backward assist is cancelled while
in operation when:
(1) The driver holds the steering
wheel while the steering wheel is
controlled
(2) The gear is shifted or the
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) is
activated
(3) The hood opens
(4) The vehicle speed exceeds 3 mph
(5 km/h)
(5) The vehicle accelerates suddenly
(6) The vehicle slips back while controlling the vehicle speed
(7) The wheel is stuck and the vehicle is unable to move
(8) Obstacles are at the front and
back of the vehicle at the same
time
(9) About 3 minutes and 50 seconds
have passed after the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward assist
(10) The gradient of the road exceeds
the range supported by Remote
Moving Forward/ Backward assist
(11) The steering, shifting gear and
drive assist are impossible
(12) The suspended status lasts for
over 1 minute
(13) The driver continuously presses
and releases the smart key's
moving forward/backward button over 10 times
(14) The Traction Control System
(TCS) is activated while controlling the vehicle speed
(15) The smart key has failure
(16) The accelerator/brake pedal is
depressed while all the doors
are closed
(17) The brake pedal is depressed
while the driver's door is open
and the smart key is outside the
vehicle
(18) The vehicle travels more than 46
ft. (14 m) after the Remote
Moving Forward/Backward assist
is activated
(19) The smart key's remote start
button is pressed
Additional Instructions
(Messages)
❈ When Remote Moving Forward/
Backward is complete, the gear P
(Park) and Electronic Parking
Brake (EPB) are engaged automatically and the vehicle turns off.
❈ The frequent beep sounds are
generated to show the deactivation status.
When the Remote Smart Parking
Assist system is in operation, the
system may be cancelled regardless
of the instruction order.
The messages will appear according
to the circumstances. Follow the
instructions provided while driving
your vehicle with the Remote Smart
Parking Assist system in activation.
Check parking assist
3
OFE048411L
If there is a problem with the system,
the above message will appear when
the system is turned on.
Also, the indicator on the RSPA button will blink and the warning sound
will beep three times.
(The Parking Distance Warning system can be operable depending on
the failure type.)
If you notice any problem, have the
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
3-145
Convenience features of your vehicle
(20) The theft alarm system is activated
Convenience features of your vehicle
Parking assist conditions not
met
Turn Signal Showing Vehicle Status while System in Activation
The turn signal indicates the vehicle status as follows when the Smart
Parking, Remote Smart Parking or Smart Exit is in activation:
Vehicle status
OFE048412N
When the Remote Smart Parking
Assist system is not getting ready for
activation, the above message will
appear when the RSPA button is
pressed.
Press the RSPA button again after a
while and check the normal operation of the system.
3-146
Turn signal
Smart Parking/Remote Smart Parking
assist in activation
The turn signal of the parking direction
blinks until the first reversing is complete
or deactivated while parking
Smart Exit assist in activation
The turn signal of the exiting direction
blinks until the exit is complete or deactivated
Smart key/Hazard lamp Showing Vehicle Status while System in Activation
The LED on the smart key indicates the vehicle status as follows when the Remote Smart Parking or Remote Moving
Forward/Backward is in activation:
Vehicle status
Hazard lamp
Smart key LED
-
Green LED blinks continuously
Remote Smart Parking
assist temporarily
stopped/in stand by
Flashing
Red LED blinks continuously
Remote Smart Parking
deactivated
Off after 3 flashes
Red LED illuminates for
about 4 seconds and then
extinguishes
Remote Smart Parking
complete
Off after one flashes
Green LED illuminates for
about 4 seconds and then
extinguishes
3
OFE048423
3-147
Convenience features of your vehicle
Remote Smart Parking
assist in activation
Convenience features of your vehicle
Link with other Systems
Activation of other systems may be
restricted according to the circumstances while the RSPA system is in
activation. The systems linked to the
RSPA system are as follows:
1. Smart Cruise Control (SCC) system
(1) SCC system can be operated at
the same time with the RSPA
system until the "Searching for
parking space" stage.
(2) The SCC system is deactivated
when the RSPA system enters
the "Remote Smart Parking
assist" stage.
(3) After the RSPA system is complete or deactivated, the SCC
system maintains the deactivation status.
3-148
2. Auto Hold
(1) The activated Auto Hold is
switched to deactivation status
when the RSPA system is activated.
(2) The Auto Hold button will not
respond while the RSPA system
is in activation.
(3) After the RSPA system is complete or deactivated, the Auto
Hold will return to the state before
the RSPA system was activated.
3. Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
(1) Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
system switches from OFF to
activation status (ESC OFF button turns off) when the RSPA system is activated.
(2) The ESC OFF button will not
respond while the RSPA system
is in activation.
(3) The ABS/TCS/ESC system activates while the RSPA is in activation.
(4) After the RSPA system is complete or deactivated, ESC maintains the ON status.
AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM
■ Type A
OFE048300/OFE048308
3-149
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
■ Type B
1. Driver’s temperature control knob
2. Passenger’s temperature control knob
3. SYNC button
4. Front windshield defroster button
5. Fan speed control button
6. OFF button
7. AUTO (automatic control) button
8. Air intake control button
9. Rear window defroster button
10. Driver only button
11. Mode selection button
12. Air conditioning button
Convenience features of your vehicle
Automatic Temperature
Control Mode
The Automatic Climate Control
System is controlled by setting the
desired temperature.
1. Press the AUTO button (7).
The modes, fan speeds, air intake
and air-conditioning will be controlled automatically by the temperature setting you select.
2. Press the temperature control button (1,2) to the desired temperature. If the temperature is set to
the lowest setting (Lo), the air conditioning system will operate continuously. After the interior has
cooled sufficiently, adjust the button to a proper temperature set
point whenever possible.
To turn the automatic operation off,
select any button of the following:
- Mode selection button
- Front windshield defroster button
(Press the button one more time to
deselect the front windshield
defroster function. The 'AUTO' sign
will illuminate on the information
display once again.)
3-150
- Fan speed control button
The selected function will be controlled manually while other functions
operate automatically.
For your convenience and to improve
the efficiency of the climate control,
use the AUTO button and set the
temperature to 72°F (22°C).
OFE048068N
NOTICE
Never place anything near the
ambient light/solar sensor to
ensure better control of the heating and cooling system.
Manual Temperature Control
Mode
The heating and cooling system can
be controlled manually by pushing
buttons other than the AUTO button.
In this case, the system works
sequentially according to the order of
buttons selected.
When pressing any button except the
AUTO button while using automatic
operation, the functions not selected
will be controlled automatically.
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Set the mode to the desired position.
To improve the effectiveness of
heating and cooling, select the
mode according to the following:
- Heating:
- Cooling:
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the air intake control to Fresh
mode or Recirculation mode position.
5. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Mode selection (11)
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
6. If air conditioning is desired, turn
the air conditioning system on.
7. Press the AUTO button to convert to
full automatic control of the system.
When starting the vehicle in cold
weather a more efficient way to heat
the passenger compartment is to do
the following.
- Turn off or lower the blower, right
after starting the engine.
• The fuel cell temperature will be
low and the heater air is still cold.
- After a few minutes to allow the
system to warm up, set the fan to
the desired level.
OFE048302
The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the
ventilation system.
3-151
Convenience features of your vehicle
The air flow outlet direction is cycled
as follows:
Face-Level (B, D, F)
Air flow is directed toward the upper
body and face. Additionally, each
outlet can be controlled to direct the
air discharged from the outlet.
Bi-Level (B, C, D, E, F)
Air flow is directed towards the face
and the floor.
Floor & Defrost
(A, C, D, E, F)
Instrument panel vents
■ Front
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor and the windshield with a small
amount directed to the side window
defrosters.
Floor-Level (A, C, D, E, F)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
floor, with a small amount of the air
being directed to the windshield and
side window defrosters.
OFE048303
■ Rear
Defrost-Level (4) (A, D)
Most of the air flow is directed to the
windshield with a small amount of air
directed to the side window defrosters.
OFE048304
The instrument panel vent air flow
can be directed up/down or left/right
using the vent adjustment lever.
3-152
Temperature control (1,2)
3
OFE048310N
OFE048309N
Press the up/down switch to increase/
decrease the temperature.
Adjusting the driver and passenger
side temperature equally
• Press the "SYNC" button to operate the driver and passenger side
temperature equally.
The passenger side temperature
will be set to the same temperature
as the driver side temperature.
• Push the driver side temperature
control switch. The driver and passenger side temperature will be
adjusted equally.
3-153
Convenience features of your vehicle
The air flow can also be CLOSED
using the vent adjustment lever. The
instrument panel air vents are the
"click-to-close" type.
To CLOSE the instrument panel
vents perform the following:
- For the driver side vents, slide the
vent adjustment lever to the LEFT
until it clicks.
- For the passenger side vents, slide
the vent adjustment lever to the
LEFT until it clicks.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Adjusting the driver and passenger
side temperature individually
Press the "SYNC" button again to
operate the driver and passenger
side temperature individually. The
button indicator will turn off.
Temperature conversion
If the battery has been discharged or
disconnected, the temperature mode
display will reset to Fahrenheit.
To change the temperature unit from
°F to °C or °C to °F:
- Press the AUTO button while pressing the OFF button on the climate
control unit for 3 seconds.
- Go to General settings mode → Unit
→ Temperature in the Infotainment
system display.
The temperature unit on both the
cluster LCD display and climate control screen will change.
3-154
Air intake control (8)
The air intake control button is used
to select either Fresh mode (outside
air) or Recirculation mode (cabin air).
Recirculation mode
When
Recirculation
mode is selected, air
from the passenger
compartment will be
recirculated through the
system and heated or
cooled according to the
function selected.
Fresh mode
When Fresh mode is
selected, air enters the
vehicle from outside and
is heated or cooled
according to the function
selected.
i Information
Operating the system primarily in
Fresh mode is recommended. Use
Recirculation mode temporarily only
when needed.
Prolonged operation of the heater in
Recirculation mode and without the
A/C ON can cause fogging of the
windshield.
In addition, prolonged use of the A/C
ON in Recirculation mode may result
in excessively dry, dehumidified air in
the cabin and may promote formation
of musty vent odor due to stagnant air.
WARNING
• Continued use of the climate
Air conditioning (12)
The fan speed can be set as desired
by pushing the fan speed control button.
More air is delivered with higher fan
speeds.
Pressing the OFF button turns off the
fan.
Push the A/C button to manually turn
the system on (indicator light will illuminate) and off.
NOTICE
OFF mode (6)
Push the OFF button to turn the climate control system off. You can still
operate the mode and air intake buttons.
Operating the fan when the
POWER button is in the ON position could cause the battery to
discharge. Operate the blower
when the vehicle is in the ready
(
) mode.
NOTICE
Operating the fan when POWER
button is in the ON position could
cause the battery to discharge.
Operate the fan when the vehicle
is in the ready (
) mode.
3-155
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
control system operation in
Recirculation mode for a prolonged period of time may
cause drowsiness to the
occupants in the cabin. This
may lead to loss of vehicle
control which may lead to an
accident.
• Continued use of the climate
control system operation in
Recirculation mode with the
A/C OFF may allow humidity
to increase inside the cabin.
This may cause condensation
to accumulate on the windshield and obscure visibility.
• Do not sleep in your vehicle or
remain parked in your vehicle
with the windows up and
either the heater or the air
conditioning ON for prolonged periods of time. Doing
so may increase the levels of
carbon dioxide in the cabin
which may lead to serious
injury or death.
Fan speed control (5)
Convenience features of your vehicle
Driver only
System Operation
Cooling / Ventilation
1. Select the Face Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
Heating
OFE048311
If you press the DRIVER ONLY button( DRIVER
ONLY ) and the indicator light
illuminates, cold air mostly blows in
the direction of the driver's seating
position. However, some of the cold
air may be vented out of other seating position ducts to keep indoor air
pleasant.
If you use the button with no passenger in the front passenger seat, energy consumption may be reduced.
DRIVER ONLY button will be turned
off under the following conditions:
1) Defrost on (the DRIVER ONLY
button indicator is not turned off)
2) DRIVER ONLY button re-push
3-156
1. Select the Floor Level
mode.
2. Set the air intake control to fresh
mode.
3. Set the temperature control to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan speed control to the
desired speed.
5. If desired, turn the air conditioning
ON with the temperature control
knob set to heat in order to dehumidify the air before it enters into
the cabin.
If the windshield fogs up, select the
Floor & Defrost
mode or press
the Front Defrost
mode.
Operation Tips
• If dust or unpleasant fumes are
entering the car through the ventilation system, temporarily set the
air intake control to the recirculation mode. Return the control to the
fresh mode when the unpleasant
air outside has diminished. This will
help keep the driver alert and comfortable.
• To help prevent the inside of the
windshield from fogging, set the air
intake control to fresh mode and
the fan speed to the desired position, turn on the air conditioning
system, and adjust the temperature
control to the desired temperature.
Air conditioning
When using the air conditioning
system, monitor the temperature
gauge closely while driving up
hills or in heavy traffic when outside temperatures. Air conditioning system operation when climbing a steep grade or in high outside ambient temperatures can
cause fuel cell stack overheating.
Continue to use the fan, but turn
the air conditioning system off if
the temperature gauge indicates
fuel cell stack overheating.
Air conditioning system operation
tips
• If the vehicle has been parked in
direct sunlight during hot weather,
open the windows for a short time
to let the hot air inside the vehicle
escape.
• After sufficient cooling has been
achieved, switch back from recirculation mode to fresh mode.
• To help reduce moisture inside of
the windows on rainy or humid
days, decrease the humidity inside
the vehicle by operating the air
conditioning system with the windows and sunroof closed.
• Use the air conditioning system
every month only for a few minutes
to ensure maximum system performance.
• If you operate air conditioner excessively, the difference between the
temperature of the outside air and
that of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield
to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In
this case, set the mode selection
knob or button to the
position
and fan speed control to the lower
speed.
3-157
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
Your HYUNDAI vehicle air conditioning system is filled with R-1234yf
refrigerant.
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Press the air conditioning button.
3. Select the Face Level
mode.
4. Set the air intake control to
Recirculation mode temporarily to
allow the cabin to cool quickly.
When the desired temperature in
the cabin is reached, change the
air intake control back to Fresh
mode.
5. Adjust the fan speed control and
temperature control to maintain
maximum comfort.
When maximum cooling is desired,
set the temperature control to the
MAX A/C position, then set the fan
speed control to the highest setting.
NOTICE
Convenience features of your vehicle
System Maintenance
Cabin air filter
If the vehicle is being driven in
severe conditions such as dusty or
rough roads and/or if transporting
pets or occupants smoke inside the
vehicle, then more frequent cabin air
filter inspections and changes are
required.
If the air flow rate suddenly decreases, the system should be checked at
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OIK047401L
[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air
[C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower
[E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core
The cabin air filter is installed behind
the glove box. It filters the dust or other
pollutants that enter the vehicle
through the heating and air conditioning system.
Have the The cabin air filter replaced
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer
according to the maintenance schedule.
3-158
Checking the amount of air conditioner refrigerant and compressor lubricant
When the amount of refrigerant is
low, the performance of the air conditioning is reduced. Overfilling also
reduces the performance of the air
conditioning system.
Therefore, if abnormal operation is
found, have the vehicle inspected by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
It is important that the correct
type and amount of oil and refrigerant is used. Otherwise, damage
to the compressor and abnormal
system operation may occur. To
prevent damage, the air conditioning system in your vehicle should
only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
NOTICE
• The refrigerant system should
only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians to insure
proper and safe operation.
• The refrigerant system should
be serviced in a well-ventilated
place.
• The air conditioning evaporator
(cooling coil) shall never be
repaired or replaced with one
removed from a used or salvaged vehicle and new replacement MAC evaporators shall be
certified (and labeled) as meeting SAE Standard J2842.
■ Example
WARNING
Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf
3
OFE088006NA
OHYK059002
Air Conditioning refrigerant label
You can find out which air conditioning refrigerant is applied to your vehicle on the label located inside of the
hood.
Each symbols and specification on
the
air conditioning refrigerant label is
represented as below:
1. Classification of refrigerant
2. Amount of refrigerant
3. Classification of compressor lubricant
4. Caution
5. Flammable refrigerant
6. To require registered technician to
service air conditioning system
7. Service manual
3-159
Convenience features of your vehicle
Since the refrigerant
is mildly flammable
and operated at high
pressure, the air conditioning
system
should only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
It is important that the correct
type and amount of oil and
refrigerant are used.
All refrigerants should be
reclaimed with proper equipment.
Venting refrigerants directly to
the atmosphere is harmful to
individuals and environment.
Failure to heed these warnings
can lead to serious injuries.
Convenience features of your vehicle
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING
WARNING
Windshield heating
Do not use the
or
position during cooling operation in
extremely humid weather. The
difference between the temperature of the outside air and that
of the windshield could cause
the outer surface of the windshield to fog up, causing loss of
visibility could cause an accident resulting in serious injury
or death. In this case, set the
mode selection knob or button
to the
position and fan
speed control knob or button to
a lower speed.
3-160
• For maximum defrost performance, set the temperature control
to the highest temperature setting
and the fan speed control to the
highest setting.
• If warm air to the floor is desired
while defrosting or defogging, set the
mode to the floor-defrost position.
• Before driving, clear all snow and
ice from the windshield, rear window, side view mirrors, and all side
windows.
• Clear all snow and ice from the hood
and air inlet in the cowl grill to
improve heater and defroster efficiency and to reduce the probability
of fogging up the inside of the windshield.
Automatic Temperature Control
System
OFE048305
To defog inside windshield
1. Select the desired fan speed.
2. Select the desired temperature.
3. Press the defroster button (
).
4. Fresh mode will be selected automatically.
Check to make sure the air intake
control is in Fresh mode. If the air
intake control LED is illuminated,
press the button once to enable
Fresh mode (LED OFF).
If the
position is selected, the fan
speed is automatically increased.
Defogging logic
To reduce the probability of fogging
up the inside of the windshield, the
air intake or air conditioning are controlled automatically according to
certain conditions such as
or
positions. To cancel or reset the
defogging logic, do the following.
If the battery has been discharged or
negative (-) battery cable is disconnected, it resets to the defog logic
status.
3-161
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048306
To defrost outside windshield
1. Set the fan speed to the highest
(extreme right) position.
2. Set the temperature to the extreme
hot (HI) position.
3. Press the defroster button (
).
4. The outside (fresh) air position will
be selected automatically.
If the
position is selected, fan
speed may increase slightly to
improve airflow.
Automatic climate control system
1. Turn the POWER button to the ON
position.
2. Press the defroster button (
).
3. While pressing the air conditioning
button (A/C), press the air intake
control button at least 5 times
within 3 seconds.
The Automatic Temperature Control
information screen will blink 3 times
to indicate that the defogging logic
has been disabled.
Repeat the steps again to re-enable
the defogging logic.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Auto Defogging System
(Additional Feature with
Automatic Temperature
Control System) (if equipped)
Auto defogging helps reduce the possibility of fogging up the inside of the
windshield by automatically sensing
the moisture on inside the windshield.
The auto defogging system operates
when the heater or air conditioning is
on.
i Information
The auto defogging system may not
operate normally, when the outside
temperature is below 14 °F (-10 °C).
3-162
When the Auto Defogging
System operates, the indicator will illuminate.
If a high amount of humidity is
detected in the vehicle, the Auto
Defogging System will be enabled.
The following steps will be performed
automatically:
Step 1) The A/C button will turn ON.
Step 2) The air intake control will
change to Fresh mode.
Step 3) The mode will be changed to
defrost to direct airflow to the
windshield.
Step 4) The fan speed will be set to
MAX.
If the air conditioning is off or recirculated air position is manually selected while Auto Defogging System is
ON, the Auto Defogging System
Indicator will blink 3 times to signal
that the manual operation has been
canceled.
To cancel or reset the
Auto Defogging System
Press the front windshield defroster
button for 3 seconds when the
POWER button is in the ON position.
When the Auto Defogging System is
canceled, the ADS OFF symbol will
blink 3 times and ADS OFF will be
displayed on the climate control
information screen.
When the Auto Defogging System is
reset, the ADS OFF symbol will blink
6 times without a signal.
i Information
NOTICE
Do not remove the sensor cover
located on the upper end of the
windshield glass.
Damage to system parts could
occur and may not be covered by
your vehicle warranty.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the rear
window defroster conducting elements bonded to the inside surface of the rear window, never use
sharp instruments or window
cleaners containing abrasives to
clean the window.
If you want to defrost and defog
the front windshield, refer to the
"Windshield
Defrosting
and
Defogging" section in this chapter.
The defroster heats the
window to remove frost,
fog and thin ice from the
interior and exterior of
the rear window, while
the vehicle is in the
ready (
) mode.
• To activate the rear window
defroster, press the rear window
defroster button located in the center
control panel. The indicator on the
rear window defroster button illuminates when the defroster is ON.
• To turn off the defroster, press the
rear window defroster button again.
i Information
• If there is heavy accumulation of
snow on the rear window, brush it
off before operating the rear
defroster.
• The rear window defroster automatically turns off after approximately
20 minutes or when the POWER
button is in the OFF position.
Side view mirror defroster
If your vehicle is equipped with the
side view mirror defrosters, they will
operate at the same time you turn on
the rear window defroster.
3-163
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• When the air conditioning is turned
on by Auto defogging system, if you
try to turn off the air conditioning, the
indicator will blink 3 times and the air
conditioning will not be turned off.
• To maintain the effectiveness and
efficiency of the Auto Defogging
System, do not select Recirculation
mode while the system is operating.
• When the Auto Defogging System is
operating, the fan speed adjustment
button, the temperature adjustment
knob, and the air intake control button are all disabled.
Rear Window Defroster
Convenience features of your vehicle
CLIMATE CONTROL ADDITIONAL FEATURES
Automatic Ventilation
(if equipped)
Sunroof Inside Air
Recirculation (if equipped)
When the POWER button is in the
ON position or when the vehicle is in
the ready (
) mode and temperature is below 59°F (15°C) with the
recirculated air position selected
more than five minutes, the air intake
position will automatically change to
the outside (fresh) air position.
When the heater or air conditioning
system is on with the sunroof
opened, the fresh mode will be automatically selected. If you press the
recirculation mode button with the
sunroof open, recirculation mode
activate but will only remain enabled
for 3 minutes. After 3 minutes the air
intake control will revert back to
Fresh mode.
When the sunroof is closed, the air
intake position will return to the original position that was selected.
To cancel or reset the Automatic
Ventilation
When the air conditioning system is
on, select Face Level
mode and
press the recirculation mode button
five times within three seconds while
pressing A/C button.
When the Automatic Ventilation feature is enabled, the recirculation button LED indicator will blink 6 times.
When the Automatic Ventilation feature is disabled, the recirculation button LED indicator will blink 3 times.
3-164
STORAGE COMPARTMENT
WARNING
Center Console Storage
Glove Box
Never store cigarette lighters,
propane cylinders, or other
flammable/explosive materials
in the vehicle. These items may
catch fire and/or explode if the
vehicle is exposed to hot temperatures for extended periods.
3
ALWAYS keep the storage compartment covers closed securely while driving. Items inside
your vehicle are moving as fast
as the vehicle. If you have to
stop or turn quickly, or if there
is a crash, the items may fly out
of the compartment and may
cause an injury if they strike the
driver or a passenger.
NOTICE
OFE048070
To open :
Grab and hold the latch (1) on the
arm rest then lift the lid.
OFE048071
To open:
Pull the lever (1).
WARNING
ALWAYS close the glove box
door after use.
An open glove box door can
cause serious injury to the passenger in an accident, even if the
passenger is wearing a seat belt.
To avoid possible theft, do not
leave valuables in the storage
compartments.
3-165
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
Convenience features of your vehicle
INTERIOR FEATURES
Cup Holder
Front
WARNING
Rear
Placing any heavy objects other
than cups or small beverages
may damage the cup holder.
■ On center console
OFE048074
OFE048075
■ Above glove box
Pull the armrest down to use the cup
holders.
WARNING
• Avoid abrupt starting and
OFE048073
Cups or small beverages cups may
be placed in the cup holders.
3-166
braking when the cup holder
is in use to prevent spilling
your drink. If hot liquid spills,
you could be burned. Such a
burn to the driver could cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
• Do not place uncovered or
WARNING
Keep cans or bottles out of
direct sun light and do not put
them in a hot vehicle. It may
explode.
Sunvisor
• Keep your drinks sealed while
driving to prevent spilling your
drink. If liquid spills, it may get
into the vehicle's electrical/electronic system and damage electrical/electronic parts.
• When cleaning spilled liquids do
not use hot air to blow out or dry
the cup holder. This may damage the interior.
3
OTM048089
To use the sunvisor, pull it downward.
To use the sunvisor to block the sun
from the side window, pull it downward, release it from the bracket (1)
and swing it to the side towards the
window (2).
To use the vanity mirror, pull down
the sunvisor and slide the mirror
cover (3).
Adjust the sunvisor forward or backward (4) as needed. Use the ticket
holder (5) to hold tickets.
3-167
Convenience features of your vehicle
unsecured cups, bottles,
cans, etc., in the cup holder
containing hot liquid while the
vehicle is in motion. Injuries
may result in the event of a
sudden stop or collision.
• Only use soft cups in the cup
holders. Hard objects can
injure you in an accident.
NOTICE
Convenience features of your vehicle
Close the vanity mirror cover securely and return the sunvisor to its original position after use.
Power Outlet
NOTICE
WARNING
For your safety, do not block
your view when using the sunvisor.
NOTICE
Do not put several tickets in the
ticket holder at one time. This
could cause damage to the ticket
holder.
OFE048077
The power outlet is designed to provide power for mobile telephones or
other devices designed to operate
with vehicle electrical systems. The
devices should draw less than 180 W
with the vehicle in the ready (
)
mode.
WARNING
Avoid electrical shocks. Do not
place your fingers or foreign
objects (pin, etc.) into a power
outlet or touch the power outlet
with a wet hand.
3-168
To prevent damage to the Power
Outlets :
• Use the power outlet only when
the vehicle is in the ready (
)
mode and remove the accessory
plug after use. Using the accessory plug for prolonged periods
of time with the vehicle off could
cause the battery to discharge.
• Only use 12V electric accessories which are less than 180 W
in electric capacity.
• Adjust the air-conditioner or
heater to the lowest operating
level when using the power outlet.
• Close the cover when not in use.
• Some electronic devices can
cause electronic interference
when plugged into a vehicle's
power outlet. These devices may
cause excessive audio static
and malfunctions in other electronic systems or devices used
in your vehicle.
AC Inverter (if equipped)
3
OUMA046410
OFE048080N
The AC inverter supplies 115V/150W
electric power to operate electric
accessories or equipments.
i Information
• Rated voltage : AC 115V
• Maximum electric power : 150W
• In order to avoid an electrical system failure, electric shock, etc., be
sure to read owner's manual before
use.
• Be sure to close the cover except the
time of use.
3-169
Convenience features of your vehicle
• Push the plug in as far as it will
go. If good contact is not made,
the plug may overheat and the
fuse may open.
• Plug in battery equipped electrical/electronic devices with
reverse current protection. The
current from the battery may
flow into the vehicle's electrical/electronic system and cause
system malfunction.
Convenience features of your vehicle
WARNING
To reduce a risk of serious or
fatal injuries:
• Do not use a heated electric
device such as a coffeepot,
toaster, heater, iron, etc.
• Do not insert foreign objects
into the outlet and do not
touch the outlet as you may
get shocked.
• Do not let children touch the
AC inverter.
3-170
NOTICE
• To prevent the battery from being
discharged, do not use the AC
inverter while the vehicle is not in
the ready (
) mode.
• When not using the AC inverter,
make sure to close the AC inverter cover.
• After using an electric accessory
or equipment, pull the plug out.
Leaving the accessory or equipment plugged in for a long time
may cause battery discharge.
• Do not use an electric accessory
or equipment the power consumption of which is greater
than 150W (115V).
• Some electric accessories or
equipments can cause electronic interference. It may cause
excessive audio noise and malfunctions in other electric systems or devices in the vehicle.
• Do not use broken electric
accessories or equipments,
which may damage the AC
inverter and electrical systems
of the vehicle.
• Do not use two or more electric
accessories or equipments at
the same time. It may cause
damage to the electrical systems of the vehicle.
• When the input voltage is lower,
outlet LED will blink and the AC
inverter will turn off automatically. If the input voltage goes up to
normal, the AC inverter will turn
on again.
USB Charger
The USB charger is designed to
recharge batteries of small size electrical devices using a USB cable.
The electrical devices can be
recharged when the POWER button
is ON.
Insert the USB charger into the USB
port, and re-charge a smart phone or
a tablet PC.
The battery charging state may be
monitored on the electrical device.
Disconnect the USB cable from the
USB port after use.
Wireless Cellular Phone
Charging System
3
OFE048078
On certain models, the vehicle
comes equipped with a wireless cellular phone charger.
The system is available when all
doors are closed, and when the
POWER button is ON.
3-171
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048079
• A smart phone or a tablet PC may
get warmer during the re-charging
process. It does not indicate any
malfunction with the charging system.
• A smart phone or a tablet PC,
which adopts a different re-charging method, may not be properly
re-charged. In this case, use an
exclusive charger of your device.
• The charging terminal is only to
recharge a device. Do not use the
charging terminal either to turn ON
an audio or to play media.
Convenience features of your vehicle
To charge a cellular phone
The wireless cellular phone charging
system charges only the Qi-enabled
cellular phones (
). Read the label
on the cellular phone accessory
cover or visit your cellular phone
manufacturer's website to check
whether your cellular phone supports
the Qi technology.
The wireless charging process starts
when you put a Qi-enabled cellular
phone on the wireless charging unit.
1. Remove other items, including the
smart key, from the wireless charging unit. If not, the wireless charging process may be interrupted.
Place the cellular phone on the
center of the charging pad (
).
2. The indicator light is orange when
the cellular phone is charging. The
indicator light turns green when
phone charging is complete.
3. You can turn ON or OFF the wireless charging function in the
Vehicle Settings mode on the
Infotainment system screen. For
further information, refer to the
separately supplied "Navigation
manual".
3-172
If your cellular phone is not charging:
- Slightly change the position of the
cellular phone on the charging
pad.
- Make sure the indicator light is
orange.
The indicator light will blink orange for
10 seconds if there is a malfunction in
the wireless charging system.
In this case, temporarily stop the
charging process, and re-attempt to
charge your cellular phone again.
The system warns you with a message on the LCD display if the cellular
phone is still on the wireless charging
unit after the POWER button is in the
OFF position and the front door is
opened.
i Information
For some manufacturer's cellular
phones, the system may not warn you
even though the cellular phone is left
on the wireless charging unit. This is
due to the particular characteristic of
the cellular phone and not a malfunction of the wireless charging.
NOTICE
• The wireless cellular phone
charging system may not support certain cellular phones,
which are not verified for the Qi
specification (
).
• When placing your cellular
phone on the charging mat,
position the phone in the middle
of the mat for optimal charging
performance. If your cell phone
is off to the side, the charging
rate may be less and in some
cases the cell phone may experience higher heat conduction.
• In some cases, the wireless
charging may stop temporarily
when the Smart Key is used,
either when starting the vehicle or
locking/unlocking the doors, etc.
• When charging certain cellular
phones, the charging indicator
may not change to green when
the cell phone is fully charged.
• When any cellular phone without a
wireless charging function or a
metallic object is placed on the
charging pad, a small noise may
sound. This small sound is due to
the vehicle discerning compatibility of the object placed on the
charging pad. It does not affect
your vehicle or the cellular phone
in any way.
Clock
WARNING
Do not attempt to adjust the
clock while driving. Doing so
may result in distracted driving
which may lead to an accident
involving personal injury or
death.
i Information
If the POWER button is in the OFF
position, the charging also stops.
i Information
This device complies with part 15 of
the FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Select the Vehicle Settings menu on
the Infotainment system screen ➟
Select [Date/Time].
• GPS time: Displays time according
to the received GNSS time.
• Daylight saving time : The clock is
adjusted forward one hour.
• Time format : Switches to 12 hour
or 24 hour.
For more details, refer to the separately supplied Navigation manual.
3-173
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
• The wireless charging process
may temporarily stop, when temperature abnormally increases
inside the wireless cellular phone
charging system. Stop the charging cellular phone and wait until
temperature falls to a certain level.
• The wireless charging process
may temporarily stop when there
is any metallic item, such as a
coin, between the wireless cellular
phone charging system and the
cellular phone.
• When charging some cellular
phones with a self-protection feature, the wireless charging speed
may decrease and the wireless
charging may stop.
• If the cellular phone has a thick
cover, the wireless charging may
not be possible.
• If the cell phone is not completely
contacting the charging pad, wireless charging may not operate
properly.
• Some magnetic items like credit
cards, phone cards or rail tickets
may be damaged if left with the
cellular phone during the charging
process.
Convenience features of your vehicle
Coat Hook
WARNING
OOS047065
These hangers are not designed to
hold large or heavy items.
3-174
Floor Mat Anchor(s)
OOS047066
Do not hang other objects such
as hangers or hard objects
except clothes. Also, do not put
heavy, sharp or breakable
objects in the clothes pockets.
In an accident or when the curtain air bag is inflated, it may
cause vehicle damage or personal injury.
OFE048081
ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors
to attach the front floor mats to the
vehicle. The anchors on the front
floor carpet keep the floor mats from
sliding forward.
WARNING
Do not overlay additional mats
or liners over the floor mats. If
using All Weather mats, remove
the carpeted floor mats before
installing them. Only use floor
mats designed to connect to the
anchors.
WARNING
WARNING
Avoid eye injury. DO NOT overstretch the luggage net. ALWAYS
keep your face and body out of
the luggage net's recoil path. DO
NOT use the luggage net when
the strap has visible signs of
wear or damage.
Use the luggage net to keep only
light items from shifting in the
luggage compartment.
OFE048082
To keep items from shifting in the luggage compartment, you can use the
4 holders located in the luggage
board to attach the luggage net.
Make sure the luggage net is securely
attached to the holders in the luggage
board.
3-175
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
The following must be observed
when installing ANY floor mat
to the vehicle.
• Ensure that the floor mats are
securely attached to the vehicle's floor mat anchor(s)
before driving the vehicle.
• Do not use ANY floor mat that
cannot be firmly attached to
the vehicle's floor mat anchors.
• Do not stack floor mats on top
of one another (e.g. all-weather rubber mat on top of a carpeted floor mat). Only a single
floor mat should be installed
in each position.
IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was
manufactured with driver’s side
floor mat anchors that are
designed to securely hold the
floor mat in place. To avoid any
interference with pedal operation, HYUNDAI recommends
that the HYUNDAI floor mat
designed for use in your vehicle
be installed.
Luggage Net Holder (if equipped)
Convenience features of your vehicle
To use the cargo security screen
Cargo Security Screen
When the cargo security screen is
not in use:
1. Pull the cargo security screen
backward and up to release it from
the guides.
2. The cargo security screen will
automatically slide back in.
i Information
OFE048083
OFE048084
Use the cargo security screen to
cover items stored in the cargo area.
1. Pull the cargo security screen
towards the rear of the vehicle by
the handle (1).
2. Insert the guide pin (2) into the
guide (3).
i Information
Pull out the cargo security screen with
the handle in the center to prevent the
guide pin from falling out of the guide.
3-176
The cargo security screen may not
automatically slide back in if the
cargo security screen is not fully
pulled out. Pull the cargo screen out
all the way and then slowly allow the
screen to retract back into the mechanism.
To remove the cargo security
screen
WARNING
• Do not place objects on the
3
Convenience features of your vehicle
OFE048085
1. Push one side of the cargo screen
inward to compress the spring
mechanism and release the
screen from the vehicle.
2. While the mechanism is compressed, pull out the cargo security
screen.
cargo security screen. Such
objects may be thrown about
inside the vehicle and possibly injure vehicle occupants
during an accident or when
braking.
• Never allow anyone to ride in
the luggage compartment. It is
designed for luggage only.
• Maintain the balance of the
vehicle and locate the weight
as forward as possible.
3-177
Convenience features of your vehicle
EXTERIOR FEATURES
Roof Side Rails (if equipped)
NOTICE
• The vehicle center of gravity will
• When carrying cargo on the roof
rack, take the necessary precautions to make sure the cargo
does not damage the roof of the
vehicle.
• When carrying large objects on
the roof rack, make sure they do
not exceed the overall roof
length or width.
WARNING
OFE048086
If your vehicle comes equipped with
roof side rails, then roof rack crossbars can be installed on top of your
vehicle.
The roof rack crossbars are an
accessory and are available at your
local HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
If the vehicle is equipped with a
sunroof, be sure not to position
cargo onto the roof rack in such a
way that it could interfere with
sunroof operation.
3-178
• The following specification is
the maximum weight that can
be loaded onto the roof rack.
Distribute the load as evenly
as possible onto the roof rack
and secure the load firmly.
Loading cargo or luggage in
excess of the specified weight
limit on the roof rack may
damage your vehicle.
ROOF
RACK
220 lbs. (100kg)
EVENLY DISTRIBUTED
be higher when items are
loaded onto the roof rack.
Avoid sudden starts, braking,
sharp turns, abrupt maneuvers
or high speeds that may result
in loss of vehicle control or
rollover resulting in an accident.
• Always drive slowly and turn
corners carefully when carrying items on the roof rack.
Severe wind updrafts, caused
by passing vehicles or natural
causes, can cause sudden
upward pressure on items
loaded on the roof rack. This
is especially true when carrying large, flat items such as
wood panels or mattresses.
This could cause the items to
fall off the roof rack and cause
damage to your vehicle or
others around you.
• To prevent damage or loss of
cargo while driving, check frequently before or while driving
to make sure the items on the
roof rack are securely fastened.
Infotainment System
Infotainment system ..............................................4-2
USB and iPod® port..........................................................4-2
Antenna ...............................................................................4-2
Steering wheel audio controls .......................................4-3
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology ..................................4-4
Blue Link® center .............................................................4-4
Audio / Video / Navigation system (Infotainment) ..4-4
4
Infotainment System
INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM
i Information
Antenna
Shark fin antenna
USB and iPod® port
• If you install an aftermarket HID
headlight, your vehicle's audio and
electronic devices may malfunction.
• Prevent chemicals such as perfume,
cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand cleaner, and air freshener from contacting
the interior parts because they may
cause damage or discoloration.
OFE048089
You can use an USB port to plug in
an USB and an iPod® port.
i Information
When using a portable audio device
connected to the power outlet, noise
may occur during playback. If this
happens, use the portable audio
device's power source.
❈ iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc.
4-2
OFE048087
The shark fin antenna will receive the
AM, FM broadcast signals, SXM,
LTE and transmit data.
Steering Wheel Audio Control
NOTICE
Do not operate multiple audio
remote control buttons simultaneously.
VOLUME (VOL + / - ) (1)
• Press the VOLUME (+) switch up
to increase volume.
• Press the VOLUME (-) switch down
to decrease volume.
/
) (2)
MODE (3)
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is
pressed up or down and held for 0.8
second or more, it will function in the
following modes:
Press the MODE button to toggle
through Radio, SXM, or Media mode.
RADIO mode
It will function as the AUTO SEEK
select button. It will SEEK until you
release the button.
• Press the MUTE button to mute the
sound.
• Press the MUTE button again to
activate the sound.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the FF/RW button.
If the SEEK/PRESET switch is
pressed up or down, it will function in
the following modes:
MUTE (
) (4)
4
i Information
Detailed information for audio control
buttons are described in the separately
supplied manual with the vehicle.
RADIO mode
It will function as the PRESET STATION UP/DOWN button.
MEDIA mode
It will function as the TRACK UP/
DOWN button.
4-3
Infotainment System
OFE048088
SEEK/PRESET (
Infotainment System
Bluetooth® Wireless
Technology
Audio / Video / Navigation system (Infotainment)
(1) Call / Answer button
(2) Call end button
(3) Microphone
Detailed information for the Bluetooth
hands-free is described in a separately supplied manual with the vehicle.
Blue Link® center
OFE048090
OFE048476N
OFE048091N
4-4
For details, refer to the Blue Link®
Owner's Guide, Navigation Manual
or Audio Manual.
Detailed
information
for
the
Infotainment system is described in a
separately supplied manual with the
vehicle.
Driving your vehicle
Before Driving ........................................................5-4
Drive Mode Integrated Control System ............5-37
Before Entering the Vehicle ...........................................5-4
Before Starting ..................................................................5-4
Drive mode change alert...............................................5-38
ECO mode climate control ............................................5-38
Power Button..........................................................5-6
Forward Collision-avoidance Assist (FCA)
System ...................................................................5-39
POWER Button Positions.................................................5-7
Starting the Vehicle ..........................................................5-9
Turning Off the Vehicle .................................................5-10
Reduction Gear.....................................................5-11
Reduction Gear Operation ............................................5-11
Parking...............................................................................5-13
LCD Display Messages ...................................................5-13
Good Driving Practices ..................................................5-16
Paddle Shifter (Regenerative Braking
Control)..................................................................5-17
Braking System ....................................................5-18
Power Brakes ...................................................................5-18
Disc Brake Wear Indicator ............................................5-19
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)...................................5-19
Auto Hold ..........................................................................5-25
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ....................................5-29
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)................................5-31
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM).........................5-34
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ....................................5-36
Good Braking Practices.................................................5-36
System Setting and Activation.....................................5-39
FCA Warning Message and System Control ............5-41
FCA Sensor (Front Radar/Front View Camera).......5-44
System Malfunction .......................................................5-46
Limitations of the System.............................................5-47
Blind-Spot Collision Warning/
Blind-Spot Collision-avoidance Assist..............5-53
System Description .........................................................5-53
System Setting and Activation.....................................5-54
Warning and System Control .......................................5-57
Detecting Sensor (Front View Camera and
Rear Corner Radar) ........................................................5-59
Limitations of the System.............................................5-62
Rear Cross-traffic Collision Warning (RCCW)/
Rear Cross-traffic Collision-avoidance Assist
(RCCA) ...................................................................5-67
System Description .........................................................5-67
System Setting and Activation.....................................5-68
Warning and System Control .......................................5-69
Limitations of the System.............................................5-73
5
Blind-Spot View Monitor System......................5-77
Operating conditions ......................................................5-77
Blind-Spot View Monitor system warning ...............5-78
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) System ...................5-79
LKA System Operation...................................................5-80
Warning Light and Message.........................................5-83
Limitations of the System.............................................5-85
LKA System Function Change......................................5-86
Declaration of conformity ...............................5-115
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert .....................5-116
Lane Following Assist (LFA) System.................5-87
Hazardous Driving Conditions....................................5-118
Rocking the Vehicle......................................................5-118
Smooth Cornering.........................................................5-119
Driving at Night .............................................................5-119
Driving in the Rain ........................................................5-119
Driving in Flooded Areas.............................................5-120
Highway Driving ............................................................5-120
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover ...............................5-121
LFA operation...................................................................5-88
Warning message ............................................................5-90
Limitations of the system .............................................5-92
5
Smart Cruise Control Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance...........................................................................5-105
Sensor to Detect Distance to the Vehicle Ahead .5-108
Limitations of the System...........................................5-110
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) System.........5-94
System Setting and Activation ..................................5-116
Special Driving Conditions ................................5-118
System Setting and Activation.....................................5-94
Resetting the System .....................................................5-95
System Standby...............................................................5-96
System Malfunction .......................................................5-96
Winter Driving ....................................................5-122
Smart Cruise Control With Stop &
Go System .............................................................5-98
Snow or Icy Conditions................................................5-122
Winter Precautions.......................................................5-124
Smart Cruise Control Switch ........................................5-99
To Adjust the Sensitivity of
Smart Cruise Control ....................................................5-100
To Convert to Cruise Control Mode .........................5-100
Smart Cruise Control Speed .......................................5-101
Vehicle Load Limit..............................................5-126
Tire Loading Information Label.................................5-126
Trailer Towing.....................................................5-131
WARNING
Keep the air intakes clear.
To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.
If you must drive with the liftgate open:
Close all windows.
Open instrument panel air vents.
Set the air intake control at "Fresh", the air flow control at "Floor" or "Face", and the fan control set to high.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-3
Driving your vehicle
BEFORE DRIVING
WARNING
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65
WARNING
A wide variety of automobile
components including components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or
emit harmful chemicals known
to the State of California to
cause cancer and birth defects
and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in
vehicles and certain products
of components contain or emit
chemicals known to the State of
California to cause cancer and
birth defects or other reproductive harm.
5-4
Before Entering the Vehicle
Before Starting
• Be sure all windows, outside mirror(s), and outside lights are clean
and unobstructed.
• Remove frost, snow, or ice.
• Visually check the tires for uneven
wear and damage.
• Check under the vehicle for any
sign of leaks.
• Be sure there are no obstacles
behind you if you intend to back up.
• Make sure the hood, the liftgate,
and the doors are securely closed
and locked.
• Adjust the position of the seat and
steering wheel.
• Adjust the inside and outside
rearview mirrors.
• Verify all the lights work.
• Fasten your seatbelt. Check that all
passengers have fastened their
seatbelts.
• Check the gauges and indicators in
the instrument panel and the messages on the instrument display
when the POWER button is in the
ON position.
• Check that any items you are carrying are stored properly or fastened down securely.
WARNING
NEVER drink or take drugs and
drive.
Drinking or taking drugs and driving is dangerous and may result
in an accident and SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH.
Drunk driving is the number
one contributor to the highway
death toll each year. Even a
small amount of alcohol will
affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment. Just one
drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions
and emergencies and your reaction time gets worse with each
additional drink.
Driving while under the influence of drugs is as dangerous
as or more dangerous than driving under the influence of alcohol.
You are much more likely to have
a serious accident if you drink or
take drugs and drive. If you are
drinking or taking drugs, don't
drive. Do not ride with a driver
who has been drinking or taking
drugs. Choose a designated driver or call a taxi.
5
Driving your vehicle
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following precautions:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt.
All passengers must be properly belted whenever the vehicle is moving. For more information, refer to "Seat Belts" in
chapter 2.
• Always drive defensively.
Assume other drivers or pedestrians may be careless and
make mistakes.
• Stay focused on the task of
driving. Driver distraction can
cause accidents.
• Leave plenty of space between
you and the vehicle in front of
you.
WARNING
5-5
Driving your vehicle
POWER BUTTON
If the vehicle is still moving, you
can restart the vehicle without
depressing the brake pedal by
pressing the POWER button
with the gear in the N (Neutral)
position.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, take the following precautions:
• NEVER allow children or any
person who is unfamiliar with
the vehicle to touch the
POWER button or related
parts. Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can
occur.
• NEVER reach through the
steering wheel for the POWER
button or any other control,
while the vehicle is in motion.
The presence of your hand or
arm in this area may cause a
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
5-6
WARNING
OFE058001
Whenever the front door is opened,
the POWER button will illuminate
and will go off 30 seconds after the
door is closed.
WARNING
To turn the vehicle off in an
emergency:
Press and hold the POWER button for more than two seconds
OR Rapidly press and release
the POWER button three times
(within three seconds).
• NEVER press the POWER button while the vehicle is in
motion except in an emergency. This will result in the
vehicle turning off and loss of
power assist for the steering
and brake systems. This may
lead to loss of directional control and braking function,
which could cause an accident.
• Before leaving the driver's seat,
always make sure the gear is in
the P (Park) position, set the
parking brake, press the
POWER button to the OFF position, and take the Smart Key
with you. Unexpected vehicle
movement may occur if these
precautions are not followed.
POWER Button Positions
Button Position
Action
OFF
To turn off the vehicle, press the POWER
button with the gear in P (Park).
Also, the vehicle will turn off when the
POWER button is pressed with the gear in D
(Drive) or R (Reverse) because the gear
automatically shifts to the P (Park) position.
But, when it is pressed in N (Neutral), the
POWER button will go to the ACC position.
Press the POWER button when the button
is in the OFF position without depressing
the brake pedal.
Some electrical accessories are usable.
5
Driving your vehicle
ACC
Notice
5-7
Driving your vehicle
Button Position
ON
START
5-8
Action
Press the POWER button while it is in the
ACC position without depressing the brake
pedal.
Notice
Do not leave the POWER button in the ON
position when the vehicle is not in the ready
(
) mode to prevent the battery from discharging.
To start the vehicle, depress the brake pedal If you press the POWER button without
and press the POWER button with the gear depressing the brake pedal, the vehicle does
in the P (Park) position.
not start and the POWER button changes as
follows:
OFF → ACC → ON → OFF or ACC
Starting the Vehicle
WARNING
• Always wear appropriate shoes
when operating your vehicle.
Unsuitable shoes, such as high
heels, ski boots, sandals, flipflops, etc., may interfere with
your ability to use the brake
and accelerator pedals.
• Do not start the vehicle with the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle can move and
lead to an accident.
i Information
i Information
• Always start the vehicle with your
foot on the brake pedal.
• If ambient temperature is low, the
"
" indicator may remain illuminated longer than the normal amount
of time.
5-9
5
Driving your vehicle
• The vehicle will start by pressing the
POWER button, only when the
smart key is in the vehicle.
• Even if the smart key is in the vehicle, and when it is far away from the
driver, the vehicle may not start.
• When the POWER button is in the
ACC or ON position, any door is
open, the system checks for the
smart key. When the smart key is
not in the vehicle, the "
" indicator will blink and the warning "Key
not in vehicle" will come on. When
all doors are closed, the chime will
also sound for about 5 seconds.
Keep the smart key in the vehicle
when in the ACC position or if the
vehicle is in the ready (
) mode.
1. Always carry the smart key with
you.
2. Make sure the parking brake is
applied.
3. Make sure the gear is in P (Park).
4. Depress the brake pedal.
5. Press the POWER button. If the
vehicle starts, the "
" indicator
will come on.
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
Emergency starting
Turning Off the Vehicle
1.
2.
3.
4.
Depress the brake pedal fully.
Shift to P (Park).
Apply the parking brake.
Press the POWER button to turn
the vehicle off.
5. Make sure the "
" indicator
light on the instrument cluster is
turned off.
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
If the "
" indicator turns off
while you are in motion, do not
attempt to shift to the P (Park)
position.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the vehicle:
When the stop lamp fuse is blown,
you cannot normally start the
vehicle. Replace the fuse with a
new one. If you are not able to
replace the fuse, you can start the
vehicle by pressing and holding
the POWER button for 10 seconds
with the POWER button in the ACC
position.
Do not press the POWER button
for more than 10 seconds except
when the stop lamp fuse is blown.
For your safety always depress
the brake pedal before starting the
vehicle.
5-10
CAUTION
OFE058004
If the smart key battery is weak or
the smart key does not work correctly, you can start the vehicle by pressing the POWER button with the
smart key in the direction of the picture above.
If the "
" indicator light on
the instrument cluster is still
on, the vehicle is not turned off
and can move when the gear is
in any position except P (Park).
REDUCTION GEAR
Gear position
Reduction Gear Operation
WARNING
OFE058005L
Select gear positions by pressing the
shift button.
For your safety, always depress the
brake pedal while shifting to another
gear.
OCN7040013N
The indicator in the instrument cluster displays the gear position when
the POWER button is in the ON position.
5-11
5
Driving your vehicle
To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death:
• ALWAYS check the surrounding areas near your vehicle for
people, especially children,
before shifting a vehicle into
D (Drive) or R (Reverse).
• Before leaving the driver's
seat, always make sure the
gear is in the P (Park) position, then set the parking
brake, and place the POWER
button in the OFF position.
Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can occur if
these precautions are not followed.
Driving your vehicle
P (Park)
Always come to a complete stop
before shifting into P (Park).
To shift the gear from R (Reverse), N
(Neutral) or D (Drive) to P (Park),
press the [P] button.
If you turn off the vehicle in D (Drive)
or R (Reverse), the gear automatically shifts to P (Park).
WARNING
• Shifting into P (Park) while the
vehicle is in motion may
cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
• After the vehicle has stopped,
always make sure the gear is
in P (Park), apply the parking
brake, and turn the vehicle off.
• Do not use the P (Park) position in place of the parking
brake.
5-12
R (Reverse)
Use this position to drive the vehicle
backward.
To shift to R (Reverse), press the [R]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
N (Neutral)
The wheels and gear are not
engaged.
To shift to N (Neutral), press the [N]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
Always depress the brake pedal
when you are shifting from N
(Neutral) to another gear.
In N (Neutral), if the driver attempts
to turn off the vehicle, the gear
remains in N (Neutral) and the
POWER button will be in the ACC
position.
To turn off the vehicle from the ACC
position, press the [P] button within 3
minutes. The vehicle will shift to P
(Park) and turn off.
When the driver’s door is opened
within 3 minutes with the POWER
button in the ACC position and the
gear in N (Neutral), the vehicle is
automatically turned OFF and shifted
to the P (Park) position.
D (Drive)
This is the normal driving position.
To shift to D (Drive), press the [D]
button while depressing the brake
pedal.
Shift-lock system
Parking
For your safety, your vehicle has a
shift-lock system which prevents
shifting the gear from P (Park) or N
(Neutral) into R (Reverse) or D
(Drive) unless the brake pedal is
depressed.
To shift from P (Park) or N (Neutral)
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive) :
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the vehicle or place the
POWER button in the ON position.
3. Press the R (Reverse) or D (Drive)
button.
Always come to a complete stop and
continue to depress the brake pedal.
Shift to the P (Park) position, apply
the parking brake, and place the
POWER button in the OFF position.
Take the Key with you when exiting
the vehicle.
You cannot shift the gear when the
battery is discharged.
Jump start your vehicle (refer to
“Jump Starting” in chapter 6) or contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OFE051008N
The message appears on the LCD
display when driving speed is too
fast to shift the gear.
Decrease the vehicle speed or slow
down before shifting the gear.
5-13
5
Driving your vehicle
When the battery (12 V) is discharged
LCD Display Messages
Shifting conditions not met
Driving your vehicle
Press brake pedal to change
gear
OFE051009N
The message appears on the LCD
display, when the brake pedal is not
depressed while shifting the gear.
Depress the brake pedal and then
shift the gear.
5-14
Shift to P after stopping
Gear already selected
OFE051010N
OFE051014N
The message appears on the LCD
display when the gear is shifted to P
(Park) while the vehicle is moving.
Stop the vehicle before shifting to P
(Park).
The message appears on the LCD
display when the selected gear button is pressed again.
Shift button held down
Check shift controls
PARK malfunction. Engage
parking brake when parking
vehicle
OFE051016N
The message appears on the LCD
display when the shift button is continuously pressed or there is problem
with the button.
Make sure that there is no object
over the shift button. If the problem
persists, immediately have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
The message appears on the LCD
display when there is problem with
the shift buttons.
Immediately have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5
OFE041530N
The message appears on the LCD
display when there is problem with
function engaging P (Park) position.
Immediately have the vehicle
inspected
by
an
authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-15
Driving your vehicle
OFE051015N
Driving your vehicle
Good Driving Practices
• Never shift to P (Park) or N
(Neutral) to any other position with
the accelerator pedal depressed.
• Never shift to P (Park) when the
vehicle is in motion.
Be sure the vehicle is completely
stopped before you attempt to shift
into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).
• Do not shift to N (Neutral) when
driving. Doing so may result in an
accident.
• Do not drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
consistent pedal pressure can
result in the brakes overheating,
brake wear and possibly even
brake failure.
• Always apply the parking brake
when leaving the vehicle. Do not
depend on placing the gear in P
(Park) to keep the vehicle from
moving.
5-16
• Exercise extreme caution when
driving on a slippery surface. Be
especially careful when braking,
accelerating or shifting gears. On a
slippery surface, an abrupt change
in vehicle speed can cause the
drive wheels to lose traction and
may cause loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident
• Optimum vehicle performance and
economy is obtained by smoothly
depressing and releasing the
accelerator.
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH:
• ALWAYS wear your seat belt.
In a collision, an unbelted
occupant is significantly more
likely to be seriously injured
or killed than a properly belted occupant.
• Avoid high speeds when cornering or turning.
• Do not make quick steering
wheel movements, such as
sharp lane changes or fast,
sharp turns.
• The risk of rollover is greatly
•
•
•
•
increased if you lose control
of your vehicle at highway
speeds.
Loss of control often occurs if
two or more wheels drop off
the roadway and the driver
over steers to reenter the
roadway.
In the event your vehicle
leaves the roadway, do not
steer sharply. Instead, slow
down before pulling back into
the travel lanes.
HYUNDAI recommends you
follow all posted speed limits.
When driving uphill or downhill, always shift to D (Drive)
for driving forward or shift to
R (Reverse) for driving rearwards. After selecting D
(Drive) or R (Reverse), check
the gear position indicated on
the cluster before driving. If
the vehicle moves in the
opposite direction of the
selected gear, the engine may
turn off and a serious accident might occur due to
degraded brake performance.
PADDLE SHIFTER (REGENERATIVE BRAKING CONTROL)
i Information
The paddle shifter does not operate
when:
• Both Paddle shifters are pulled at
the same time.
• The Smart Cruise Control system is
activated.
• The vehicle is shifted to P (Park), R
(Reverse) and N (Neutral).
OFE058017
NOTICE
If the battery is fully charged when
descending down a long or steep
hill, the regenerative braking is
not working even though operating the paddle shifter. In this case,
depress the brake pedal to brake
the vehicle. This is normal and
does not indicate a problem with
your paddle shifter and brakes.
OFE051018N
The selected regenerative braking
rate is displayed on the instrument
cluster.
What Does Regenerative
Braking Do?
It uses the electric motor when
decelerating or braking which transforms vehicle motion (kinetic energy)
to electrical energy to charge the
high voltage batteries.
5-17
5
Driving your vehicle
The paddle shifter is used to adjust
the regenerative braking rate from 0
to 3 during decelerating or braking.
• Left side (
): Increases regenerative braking and deceleration.
• Right side (
): Decreases
regenerative braking and deceleration.
• Pull and hold the left side paddle
shifter to change to 0.
• Pull and hold the left side paddle
shifter to change to 3.
Driving your vehicle
BRAKING SYSTEM
Power Brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted
brakes that adjust automatically
through normal usage.
If the power is not supplied such as
battery discharge, the power assist
for the brakes will not work. You can
still stop your vehicle by applying
greater force to the brake pedal than
typical. The stopping distance, however, will be longer than with power
brakes.
Do not pump the brake pedal when
the power assist has been interrupted.
i Information
• When the brake pedal is depressed
under certain driving conditions
or weather conditions, you may
temporarily hear a noise. This is
normal and does not indicate a
problem with your brakes.
5-18
• While driving on a road with deicing chemicals, brake noise or abnormal tire wear may occur due to
deicing chemicals. In a safe traffic
condition, additionally apply the
brakes to remove deicing chemicals
on the brake discs and pads.
WARNING
Take the following precautions:
• Do not drive with your foot
resting on the brake pedal.
This will create abnormal high
brake temperatures, excessive brake lining and pad
wear, and increased stopping
distances.
• When descending down a
long or steep hill, use the paddle shifter (left side lever) to
increase regenerative braking
control in order to control
your speed without using the
brake pedal excessively.
Applying the brakes continuously will cause the brakes to
overheat and could result in a
temporary loss of braking performance.
• Wet brakes may impair the
vehicle's ability to safely slow
down; the vehicle may also
pull to one side when the
brakes are applied. Applying
the brakes lightly will indicate
whether they have been
affected in this way. Always
test your brakes in this fashion after driving through deep
water. To dry the brakes, lightly tap the brake pedal to heat
up the brakes while maintaining a safe forward speed until
brake performance returns to
normal. Avoid driving at high
speeds until the brakes function correctly.
NOTICE
When your brake pads are worn and
new pads are required, you will hear
a high pitched warning sound from
your front or rear brakes. You may
hear this sound come and go or it
may occur whenever you depress
the brake pedal.
Electronic Parking Brake
(EPB)
Applying the parking brake
NOTICE
To avoid costly brake repairs, do
not continue to drive with worn
brake pads.
i Information
Always replace brake pads as complete front or rear axle sets.
5
OFE058019
To apply the EPB (Electronic
Parking Brake):
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Pull the EPB switch upwards.
Make sure the Parking Brake
Warning Light comes on.
With the AUTO HOLD feature
enabled, the EPB is automatically
applied when the vehicle is shut off.
5-19
Driving your vehicle
• Do not continue depressing the
brake pedal if the "
" indicator is OFF. The battery may be
discharged.
• Noise and vibration generated
during braking is normal.
• Under normal operation, electric
brake pump noise and motor
vibration may occur temporarily
in below cases.
- When the pedal is depressed
suddenly.
- When the pedal is repeatedly
depressed in short intervals.
- When the ABS function is activated while braking.
Disc Brake Wear Indicator
Driving your vehicle
However, if the Auto Hold function is
not activated, the EPB is not automatically applied even though the
vehicle stops and turned off.
Releasing the parking brake
WARNING
To reduce the risk of SERIOUS
INJURY or DEATH, do not operate the parking brake while the
vehicle is moving except in an
emergency situation. It could
damage the brake system and
lead to an accident.
5-20
OFE058020
To release the EPB (Electronic
Parking Brake), press the EPB
switch in the following condition:
• Have the POWER button in the ON
position.
• Depress the brake pedal.
Make sure the Parking Brake
Warning Light goes off.
To release EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) automatically:
• Shifted to P (Park)
With the vehicle in the ready (
)
mode depress the brake pedal and
shift out of P (Park) to R (Reverse),
D (Drive).
• Shifted to N (Neutral)
With the vehicle in the ready (
)
mode depress the brake pedal and
shift out of N (Neutral) to R
(Reverse) or D (Drive).
• Under the following conditions
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Fasten the driver's seat belt.
3. Close the driver's door, hood
and liftgate.
4. Depress the accelerator pedal
while the gear is in D (Drive) or
R (Reverse).
The Parking Brake Warning Light
should be turned off when the EPB is
released.
i Information
• For your safety, you can engage the
EPB even though the POWER button is in the OFF position, but you
cannot release it.
• For your safety, depress the brake
pedal and release the parking brake
manually with the EPB switch when
you drive downhill or when backing
up the vehicle.
EPB (Electronic Parking Brake)
may be automatically applied
when:
• Requested by other systems
• If the driver turns the vehicle off
while Auto Hold is operating, EPB
will be automatically applied.
Warning messages
NOTICE
OFE061038N
To release EPB, fasten seatbelt and
close door, hood and liftgate
• If you try to drive with the EPB
applied, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
• If the driver's seat belt is not fastened and the hood or liftgate is
opened, a warning will sound and
a message will appear.
• If there is a problem with the vehicle, a warning may sound and a
message may appear.
If the situation occurs, depress the
brake pedal and release EPB by
pressing the EPB switch.
5-21
5
Driving your vehicle
• If the parking brake warning light
is still on even though the EPB
has been released, have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Do not drive your vehicle with
the EPB applied. It may cause
excessive brake pad and brake
rotor wear.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• To prevent unintentional movement when stopped and leaving the vehicle, do not use the
P (Park) position in place of the
parking brake. Set the parking
brake and make sure the vehicle is securely positioned in P
(Park).
• Never allow anyone who is
unfamiliar with the vehicle to
touch the parking brake. If the
parking brake is released
unintentionally, serious injury
may occur.
• All vehicles should always
have the parking brake fully
engaged when parking to
avoid inadvertent movement
of the car which can injure
occupants or pedestrians.
5-22
NOTICE
• A click sound may be heard
while operating or releasing the
EPB, but these conditions are
normal and indicate that the
EPB is functioning properly.
• When leaving your keys with a
parking lot attendant or valet,
make sure to inform him/her
how to operate the EPB.
• The EPB may malfunction if you
drive with the EPB applied.
• When you automatically release
EPB by depressing the accelerator pedal, depress it slowly.
OIK060067L
AUTO HOLD turning Off!
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold
to EPB is not working properly a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
EPB malfunction indicator
The EPB malfunction indicator may
illuminate when the ESC (Electronic
Stability Control) indicator comes on
to indicate that the ESC is not working properly, but it does not indicate a
malfunction of the EPB.
NOTICE
OIK060069L
OFE041531N
This warning light illuminates if the
POWER button is changed to the ON
position and goes off in approximately 3 seconds if the system is operating normally.
If the EPB malfunction indicator
remains on, comes on while driving,
or does not come on when the
POWER button is changed to the ON
position, this indicates that the EPB
may have malfunctioned.
If this occurs, have the system
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
5-23
5
Driving your vehicle
Parking brake automatically
engaged
If the EPB is applied while Auto Hold
is activated, a warning will sound and
a message will appear.
• If the EPB warning light is still
on, have the system checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the parking brake warning
light does not illuminate or
blinks even though the EPB
switch was pulled up, the EPB
may not be applied.
• If the parking brake warning
light blinks when the EPB warning light is on, press the switch,
then pull it up. Once more press
it back to its original position
and pull it back up. If the EPB
warning does not go off, have
the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Driving your vehicle
Parking brake warning light
Emergency braking
Check the Parking
Brake Warning Light
by placing the POWER
button to the ON position (do not start the
vehicle).
This light will be illuminated when the
parking brake is applied with the
POWER button in the START or ON
position.
Before driving, be sure the parking
brake is released and the Brake
Warning Light is OFF.
If the Parking Brake Warning Light
remains on after the parking brake is
released while the vehicle is in the
ready (
) mode, there may be a
malfunction in the brake system.
Immediate attention is necessary.
If at all possible, cease driving the
vehicle immediately. If that is not possible, use extreme caution while
operating the vehicle and only continue to drive the vehicle until you
can reach a safe location.
If there is a problem with the brake
pedal while driving, emergency braking is possible by pulling up and
holding the EPB switch. Braking is
possible only while you are holding
the EPB switch.
5-24
WARNING
Do not operate the parking
brake while the vehicle is moving except in an emergency situation.
i Information
During emergency braking by the
EPB, the parking brake warning light
will illuminate to indicate that the system is operating.
NOTICE
If you continuously notice a noise
or burning smell when the EPB is
used for emergency braking, have
the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
When the EPB (Electronic Parking
Brake) does not release
If the EPB does not release normally, contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer by loading the vehicle on a
flatbed tow truck and have the system checked.
Auto Hold
The Auto Hold maintains the vehicle
in a standstill even though the brake
pedal is not depressed after the driver brings the vehicle to a complete
stop by depressing the brake pedal.
Set up
White
White
Green
OFE058025
OFE058024
5-25
5
Driving your vehicle
1. With the driver's door, liftgate and
hood closed, depress the brake
pedal and then press the [AUTO
HOLD] switch. The white AUTO
HOLD indicator will come on and
the system will be in the standby
position.
2. When you stop the vehicle completely by depressing the brake
pedal, the AUTO HOLD indicator
changes from white to green.
3. The vehicle will remain stationary
even if you release the brake
pedal.
4. If EPB is applied, Auto Hold will be
released.
Driving your vehicle
Leaving
• If you press the accelerator pedal
with the gear in D (Drive) or R
(Reverse), the Auto Hold will be
released automatically and the
vehicle will start to move. The
AUTO HOLD indicator changes
from green to white.
• If the vehicle is restarted using the
cruise control toggle switch (RES+
or SET-) while Auto Hold and cruise
control is operating, the Auto Hold
will be released regardless of
accelerator pedal operation. The
AUTO HOLD indicator changes
from green to white. (if equipped
with Smart Cruise Control system)
WARNING
When driving off from Auto
Hold by depressing the accelerator pedal, always check the
surrounding area near your
vehicle.
Slowly depress the accelerator
pedal for a smooth start.
5-26
Cancel
i Information
Light off
OFE058026
To cancel the Auto Hold operation,
press the [AUTO HOLD] switch. The
AUTO HOLD indicator will turn off.
To cancel the Auto Hold operation
when the vehicle is at a standstill,
press the [AUTO HOLD] switch while
depressing the brake pedal.
• The Auto Hold does not operate
when:
- Driver's door is opened
- Liftgate is opened
- Hood is opened
- The gear is in P (Park)
- The EPB is applied
• For your safety, the Auto Hold automatically switches to EPB in such
cases:
- Driver's door is opened
- Liftgate is opened
- Hood is opened
- The vehicle is in a standstill for
more than 10 minutes
- The vehicle is standing on a steep
slope
- The vehicle moved several times
WARNING
Warning messages
• Depress the accelerator pedal
slowly when you start the
vehicle.
• For your safety, cancel the
Auto Hold when you drive
downhill, back up the vehicle
or park the vehicle.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
driver's door, liftgate or hood
open detection system, the Auto
Hold may not work properly.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OIK060069L
Parking brake automatically
engaged
When the EPB is applied from Auto
Hold, a warning will sound and a
message will appear.
5-27
5
Driving your vehicle
In these cases, the parking brake
warning light comes on, the AUTO
HOLD indicator changes from green
to white, and a warning sounds and
a message will appear to inform you
that EPB has been automatically
engaged. Before driving again,
depress the brake pedal, check the
surrounding area near your vehicle
and release the parking brake manually with the EPB switch.
• If the AUTO HOLD indicator lights
up yellow, the Auto Hold not working properly. Contact an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• While operating Auto Hold, you may
hear mechanical noise. However, it is
normal operating noise.
Driving your vehicle
OIK060067L
OIK060071L
OFE061037N
AUTO HOLD turning Off!
Press brake pedal
When the conversion from Auto Hold
to EPB is not working properly a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
Depress the brake pedal when the
above message appears for the Auto
Hold and EPB may not activate.
Press brake pedal to deactivate
AUTO HOLD
If you did not apply the brake pedal
when you release the Auto Hold by
pressing the [AUTO HOLD] switch, a
warning will sound and a message
will appear.
AUTO HOLD conditions not met.
Close door, Hood and liftgate
When you press the [AUTO HOLD]
switch, if the driver's door, hood and
liftgate are not closed, a warning will
sound and a message will appear on
the LCD display.
Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch after
closing the driver's door, hood and
liftgate.
5-28
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
WARNING
face is pitted or has different
surface height.
• Tire chains are installed on
your vehicle.
The safety features of an ABS
or ESC equipped vehicle should
not be tested by high speed
driving or cornering. This could
endanger the safety of yourself
or others.
ABS is an electronic braking system
that helps prevent a braking skid.
ABS allows the driver to steer and
brake at the same time.
Using ABS
To obtain the maximum benefit from
your ABS in an emergency situation,
do not attempt to modulate your
brake pressure and do not try to
pump your brakes. Depress your
brake pedal as hard as possible.
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the
wheels, you may hear sounds from
the brakes, or feel a corresponding
sensation in the brake pedal. This is
normal and it means your ABS is
active.
ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes to stop the vehicle.
Always maintain a safe distance from
the vehicle in front of you.
ABS will not prevent a skid that
results from sudden changes in
direction, such as trying to take a
corner too fast or making a sudden
lane change. Always drive at a safe
speed for the road and weather conditions.
5-29
5
Driving your vehicle
An Anti-Lock Braking System
(ABS) or an Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) system will not
prevent accidents due to
improper or dangerous driving
maneuvers. Even though vehicle control is improved during
emergency braking, always
maintain a safe distance
between you and objects ahead
of you. Vehicle speeds should
always be reduced during
extreme road conditions. The
braking distance for cars
equipped with ABS or ESC may
be longer than for those without
these systems in the following
road conditions.
Drive your vehicle at reduced
speeds during the following
conditions:
• Rough, gravel or snow-covered roads.
• On roads where the road sur-
Driving your vehicle
ABS cannot prevent a loss of stability. Always steer moderately when
braking hard. Severe or sharp steering wheel movement can still cause
your vehicle to veer into oncoming
traffic or off the road.
On loose or uneven road surfaces,
operation of the anti-lock brake system may result in a longer stopping
distance than for vehicles equipped
with a conventional brake system.
The ABS warning light (
) will stay
on for several seconds after the
POWER button is in the ON position.
During that time, the ABS will go
through self-diagnosis and the light
will go off if everything is normal. If
the light stays on, you may have a
problem with your ABS. Contact an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
5-30
WARNING
If the ABS warning light (
) is
on and stays on, you may have
a problem with the ABS. Your
power brakes will work normally. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death, contact your
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
NOTICE
When you drive on a road having
poor traction, such as an icy road,
and apply your brakes continuously, the ABS will be active continuously and the ABS warning
light (
) may illuminate. Pull
your car over to a safe place and
turn the vehicle off.
Restart the vehicle. If the ABS
warning light is off, then your ABS
system is normal.
Otherwise, you may have a problem with your ABS system.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
i Information
When you jump start your vehicle
because of a drained battery, the ABS
warning light (
) may turn on at the
same time. This happens because of
the low battery voltage. It does not
mean your ABS is malfunctioning.
Have the battery recharged before
driving the vehicle.
Electronic Stability Control
(ESC)
WARNING
Never drive too fast for the road
conditions or too quickly when
cornering. The ESC system will
not prevent accidents.
Excessive speed in turns,
abrupt
maneuvers,
and
hydroplaning on wet surfaces
can result in severe accidents.
ESC operation
ESC ON condition
When the POWER button is in the
ON position, the ESC and the ESC
OFF indicator lights illuminate for
approximately three seconds. After
both lights go off, the ESC is
enabled.
5
OFE058030
Driving your vehicle
The Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) system helps to stabilize the
vehicle during cornering maneuvers.
ESC checks where you are steering
and where the vehicle is actually
going. ESC applies braking pressure
to any one of the vehicle's brakes
and intervenes in the electric vehicle
control system to assist the driver
with keeping the vehicle on the
intended path. It is not a substitute
for safe driving practices. Always
adjust your speed and driving to the
road conditions.
5-31
Driving your vehicle
When operating
When the ESC is in operation, the ESC indicator light
blinks:
• When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may lock the
wheels, you may hear sounds from
the brakes, or feel a corresponding
sensation in the brake pedal. This is
normal and it means your ESC is
active.
• When the ESC activates, the vehicle may not respond to the accelerator as it does under routine conditions.
• If the Smart Cruise Control was in
use when the ESC activates, the
Smart Cruise Control automatically
disengages. The Smart Cruise
Control can be reengaged when the
road conditions allow. See "Smart
cruise control with stop & go system" later in this chapter.
5-32
ESC OFF condition
To cancel ESC operation :
• State 2
• State 1
OFE051032N
OFE051031N
Press the ESC OFF button briefly.
The ESC OFF indicator light and
message "Traction Control disabled"
will illuminate. In this state, the traction control function of ESC is disabled, but the brake control function
of ESC still operates.
Press and hold the ESC OFF button
continuously for more than 3 seconds. The ESC OFF indicator light
and message "Traction & Stability
Control disabled" illuminates and a
warning chime sounds. In this state,
both the traction control function of
ESC and the brake control function
of ESC are disabled.
If the POWER button is placed to the
OFF position when ESC is off, ESC
remains off. Upon restarting the vehicle, the ESC will automatically turn
on again.
Indicator lights
■ ESC indicator light (blinks)
■ ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)
When the ESC is blinking, this
indicates the ESC is active:
Drive slowly and NEVER attempt
to accelerate. NEVER turn the
ESC off while the ESC indicator
light is blinking or you may lose
control of the vehicle resulting in
an accident.
ESC OFF usage
When Driving
The ESC OFF mode should only be
used briefly to help free the vehicle if
stuck in snow or mud, by temporarily
stopping operation of the ESC, to
maintain wheel torque.
To turn ESC off while driving, press
the ESC OFF button while driving on
a flat road surface.
NOTICE
5
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the ESC
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four
tires and wheels are the same
size. Never drive the vehicle with
different sized wheels and tires
installed.
Driving your vehicle
When the POWER button is pressed
to the ON position, the ESC indicator
light illuminates, then goes off if the
ESC system is operating normally.
The ESC indicator light blinks whenever the ESC is operating.
If the ESC indicator light stays on,
your vehicle may have a malfunction
with the ESC system. When this
warning light illuminates, have the
vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
The ESC OFF indicator light comes
on when the ESC is turned off with
the button.
WARNING
5-33
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
• Do not allow wheel(s) of one
axle to spin excessively while
the ESC, ABS, and parking brake
warning lights are displayed.
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.
Reduce vehicle power and do
not spin the wheel(s) excessively while these lights are displayed.
• When operating the vehicle on a
dynamometer, make sure the
ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light
illuminated).
i Information
Turning the ESC off does not affect
ABS or standard brake system operation.
5-34
Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM)
VSM operation
VSM ON condition
The Vehicle Stability Management
(VSM) is a function of the Electronic
Stability Control (ESC) system. It
helps ensure the vehicle stays stable
when accelerating or braking suddenly on wet, slippery and rough
roads where traction over the four
tires can suddenly become uneven.
The VSM operates when:
• The Electronic Stability Control
(ESC) is on.
• Vehicle speed is approximately
above 9 mph (15 km/h) on curve
roads.
• Vehicle speed is approximately
above 18 mph (30 km/h) when the
vehicle is braking on rough roads.
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the Vehicle Stability
Management (VSM):
• ALWAYS check the speed and
the distance to the vehicle
ahead.The VSM is not a substitute for safe driving practices.
• Never drive too fast for the
road conditions. The VSM system will not prevent accidents. Excessive speed in bad
weather, slippery and uneven
roads can result in severe
accidents.
When operating
When you apply your brakes under
conditions which may activate the
ESC, you may hear sounds from the
brakes, or feel a corresponding sensation in the brake pedal. This is normal and it means your VSM is active.
i Information
The VSM does not operate when:
• Driving on a banked road such as a
gradient or incline.
• Driving in reverse.
• The ESC OFF indicator light is on.
• The MDPS (Motor power steering)
warning light ( ) is on or blinks.
VSM OFF condition
To cancel VSM operation, press the
ESC OFF button. ESC OFF indicator
light ( ) will illuminate.
To turn on VSM, press the ESC OFF
button again. The ESC OFF indicator
light will go out.
WARNING
NOTICE
Driving with wheels and tires with
different sizes may cause the VSM
system to malfunction. Before
replacing tires, make sure all four
tires and wheels are the same
size. Never drive the vehicle with
different sized tires and wheels
installed.
If the ESC indicator light ( ) or
MDPS warning light (
) stays
on or blinks, your vehicle may
have a malfunction with the
VSM system. When the warning
light illuminates, have the vehicle checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as
possible.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-35
Driving your vehicle
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
The Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)
helps prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards when starting a vehicle
from a stop on a hill. The system
operates the brakes automatically for
approximately 5 seconds and releases the brake after 5 seconds or when
the accelerator pedal is depressed.
WARNING
Always be ready to depress the
accelerator pedal when starting
off on a incline. The HAC activates only for approximately 5
seconds.
Good Braking Practices
WARNING
Whenever leaving the vehicle or
parking, always come to a complete stop and continue to
depress the brake pedal. Shift
to the P (Park) position, then
apply the parking brake, and
place the POWER button in the
OFF position.
Vehicles parked with the parking brake not applied or not
fully engaged may roll inadvertently and may cause injury to
the driver and others. ALWAYS
apply the parking brake before
exiting the vehicle.
i Information
• The HAC does not operate when the
gear is in P (Park) or N (Neutral).
• The HAC activates even when the
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is
off. However, it does not activate,
when the ESC does not operate normally.
5-36
Wet brakes can be dangerous! The
brakes may get wet if the vehicle is
driven through standing water or if it
is washed. Your vehicle will not stop
as quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet
brakes may cause the vehicle to pull
to one side.
To dry the brakes, apply the brakes
lightly until the braking action returns
to normal. If the braking action does
not return to normal, stop as soon as
it is safe to do so and call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.
DO NOT drive with your foot resting
on the brake pedal. Even light, but
constant pedal pressure can result in
the brakes overheating, brake wear,
and possibly even brake failure.
If a tire goes flat while you are driving, apply the brakes gently and
keep the vehicle pointed straight
ahead while you slow down. When
you are moving slowly enough for it
to be safe to do so, pull off the road
and stop in a safe location.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake
pedal when the vehicle is stopped to
prevent the vehicle from rolling forward.
DRIVE MODE INTEGRATED CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
The mode changes, as below,
whenever the DRIVE MODE button
is pressed.
NORMAL
ECO
• Press and hold the DRIVE MODE
button to select ECO+ mode.
OFE058033
i Information
If there is a problem with the instrument cluster, the drive mode will be in
NORMAL mode and may not change
to ECO mode.
The above situations are normal
conditions when ECO mode is activated to improve fuel efficiency.
ECO mode
ECO mode improves battery charge use efficiency
for eco-friendly driving.
• When ECO mode is selected by
pressing the DRIVE MODE button,
the ECO indicator (green color) will
illuminate.
• If the vehicle is set to ECO mode,
when the vehicle is turned OFF
and restarted the Drive Mode setting will remain in ECO mode.
5
Driving your vehicle
The drive mode may be selected
according to the driver's preference
or road condition.
The system resets to be in the NORMAL mode (except if it is in ECO
mode), when the vehicle is restarted.
When ECO mode is activated:
• The acceleration response may be
slightly reduced as the accelerator
pedal is depressed moderately.
• The air conditioner performance
may be limited.
i Information
Battery charge use efficiency depends
on the driver's driving habit and road
condition.
5-37
Driving your vehicle
ECO+ mode
ECO+
mode
helps
improve fuel efficiency
with ultra power saving
driving mode.
When ECO+ mode is selected by
pressing and holding the DRIVE
MODE button, the ECO+ indicator
will illuminate.
Distance to empty may not change
when the air conditioner/heater
system is off. However, actual distance may be extended.
Air conditioner/heater system turns
off (except the defroster) but you
may turn it on if necessary.
When the drive mode is switched
from the ECO+ mode to a different
mode, it is changed to air conditioner/heater operation status of
the ECO mode.
Whenever the vehicle is restarted,
the Drive Mode will reverse back to
NORMAL mode.
If ECO + mode is activated, the
maximum vehicle speed is limited
below 60 mph (100 km/h).
(&2
•
•
•
•
•
•
5-38
Drive mode change alert
ECO mode climate control
The driver can select the Drive mode
change alert on the Infotainment system screen.
Go to "Vehicle settings → Drive
mode → Drive mode change alert".
ECO Mode Climate Control helps
extend driving range by reducing the
heating and cooling power of the climate control.
The driver can activate/deactivate
the system on the Infotainment system screen.
Go to "Vehicle settings → Drive
mode → Eco mode climate control".
The information, which will be shown
whenever the drive mode is
changed.
[Detailed alert] : A change of the
drive
mode
is
shown by an image
of the vehicle.
[Simple alert] : A change of the drive
mode is indicated by
a short message on
top of the screen.
[No alert] : A change of the drive
mode is not indicated.
FORWARD COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST (FCA) SYSTEM
The Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system is designed to
help detect and monitor the vehicle
ahead or help detect a pedestrian or
cyclists in the roadway through radar
signals and camera recognition to
warn the driver that a collision is
imminent, and if necessary, apply
emergency braking.
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the Forward CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system:
• This system is only a supple-
• The driver can activate the FCA by
placing the power button to the ON
position and by selecting on the
Infotainment system screen :
"Vehicle settings → Driver assistance → Forward safety"
- If you select "Active assistance",
the FCA system activates. The
FCA produces warning messages and warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels. Also, it controls the brakes
in accordance with the collision
risk levels.
- If you select "Warning Only", the
FCA system activates and produces only warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels. You should control the
brake directly because the FCA
system do not control the brake.
- If you select "Off", the FCA system deactivates,
5-39
5
Driving your vehicle
mental system and it is not
intended to, nor does it replace
the need for extreme care and
attention of the driver. The
sensing range and objects
detectable by the sensors are
limited. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
• NEVER drive too fast in accordance with the road conditions or while cornering.
• Always drive cautiously to
prevent accidents from any
unexpected and sudden situations. The Forward CollisionAvoidance system may not
always stop the vehicle completely and is only intended to
help mitigate a collision that
is imminent.
System Setting and Activation
System setting
Driving your vehicle
The warning light illuminates on the LCD
display, when you cancel the FCA system.
The driver can monitor the FCA
ON/OFF status on the Infotainment
system screen. Also, the warning
light illuminates when the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control) is
turned off. If the warning light
remains ON when the FCA is activated, have the system checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• The driver can select the initial
warning activation time on the
Infotainment system screen.
Go to the "Vehicle settings →Driver
assistance → Warning time →
Normal/Later"
•
5-40
The options for the initial Forward
Collision Warning includes the following:
- Normal :
When this condition is selected,
the initial Forward Collision
Warning is activated sensitively. If
you feel the warning activates too
early, set the Forward Collision
Warning to 'Later'.
Even though, 'Normal' is selected if
the front vehicle suddenly stops
the initial warning activation time
may not seem fast.
- Later :
When this condition is selected,
the initial Forward Collision
Warning is activated later than normal. This setting reduces the
amount of distance between the
vehicle, pedestrian or cyclists
ahead before the initial warning
occurs.
Select 'Later' when traffic is light
and when driving speed is slow.
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning timing.
Prerequisite for activation
• Completely stop the vehicle
on a safe location before
operating the switch on the
steering wheel to activate/
deactivate the FCA system.
• The FCA automatically activates upon placing the
POWER button to the ON
position. The driver can deactivate the FCA by canceling
the system setting on the
Infotainment system screen.
• The FCA automatically deactivates upon canceling the ESC
(Electronic Stability Control).
When the ESC is canceled,
the FCA cannot be activated
on the Infotainment system
screen. The FCA warning light
will illuminate which is normal.
FCA Warning Message and
System Control
The FCA produces warning messages and warning alarms in accordance with the collision risk levels,
such as abrupt stopping of the vehicle in front, insufficient braking distance, or pedestrian or cyclists
detection. Also, it controls the brakes
in accordance with the collision risk
levels.
The driver can select the initial warning activation time in the Vehicle settings in the Infotainment system
screen. The options for the initial
Forward Collision Warning include
Early or Later initial warning time.
❈ The FCA may not operate properly according to the frontal situation, the direction of pedestrian or
cyclist and speed.
5-41
5
Driving your vehicle
The FCA system is on and ready
when FCA is selected on the
Infotainment system vehicle settings
and when the following prerequisites
are satisfied:
- The ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) is on.
- Driving speed exceeds approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) (The FCA
is only activated within a certain
speed range.).
- The system detects a pedestrian,
cyclists or a vehicle in front, which
may collide with your vehicle. (The
FCA may not be activated or may
sound a warning alarm in accordance with the driving situation or
vehicle condition.)
If you select "Warning only", the
FCA system activates and produces only warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels.
WARNING
Driving your vehicle
Collision Warning (First warning)
- If you select "Warning Only", the
FCA system activates and produces only warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels. You should control the brake
directly because the FCA system
do not control the brake.
Emergency Braking
(Second warning)
OFE051035N
This warning message appears on
the LCD display with a warning
chime. Additionally, some vehicle
system intervention occurs by the
driving management system to help
decelerate the vehicle.
- Your vehicle speed may decelerate
moderately.
- The FCA system limitedly controls
the brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision.
5-42
OFE051036N
This warning message appears on
the LCD display with a warning
chime.
Additionally, some vehicle system
intervention occurs by the driving
management system to help decelerate the vehicle.
- The FCA system limitedly controls
the brakes to preemptively mitigate
impact in a collision. The brake
control is maximized just before a
collision.
- If you select "Warning Only", the
FCA system activates and produces only warning alarms in
accordance with the collision risk
levels. You should control the brake
directly because the FCA system
do not control the brake.
Brake operation
• The driver should always use
extreme caution while operating the vehicle, whether or not
there is a warning message or
alarm from the FCA system.
• If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the
Forward
CollisionAvoidance Assist (FCA) system warning may not sound.
WARNING
The FCA system logic operates
within certain parameters, such
as the distance from the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclists
ahead, the speed of the vehicle
ahead, and the driver's vehicle
speed. Certain conditions such
as inclement weather and road
conditions may affect the operation of the FCA system.
5
WARNING
WARNING
The FCA braking control cannot
completely stop the vehicle nor
avoid all collisions. The driver
should hold the responsibility
to safely drive and control the
vehicle.
Never deliberately drive dangerously to activate the system.
5-43
Driving your vehicle
• In an urgent situation, the braking
system enters into the ready status
for prompt reaction against the driver's depressing the brake pedal.
• The FCA provides additional braking power for optimum braking performance, when the driver
depresses the brake pedal.
• The braking control is automatically deactivated, when the driver
sharply depresses the accelerator
pedal, or when the driver abruptly
operates the steering wheel.
• The FCA braking control is automatically canceled, when risk factors disappear.
CAUTION
Driving your vehicle
FCA Sensor (Front Radar/
Front View Camera)
■ Front radar
Dirt, snow, or foreign substances on
the sensor cover or sensor may
adversely affect the sensing performance of the sensor.
NOTICE
OFE058106N
■ Front view camera
OFE052038N
In order for the FCA system to operate properly, always make sure the
sensor cover or sensor is clean and
free of dirt, snow, and debris.
5-44
• Do not apply license plate frame
or foreign objects such as a
bumper sticker or a bumper
guard near the sensor. Doing so
may adversely affect the sensing performance of the radar.
• Always keep the sensor and
cover clean and free of dirt and
debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash the
vehicle. Do not spray pressurized water directly on the sensor
or sensor cover.
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is
forcibly moved out of proper
alignment, the FCA system may
not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may
not be displayed. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around the
sensor, the FCA system may not
operate properly. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine HYUNDAI
parts to repair or replace a damaged sensor or sensor cover. Do
not apply paint to the sensor
cover.
NOTICE
i Information
Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer when:
• The windshield glass is replaced.
• The radar sensor or cover gets damaged or replaced.
However, the FCA may not properly
operate in an area (for example,
open terrain), where any substances
are not detected or the camera is
blocked with dirt, snow or debris after
turning on the vehicle.
Also, even though a warning message does not appear on the LCD
display, the FCA may not properly
operate.
WARNING
OTM070095N
Forward Safety system disabled.
Radar blocked
When the sensor cover is blocked
with dirt, snow, or debris, the FCA
system operation may stop temporarily. If this occurs, a warning message
will appear on the LCD display.
Remove any dirt, snow, or debris and
clean the radar sensor cover before
operating the FCA system.
The FCA system may not activate according to the road conditions, inclement weather, driving conditions or traffic conditions.
5-45
5
Driving your vehicle
• NEVER install any accessories
or stickers on the front windshield, nor tint the front windshield.
• NEVER locate any reflective
objects (for example, white
paper, mirror) over the dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the system.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera out of water.
• NEVER disassemble the camera
assembly, nor apply any impact
on the camera assembly.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the system warning sounds.
Warning message and warning
light
Driving your vehicle
System Malfunction
WARNING
• Even if there is a problem with
• The FCA is only a supplemen-
OTM070094N
Check Forward Safety system
• When the FCA is not working properly, the FCA warning light (
)
will illuminate and the warning
message will appear for a few seconds. After the message disappears, the master warning light
(
) will illuminate. In this case,
have the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• The FCA warning message may
appear along with the illumination
of the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) warning light.
5-46
tal system for the driver’s convenience. The driver has the
responsibility to control vehicle operation. Do not solely
depend on the FCA system.
Rather, maintain a safe braking distance, and, if necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce the driving speed.
• In certain instances and
under certain driving conditions, the FCA system may
activate unintentionally. This
initial
warning
message
appears on the LCD display
with a warning chime.
Also, in certain instances the
front radar sensor or camera
recognition system may not
detect the vehicle, pedestrian
or cyclists ahead. The FCA
system may not activate and
the warning message will not
be displayed.
•
•
•
•
the brake control function of
the FCA system, the vehicle's
basic braking performance
will
operate
normally.
However, brake control function for avoiding collision will
not activate.
If the vehicle in front of you
stops suddenly, you may have
less control of the brake system. Therefore, always keep a
safe distance between your
vehicle and the vehicle in
front of you.
The FCA system may activate
during braking and the vehicle may stop suddenly shifting loose objects toward the
passengers. Always keep
loose objects secured.
The FCA system may not activate if the driver applies the
brake pedal to avoid a collision.
The brake control may not
work, possibly causing a collision, if a vehicle in front
abruptly stops. Always pay
extreme caution.
• The FCA system does not
the vehicle abruptly stops by
the activated FCA system.
Exercise extreme caution.
• The FCA system operates
only to help detect vehicles,
pedestrian or cyclist in front
of the vehicle.
detect cross traffic vehicles
that are approaching.
• The FCA system cannot
detect the driver approaching
the side view of a parked vehicle (for example on a dead
end street).
• The FCA system cannot
detect the cross traffic cyclist
that are approaching.
In these cases, you must maintain a safe braking distance,
and if necessary, depress the
brake pedal to reduce the driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance.
WARNING
• The FCA system operates
only to help detect vehicles or
pedestrians in front of the
vehicle.
• The FCA system does not
operate when the vehicle is in
reverse.
• The FCA system is not
designed to detect other
objects on the road such as
animals.
• The FCA system does not
detect vehicles in the opposite lane.
Limitations of the System
The Forward Collision Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system is designed to
monitor the vehicle ahead or a
pedestrian or cyclists on the roadway
through radar signals and camera
recognition to warn the driver that a
collision is imminent, and if necessary, apply emergency braking.
In certain situations, the radar sensor or the camera may not be able to
detect the vehicle, a pedestrian or
cyclists ahead. In these cases, the
FCA system may not operate normally. The driver must pay careful
attention in the following situations
where the FCA operation may be
limited.
Detecting vehicles
The sensor may be limited when:
• The radar sensor or camera is
blocked with a foreign object or
debris
• Inclement weather such as heavy
rain or snow obscures the field of
view of the radar sensor or camera
• There is interference by electromagnetic waves
5-47
5
Driving your vehicle
• Occupants may get injured, if
Driving your vehicle
• The vehicle is on unpaved or
uneven rough surfaces, or road
with sudden gradient changes.
• The vehicle drives through a construction area, on an unpaved
road, or above metal materials,
such as a railway
• The vehicle in front is too small to
be detected (for example a motorcycle or a bicycle, etc.)
• The camera’s field of view is not
well illuminated (either too dark or
too much reflection or too much
backlight that obscures the field of
view)
• The camera does not recognize
the entire vehicle in front.
• The vehicle in front is an oversize
vehicle or trailer that is too big to
be detected by the camera recognition system (for example a tractor
trailer, etc.)
• The vehicle in front does not have
rear lights or the rear lights are not
turned ON or the rear lights are
located unusually.
• The outside brightness changes
suddenly, for example when entering or exiting a tunnel
5-48
• The vehicle drives inside a building,
such as a basement parking lot
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
• You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front circles
• The camera lens is contaminated
due to tinted, filmed or coated
windshield, damaged glass, or
stuck of foreign matter (sticker,
bug, etc.) on the glass
• The camera is damaged.
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlights are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel.
• Light coming from a street light or
an oncoming vehicle is reflected on
a wet road surface such as a puddle in the road
• The field of view in front is obstructed by sun glare
• The shadow is on the road by a
median strip, trees, etc.
• The vehicle drives through a tollgate.
• The windshield glass is fogged up; a
clear view of the road is obstructed
• The radar/camera sensor recognition is limited
• The rear part of the vehicle in front
is not normally visible (for example,
the vehicle is spinning or the vehicle is overturned)
• There is severe irregular reflection
from the radar sensor
• The sensor recognition changes
suddenly when passing over a
speed bump
• The vehicle in front is driving erratically
• The vehicle in front is moving vertically to the driving direction
• The vehicle in front is stopped vertically
• The vehicle in front is driving
towards your vehicle or reversing
• You are on a roundabout and the
vehicle in front circles.
OTM058073
OFE058041
Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist
system may recognize in the next
lane or outside the lane when driving on a curved road.
If this occurs, the system may unnecessarily alarm the driver and apply
the brake.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
- Driving on a slope
The performance of Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system
may be decreased while driving
upward or downward on a slope. The
front camera or front radar sensor
recognition may not detect the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist in front.
This may result in unnecessary
alarm and braking or no alarm and
braking when necessary.
When the system suddenly recognizes the vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist in front while passing over a
slope, you may experience sharp
deceleration.
5-49
5
Driving your vehicle
OTM058117
- Driving on a curve
The performance of Forward
Collision-Avoidance Assist system
may be limited when driving on a
curved road.
The front camera or radar sensor
recognition system may not detect
the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist traveling in front on a curved road.
This may result in no alarm and braking when necessary.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, and if necessary,
depress the brake pedal to reduce
your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.
Driving your vehicle
Always keep your eyes forward while
driving upward or downward on a
slope and if necessary depress the
brake pedal to reduce your driving
speed in order to maintain distance.
5-50
OTM058074
OTM058119
- Changing lanes
When a vehicle changes lanes in
front of you, the FCA system may not
immediately detect the vehicle, especially if the vehicle changes lanes
abruptly. In this case, you must maintain a safe braking distance, and if
necessary, depress the brake pedal
to reduce your driving speed in order
to maintain a safe distance.
When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a stopped vehicle in front of you
merges out of the lane, the FCA system may not immediately detect the
new vehicle that is now in front of
you. In this case, you must maintain
a safe braking distance, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain a safe distance.
Detecting pedestrians or
cyclists
OFE058042
5-51
5
Driving your vehicle
- Detecting the vehicle in front of you
If the vehicle in front of you has cargo
that extends rearward from the cab,
or when the vehicle in front of you
has higher ground clearance, additional special attention is required.
The FCA system may not be able to
detect the cargo extending from the
vehicle. In these instances, you must
maintain a safe braking distance
from the rearmost object, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to
reduce your driving speed in order to
maintain distance.
The sensor may be limited when:
• The pedestrian or cyclist is not fully
detected by the camera recognition system, for example, if the
pedestrian is leaning over or is not
fully walking upright
• The pedestrian or cyclist is moving
very quickly or appears abruptly in
the camera detection area
• The pedestrian or cyclist is wearing clothing that easily blends into
the background, making it difficult
to be detected by the camera
recognition system
• The outside lighting is too bright
(for example, when driving in bright
sunlight or in sun glare) or too dark
(for example, when driving on a
dark rural road at night)
• It is difficult to detect and distinguish the pedestrian or cyclist from
other objects in the surroundings,
for example, when there is a group
of pedestrians, cyclist or a large
crowd
• There is an item similar to a person's body structure
• The pedestrian or cyclist is small
• The pedestrian has impaired
mobility
• The sensor recognition is limited
• The radar sensor or camera is
blocked with a foreign object or
debris
• Inclement weather such as heavy
rain or snow obscures the field of
view of the radar sensor or camera
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving
• When the pedestrian or cyclist
suddenly interrupts in front of the
vehicle
Driving your vehicle
• When the cyclist in front is riding
intersected with the driving direction
• When there is any other electromagnetic interference
• When the construction area, rail or
other metal object is near the
cyclist
• If the bicycle material is not reflected well on the radar
i Information
In some instances, the FCA system
may be canceled when subjected to
electromagnetic interference.
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
WARNING
• Do not use the Forward
Collision Avoidance Assist
(FCA) system when towing a
vehicle. Application of the
FCA system while towing may
adversely affect the safety of
your vehicle or the towing
vehicle.
• Use extreme caution when the
vehicle in front of you has
cargo that extends rearward
from the cab, or when the
vehicle in front of you has
higher ground clearance.
5-52
• Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist system may operate
when an object, which has
similar shape or characteristic to a vehicle, pedestrian or
cyclist, is detected.
• The FCA system is designed
to detect and monitor the
vehicle ahead or detect a
pedestrian or cyclist in the
roadway through radar signals and camera recognition.
It is not designed to detect,
motorcycles,
or
smaller
wheeled objects such as luggage bags, shopping carts, or
strollers.
• Never try to test the operation
of the FCA system. Doing so
may cause severe injury or
death.
• If the front bumper, front
glass, radar or camera have
been replaced or repaired,
have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
BLIND-SPOT COLLISION WARNING/BLIND-SPOT COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST
System Description
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW)
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist (BCA)
2) Closing at high speed
The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCA) system uses radar sensors in
the rear bumper to monitor and warn
the driver of an approaching vehicle
in the driver's blind spot area.
1) Blind-Spot Area
OTM058121L
OTM058120L
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to vehicle speed.
Note that if your vehicle is traveling
much faster than the vehicles around
you, the warning will not occur.
OTM058108
The Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist (BCA) system detects the
front lane through the camera
installed on the upper front windshield and detects the side/rear
areas through radar sensors.
The Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist system may activate the
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) in
accordance with a colliding possibility with an approaching vehicle while
changing lanes. It is to lower the colliding risk or mitigate the colliding
damage.
5-53
5
Driving your vehicle
The Lane Change Assist feature will
alert you when a vehicle is approaching in an adjacent lane at a high rate
of speed. If the driver activates the
turn signal when the system detects
an oncoming vehicle, the system
sounds an audible alert.
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• Always be aware of road conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations even though the BlindSpot Collision Warning system and Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist system are
operating.
• The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning (BCW) system and
Blind-Spot
CollisionAvoidance Assist (BCA) system are supplemental systems to assist you. Do not
entirely rely on the systems.
Always pay attention, while
driving, for your safety.
• The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning (BCW) system and
Blind-Spot
CollisionAvoidance Assist (BCA) system are not substitutes for
proper and safe driving.
Always drive safely and use
caution when changing lanes
or backing up the vehicle.
5-54
The Blind-Spot Collision
Warning (BCW) system and
Blind-Spot
CollisionAvoidance Assist (BCA) system may not detect every
object alongside the vehicle.
System Setting and Activation
System setting
• The driver can activate the system
by placing the power button to the
ON position and by selecting
"Vehicle settings → Driver assistance → Blind-spot safety" on
Infotainment system screen.
- The BCA and BCW turn on and
get ready to be activated when
'Active assistance' is selected.
Then, if a vehicle approaches the
driver's blind spot area a warning
sounds or braking power is
applied.
- The BCW turns on and gets
ready to be activated when
'Warning Only' is selected. Then,
if a vehicle approaches the driver's blind spot area a warning
sounds.
- The system is deactivated and
the indicator on the BCW/BCA
button is extinguished when 'Off'
is selected.
• If the vehicle is turned off then on
again, the system maintains the
previous state.
• The driver can select the initial
warning activation time in the User
Settings in the "Vehicle settings →
Driver assistance → Warning time"
on Infotainment system screen.
OFE058188N
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning timing.
5-55
5
Driving your vehicle
• If you press the BCW/BCA switch
while 'Active assistance' or
'Warning Only' is selected the indicator on the button will turn off and
the system will deactivate.
• If you press the BCW/BCA switch
while the system is canceled the
indicator on the button illuminates
and the system activates. In this
case, the system returns to the
state before the vehicle was turned
off.
When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again while the system
is in activation, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outer side view mirror.
• The options for the initial BlindSpot Collision Warning includes
the following:
- Normal:
When this condition is selected,
the initial Blind-Spot Collision
Warning is activated normally. If
this setting feels sensitive,
change the option to 'Later'.
The warning activation time may
feel late if a vehicle at the side or
rear abruptly accelerates.
- Later:
Select this warning activation
time when the traffic is light and
you are driving in a low speed.
Driving your vehicle
• The driver can select the warning
volume of Blind-Spot Collision
Warning in the Vehicle Settings in
the Infotainment system screen by
selecting 'Vehicle Settings →
Driver Assistance → Warning
Volume → High/Medium/Low'.
For more information refer to the
separately supplied Navigation
manual.
i Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning volume.
5-56
Operating Conditions
The system enters the ready status,
when 'Active assistance' or 'Warning
Only' is selected and the following
conditions are satisfied:
• Active assistance
1) The
Blind-Spot
CollisionAvoidance Assist system will activate when :
- Vehicle speed is between 40
mph and 110 mph (60 km/h and
180 km/h).
- The system detects both of the
lane lines.
- An approaching vehicle is
detected next to or behind your
vehicle.
2) The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system will activate when
The vehicle speed is above
approximately 20 mph (30 km/h).
• Warning Only
1) The Blind-Spot Collision Warning
system will activate when :
- The vehicle speed is approximately 20 mph (30 km/h).
❈The Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist system is not activated.
Warning and System Control
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCW) system
■ Left side
■ Right side
■ Left side
■ Right side
OFE058045
OFE058046
[A] : Warning sound
First stage alert
If a vehicle is detected within the
boundary of the system, a warning
light will illuminate on the outer side
view mirror.
Once the detected vehicle is no
longer within the blind spot area, the
warning will turn off according to the
driving conditions of the vehicle.
Second stage alert
A warning chime to alert the driver will activate when:
1. A vehicle has been detected in the blind spot area by the radar system
AND.
2. The turn signal is applied (same side as where the vehicle is being detected).
When this alert is activated, the warning light on the outer side view mirror
will also blink. And a warning chime will sound.
If you turn off the turn signal indicator, the second stage alert will be deactivated.
Once the detected vehicle is no longer within the blind spot area, the warning will turn off according to the driving conditions of the vehicle.
5-57
5
Driving your vehicle
OFE058044
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
CAUTION
• The warning light on the outer
• The driver should always use
side view mirror will illuminate whenever a vehicle is
detected at the rear side by
the system.
To avoid accidents, do not
focus only on the warning
light and neglect to see the
surrounding of the vehicle.
• Drive safely even though the
vehicle is equipped with a
Blind-Spot Collision Warning
(BCA) system. Do not solely
rely on the system but check
your surrounding before
changing lanes or backing the
vehicle up.
• The system may not alert the
driver in some conditions so
always check your surroundings while driving.
extreme caution while operating the vehicle, whether or not
the warning light on the outer
side view mirror illuminates or
there is a warning alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the
Blind-Spot
Collision
Warning system warning
sounds.
• If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the
Blind-Spot
Collision
Warning (BCW) system warning may not sound.
5-58
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist (BCA) system
OFE041489N/OFE041490N
The Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist (BCA) system may apply braking power, when an approaching
vehicle is detected within a certain
distance next to or behind your vehicle.
It gently applies braking power on
the tire, which is located in the opposite side of the possibly-colliding
point. The instrument cluster will
inform the driver of the system activation.
WARNING
• The driver is responsible for
accurate steering.
Detecting Sensor
(Front View Camera and Rear
Corner Radar)
■ Front view camera
• Do not unnecessarily operate
the steering wheel, when the
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance
Assist System is in operation.
• Always exercise extreme caution while driving. The BlindSpot
Collision-Avoidance
Assist system may not operate or unnecessarily operate
in accordance with your driving situations.
• The Blind-Spot CollisionAvoidance Assist system is
not a substitute for safe driving practices, but a convenience function only. It is the
responsibility of the driver to
always drive cautiously to
prevent unexpected and sudden situations from occurring. Pay attention to the road
conditions at all times.
5
OFE052038N
Driving your vehicle
Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist
(BCA) system is automatically deactivated when:
- The vehicle drives a certain distance away
- The vehicle direction is changed
against the possible-colliding point
- The steering wheel is abruptly
moved
- The brake pedal is depressed
- After a certain period of time
The driver should drive the vehicle in
the middle of the vehicle lanes to
keep the system in the ready status.
When the vehicle drives too close to
one side of the vehicle lanes, the
system may not properly operate.
In addition, the system may not properly control your vehicle in accordance with driving situations. Thus,
always pay close attention to road
situations.
■ Rear corner radar
OFE052049L
5-59
Driving your vehicle
Front view camera
The front camera is a sensor detecting the lane. If the sensor is covered
with snow, rain or foreign substance,
the system may temporarily be canceled. The system is canceled due to
the degradation of the sensor's
detection performance. Always keep
the sensor clean.
* Refer to Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) System for cautions for the
front camera sensor.
CAUTION
• Be careful not to apply unnec-
• The system may not work
•
Rear corner radar
•
The rear radars are the sensors
inside the rear bumper for detecting
the side and rear areas. Always keep
the rear bumper clean for proper
operation of the system.
•
•
properly when the bumper
has been damaged, or if the
rear bumper has been
replaced or repaired.
The sensing range differs
somewhat according to the
width of the road. When the
road is narrow, the system
may detect other vehicles in
the next lane.
The system may turn off due
to strong electromagnetic
waves.
Always keep the sensors
clean.
NEVER arbitrarily disassemble the sensor component nor
apply any impact on the sensor component.
•
•
•
•
5-60
essary force on the radar sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved out of
proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In
this case, a warning message
may not be displayed. Have
the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Do not apply foreign objects
such as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor or apply paint to the
sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of the sensor.
NEVER install any accessories or stickers on the front
windshield, nor tint the front
windshield.
Pay extreme caution to keep
the camera sensor out of
water.
NEVER locate any reflective
objects (for example, white
paper, mirror) over the crash
pad. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the
system.
Warning message
If any of these conditions occur, the
light on the BCW/BCA switch and the
system will turn off automatically.
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear
bumper is free from any dirt or snow
in the areas where the sensor is
located. Remove any dirt, snow, or
foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
OTM070098N
After any dirt or debris is removed,
the system should operate normally
after about 10 minutes of driving the
vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Turn off the BCW, BCA and RCCW
system when a trailer or carrier is
installed.
- Press the BCW/BCA switch (the
indicator on the switch will turn off)
- Deactivate the RCCW system by
deselecting
"Vehicle settings → Driver assistance → Blind-spot safety → Rear
cross-traffic
safety"
on
Infotainment system screen.
If you use BCW, BCA and RCCW system, remove a trailer or carrier.
5
Driving your vehicle
Blind-Spot Safety system disabled.
Radar blocked
This warning message may appear
when :
- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
i Information
5-61
Driving your vehicle
Limitations of the System
OTM070099N
OTM070099N
Check Blind-Spot Safety system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will
appear and the light on the switch
will turn off. The system will turn off
automatically. BCA will not operate
also if the BCW system turns off due
to malfunction. Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Check Blind-Spot Safety system
If there is a problem with the BCA
system, a warning message will
appear. The system will turn off automatically. BCW will still operate even
if the BCA system turns off due to
malfunction. Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
5-62
The driver must be cautious in the
below situations, because the system may not detect other vehicles or
objects in certain circumstances.
• When a trailer or carrier is
installed.
• The vehicle driven in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or
snow.
• The sensor is polluted with rain,
snow, mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or
the sensor is out of the original
default position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
trunk, abnormal tire pressure, etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the
same time as the vehicle next to
you and has accelerated.
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you
OR when the vehicle two lanes
away moves to the next lane from
you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such
as a sports car.
• The brake pedal is depressed.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
is activated.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
malfunctions.
• The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged.
• The vehicle abruptly changes driving direction.
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle sharply stops.
• Temperature is extremely low
around the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road,
uneven/bumpy road, or concrete
patch.
• The vehicle drives on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
• The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) or
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) do
not operate normally. (if equipped)
For more information refer to "Lane
Keeping Assist (LKA) system" in
this chapter.
5-63
5
Driving your vehicle
• The vehicle driven on a curved
road.
• The vehicle driven through a tollgate.
• The road pavement (or the peripheral ground) abnormally contains
metallic components (for example,
possibly due to subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
• Driving on a narrow road where
trees or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle or structure for an extended
period of time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the
guardrail or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus
or truck.
• When the other vehicle approaches very close.
Driving your vehicle
OTM058109
OTM058110
OTM058111
• Driving on a curve
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving on a
curved road. In certain instances, the
system may not detect the vehicle in
the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving on a
curved road. In certain instances, the
system may recognize a vehicle in
the same lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
• Driving where the road is merging/dividing
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving where
the road is merging/dividing. In certain instances, the system may not
detect the vehicle in the next lane.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
5-64
OFE058109N
• Driving where the heights of the
lanes are different
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving where
the heights of the lanes are different.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle on a road with
different lane heights (for example,
underpass joining section, grade
separated intersections, etc.).
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
OFE058110N
[A] : noise barrier, [B] : guardrail
• Driving where there is a structure
beside the road
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving where
there is structure beside the road.
In certain instances, the system may
recognize structures (for example,
noise barriers, guardrail, double
guardrail, median strip, bollard,
street light, road sign, tunnel wall,
etc.) beside the road.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
5-65
5
Driving your vehicle
OFE058125
• Driving on a slope
The BCW and BCA systems may not
operate properly when driving on a
slope. In certain instances the system may not detect the vehicle in the
next lane.
Also, in certain instances, the system
may recognize the ground or structures.
Always pay attention to road and
driving conditions, while driving.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
5-66
REAR CROSS-TRAFFIC COLLISION WARNING (RCCW) / REAR CROSS-TRAFFIC COLLISIONAVOIDANCE ASSIST (RCCA)
System Description
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) system
The Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) system uses radar
sensors to monitor the approaching
cross traffic from the left and right
side of the vehicle when your vehicle
is in reverse.
The blind spot detection range varies
relative to the approaching vehicle
speed.
The Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
monitors approaching cross traffic
from the left and right side of the
vehicle when your vehicle is
approaching.
The Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
may activate the Electronic Stability
Control (ESC) in accordance with a
colliding possibility with an approaching vehicle. It is to lower the colliding risk or mitigate the colliding
damage.
WARNING
• Always be aware of road conditions while driving and be
alert for unexpected situations even though the Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
system and Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision-Avoidance
Assist
system are operating.
• The
Rear
Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning system and
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist system are
supplemental systems to
assist you. Do not entirely rely
on the systems. Always pay
attention, while driving, for
your safety.
• The
Rear
Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning system and
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist system are
not substitutes for proper and
safe driving. Always drive
safely and use caution when
backing up the vehicle.
5-67
5
Driving your vehicle
OTM058092
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA) system
Driving your vehicle
System Setting and Activation
System setting
• The driver can activate the systems by placing the power button
to the ON position and by selecting
"Vehicle settings → Driver assistance → Blind-spot safety → Rear
Cross-Traffic
Safety"
on
Infotainment system screen. The
RCCA and RCCW turn on and get
ready to be activated when 'Rear
Cross-Traffic Safety' is selected.
• When the vehicle is turned off then
on again, the systems are always
ready to be activated.
• When the system is initially turned
on and when the vehicle is turned
off then on again, the warning light
will illuminate for 3 seconds on the
outer side view mirror.
The driver can select the initial warning activation time in the User
Settings in the Infotainment system
screen by selecting 'Vehicle settings
→ Driver Assistance → Warning
Timing'. The options for the initial
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning
includes the following:
- Normal:
When this condition is selected, the
initial Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning is activated normally. If this
setting feels sensitive, change the
option to 'Later'.
The warning activation time may feel
late if the a vehicle at the side or rear
abruptly accelerates.
- Later:
Select this warning activation time
when the traffic is light and you are
driving in a low speed.
i Information
If you change the warning timing, the
warning time of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning timing.
5-68
The driver can select the warning
volume of the Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning in the Vehicle
Settings in the Infotainment system
screen by selecting 'Vehicle settings
→ Driver Assistance → Warning
Volume → High/Medium/ Low'.
For more information refer to the
separately supplied Navigation
manual.
i Information
If you change the warning volume, the
warning volume of other systems may
change. Always be aware before
changing the warning volume.
Operating conditions
The system's detecting range is
approximately 1 – 65 ft. (0.5 – 20 m).
An approaching vehicle will be
detected if the vehicle speed is within 5 – 22.5 mph (8 – 36 km/h).
Note that the detecting range may
vary under certain conditions. As
always, use caution and pay close
attention to your surroundings when
backing up your vehicle.
■ Left
OFE058120
■ Right
If the vehicle detected by the sensors
approaches from the rear left/right
side of your vehicle, the warning
chime will sound, the warning light
on the outer side view mirror will
blink and a message will appear on
the LCD display. If the rear view monitor system is in activation, a message will also appear on the
Infotainment system screen.
The warning will stop when:
- The detected vehicle moves out of
the sensing area or
- when the vehicle is right behind
your vehicle or
- when the vehicle is not approaching your vehicle or
- when the other vehicle slows
down.
OFE058121
5-69
5
Driving your vehicle
To operate:
Go to the 'Vehicle settings → Driver
Assistance → Blind-Spot Safety →
Rear Cross-Traffic Safety' on the
Infotainment system screen. The
system will turn on and standby to
activate.
The system will activate when vehicle speed is below 10 mph (16 km/h)
and with the gear in R (Reverse).
* The system will not activate when
the vehicle speed exceeds 10 mph
(16 km/h). The system will activate
again when the speed is below 10
mph (16 km/h).
Warning and System Control
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning (RCCW) system
Driving your vehicle
Rear Cross-Traffic CollisionAvoidance Assist (RCCA)
system
■ Left
OFE051053N
■ Right
OFE051054N
5-70
If the risk of collision is detected
while the RCCW is generated, brake
is controlled. The instrument cluster
will inform the driver of the brake
control. If the rear view monitor system is in activation, a message will
also appear on the Infotainment system screen.
After the brake control, the driver
must immediately depress the brake
pedal and check the surroundings.
- The brake activation by the system
lasts for about 2 seconds.
The driver must pay attention as
the brake is disengaged after 2
seconds.
- The brake control by the system is
canceled if the driver depresses
the brake pedal with sufficient
power.
- Brake control is activated once for
each right/left approach after shifting the gear to R (Reverse).
The brake control may not operate
properly according to the status of
the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control). The same warning message is displayed on the instrument
cluster for this case also.
- When the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) warning light is on.
- When the ESC (Electronic Stability
Control) is engaged in a different
function.
CAUTION
• When the operation condition
of the Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision Warning system is
satisfied, the warning will
occur every time a vehicle
approaches the side or rear
of your stopped (0 mph vehicle speed) vehicle.
• The system's warning or
brake may not operate properly if the left or right of your
vehicle's rear bumper is
blocked by a vehicle or obstacle.
• The driver should always use
extreme caution while operating the vehicle, whether or not
the warning light on the outer
side view mirror illuminates or
there is a warning alarm.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the system's warning sounds.
• If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning system warning may
not sound.
• Drive safely even though the
vehicle is equipped with a
Rear Cross-Traffic Collision
Warning system and Rear
Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance
Assist system. Do not solely
rely on the system but check
your surrounding when backing the vehicle up.
Detecting Sensor
OFE052049L
The rear corner radars are the sensors inside the rear bumper for
detecting the side and rear areas.
Always keep the rear bumper clean
for proper operation of the system.
5-71
5
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
• The driver is responsible for
accurate brake control.
• Always pay extreme caution
while driving. The Rear CrossTraffic Collision Warning system and Rear Cross-Traffic
Collision-Avoidance Assist
system may not operate properly or unnecessarily operate
in accordance with your driving situations.
• The
Rear
Cross-Traffic
Collision-Avoidance Assist
system is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It
is the responsibility of the
driver to always drive cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
Driving your vehicle
CAUTION
• The system may not work
•
•
•
•
properly when the bumper
has been damaged, or if the
rear bumper has been
replaced or repaired.
The system may turn off due
to strong electromagnetic
waves.
Always keep the sensors
clean.
NEVER arbitrarily disassemble the sensor component nor
apply any impact on the sensor component.
Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved out of
proper alignment, the system
may not operate correctly. In
this case, a warning message
may not be displayed. Have
the vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-72
• Do not apply foreign objects
Warning message
such as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor or apply paint to the
sensor area. Doing so may
adversely affect the performance of the sensor.
OTM070098N
Blind-Spot Safety system disabled.
Radar blocked
This warning message may appear
when:
- One or both of the sensors on the
rear bumper is blocked by dirt or
snow or a foreign object.
- Driving in rural areas where the
sensor does not detect another
vehicle for an extended period of
time.
- When there is inclement weather
such as heavy snow or rain.
i Information
Turn off the BCW and RCCW system
when a trailer or carrier is installed.
- Press the BCW/BCA switch (the
indicator on the switch will turn off)
- Deactivate the RCCW system by
deselecting "Vehicle settings →
Driver assistance → Blind-spot safety → Rear cross-traffic safety" on
Infotainment system screen.
Limitations of the System
OTM070099N
Check Blind-Spot Safety system
If there is a problem with the BCW
system, a warning message will
appear and the light on the switch
will turn off. The system will turn off
automatically. RCCW and RCCA will
not operate also if the BCW system
turns off due to malfunction. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The driver must be cautious in the
below situations, because the system may not detect other vehicles or
objects in certain circumstances.
• When a trailer or carrier is
installed.
• The vehicle drives in inclement
weather such as heavy rain or snow.
• The sensor is polluted with rain,
snow, mud, etc.
• The rear bumper where the sensor
is located is covered with a foreign
object such as a bumper sticker, a
bumper guard, a bike rack, etc.
• The rear bumper is damaged, or
the sensor is out of the original
default position.
• The vehicle height gets lower or
higher due to heavy loading in a
trunk, abnormal tire pressure, etc.
• When the temperature of the rear
bumper is high.
• When the sensors are blocked by
other vehicles, walls or parking-lot
pillars.
• The vehicle drives on a curved
road.
5-73
5
Driving your vehicle
If any of these conditions occur, the
light on the BCW/BCA switch and the
system will turn off automatically.
When the BCW canceled warning
message is displayed in the cluster,
check to make sure that the rear
bumper is free from any dirt or snow
in the areas where the sensor is
located. Remove any dirt, snow, or
foreign material that could interfere
with the radar sensors.
After any dirt or debris is removed,
the system should operate normally
after about 10 minutes of driving the
vehicle.
If the system still does not operate
normally have your vehicle inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Driving your vehicle
• The road pavement (or the peripheral ground) abnormally contains
metallic components (for example,
possibly due to subway construction).
• There is a fixed object near the
vehicle, such as a guardrail.
• While going down or up a steep
road where the height of the lane is
different.
• Driving on a narrow road where
trees or grass or overgrown.
• Driving in rural areas where the sensor does not detect another vehicle
for an extended period of time.
• Driving on a wet road.
• Driving on a road where the
guardrail or wall is in double structure.
• A big vehicle is near such as a bus
or truck.
• When the other vehicle approaches very close.
• When the other vehicle passes at a
very fast speed.
• While changing lanes.
• If the vehicle has started at the
same time as the vehicle next to
you and has accelerated.
5-74
• When the vehicle in the next lane
moves two lanes away from you OR
when the vehicle two lanes away
moves to the next lane from you.
• A motorcycle or bicycle is near.
• A flat trailer is near.
• If there are small objects in the
detecting area such as a shopping
cart or a baby stroller.
• If there is a low height vehicle such
as a sports car.
• The brake pedal is depressed.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
is activated.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
malfunctions.
• The tire pressure is low or a tire is
damaged.
• The brake is reworked.
• The vehicle sharply stops.
• Temperature is extremely low
around the vehicle.
• The vehicle severely vibrates while
driving over a bumpy road, uneven/
bumpy road, or concrete patch.
• The vehicle drives on a slippery
surface due to snow, water puddle,
or ice.
OTM058102L
[A] : Structure
• Driving where there is a vehicle or
structure near
The system may not operate properly when driving where there is a vehicle or structure near.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from behind and the warning or
brake may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
OTM058103
OTM058104L
[A] : Vehicle
• When the vehicle is parked diagonally
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is parked diagonally.
In certain instances, when the diagonally parked vehicle is pulled out of
the parking space, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right of your vehicle. In this case, the warning or brake
may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
OFE058127N
• When the vehicle is on/near a
slope
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is on/near a
slope.
In certain instances, the system may
not detect the vehicle approaching
from the rear left/right and the warning or brake may not operate properly.
Always pay attention to your surrounding while driving.
5-75
5
Driving your vehicle
• When the vehicle is in a complex
parking environment
The system may not operate properly when the vehicle is in a complex parking environment.
In certain instances, the system
may not be able to exactly determine the risk of collision for the
vehicles which are parking or
pulling out near your vehicle (for
example, a vehicle escaping
beside your vehicle, a vehicle
parking or pulling out in the rear
area, a vehicle approaching your
vehicle making a turn, etc.).
If this occurs, the warning or brake
may not operate properly.
Driving your vehicle
i Information
OTM058106L
[A] : Structure, [B] : Wall
• Pulling into the parking space
where there is a structure
The system may not operate properly when pulling in the vehicle to the
parking space where there is a structure at the back or side of your vehicle.
In certain instances, when backing
into the parking space, the system
may not detect the vehicle moving in
front of your vehicle. In this case, the
warning or brake may not operate
properly.
Always pay attention to the parking
space while driving.
5-76
OTM058107
• When the vehicle is parked rearward
If the vehicle is parked rearward and
the sensor detects another vehicle in
the rear area of the parking space,
the system can warn or control braking. Always pay attention to the parking space while driving.
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
BLIND-SPOT VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
Operating conditions
With the vehicle on, select the
"Driver assistance → Blind-spot
safety → Blind-spot view" from the
vehicle settings in the Infotainment
system screen. Then the corresponding left or right side of the vehicle
will be displayed on the cluster if the
driver turns on the turn signal while
driving.
System operation
■ Left
OFE058057N
OFE051055N
5
■ Right
Driving your vehicle
The Blind-Spot View Monitor system
is designed to help driving by providing broader view than the outer side
view mirror by displaying rear/side
area view on the cluster when the
driver turns on the turn signal to
change lane.
The system shows the following
vehicle on the corresponding side
using the cameras at the outside
rearview mirrors when the driver
turns on the turn signal to change
lane.
OFE052056N
Operate the turn signal while driving
and the corresponding left or right
side rear view will be shown on the
cluster.
5-77
Driving your vehicle
Blind-Spot View Monitor
system warning
View may be obscured due to
weather conditions
This message is displayed if the
camera recognition system cannot
detect the following vehicle due to
the weather condition and the system may not operate properly.
Check the surrounding condition
visually and with the outer side view
mirror when driving.
5-78
LANE KEEPING ASSIST (LKA) SYSTEM
WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It is
the responsibility of the driver
to always be aware of the surrounding and steer the vehicle.
OFE052038N
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) system:
• Do not steer the steering
wheel suddenly when the
steering wheel is being assisted by the system.
• LKA system helps to prevent
the driver from moving out of
the lane unintentionally by
assisting the driver's steering.
However, the driver should not
solely rely on the system but
always pay attention on the
steering wheel to stay in the
lane.
tem can be canceled or not
work properly according to
road condition and surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
• Do not disassemble the LKA
system camera temporarily to
tint the window or attach any
types of coatings and accessories. If you disassemble the
camera and assemble it again,
take your vehicle to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked for
calibration.
• When you replace the windshield glass, LKA system
camera or related parts of the
steering wheel, take your
vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked for calibration.
5-79
5
Driving your vehicle
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system helps detect lane markers on the
road with a front view camera at the
front windshield, and assists the driver's steering to help keep the vehicle between lanes.
When the system detects the vehicle
straying from its lane, it alerts the
driver with a visual and audible warning, while applying a counter-steering torque, to try to prevent the vehicle from moving out of its lane.
• The operation of the LKA sys-
Driving your vehicle
• The system detects lane lines
•
•
•
•
•
and controls the steering
wheel by a camera, therefore,
if the lane lines are hard to
detect, the system may not
work properly.
Please refer to "Limitations of
the system".
Do not remove or damage the
related parts of LKA system.
You may not hear a warning
sound of LKA system because
of excessive audio sound.
If any other warning sound
such as seat belt warning
chime is already generated,
the Lane Keeping Assist
(LKA) system warning may
not sound.
Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. The system may malfunction if the sunlight is reflected.
Always have your hands on the
steering wheel while the LKA
system is activated. Also, when
Active LKA is selected from the
5-80
User Settings mode and if you
continue to drive with your
hands off the steering wheel
after the "Keep hands on steering wheel" warning message
appears, the system will stop
controlling the steering wheel.
However, if the driver has their
hands on the steering wheel
again, the system will start controlling the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel is not continuously controlled so if the
vehicle speed is at a higher
speed when leaving a lane the
vehicle may not be able to be
controlled by the system. The
driver must always follow the
speed limit when using the
system.
• If you attach objects to the
steering wheel, the system
may not assist steering or the
hands off alarm may not work
properly. When you tow a trailer, make sure that you turn off
the LKA system.
• When you tow a trailer, make
sure that you turn off the LKA
system.
LKA System Operation
OFE058189N
With the POWER button in the ON
position, press the LKA button located on the instrument panel on the
lower left hand side of the driver.
• The indicator (
) in the cluster
display will initially illuminate white.
• When the indicator(white) activated in the previous ignition cycle,
the system turns on without any
control.
• If you press the LKA button again,
the indicator on the cluster display
will go off.
The color of indicator will
change depending on the
condition of LKA system.
LKA system activation
WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
is a system to help prevent the
driver from leaving the lane.
However, the driver should not
solely rely on the system but
always check the road conditions when driving.
- White : Sensor does not detect
lane markers or vehicle
speed is under 37 mph (60
km/h).
- Green : Sensor detects lane markers and the system is able
to control vehicle steering.
i Information
OFE050193
5
• After LKA is activated, if both lane
markers are detected, vehicle
speed is over 37 mph (60 km/h)
and all the activation conditions are
satisfied, LKA indicator will change
to green and the steering wheel
will be controlled.
Driving your vehicle
If the indicator (white) is activated
from the previous ignition cycle, the
system will turn ON without any additional control. If you press the LKA
switch again, the indicator on the cluster goes off.
5-81
Driving your vehicle
• If your vehicle departs from the
projected lane in front of you, the
LKA system operates as follows:
■ Lane marker undetected
■ Left lane marker
OFE050193
■ Lane marker detected
OFE050091
■ Right lane marker
OFE050126
• If vehicle speed is over 37 mph (60
km/h) and the system detects lane
markers, the color changes from
gray to white.
• Both lane markers must be detected for the system to fully activate.
5-82
OFE050092
1. A visual warning appears on the
cluster LCD display. Either the left
lane marker or the right lane
marker in the cluster LCD display
will blink depending on which
direction the vehicle is veering.
Also, a warning sound will be
heard.
2. The LKA system will control the
vehicle's steering to prevent the
vehicle from crossing the lane
maker in below conditions.
- Vehicle speed is over 37 mph (60
km/h)
- The system detects both lane
markers
- When driving, the vehicle is
located between both lanes normally.
- The steering wheel is not turned
suddenly.
When lanes are detected and all the
conditions to activate the LKA system are satisfied, a LKA system indicator light (
) will change from
white to green. This indicates that the
LKA system is in the ENABLED state
and the steering wheel will be able to
be controlled.
Warning Light and Message
Place hands on the steering
wheel
WARNING
The warning message may
appear late according to road
conditions. Therefore, always
have your hands on the steering
wheel while driving.
WARNING
• The driver is responsible for
accurate steering.
• Turn off the system in below
i Information
situations.
- In bad weather
- In bad road condition
- When the steering wheel
needs to be controlled by the
driver frequently.
• Even though the steering is assisted
by the system, the driver can still
steer to control the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted
by the system than when it is not.
Check Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system
If there is a problem with the system
a message will appear for a few seconds. If the problem continues the
LKA system failure indicator will illuminate.
If the steering wheel is held very lightly, the message may still appear
because the LKA system may not recognize that the driver has their hands
on the wheel.
5-83
5
Driving your vehicle
OFE051115N
If the driver takes their hands off the
steering wheel for several seconds
while the LKA system is activated,
the system will warn the driver.
i Information
Driving your vehicle
LKA system failure indicator
The LKA system failure
indicator (yellow) will illuminate if the LKA system
is not working properly.
Have your vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
When there is a problem with the
system do one of the following:
• Turn the system on after turning
the vehicle off and on again.
• Check if the POWER button is in
the ON position.
• Check if the system is affected by
the weather. (for example, fog,
heavy rain, etc.)
• Check if there is foreign matter on
the camera lens.
If the problem is not solved, have
your vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
5-84
The LKA system will not be in the
ENABLED state and/or the steering
wheel will not be assisted when:
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on, the
steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle of the lane when the system is
turned on or right after changing a
lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp
curve.
• Vehicle speed is below 37 mph
(60 km/h) and over 110 mph (180
km/h).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• There are more than two lane lines
on the road. (for example, construction area)
• Only one side of the lane marker is
detected.
• Radius of a curve is too small.
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
Limitations of the System
The LKA system may operate prematurely even if the vehicle does not
depart from the intended lane, OR,
the LKA system may not warn you if
the vehicle leaves the intended lane
under the following circumstances:
When external conditions intervene
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlights are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in
the roadway such as a concrete
barrier, guardrail and reflector post
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road.
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance
between you and the vehicle in
front to be able to detect the lane
marker or the vehicle ahead is driving on the lane marker.
• Driving on a steep grade, over a
hill, or when driving on a curved
road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high
due to direct sunlight, etc.
5-85
5
Driving your vehicle
When the lane and road conditions are poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marker from the road because the
lane marker is covered with dust or
sand.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color
of the lane marker from the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker is indistinct or
damaged.
• The lane marker is merged or
divided. (for example, tollgate)
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road in front of you.
• The lane marker is very thick or
thin.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• The lane marker ahead is not visible
due to rain, snow, water on the
road, damaged or stained road surface, or other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker
by a median strip, trees, guardrail,
noise barriers, etc.
• The lane markers are complicated
or a structure substitutes for the
lines such as a construction area.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane marker in a tunnel is
stained with oil, etc.
• The lane suddenly disappears
such as at the intersection.
Driving your vehicle
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the camera lens
is blocked with dirt or debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard,
etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
because of fog, heavy rain or snow.
WARNING
The Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system is a system to help prevent the driver from leaving the
lane. However, the driver should
not solely rely on the system
but always take the necessary
actions for safe driving practices.
5-86
LKA System Function Change
Lane Departure Warning
The driver can change LKA to the
Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system or change the LKA system mode
from the Infotainment system screen.
Go to the "Vehicle settings → Driver
Assistance → Lane Safety → Lane
Keeping
Assist
(LKA)/Lane
Departure Warning (LDW)/Off".
The system is automatically set to
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) if a function is not selected.
LDW system alerts the driver with a
visual warning and a warning alarm
when the system detects the vehicle
departing the lane. The steering
wheel will not be controlled.
lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
This mode guides the driver to help
keep the vehicle within the lanes. It
rarely controls the steering wheel,
when the vehicle drives well inside
the lanes. However, it starts to control the steering wheel, when the
vehicle is about to deviate out of the
lane.
Off
If you select "Off", the LKA system is
deactivated.
LANE FOLLOWING ASSIST (LFA) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)
WARNING
The Lane Following Assist (LFA)
system is not a substitute for safe
driving practices, but a convenience function. It is the responsibility of the driver to always be
aware of the surrounding and
steer the vehicle.
OFE052038N
WARNING
Take the following precautions
when using the Lane Following
Assist (LFA) system:
• Do not steer the steering
wheel unnecessarily when the
steering wheel is being assisted by the system.
• LFA system helps the driver
to keep the vehicle in the center of the lane by assisting the
driver's steering. However, the
driver should not solely rely
on the system but always pay
attention on the steering
wheel to stay in the lane.
tem can be canceled or not
work properly according to
road condition and surroundings. Always be cautious
when driving.
• Do not disassemble the LFA
system camera temporarily to
tint the window or attach any
types of coatings and accessories. If you disassemble the
camera and assemble it again,
have your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer
and have the system checked
for calibration.
• When you replace the windshield glass, LFA system camera or related parts of the
steering wheel, have your
vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the
system checked for calibration.
5-87
5
Driving your vehicle
The Lane Following Assist (LFA) system helps detect lane markers on the
road with a front view camera at the
front windshield, and assists the driver's steering to help keep the vehicle between lanes.
• The operation of the LFA sys-
Driving your vehicle
• The system detects lane
•
•
•
•
markers and controls the
steering wheel by a camera,
therefore, if the lane markers
are hard to detect, the system
may not work properly.
Please refer to "Limitations of
the system".
Do not remove or damage the
related parts of LFA system.
You may not hear a warning
sound of LFA system because
of excessive audio sound.
Do not place objects on the
dashboard that reflects light
such as mirrors, white paper,
etc. The system may malfunction if the sunlight is reflected.
Always have your hands on
the steering wheel while the
LFA system is activated. If you
continue to drive with your
hands off the steering wheel
after the "Keep hands on
steering wheel" warning message appears, the system will
be turned off automatically.
5-88
However, if the driver has their
hands on the steering wheel
again, the system will start
controlling the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may not
be continuously controlled by
the system if the vehicle
speed is too high. The driver
must always follow the speed
limit when using the system.
• If you attach objects to the
steering wheel, the system
may not assist steering normally or the hands off alarm
may not work properly.
• When you tow a trailer, make
sure that you turn off the LFA
system.
LFA operation
The driver can turn on the LFA system with the vehicle on and by
selecting "Vehicle settings → Driver
assistance → Driving assist → LFA
(Lane Following Assist)" in the
Infotainment system screen.
The set-up of the LFA system will be
maintained, as selected, when the
vehicle is restarted.
Operating conditions
LFA activation
• When the system does not recognize the lane or depending on the
vehicle condition in front (presence
of the vehicle, driving status, etc.).
the steering wheel is controlled
restrictively.
When the control of the steering
wheel is stopped temporarily the
activation indicator blinks in green
and then changes to white.
The system is activated when the
Lane Following Assist is selected
from the vehicle Settings mode when
the following conditions are satisfied:
- The Smart Cruise Control is in activation (vehicle deceleration and
acceleration)
- Vehicle speed is lower than 90
mph (145 km/h)
OFE050126
5
• After LFA is activated, if the vehicle
is within the lane and both lane
markers are detected (lane color
changes grey to white) and there is
no abrupt steering by the driver,
indicator light will change from
white to green. This indicates that
the LFA system is in the ASSIST
state and the steering wheel will be
able to be controlled.
Driving your vehicle
When the system is activated, the
indicator ( ) on the cluster will illuminate. The color of the indicator will
change depending on the condition
of LFA system.
- Green : The system is in the assist
state.
- White : The system is in the ready
state.
5-89
Driving your vehicle
Warning message
WARNING
The warning message may
appear late according to road
conditions. Therefore, always
have your hands on the steering
wheel while driving.
OTM070117N
OFE051115N
Place hands on the steering wheel
If the driver takes their hands off from
the steering wheel for certain time
while the LFA system is activated,
the system will warn the driver.
i Information
If the steering wheel is held very lightly the message may still appear
because the LFA system may not recognize that the driver has their hands
on the wheel.
5-90
Lane Following Assist (LFA) canceled
If the driver still does not have their
hands on the steering wheel after the
message "Keep hands on steering
wheel", the system will not control
the steering wheel and warn the driver only when the driver crosses the
lane markers.
However, if the driver has their hands
on the steering wheel again, the system will start controlling the steering
wheel.
WARNING
• The driver is responsible for
accurate steering.
• Turn off the system and drive
the vehicle in following situations.
- In bad weather
- In bad road condition
- When the steering wheel
needs to be controlled by the
driver frequently.
• Even though the steering is assisted
by the system, the driver may control the steering wheel.
• The steering wheel may feel heavier
when the steering wheel is assisted
by the system than when it is not.
5-91
5
Driving your vehicle
i Information
OTM070118N
Check Lane Following Assist (LFA)
system
If there is a problem with the system
a message will appear for a few seconds. Have the vehicle checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
The LFA system will not be in the
ASSIST state when :
• The turn signal is turned on before
changing a lane. If you change
lanes without the turn signal on,
the steering wheel might be controlled.
• The vehicle is not driven in the middle of the lane when the system is
turned on or right after changing a
lane.
• ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or
VSM (Vehicle Stability Management)
is activated.
• The vehicle is driven on a sharp
curve with high speed.
• Vehicle speed is over 90 mph (145
km/h).
• The vehicle makes sharp lane
changes.
• The vehicle brakes suddenly.
• Only one lane marker is detected.
• The lane is very wide or narrow.
• Radius of a curve is too small.
• The vehicle is driven on a steep
incline.
• The steering wheel is turned suddenly.
Driving your vehicle
Limitations of the system
The LFA system may operate prematurely even if the vehicle does not
depart from the intended lane, OR,
the LFA system may not assist your
steering if the vehicle leaves the
intended lane under the following circumstances:
When the lane and road conditions are poor
• It is difficult to distinguish the lane
marking from the road surface or
the lane marking is faded or not
clearly marked.
• It is difficult to distinguish the color
of the lane marker from the road.
• There are markings on the road
surface that look like a lane marker
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• The lane marker is indistinct or
damaged.
• The lane marker is merged or
divided. (for example, tollgate)
5-92
• The lane number increases or
decreases or the lane marker are
crossing complicatedly.
• There are more than two lane
markers on the road in front of you.
• The lane marker is very thick or
thin.
• The lane marker ahead is not visible due to rain, snow, water on the
road, damaged or stained road
surface, or other factors.
• The shadow is on the lane marker
by a median strip, trees, guardrail,
noise barriers, etc.
• The lane markers are complicated
or a structure substitutes for the
lines such as a construction area.
• There are crosswalk signs or other
symbols on the road.
• The lane suddenly disappears
such as at the intersection.
When external condition is intervened
• The brightness outside changes
suddenly such as when entering or
exiting a tunnel, or when passing
under a bridge.
• The brightness outside is too low
such as when the headlights are
not on at night or the vehicle is
going through a tunnel.
• There is a boundary structure in
the roadway such as a concrete
barrier, guardrail and reflector post
that is inadvertently being detected
by the camera.
• When light coming from a street
light or an oncoming vehicle is
reflected on a wet road surface
such as a puddle in the road.
• The field of view in front is
obstructed by sun glare.
• There is not enough distance
between you and the vehicle in
front to be able to detect the lane
marker or the vehicle ahead is driving on the lane marker.
• Driving on a steep grade, over a
hill, or when driving on a curved
road.
• The adverse road conditions cause
excessive vehicle vibrations while
driving.
• The surrounding of the inside rear
view mirror temperature is high
due to direct sunlight, etc.
When front visibility is poor
• The windshield or the camera lens
is blocked with dirt or debris.
• The windshield glass is fogged up;
a clear view of the road is obstructed.
• Placing objects on the dashboard,
etc.
• The sensor cannot detect the lane
because of fog, heavy rain or snow.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-93
Driving your vehicle
DRIVER ATTENTION WARNING (DAW) SYSTEM
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system can help determine the condition of the driver's fatigue and inattention.
System Setting and Activation
System setting
• To turn ON the Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system, turn on
the vehicle, and then select
'Vehicle
settings
→ Driver
Assistance → Driver Attention
Warning → High sensitivity/Normal
sensitivity’ on the Infotainment system screen.
• The driver can select the mode of
the Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system.
- High sensitivity : The Driver
Attention Warning system helps
alert the driver of his/her fatigue
level or inattentive driving practices faster than Normal mode.
- Normal sensitivity : The Driver
Attention Warning system helps
alert the driver of his/her fatigue
level or inattentive driving practices.
- Off : The Driver Attention Warning
system is deactivated.
• The set-up of the Driver Attention
Warning system will be maintained, as selected, when the vehicle is re-started.
Driver's attention level
■ System off
OTM070102N
■ Attentive driving
OFE051097N
5-94
• When the driver turns on the system while driving, it displays 'Last
Break time' and level reflected that.
■ Inattentive driving
Take a break
OFE051098N
OTM070105L
• The "Consider taking a break"
message appears on the LCD display and a warning sounds in order
to suggest the driver to take a
break, when the driver’s attention
level is below 1.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system does not suggest
the driver to take a break, when the
total driving time is shorter than 10
minutes.
• The last break time is set to 00:00
and the driver's attention level is
set to 5 (very attentive) when the
driver resets the Driver Attention
Warning (DAW) system.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system resets in the following situations.
- The vehicle is turned OFF.
- The driver unfastens the seat
belt and then opens the driver's
door.
- The vehicle is stopped for more
than 10 minutes.
• The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system operates again,
when the driver restarts driving.
5-95
5
Driving your vehicle
• The driver can monitor their driving
conditions on the LCD display.
The DAW screen will appear when
you select the Assist mode tab ( )
on the LCD display if the system is
activated. For more details, refer to
"LCD Display Modes" in chapter 3.
• The driver's attention level is displayed on the scale of 1 to 5. The
lower the number is, the more inattentive the driver is.
• The number decreases when the
driver does not take a break for a
certain period of time.
• The number increases when the
driver attentively drives for a certain period of time.
Resetting the System
Driving your vehicle
System Standby
System Malfunction
WARNING
• The Driver Attention Warning
OTM070106N
OTM070107L
The Driver Attention Warning (DAW)
system enters the ready status and
displays the 'Standby' screen in the
following situations.
- The camera sensor keeps failing to
detect the lanes.
- Driving speed remains under 40
mph (64 km/h) or over 110 mph
(177 km/h).
Check Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system
When the warning message
appears, the system is not working
properly. In this case, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
5-96
system is not a substitute for
safe driving practices, but a
convenience function only. It
is the responsibility of the
driver to always drive cautiously to prevent unexpected
and sudden situations from
occurring. Pay attention to the
road conditions at all times.
• The system may suggest a
break according to the driver's driving pattern or habits
even if the driver doesn't feel
fatigue.
• The driver, who feels fatigued,
should take a break, even
though there is no break suggestion by the Driver Attention
Warning system.
NOTICE
CAUTION
The Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system may not properly
operate with limited alerting in
the following situations:
• The lane detection performance is limited. (For more
details, refer to "Lane Keeping
Assist (LKA) system" in this
chapter.)
• The vehicle is violently driven
or is abruptly turned for obstacle avoidance (for example,
construction area, other vehicles, fallen objects, bumpy
road).
• Forward drivability of the vehicle is severely undermined
(possibly due to wide variation
in tire pressures, uneven tire
wear-out, toe-in/toe-out alignment).
• The vehicle drives on a curvy
road.
• The vehicle drives on a bumpy
road.
• The vehicle drives through a
windy area.
• The vehicle is controlled by the
following driving assist systems:
- Lane Keeping Assist (LKA)
system
- Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) system
- Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
system
- Lane Following Assist (LFA)
system
CAUTION
Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the Driver Attention Warning
(DAW) system warning sounds.
5-97
5
Driving your vehicle
The Driver Attention Warning system utilizes the camera sensor on
the front windshield for its operation. To keep the camera sensor in
the best condition, you should
observe the followings:
• Do not disassemble the camera
temporarily to tint the window or
to attach any types of coatings
and accessories. If you disassemble a camera and assemble
it again, take your vehicle to an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
have the system checked for calibration.
• NEVER install any accessories
or stickers on the front windshield, nor tint the front windshield.
• NEVER locate any reflective
objects (for example, white
paper, mirror) over the dashboard. Any light reflection may
cause a malfunction of the
Driver Attention Alert (DAW)
system.
• Pay extreme caution to keep the
camera sensor out of water.
Driving your vehicle
SMART CRUISE CONTROL WITH STOP & GO SYSTEM
WARNING
For your safety, please read the
owner's manual before using the
Smart Cruise Control system.
WARNING
OFE051060N
➀ Cruise indicator (
➁ Set speed
➂ Vehicle-to-vehicle distance
)
The Smart Cruise Control System
allows you to program the vehicle to
help maintain a constant speed and
distance detecting the vehicle ahead
without depressing the accelerator/
brake pedal.
5-98
The Smart Cruise Control system is not a substitute for safe
driving practices, but a convenience function only. It is the
responsibility of the driver to
always check the speed, distance to the vehicle ahead and
road & driving conditions.
WARNING
Take the following precautions :
• Always set the vehicle speed
under the speed limit in your
country.
• If the Smart Cruise Control is
left on, (cruise (
)
indicator light in the instrument cluster is illuminated)
the Smart Cruise Control can
be activated unintentionally.
Keep the Smart Cruise
Control System off (cruise
(
) indicator light
OFF) when the Smart Cruise
Control is not in use, to avoid
inadvertently setting a speed.
• Use the Smart Cruise Control
System only when traveling
on open highways in good
weather.
WARNING
• Do not use the Smart Cruise
Smart Cruise Control Switch
OFE058170N
CRUISE: Turns cruise control system on or off.
RES+: Resumes or increases cruise
control speed.
SET-: Sets or decreases cruise control speed.
: Sets vehicle-to-vehicle distance.
CANCEL: Cancels cruise control
operation.
5-99
5
Driving your vehicle
Control when it may not be
safe to keep the vehicle at a
constant speed:
- When driving in heavy traffic
or when traffic conditions
make it difficult to drive at a
constant speed
- When driving on rainy, icy, or
snow-covered roads
- When driving on hilly or
windy roads
- When driving in windy areas
- When driving in parking lots
- When driving near crash
barriers
- When driving on a sharp
curve
- When driving with limited
view (possibly due to bad
weather, such as fog, snow,
rain or sandstorm)
- When the vehicle sensing
ability decreases due to
vehicle modification resulting level difference of the
vehicle's front and rear
Driving your vehicle
To Adjust the Sensitivity of
Smart Cruise Control
To Convert to Cruise Control
Mode
The sensitivity of vehicle speed
when following the front vehicle to
maintain the set distance can be
adjusted. Go to the 'Vehicle settings
→ Driver Assistance → SCC
Reaction → Fast/Normal/Slow' on
the Infotainment system screen. You
may select one of the three stages
you prefer.
• Fast:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is faster than normal speed.
• Normal:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is normal.
• Slow:
Vehicle speed following the front
vehicle to maintain the set distance
is slower than normal speed.
The driver may choose to switch to
use the conventional Cruise Control
mode (speed only control function)
by following these steps:
1. Push the CRUISE button on the
steering wheel to turn the system
on. The cruise (
) indicator will illuminate.
2. Push and hold the Vehicle-toVehicle Distance button for more
than 2 seconds.
3. Choose between "Smart Cruise
Control" and "Cruise Control".
When the system is canceled using
the CRUISE button or the CRUISE
button is used after the vehicle is
turned on, the Smart Cruise Control
mode will turn on.
i Information
The last selected speed sensitivity of
the smart cruise control is remained in
the system.
5-100
WARNING
When using the conventional
Cruise Control mode, you must
manually adjust the distance to
other vehicles by depressing
the brake pedal. The system
does not automatically adjust
the distance to vehicles in front
of you.
i Information
Smart Cruise Control Speed
To set Smart Cruise Control
speed
• Vehicle speed may decrease on an
upward slope and increase on a
downward slope.
• When you are setting the cruise control speed, with a vehicle in front
and your vehicle speed is between
0 ~ 20 mph (0 ~ 30 km/h), the speed
will set to 20 mph (30 km/h).
OFE058062N
OFE058061N
5
Driving your vehicle
1. Push the CRUISE button on the
steering wheel to turn the system
on. The cruise indicator will illuminate.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.
The Smart Cruise Control speed
can be set as follows:
• 6 – 100 mph (10 - 160 km/h) :
when there is no vehicle in front
• 0 – 100 mph (0 - 160 km/h) :
when there is a vehicle in front
3. Push the toggle switch down
(SET-), and release it at the
desired speed. The Set Speed
and Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance
on the LCD display will illuminate.
4. Release the accelerator pedal.
The desired speed will automatically be maintained.
If there is a vehicle in front of you, the
speed may decrease to maintain the
distance to the vehicle ahead.
On a steep grade, the vehicle may
slow down or speed up slightly while
going uphill or downhill.
5-101
Driving your vehicle
To increase Smart Cruise
Control set speed
CAUTION
To decrease the Smart Cruise
Control set speed
Check the driving condition
before using the toggle switch.
Driving speed sharply increases, when you push up and hold
the toggle switch.
OFE058063N
OFE058062N
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch up (RES+),
and release it immediately. The
cruising speed will increase by
1 mph (1 km/h) each time you
move the toggle switch up in this
manner.
• Push the toggle switch up (RES+),
and hold it. Your vehicle set speed
will increase by 5 mph (10 km/h).
Release the toggle switch at the
speed you want.
You can set the speed to 105 mph
(170 km/h).
Follow either of these procedures:
• Push the toggle switch down
(SET-), and release it immediately.
The cruising speed will decrease
by 1 mph (1 km/h) each time you
move the toggle switch down in
this manner.
• Push the toggle switch down
(SET-), and hold it. Your vehicle set
speed will decrease by 5 mph (10
km/h). Release the toggle switch
at the speed you want.
• You can set the speed to 20 mph
(30 km/h).
5-102
To temporarily accelerate with
the Smart Cruise Control on
If you want to speed up temporarily
when the Smart Cruise Control is on,
depress the accelerator pedal.
Increased speed will not interfere
with Smart Cruise Control operation
or change the set speed.
To return to the set speed, take your
foot off the accelerator pedal.
If you push the toggle switch down
(SET-) at increased speed, the cruising speed will be set again pedal.
Smart Cruise Control set speed
will be temporarily canceled
when:
Be careful when accelerating
temporarily, because the speed
is not controlled automatically
at this time even if there is a
vehicle in front of you.
OFE058064N
Canceled manually
• Depressing the brake pedal.
• Pushing the CANCEL button located on the steering wheel.
• Depress the brake pedal and press
the button at the same time, when
the vehicle is at a standstill.
The Smart Cruise Control turns off
temporarily when the Set Speed and
Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance indicator
on the LCD display turns off.
The cruise indicator is illuminated
continuously.
• The driver's door is opened.
• The vehicle is shifted to N (Neutral),
R (Reverse) or P (Park).
• The EPB (Electronic Parking Brake)
is applied.
• The vehicle speed is over 105 mph
(170 km/h).
• The vehicle stops on a steep incline.
• The ESC (Electronic Stability
Control), TCS (Traction Control
System) or ABS is operating.
• The ESC is turned off.
• The sensor or the cover is dirty or
blocked with foreign matter.
• The vehicle is stopped for a certain
period of time.
• The vehicle stops and goes repeatedly for a long period of time.
• The accelerator pedal is continuously depressed for a long period
of time.
• The driving performance is abnormal.
5-103
5
Driving your vehicle
CAUTION
Canceled automatically
Driving your vehicle
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator pedal, after the vehicle is
stopped by the Smart Cruise
Control system with no other vehicle ahead.
• The driver starts driving by pushing
the toggle switch up (RES+)/down
(SET-) or depressing the accelerator pedal, after stopping the vehicle
with a vehicle stopped far away in
front.
• The Forward Collision-Avoidance
Assist (FCA) is activated.
Each of these actions will cancel the
Smart Cruise Control operation. The
Set Speed and Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance on the LCD display will go
off.
In a condition the Smart Cruise
Control is cancelled automatically,
the Smart Cruise Control will not
resume even though the RES+ or
SET- toggle switch is pushed.
5-104
i Information
If the Smart Cruise Control is canceled
by other than the reasons mentioned,
have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OTM070113N
Smart Cruise Control canceled
If the system is cancelled, the warning chime will sound and a message
will appear for a few seconds.
You must adjust the vehicle speed by
depressing the accelerator or brake
pedal according to the road condition
ahead and driving condition.
Always check the road conditions.
Do not rely on the warning chime.
To resume Smart Cruise Control
set speed
If any method other than the cruise
toggle switch was used to cancel
cruising speed and the system is still
activated, the cruising speed will
automatically resume when you
push the toggle switch up (RES+) or
down (SET-).
If you push the toggle switch up
(RES+), the speed will resume to the
recently set speed. However, if vehicle speed drops below 20 mph (30
km/h), it will resume when there is a
vehicle in front of your vehicle.
Always check the road conditions when you push the toggle
switch up (RES+) to resume
speed.
Smart Cruise Control Vehicleto-Vehicle Distance
To set Vehicle-to-Vehicle
Distance
OFE058061N
• Push the CRUISE button (the
cruise indicator light will go off).
If you wish not to use the cruise
control system, always turn the
system off by pushing the CRUISE
button.
5
OFE058066N
When the Smart Cruise Control system is ON, you can set and maintain
the distance from the vehicle ahead
of you without pressing the accelerator or brake pedal.
5-105
Driving your vehicle
CAUTION
To turn Cruise Control off
Driving your vehicle
Each time the button is pressed, the
vehicle to vehicle distance changes
as follows:
Distance 4
Distance 3
When the lane ahead is clear:
When there is a vehicle ahead
of you in your lane:
Distance 2
Distance 1
For example, if you drive at 56 mph
(90 km/h), the distance is maintained
as follows:
Distance
Distance
Distance
Distance
4
3
2
1
-
approximately
approximately
approximately
approximately
172 feet
130 feet
106 feet
82 feet
i Information
The distance is set to the last set distance when the system is used for the
first time after starting the vehicle.
5-106
OFE051067N
The vehicle speed will maintain the
set speed.
Distance 4
Distance 3
Distance 2
Distance 1
OFE051071N/OFE051070N
OFE051069N/OFE051068N
• Your vehicle speed will slow down
or speed up to maintain the selected distance.
• If the vehicle ahead speeds up,
your vehicle will travel at a steady
cruising speed after accelerating to
the set speed.
• If distance from the front vehicle
has changed due to accelerating or
decelerating of the front vehicle,
the distance on the LCD display
may change.
WARNING
• Even if the warning chime is
not activated, always pay
attention to the driving conditions to prevent dangerous
situations from occurring.
• Playing the vehicle audio system at high volume may offset
the system warning sounds.
CAUTION
OFE051073N
When using the Smart Cruise
Control system:
• The warning message appears
and warning chime sounds if
the vehicle is unable to maintain
the selected distance from the
vehicle ahead.
• If the warning message appears
and warning chime sounds,
depress the brake pedal or use
the steering wheel toggle
switch to actively adjust the
vehicle speed, and the distance
to the vehicle ahead.
If the vehicle ahead (vehicle
speed: less than 20 mph (30
km/h)) disappears to the next
lane, the warning chime will
sound and a message "Watch
for surrounding vehicles" will
appear. Adjust your vehicle
speed for vehicles or objects
that can suddenly appear in
front of you by depressing the
brake pedal.
Always pay attention to the road
condition ahead.
5-107
5
Driving your vehicle
OFE041491N
Driving your vehicle
In traffic situation
• If you push the smart cruise control
toggle switch (RES+ or SET-) while
Auto Hold and smart cruise control
is operating the Auto Hold will be
released regardless of accelerator
pedal operation and the vehicle will
start to move. The AUTO HOLD
indicator changes from green to
white.
Sensor to Detect Distance to
the Vehicle Ahead
■ Front radar
OTM070114L
Use switch or pedal to accelerate
• In traffic, your vehicle will stop if the
vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if
the vehicle ahead of you starts
moving, your vehicle will start as
well. However, if the vehicle stops
for more than 3 seconds, you must
depress the accelerator pedal or
push up the toggle switch (RES+)
or push down the toggle switch
(SET-) to start driving.
OFE058106N
■ Front view camera
OFE052038N
The Smart Cruise Control uses a
sensor to detect distance to the vehicle ahead.
5-108
If the sensor is covered with dirt or
other foreign matter, the vehicle to
vehicle distance control may not
operate correctly.
Always keep the sensor clean.
Warning message
i Information
For the SCC operation is temporarily
stopped if the radar is blocked, but
you wish to use conventional cruise
control mode (speed only control function), you must convert to the cruise
control mode (refer to "To convert to
Cruise Control mode" in this chapter).
CAUTION
OTM070115N
• Do not apply license plate
frame or foreign objects such
as a bumper sticker or a
bumper guard near the radar
sensor. Doing
so
may
adversely affect the sensing
performance of the radar.
• Always keep the radar sensor
and lens cover clean and free
of dirt and debris.
• Use only a soft cloth to wash
the vehicle. Do not spray pressurized water directly on the
sensor or sensor cover.
5-109
5
Driving your vehicle
Smart Cruise Control disabled.
Radar blocked
When the sensor lens cover is
blocked with dirt, snow, or debris, the
Smart Cruise Control system operation may stop temporarily. If this
occurs, a warning message will
appear on the LCD display. Remove
any dirt, snow, or debris and clean
the radar sensor lens cover before
operating the Smart Cruise Control
system. The Smart Cruise Control
system may not properly activate, if
the radar is totally contaminated, or if
any substance is not detected after
turning on the vehicle (for example,
in an open terrain).
Driving your vehicle
Limitations of the System
• Be careful not to apply unnecessary force on the radar sensor or sensor cover. If the sensor is forcibly moved out of
proper alignment, the Smart
Cruise Control system may
not operate correctly. In this
case, a warning message may
not be displayed. Have the
vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• If the front bumper becomes
damaged in the area around
the radar sensor, the Smart
Cruise Control System may
not operate properly. Have the
vehicle inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Use only genuine HYUNDAI
parts to repair or replace a
damaged sensor or sensor
cover. Do not apply paint to
the sensor cover.
5-110
The Smart Cruise Control system
may have limits to its ability to detect
distance to the vehicle ahead due to
road and traffic conditions.
OTM070116N
Check Smart Cruise Control System
The message will appear when the
vehicle to vehicle distance control
system is not functioning normally.
Take your vehicle to an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and have the system checked.
On curves
On inclines
OTM058073
OTM058117
OFE058041
• During uphill or downhill driving,
the Smart Cruise Control system
may not detect a moving vehicle in
your lane, and cause your vehicle
to accelerate to the set speed.
Also, the vehicle speed will rapidly
decrease when the vehicle ahead
is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on inclines and apply the brake or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
5-111
5
Driving your vehicle
• The Smart Cruise Control system
may not detect a moving vehicle in
your lane, and then your vehicle
could accelerate to the set speed.
Also, the vehicle speed will
decrease when the vehicle ahead
is recognized suddenly.
• Select the appropriate set speed
on curves and apply the brakes or
accelerator pedal if necessary.
Your vehicle speed can be reduced
due to a vehicle in the adjacent lane.
Apply the accelerator pedal and
select the appropriate set speed.
Check to be sure that the road conditions permit safe operation of the
Smart Cruise Control.
Driving your vehicle
Lane changing
Detecting vehicles
OTM058074
• A vehicle which moves into your
lane from an adjacent lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor until it
is in the sensor's detection range.
• The radar may not detect immediately when a vehicle cuts in suddenly. Always pay attention to the
traffic, road and driving conditions.
• If a slower vehicle moves into your
lane, your speed may decrease to
maintain the distance to the vehicle
ahead.
• If a faster vehicle which moves into
your lane, your vehicle will accelerate to the set speed.
5-112
OTM058128
Some vehicles in your lane cannot
be recognized by the sensor:
- Narrow vehicles such as motorcycles or bicycles
- Vehicles offset to one side
- Slow-moving vehicles or suddendecelerating vehicles
- Stopped vehicles
- Vehicles with small rear profile
such as trailers with no loads
A vehicle ahead cannot be recognized correctly by the sensor if any of
following occurs:
- When the vehicle is pointing
upwards due to overloading in the
luggage compartment
- While the steering wheel is operating
- When driving to one side of the
lane
- When driving on narrow lanes or
on curves
Apply the brake or accelerator pedal
if necessary.
OTM058119
OTM058124
• When driving in stop-and-go traffic,
and a stopped vehicle in front of
you merges out of the lane, the
system may not immediately
detect the new vehicle that is now
in front of you. In this case, you
must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, depress
the brake pedal to reduce your
driving speed in order to maintain a
safe distance.
• Always look out for pedestrians
when your vehicle is maintaining a
distance with the vehicle ahead.
5
Driving your vehicle
OTM058129
• Your vehicle may accelerate when
a vehicle ahead of you disappears.
• When you are warned that the
vehicle ahead of you is not detected, drive with caution.
5-113
Driving your vehicle
WARNING
OFE058042
• Always be cautious for vehicles
with higher height or vehicles carrying loads that sticks out from the
back of the vehicle.
5-114
When using the Smart Cruise
Control take the following precautions:
• If an emergency stop is necessary, you must apply the
brakes. The vehicle cannot be
stopped at every emergency
situation by using the Smart
Cruise Control system.
• Keep a safe distance according to road conditions and
vehicle speed. If the vehicle to
vehicle distance is too close
during a high-speed driving, a
serious collision may result.
• Always maintain sufficient
braking distance and decelerate your vehicle by applying
the brakes if necessary.
• The Smart Cruise Control system cannot recognize a
stopped vehicle, pedestrians or
an oncoming vehicle. Always
look ahead cautiously to prevent unexpected and sudden
situations from occurring.
• Vehicles moving in front of
you with a frequent lane
change may cause a delay in
the system's reaction or may
cause the system to react to a
vehicle actually in an adjacent
lane. Always drive cautiously
to prevent unexpected and
sudden situations from occurring.
• Always be aware of the selected speed and vehicle to vehicle distance. The driver
should not solely rely on the
system but always pay attention to driving conditions and
control your vehicle speed.
• The Smart Cruise Control system may not recognize complex driving situations so
always pay attention to driving conditions and control
your vehicle speed.
• For your safety, please read
the owner's manual before
using the Smart Cruise
Control system.
i Information
The Smart Cruise Control system
may not operate temporarily due to:
• Electrical interference
• Modifying the suspension
• Differences of tire abrasion or tire
pressure
• Installing different type of tires
i Information
Radio frequency radiation exposure
information:
This equipment complies with FCC
radiation exposure limits set forth for
an uncontrolled environment.
This equipment should be installed
and operated with minimum distance
of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator
(antenna) and your body.
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with
any other antenna or transmitter.
The radio frequency components (Rear Corner Radar)
complies:
5
OANATEL002
OANATEL003
5-115
Driving your vehicle
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1.This device may not cause harmful
interference, and
2.This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
3.Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user's authority to operate
the device.
i Information
DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (IF EQUIPPED)
Driving your vehicle
LEADING VEHICLE DEPARTURE ALERT (IF EQUIPPED)
The Leading Vehicle Departure Alert
system alerts the driver of the departure of a detected vehicle in front
when the vehicle is stopped and the
Smart Cruise Control (SCC) system
is in activation.
5-116
System Setting and Activation
System setting
With the vehicle ON, the Leading
Vehicle Departure Alert system turns
on and gets ready to be activated
when the 'vehicle Settings → Driver
Assistance → Driving Assist →
Leading vehicle departure alert' is
selected selected in the Infotainment
system screen display. The system
stops operation when the setting is
deactivated. However, if the vehicle
is turned off then on again, the system maintains the previous state.
System standby
OTM070114L
While the Smart Cruise Control
(SCC) system is in operation, your
vehicle stops behind the vehicle in
front when it stops. The message is
displayed on the cluster within 3 seconds after the stop and the system
will be in the standby position.
System activation
WARNING
Always check the front of the
vehicle and road conditions
before departure.
OFE051114N
5
Driving your vehicle
If the driver does not take action for a
certain period of time after the vehicle in front departs, the message is
displayed on the cluster.
The vehicle departs automatically if
the accelerator pedal is depressed or
RES + or SET - toggle switch is
pushed up or down when there is a
vehicle in front.
The Smart Cruise Control (SCC)
system is deactivated if the accelerator pedal is depressed or RES + or
SET - toggle switch is pushed up or
down when there is no vehicle in
front.
5-117
Driving your vehicle
SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS
Hazardous Driving Conditions
Rocking the Vehicle
When hazardous driving elements
are encountered such as water,
snow, ice, mud and sand, take the
bellow suggestions:
• Drive cautiously and keep a longer
braking distance.
• Avoid abrupt braking or steering.
• When your vehicle is stuck in snow,
mud, or sand, turn off the vehicle.
Remove the mud, snow or sand
from around the front wheels and
restart the vehicle. Accelerate
slowly to avoid unnecessary wheel
spin.
• Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or
other non-slip materials under the
wheels to provide additional traction while the vehicle becomes
stuck in ice, snow, or mud.
If it is necessary to rock the vehicle
to free it from snow, sand, or mud,
first turn the steering wheel right and
left to clear the area around your
front wheels. Then, shift back and
forth between R (Reverse) and a forward gear.
Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and
do not race the vehicle.
To prevent reduction gear wear, wait
until the wheels stop spinning before
shifting gears. Release the accelerator pedal while shifting, and press
lightly on the accelerator pedal while
the reduction gear is in gear. Slowly
spinning the wheels in forward and
reverse directions causes a rocking
motion that may free the vehicle.
5-118
WARNING
If the vehicle is stuck and
excessive wheel spin occurs,
the temperature in the tires can
increase very quickly. If the tires
become damaged, a tire blow
out or tire explosion can occur.
This condition is dangerous you and others may be injured.
Do not attempt this procedure if
people or objects are anywhere
near the vehicle.
If you attempt to free the vehicle, the vehicle can overheat
quickly, possibly causing an
fuel cell power module compartment fire or other damage.
Try to avoid spinning the
wheels as much as possible to
prevent overheating of either
the tires or the vehicle. DO NOT
allow the vehicle to spin the
wheels above 56 km/h (35 mph).
i Information
The ESC system (if equipped) must be
turned OFF before rocking the vehicle.
Driving in the Rain
Avoid braking, especially when roads
are wet. Ideally, corners should
always be taken under gentle acceleration.
Rain and wet roads can make driving
dangerous. Here are a few things to
consider when driving in the rain or
on slick pavement:
• Slow down and allow extra following distance. A heavy rainfall
makes it harder to see and increases the distance needed to stop
your vehicle.
• Turn OFF your Cruise Control. (if
equipped)
• Replace your windshield wiper
blades when they show signs of
streaking or missing areas on the
windshield.
• Be sure your tires have enough
tread. If your tires do not have
enough tread, making a quick stop
on wet pavement can cause a skid
and possibly lead to an accident.
See "Tire Tread" in chapter 7.
• Turn on your headlights to make it
easier for others to see you.
• Driving too fast through large puddles can affect your brakes. If you
must go through puddles, try to
drive through them slowly.
NOTICE
If you are still stuck after rocking
the vehicle a few times, have the
vehicle pulled out by a tow vehicle
to avoid vehicle overheating, possible damage to the reduction
gear and tire damage. See
"Towing" in chapter 6.
Driving at Night
Night driving presents more hazards
than driving in the daylight. Here are
some important tips to remember:
• Slow down and keep more distance between you and other vehicles, as it may be more difficult to
see at night, especially in areas
where there may not be any street
lights.
• Adjust your mirrors to reduce the
glare from other driver's headlights.
• Keep your headlights clean and
properly aimed. Dirty or improperly
aimed headlights will make it much
more difficult to see at night.
• Avoid staring directly at the headlights of oncoming vehicles. You
could be temporarily blinded, and it
will take several seconds for your
eyes to readjust to the darkness.
5-119
5
Driving your vehicle
Smooth Cornering
Driving your vehicle
• If you believe your brakes may be
wet, apply them lightly while driving until normal braking operation
returns.
Hydroplaning
If the road is wet enough and you are
going fast enough, your vehicle may
have little or no contact with the road
surface and actually ride on the
water. The best advice is SLOW
DOWN when the road is wet.
The risk of hydroplaning increases as the depth of tire tread
decreases, refer to "Tire Tread" in
chapter 7.
Driving in Flooded Areas
Avoid driving through flooded areas
unless you are sure the water is no
higher than the bottom of the wheel
hub. Drive through any water slowly.
Allow adequate stopping distance
because brake performance may be
reduced.
After driving through water, dry the
brakes by gently applying them several times while the vehicle is moving
slowly.
Highway Driving
Tires
Adjust the tire inflation, as specified.
Under-inflation may overheat or
damage the tires.
Do not install worn-out or damaged
tires, which may reduce traction or
fail the braking operation.
i Information
Never over-inflate your tires above the
maximum inflation pressure, as specified on your tires.
Coolant and high voltage battery
Be sure to check both the coolant
level and the high voltage battery
level before driving.
5-120
Reducing the Risk of a
Rollover
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than
other types of vehicles. To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
• Take corners at slower speeds
than you would with a passenger vehicle.
• Avoid sharp turns and abrupt
maneuvers.
• Do not modify your vehicle in
any way that you would raise
the center of gravity.
• Keep tires properly inflated.
• Do not carry heavy cargo on
the roof.
5
Driving your vehicle
Your multi-purpose passenger vehicle is defined as a Sports Utility
Vehicle (SUV). SUV's have higher
ground clearance and a narrower
track to make them capable of performing in a wide variety of off-road
applications. The specific design
characteristics give them a higher
center of gravity than ordinary vehicles making them more likely to roll
over if you make abrupt turns. Utility
vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles. Due to this risk, driver and passengers are strongly recommended
to buckle their seat belts. In a rollover
crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.
There are steps that a driver can
make to reduce the risk of a rollover.
If at all possible, avoid sharp turns or
abrupt maneuvers, do not load your
vehicle with heavy cargo on the roof,
and never modify your vehicle in any
way.
WARNING
5-121
Driving your vehicle
WINTER DRIVING
The severe weather conditions of
winter quickly wear out tires and
cause other problems. To minimize
winter driving problems, you should
take the following suggestions:
Snow or Icy Conditions
You need to keep sufficient distance
between your vehicle and the vehicle
in front of you.
Apply the brakes gently. Speeding,
rapid acceleration, sudden brake
applications, and sharp turns are
potentially very hazardous practices.
During deceleration, use regenerative braking to the fullest extent.
Sudden brake applications on snowy
or icy roads may cause the vehicle to
skid.
To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it
may be necessary to use snow tires
or to install tire chains on your tires.
Always carry emergency equipment.
Some of the items you may want to
carry include tire chains, tow straps
or chains, a flashlight, emergency
flares, sand, a shovel, jumper cables,
a window scraper, gloves, ground
cloth, coveralls, a blanket, etc.
5-122
Snow tires
Air cleaner filter (FCEV)
WARNING
Snow tires should be equivalent
in size and type to the vehicle's
standard tires. Otherwise, the
safety and handling of your
vehicle may be adversely affected.
If you mount snow tires on your vehicle, make sure to use radial tires of
the same size and load range as the
original tires. Mount snow tires on all
four wheels to balance your vehicle’s
handling in all weather conditions.
The traction provided by snow tires
on dry roads may not be as high as
your vehicle's original equipment
tires. Check with the tire dealer for
maximum speed recommendations.
i Information
Do not install studded tires without
first checking local, state and municipal regulations for possible restrictions against their use.
The snow may block the air cleaner
filter after driving the vehicle in heavy
snow when the ambient temperature
is below 50°F (10°C).
If a warning message "Air filter
blocked. Check filter or see user
manual" appears on LCD display
after turning off the vehicle, remove
the snow from the inside of the air
cleaner filter and turn on and off the
vehicle. If the warning message is
displayed again, the exhaust pipe
may be blocked. Then, move your
vehicle indoors and leave it inside
more than one day to defrost the
exhaust pipe.
If the warning message is displayed
again, have the vehicle checked by
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Tire chains
WARNING
OFE058102
i Information
• Install tire chains only in pairs and
on the front tires. It should be noted
that installing tire chains on the
tires will provide a greater driving
force, but will not prevent side
skids.
• Do not install studded tires without
first checking local, state and
municipal regulations for possible
restrictions against their use.
5-123
5
Driving your vehicle
Since the sidewalls of radial tires are
thinner than other types of tires, they
may be damaged by mounting some
types of tire chains on them.
Therefore, the use of snow tires is
recommended instead of tire chains.
Do not mount tire chains on vehicles
equipped with aluminum wheels; if
possible use a wire type chain. If tire
chains must be used, use genuine
HYUNDAI parts and install the tire
chain after reviewing the instructions
provided with the tire chains.
Damage to your vehicle caused by
improper tire chain use is not covered by your vehicle manufacturer’s
warranty.
The use of tire chains may
adversely affect vehicle handling:
• Drive less than 20 mph (30
km/h) or the chain manufacturer's recommended speed
limit, whichever is lower.
• Drive carefully and avoid
bumps, holes, sharp turns,
and other road hazards, which
may cause the vehicle to
bounce.
• Avoid sharp turns or locked
wheel braking.
Chain Installation
When installing tire chains, follow the
manufacturer's instructions and
mount them as tightly possible. Drive
slowly (less than 20 mph (30 km/h))
with chains installed. If you hear the
chains contacting the body or chassis, stop and tighten them. If they still
make contact, slow down until the
noise stops. Remove the tire chains
as soon as you begin driving on
cleared roads.
When mounting snow chains, park
the vehicle on level ground away
from traffic. Turn on the vehicle
Hazard Warning Flasher and place a
triangular emergency warning device
behind the vehicle (if available).
Always place the vehicle in P (Park),
apply the parking brake and turn off
the vehicle before installing snow
chains.
Driving your vehicle
NOTICE
When using tire chains:
• Wrong size chains or improperly
installed chains can damage
your vehicle's brake lines, suspension, body and wheels.
• Use SAE "S" class or wire
chains.
• If you hear noise caused by
chains contacting the body,
retighten the chain to prevent
contact with the vehicle body.
• To prevent body damage,
retighten the chains after driving
0.3~0.6 miles (0.5~1.0 km).
• Do not use tire chains on vehicles equipped with aluminum
wheels. If unavoidable, use a
wire type chain.
• Use wire chains less than 0.47 in
(12 mm) thick to prevent damage
to the chain's connection.
5-124
Winter Precautions
Use high quality ethylene glycol
coolant
Your vehicle is delivered with high
quality ethylene glycol coolant in the
cooling system. It is the only type of
coolant that should be used because
it helps prevent corrosion in the cooling system, lubricates the water
pump and prevents freezing. Be sure
to replace or replenish your coolant
in accordance with the maintenance
schedule in chapter 7. Before winter,
have your coolant tested to assure
that its freezing point is sufficient for
the temperatures anticipated during
the winter.
Use approved window washer
anti-freeze in system
To keep the water in the window
washer system from freezing, add an
approved window washer anti-freeze
solution in accordance with instructions on the container. Window washer anti-freeze is available from an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer and
most auto parts outlets. Do not use
coolant or other types of anti-freeze
as these may damage the paint finish.
Do not let your parking brake
freeze
Under some conditions your parking
brake can freeze in the engaged
position. This is most likely to happen
when there is an accumulation of
snow or ice around or near the rear
brakes or if the brakes are wet. If
there is a risk the parking brake may
freeze, apply it only temporarily while
you shift to P (Park) and block the
rear wheels so the car cannot roll.
Then release the parking brake.
Do not let ice and snow accumulate underneath
Under some conditions, snow and
ice can build up under the fenders
and interfere with the steering. When
driving in severe winter conditions
where this may happen, you should
periodically check underneath the
car to be sure the movement of the
front wheels and the steering components is not obstructed.
To keep locks from freezing
To keep the locks from freezing,
squirt an approved de-icer fluid or
glycerine into the key opening. If a
lock is covered with ice, squirt it with
an approved de-icing fluid to remove
the ice. If the lock is frozen internally,
you may be able to thaw it out by
using a heated key. Handle the heated key with care to avoid injury.
Don't place foreign objects or
materials in the fuel cell power
module compartment
5
Driving your vehicle
Placement of foreign object or materials which prevent cooling of the
vehicle, in the fuel cell power module
compartment, may cause a failure.
The manufacturer is not responsible
for the damage caused by such
placement.
5-125
Driving your vehicle
VEHICLE LOAD LIMIT
Two labels on your driver's door sill
show how much weight your vehicle
was designed to carry: the Tire and
Loading Information Label and the
Certification Label.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms
for determining your vehicle's weight
ratings, from the vehicle's specifications and the Certification Label:
Base Curb Weight
This is the weight of the vehicle
including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not
include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight
This is the weight of your new vehicle
when you picked it up from your dealer plus any aftermarket equipment.
Cargo Weight
This figure includes all weight added
to the Base Curb Weight, including
cargo and optional equipment.
5-126
GAW (Gross Axle Weight)
This is the total weight placed on
each axle (front and rear) - including
vehicle curb weight and all payload.
Tire Loading Information Label
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
This is the maximum allowable
weight that can be carried by a single
axle (front or rear). These numbers
are shown on the Certification Label.
The total load on each axle must
never exceed its GAWR.
OFE068027N
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
This is the Base Curb Weight plus
actual Cargo Weight plus passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating)
This is the maximum allowable
weight of the fully loaded vehicle
(including all options, equipment,
passengers and cargo). The GVWR
is shown on the Certification Label
located on the driver’s door sill.
OFE068028N
The label located on the driver's door
sill gives the original tire size, cold
tire pressures recommended for your
vehicle, the number of people that
can be in your vehicle and vehicle
capacity weight.
Vehicle capacity weight
903 lbs. (410 kg)
Vehicle capacity weight is the maximum combined weight of occupants
and cargo. If your vehicle is equipped
with a trailer, the combined weight
includes the tongue load.
Seating capacity
Total : 5 persons
(Front seat : 2 persons,
Rear seat : 3 persons)
Seating capacity is the maximum
number of occupants including a
driver, your vehicle may carry.
However, the seating capacity may
be reduced based upon the weight of
all of the occupants, and the weight
of the cargo being carried or towed.
Do not overload the vehicle as there
is a limit to the total weight, or load
limit including occupants and cargo,
the vehicle can carry.
We do not recommend using this
vehicle for trailer towing.
Cargo capacity
The cargo capacity of your vehicle
will increase or decrease depending
on the weight and the number of
occupants and the tongue load, if
your vehicle is equipped with a trailer.
1. Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX
kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle's
placard.
2. Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will
be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of
the driver and passengers from
XXX kg or XXX lbs.
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
the "XXX" amount equals 1400
lbs. and there will be five 150 lb
passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs.
(1400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded
on the vehicle. That weight may
not safely exceed the available
cargo and luggage load capacity
calculated in Step 4.
5-127
5
Driving your vehicle
Towing capacity
Steps for determining correct
load limit
Driving your vehicle
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult
this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
WARNING
Do not overload the vehicle as
there is a limit to the total
weight, or load limit, including
occupants and cargo, the vehicle can carry. Overloading can
shorten the life of the vehicle. If
the GVWR or the GAWR is
exceeded, parts on the vehicle
can be broken, and it can
change the handling of your
vehicle. These could cause you
to lose control and result in an
accident.
5-128
Example 1
≥
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
+
Cargo Weight
(1100 lbs.)
(499 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 2 = 300 lbs.)
(68 kg × 2 = 136 kg)
Example 2
≥
5
Cargo Weight
(650 lbs.)
(295 kg)
Passenger Weight
(150 lbs. × 5 = 750 lbs.)
(68 kg × 5 = 340 kg)
Driving your vehicle
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
+
Example 3
≥
Maximum Load
(1400 lbs.)
(635 kg)
+
Passenger Weight
(172 lbs. × 5 = 860 lbs.)
(78 kg × 5 = 390 kg)
Cargo Weight
(540 lbs.)
(245 kg)
5-129
Driving your vehicle
Certification label
The total weight of the vehicle,
including all occupants, accessories,
cargo, and trailer tongue load must
not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight
Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle
Weight Rating (GAWR). To find out
the actual loads on your front and
rear axles, you need to go to a weigh
station and weigh your vehicle. Be
sure to spread out your load equally
on both sides of the centerline.
OBH059070
The certification label is located on
the driver’s door sill at the center pillar and shows the maximum allowable weight of the fully loaded vehicle. This is called the GVWR (Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating). The GVWR
includes the weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, fuel and cargo.
This label also tells you the maximum weight that can be supported
by the front and rear axles, called
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).
5-130
WARNING
Overloading
• Never exceed the GVWR for
your vehicle, the GAWR for
either the front or rear axle
and vehicle capacity weight.
Exceeding these ratings can
affect your vehicle’s handling
and braking ability, and cause
an accident.
• Do not overload your vehicle.
Overloading your vehicle can
cause heat buildup in your
vehicle’s tires and possible
tire failure, increased stopping distances and poor vehicle handling-all of which may
result in a crash.
TRAILER TOWING
NOTICE
Overloading your vehicle may
cause damage. Repairs would not
be covered by your warranty. Do
not overload your vehicle.
WARNING
We do not recommend using this
vehicle for trailer towing.
If you carry items inside your
vehicle (for example, suitcases,
tools, packages, or anything
else), they are moving as fast as
the vehicle. If you have to stop
or turn quickly, or if there is a
crash, the items will keep going
and can cause an injury if they
strike the driver or a passenger.
• Put items in the cargo area of
your vehicle. Try to spread the
weight evenly.
• Do not stack items like suitcases inside the vehicle
above the tops of the seats.
• Do not leave an unsecured
child restraint in your vehicle.
• When you carry something
inside the vehicle, secure it.
5
Driving your vehicle
5-131
What to do in an emergency
Hazard Warning Flasher .......................................6-2
In Case of an Emergency While Driving.............6-2
If an accident occurs........................................................6-2
If a fire occurs ...................................................................6-3
Emergency venting of hydrogen gas...........................6-3
If a submersion in water occurs....................................6-3
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing.........6-3
If you have a flat tire while driving..............................6-4
If the vehicle stalls while driving...................................6-4
If You Have a Flat Tire
(With Tire Mobility Kit).......................................6-17
Towing ...................................................................6-24
Towing Service.................................................................6-24
Removable Towing Hook ...............................................6-25
Emergency Towing..........................................................6-26
If the Vehicle Will Not Start .................................6-4
If the 12 Volt Battery is Discharged ...................6-5
Before Jump Starting .......................................................6-5
Jump Starting......................................................................6-6
If the Vehicle Overheats .......................................6-9
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS).......6-11
Check Tire Pressure .......................................................6-11
Tire Pressure Monitoring System...............................6-12
Low Tire Pressure Telltale ............................................6-13
Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position
Indicator.............................................................................6-13
TPMS Malfunction Indicator ........................................6-14
Changing a Tire with TPMS..........................................6-15
6
What to do in an emergency
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
To turn the hazard warning flasher
on or off, press the hazard warning
flasher button. The button is located
in the center fascia panel. Both the
left and right turn signal lights will
flash simultaneously.
• The hazard warning flasher operates whether your vehicle is running or not.
• The turn signals do not work when
the hazard flasher is on.
OFE068001
The hazard warning flasher serves
as a warning to other drivers to exercise extreme caution when approaching, overtaking, or passing your vehicle.
It should be used whenever emergency repairs are being made or
when the vehicle is stopped near the
edge of a roadway.
6-2
IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY
WHILE DRIVING
If an accident occurs
1. Stop the vehicle, shift gear to the
P (Park) position, engage the
parking brake, and turn the vehicle
off.
The flow of hydrogen into the fuel
cell stack will be shut off to prevent
the electricity from being generated.
2. Evacuate to the safety place.
3. Call emergency services for help
and let them know the vehicle is a
Fuel Cell Electric Vehicle.
If a fire occurs
WARNING
Do not use water to extinguish a
fire when the vehicle power is
turned on. Serious electric
shock may result.
Emergency venting of hydrogen gas
If the temperature near the safety
valve located at the rear under vehicle is over 230°F (110°C) caused by
a fire or other reasons, the safety
valve will open to vent hydrogen gas.
Venting the hydrogen gas makes a
loud noise because the venting
speed is very fast. Stay well away
from the vehicle. The discharge of
hydrogen gas from the vehicle is
flammable and could cause a fire.
If a submersion in water
occurs
If your vehicle was flooded and has
soaked carpeting or water on the
flooring, you should not try to start
the vehicle by pressing the POWER
button.
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer immediately.
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or
crossing, set the gear in the N
(Neutral) position and then push the
vehicle to a safe place.
6-3
What to do in an emergency
1. Stop the vehicle, shift gear to the
P(Park) position, engage the parking brake, and turn the vehicle off.
The flow of hydrogen into the fuel
cell stack will be shut off to prevent
the electricity from being generated.
2. If the fire is small, which can be
extinguished with fire extinguisher,
use carbon dioxide extinguisher.
You can also extinguish the fire
with water when the vehicle power
is turned off.
If the fire is too big to be extinguished with the fire extinguisher,
evacuate from the vehicle, call the
fire department, and let them know
the vehicle is a Fuel Cell Electric
Vehicle. Do not come close to the
vehicle until the fire is totally extinguished.
6
What to do in an emergency
If you have a flat tire while
driving
If the vehicle stalls while driving
If a tire goes flat while you are driving:
1. Take your foot off the accelerator
pedal and let the vehicle slow
down while driving straight ahead.
Do not apply the brakes immediately or attempt to pull off the road
as this may cause a loss of control. When the vehicle has slowed
to such a speed that it is safe to do
so, brake carefully and pull off the
road. Drive off the road as far as
possible and park on firm, level
ground. If you are on a divided
highway, do not park in the median area between the two traffic
lanes.
2. When the vehicle is stopped, turn
on your emergency hazard flashers, set the parking brake and shift
gear to the P(Park) position.
3. Have all passengers get out of the
vehicle. Be sure they all get out on
the side of the vehicle that is away
from traffic.
1. Reduce your speed gradually,
keeping a straight line. Move cautiously off the road to a safe place.
2. Turn on your emergency flashers.
3. Try to start the vehicle again. If
your vehicle will not start, contact
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-4
IF THE VEHICLE WILL NOT
START
• Be sure the shift lever is in P
(Park). The vehicle starts only
when the shift lever is in P (Park).
• This vehicle does not have a regular 12V battery that needs periodic
replacement. It is lithium ion polymer type integrated into the high
voltage battery. The vehicle has a
12V battery protection system that
cuts 12V battery from vehicle draw
to prevent full discharge. If vehicle
will not start, first try pressing the
12V Battery Reset switch (left side
of the steering wheel near the fuel
door open switch) to reconnect the
12V battery, but you must start
vehicle within 15 seconds of pressing the 12V Battery Reset switch.
After starting vehicle, operate the
vehicle safely outdoors in ready
mode stopped and/or drive it for 30
minutes total to charge the 12V
battery fully.
• Check the fuel level and add fuel if
necessary.
• Do not push or pull the vehicle to
start it.
If the vehicle still does not start, call
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for
assistance.
IF THE 12 VOLT BATTERY IS DISCHARGED
Before Jump Starting
OFEQ019028L
1. Press the 12V Battery Reset
switch to reconnect the 12V battery.
2. Start the vehicle within 15 seconds of pressing the 12V Battery
Reset switch.
3. After starting vehicle (
indicator on), move the vehicle outside
and keep the vehicle ready (
)
mode more than 30 minutes safely to charge the 12V battery.
If you do not start the vehicle immediately after pressing the 12V Battery
Reset switch, the power of 12V battery is automatically disconnected
after few seconds to save the 12V
battery from additional discharge. If
the 12V battery is disconnected prior
to starting the vehicle, press the 12V
Battery Reset switch again and then
immediately start the vehicle as
explained.
Repeated use of the 12V Battery
Reset switch without a sufficient
vehicle ON cycle (30 Min+) may
cause over discharge of the 12V battery, which will prevent the vehicle
from starting. If the 12V battery is
over discharged to a point that the
reset does not work, try to jump-start
the vehicle.
i Information
After starting the vehicle (
indicator on), the 12V battery is being
charged whether the accelerator pedal
is depressed or not.
6-5
What to do in an emergency
This vehicle does not have a regular
12V battery that needs periodic
replacement. It is lithium ion polymer
type integrated into the high voltage
battery. The vehicle has a 12V battery protection system that cuts 12V
battery from vehicle draw to prevent
full discharge.
Using the 12V Battery Reset
Switch
6
What to do in an emergency
The following items may need to be
reset after the battery has been discharged or the battery has been disconnected. See chapter 3 or 4 for:
• Power Windows
• Trip Computer
• Climate Control System
• Clock
• Audio System
• Sunroof
• Driver Position Memory System
NOTICE
External power source using 12V
battery
The use of external power accessories may reduce performance
and function of the vehicle.
Especially, the use of dash cameras may shut off the power of the
vehicle prior to the dash camera's
automatic shut-down.
If the power of the vehicle is shut
off, start the vehicle as explained.
(refer to "Using the 12V Battery
Switch")
6-6
Jump Starting
In the event vehicle still does not
have a functional 12V battery (check
if interior lights will not turn on) then
you can try a jump start using a 12V
booster pack or jumper cables from
another vehicle's 12V battery
according to the following instructions.
CAUTION
Jump starting can be dangerous if done incorrectly. Follow
the jump starting procedure in
this section to avoid serious
injury or damage to your vehicle. If in doubt about how to
properly jump start your vehicle, we strongly recommend
that you have a service technician or towing service do it for
you.
1. Position the vehicles close enough
that the jumper cables will reach,
but do not allow the vehicles to
touch.
2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in
the fuel cell power module compartment at all times, even when
the vehicles are turned off.
3. Turn off all electrical devices such
as radios, lights, air conditioning,
etc. Put the vehicles in P (Park)
and set the parking brake. Turn
both vehicles OFF.
CAUTION
Before jump starting, make sure
to correctly identify the positive
(+) and negative (-) terminals to
avoid reverse polarity connections.
WARNING
OFE068003N
4. Connect the jumper cables in the
exact sequence shown in the illustration. First connect one jumper
cable to the red, positive (+)
jumper terminal of your vehicle
(1).
5. Connect the other end of the
jumper cable to the red, positive
(+) battery/jumper terminal of the
assisting vehicle (2).
Do not connect the jumper
cable to the negative (-) jumper
terminal of the discharged battery. A spark could cause the
battery to explode and lead to a
personal injury or vehicle damage.
OFEQ019028L
8. Press the 12V Battery Reset
switch.
9. Start the engine of the assisting
vehicle and let it run for a few minutes.
10. Start your vehicle as soon as
possible. After starting vehicle
(
indicator on), operate the
vehicle safely outdoors in ready
mode stopped and/or drive it for
30 minutes total to charge the
12V battery fully.
6-7
What to do in an emergency
6. Connect the second jumper cable
to the black, negative (-)
battery/jumper terminal of the
assisting vehicle (3).
7. Connect the other end of the second jumper cable to the black,
negative (-) chassis ground of
your vehicle (4).
Do not allow the jumper cables to
contact anything except the correct battery or jumper terminals or
the correct ground. Do not lean
over the battery when making
connections.
6
What to do in an emergency
If your vehicle will not start after a
few attempts, it probably requires
servicing. In this event please seek
qualified assistance. If the cause of
your battery discharging is not
apparent, have your vehicle checked
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
i Information
The voltage range of the charger
should be 13.3~14V and its current
range should be less than 60A. (13.8V
is recommended).
CAUTION
Disconnect the jumper cables in the
exact reverse order you connected
them:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from
the black, negative (-) chassis
ground of your vehicle (4).
2. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the black, negative (-) battery/chassis ground of
the assisting vehicle (3).
3. Disconnect the second jumper
cable from the red, positive (+)
battery/jumper terminal of the
assisting vehicle (2).
4. Disconnect the other end of the
jumper cable from the red, positive
(+) jumper terminal of your vehicle
(1).
6-8
• The use of an improper charger with a voltage and current
range higher than specified
may cause overheating and
damage to the 12V battery.
• The use of an incorrect charger will lead to a power shut-off
to save the 12V battery. Stop
using the incorrect charger
once the power of the vehicle
is shut off.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to your vehicle:
• Only use a 12-volt power supply
(battery or jumper system) to
jump start your vehicle.
• Do not attempt to jump start
your vehicle by push-starting.
CAUTION
Do not jump start another vehicle with your hybrid vehicle.
Jump starting another vehicle
will damage the hybrid vehicle’s
12 volt battery (lithium polymer
type).
WARNING
i Information
Pb
An inappropriately disposed
battery can be harmful to the
environment and human
health. Dispose of the battery
according to your local law(s)
or regulations.
While jump starting your vehicle, avoid the positive (+) and
negative (-) cables to come in
contact. A spark could cause
personal injury.
IF THE VEHICLE OVERHEATS
WARNING
While the vehicle is
running, keep hands,
clothing and tools
away from the moving parts such as the
cooling fan to prevent
serious injury.
4. Check for coolant leaking from the
radiator, hoses or under the vehicle. (If the air conditioning had
been in use, it is normal for cold
water to be draining from it when
you stop.)
5. If coolant is leaking out, stop the
vehicle immediately and call the
nearest authorized HYUNDAI
dealer for assistance.
WARNING
Your
vehicle
is
equipped with a pressurized
coolant
reserve tank. NEVER
remove the coolant
reserve tank cap or the radiator
drain plug while the radiator is
HOT. Hot coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure,
causing serious injury.
Turn the vehicle off and wait
until the vehicle cools down.
Use extreme care when removing the coolant reserve tank
cap. Wrap a towel or thick rag
around it, and turn it counterclockwise slowly to release
some of the pressure from the
system. Step back while the
pressure is released.
When you are sure all the pressure has been released, continue turning the cap counterclockwise to remove it.
6-9
What to do in an emergency
1. Pull off the road and stop as soon
as it is safe to do so.
2. Shift to P (Park) and set the parking brake. If the air conditioning is
on, turn it off.
3. If coolant is running out under the
vehicle or steam is coming out
from the hood, stop the vehicle.
Do not open the hood until the
coolant has stopped running or
the steaming has stopped. If there
is no visible loss of coolant and no
steam, leave the vehicle running
and check to be sure the vehicle
cooling fan is operating. If the fan
is not running, turn the vehicle off.
6
What to do in an emergency
6. If you cannot find the cause of the
overheating, wait until the radiator
temperature has returned to normal. Then, if coolant has been
lost, carefully add coolant to the
reservoir to bring the fluid level in
the reservoir up to the halfway
mark.
7. Proceed with caution, keeping
alert for further signs of overheating. If overheating happens again,
call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.
CAUTION
Serious loss of coolant indicates a leak in the cooling system and should be checked as
soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
6-10
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
Check Tire Pressure
OFE068004
OFE041121N
OFE061021N
(1) Low Tire Pressure / TPMS
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(2) Low Tire Pressure /
Tire Pressure Monitor /
TPMS Malfunction Display
(shown on the cluster LCD display)
• You can check the tire pressure in
the information mode on the cluster.
Refer to the "LCD Display Mode"
section in chapter 3.
• A "Drive to display" message will
appear for the first few minutes of
driving after initial vehicle start up.
If the tire pressure is not displayed
after a few minutes of driving,
check the tire pressures.
What to do in an emergency
• The displayed tire pressure values
may differ from those measured
with a tire pressure gage.
• You can change the tire pressure
unit in the General Settings mode
on the Infotainment system.
- psi, kpa, bar (For more details,
refer to the separately supplied
Navigation manual.)
6
6-11
What to do in an emergency
Tire Pressure Monitoring
System
WARNING
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and
lead to sudden tire failure that
may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly
when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. If
your vehicle has tires of a different
size than the size indicated on the
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should determine the
proper tire inflation pressure for
those tires.
6-12
As an added safety feature, your
vehicle has been equipped with a tire
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure
telltale when one or more of your
tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the
tire to overheat and can lead to tire
failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle's handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a
substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not
reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped
with a TPMS malfunction indicator to
indicate when the system is not
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure telltale. When
the system detects a malfunction,
the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence
will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator is
illuminated, the system may not be
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of
replacement or alternate tires or
wheels on the vehicle that prevent
the TPMS from functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more
tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
to continue to function properly.
NOTICE
Low Tire Pressure
LCD Display with
Position Indicator
OFE041115N
When the tire pressure monitoring
system warning indicators are illuminated and the warning message is
displayed on the cluster LCD display,
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. The LCD position indicator will indicate which tire
is significantly under-inflated by illuminating the corresponding position
light.
If any of your tire pressures are indicated as being low, immediately
reduce your speed, avoid hard cornering, and anticipate increased
stopping distances. You should stop
and check your tires as soon as possible. Inflate the tires to the proper
pressure as indicated on the vehicle’s placard or tire inflation pressure
label located on the driver's side center pillar outer panel.
The Low Tire Pressure LCD position
indicator will remain on and the
TPMS Malfunction Indicator may
blink for one minute and then remain
illuminated until you have the low
pressure tire repaired and replaced
on the vehicle.
6-13
What to do in an emergency
If any of the below happens, have
the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
1. The Low Tire Pressure TPMS
Malfunction Indicator does not
illuminate for 3 seconds when
the POWER button is placed to
the ON position or vehicle is ON
(
indicator ON).
2. The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
remains illuminated after blinking for approximately 1 minute.
3. The Low Tire Pressure LCD display remains illuminated
Low Tire Pressure
Telltale
6
What to do in an emergency
CAUTION
In winter or cold weather, the
Low Tire Pressure Telltale may
be illuminated if the tire pressure was adjusted to the recommended tire inflation pressure
in warm weather. It does not
mean your TPMS is malfunctioning because the decreased
temperature leads to a proportional lowering of tire pressure.
When you drive your vehicle
from a warm area to a cold area
or from a cold area to a warm
area, or the outside temperature
is greatly higher or lower, you
should check the tire inflation
pressure and adjust the tires to
the recommended tire inflation
pressure.
6-14
TPMS Malfunction
Indicator
WARNING
Low pressure damage
Significantly low tire pressure
makes the vehicle unstable and
can contribute to loss of vehicle
control and increased braking
distances.
Continued driving on low pressure tires can cause the tires to
overheat and fail.
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator will
illuminate after it blinks for approximately one minute when there is a
problem with the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System.
Have the system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon
as possible.
NOTICE
If there is a malfunction with the
TPMS, the individual tire pressures in the cluster LCD display
will not be available. Have the system checked by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.
NOTICE
If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire
Pressure and LCD position indicator
will come on. Have the flat tire
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
CAUTION
If the indicators do not disappear
after a few minutes, please visit an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Each wheel is equipped with a tire
pressure sensor mounted inside the
tire behind the valve stem. You must
use TPMS specific wheels. It is recommended that you always have
your tires serviced by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
Never use a puncture-repairing
agent not approved by HYUNDAI
dealer to repair and/or inflate a
low pressure tire. Tire sealant
not approved by HYUNDAI dealer may damage the tire pressure
sensor.
What to do in an emergency
The TPMS Malfunction Indicator
may illuminate after blinking for
one minute if the vehicle is near
electric power supply cables or
radio transmitters such as police
stations, government and public
offices, broadcasting stations,
military installations, airports,
transmitting towers, etc.
Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction
Indicator may illuminate if snow
chains are used or electronic
devices such as computers, chargers, remote starters, navigation,
etc. This may interfere with normal
operation of the TPMS.
Changing a Tire with TPMS
6
Once the original tire equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring sensor is
reinflated to the recommended pressure and reinstalled on the vehicle,
the Low Tire Pressure LCD position
indicator and TPMS Malfunction
Indicator will go off within a few minutes of driving.
6-15
What to do in an emergency
You may not be able identify a tire
with low pressure by simply looking
at it. Always use a good quality tire
pressure gage to measure the tire's
inflation pressure. Please note that a
tire that is hot (from being driven) will
have a higher pressure measurement than a tire that is cold.
A cold tire means the vehicle has
been sitting for 3 hours and driven for
less than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3
hour period.
Allow the tire to cool before measuring the inflation pressure. Always be
sure the tire is cold before inflating to
the recommended pressure.
WARNING
• The TPMS cannot alert you to
severe and sudden tire damage caused by external factors such as nails or road
debris.
• If you feel any vehicle instability, immediately take your foot
off the accelerator, apply the
brakes gradually with light
force, and slowly move to a
safe position off the road.
WARNING
Tampering with, modifying, or
disabling the Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)
components may interfere with
the system's ability to warn the
driver of low tire pressure conditions and/or TPMS malfunctions. Tampering with, modifying, or disabling the Tire
Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) components may void
the warranty for that portion of
the vehicle.
6-16
i Information
This device complies with Part 15 of
the FCC rules.
Operation is subject to the following
three conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful
interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
3. Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user's authority to operate
the equipment.
IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE (WITH TIRE MOBILITY KIT)
The Tire Mobility Kit is a temporary fix
to the tire and the tire should be
inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer as soon as possible.
OFE068014
For safe operation, carefully read
and follow the instructions in this
manual before use.
(1) Compressor
(2) Sealant bottle
When two or more tires are flat,
do not use the tire mobility kit
because the sealant provided
with the Tire Mobility Kit must
be used for only one flat tire.
Have your tire repaired as soon
as possible. The tire may lose
air pressure at any time after
inflating with the Tire Mobility
Kit.
WARNING
What to do in an emergency
CAUTION
WARNING
6
Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit
to repair punctures in the tire
walls. This can result in an accident due to tire failure.
6-17
What to do in an emergency
Introduction
With the Tire Mobility Kit you stay
mobile even after experiencing a tire
puncture.
The compressor and sealing compound system effectively and comfortably seals most punctures in a
passenger car tire caused by nails
or similar objects and reinflates the
tire.
After you ensure that the tire is properly sealed you can drive cautiously
on the tire (distance up to 120 miles
(200 km)) at a max. speed of (50
mph (80 km/h)) in order to reach a
service station or tire dealer for the
tire replacement.
It is possible that some tires, especially with larger punctures or damage to the sidewall, cannot be sealed
completely.
Air pressure loss in the tire may
adversely affect tire performance.
For this reason, you should avoid
abrupt steering or other driving
maneuvers, especially if the vehicle
is heavily loaded or if a trailer is in
use.
6-18
The Tire Mobility Kit is not designed
or intended as a permanent tire
repair method and is to be used for
one tire only.
This instruction shows you step by
step how to temporarily seal the
puncture simply and reliably.
Read the section "Notes on the safe
use of the Tire Mobility Kit".
Notes on the safe use of the
Tire Mobility Kit
• Park your car at the side of the
road so that you can work with the
Tire Mobility Kit away from moving
traffic.
• To be sure your vehicle will not
move, even when you're on fairly
level ground, always set your parking brake.
• Only use the Tire Mobility Kit for
sealing/inflation passenger car
tires. Only punctured areas located
within the tread region of the tire
can be sealed using the tire mobility kit.
• Do not use on motorcycles, bicycles or any other type of tires.
• When the tire and wheel are damaged, do not use Tire Mobility Kit
for your safety.
• Use of the Tire Mobility Kit may not
be effective for tire damage larger
than approximately 0.16 in. (4
mm).
Please contact the nearest
HYUNDAI dealership if the tire
cannot be made roadworthy with
the Tire Mobility Kit.
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if a
tire is severely damaged by driving
run flat or with insufficient air pressure.
• Do not remove any foreign objects
such as nails or screws that have
penetrated the tire.
• Provided the car is outdoors, leave
the vehicle ON (
indicator ON).
Otherwise operating the compressor may eventually drain the car
battery.
• Never leave the Tire Mobility Kit
unattended while it is being used.
• Do not leave the compressor running for more than 10 minutes at a
time or it may overheat.
Components of the Tire Mobility Kit
What to do in an emergency
• Do not use the Tire Mobility Kit if
the ambient temperature is below
-22°F (-30°C).
• In case of skin contact with thesealant, wash the area thoroughlywith plenty of water. If the irritationpersists, seek medical attention.
• In case of eye contact with the
sealant,flush your eyes for at least
15 minutes. If the irritation persists,
seek medical attention.
• In case of swallowing the
sealant,rinse the mouth and drink
plenty ofwater. However, never give
anythingto an unconscious person
and seek medical attention immediately.
• Long time exposure to the sealantmay cause damage to bodily tissue
such as kidney, etc.
6
ODE067044
1. Speed restriction label
2. Sealant bottle and label with
speed restriction
3. Sealant/Air filling hose
4. Connectors and cable for power
outlet direct connection
5.
6.
7.
8.
Holder for the sealant bottle
Compressor
ON/OFF switch
Pressure gauge for displaying the
tire inflation pressure
9. Button for reducing tire inflation
pressure
6-19
What to do in an emergency
Connectors, cable and connection
hose are stored in the compressor
housing.
Using the Tire Mobility Kit
CAUTION
Strictly follow the specified sequence,
otherwise the sealant may escape
under high pressure.
WARNING
Do not use the tire sealant after
the sealant has expired (for
example, pasted the expiration
date on the sealant container).
This can increase the risk of tire
failure.
WARNING
• Keep out of reach of children.
• Avoid contact with eyes.
• Do not swallow.
ONE1081031
OFE068010
Detach the speed restriction
label (1) from the sealant bottle
(2), and place it in a highly visible place inside the vehicle
such as on the steering wheel
to remind the driver not to drive
too fast.
1. Shake the sealant bottle (2).
6-20
2. Connect the filling hose (3) to the
sealant bottle (2) in the direction of
(A) and connect the sealant bottle
to the compressor (6) in the direction of (B).
3. Ensure that the compressor is
switched OFF.
CAUTION
OFE068015
OFE068016
4. Unscrew the valve cap from the
valve of the defective wheel and
screw the filling hose (3) of the
sealant bottle onto the valve.
5. Plug the compressor power cord
(4) into the vehicle power outlet.
6. With the vehicle ON (
indicator ON), switch on the compressor
and let it run for approximately
5~7 minutes to fill the sealant up
to proper pressure. (refer to the
Tire and Wheels, chapter 8). The
inflation pressure of the tire after
filling is unimportant and will be
checked/corrected later.
Be careful not to overinflate the
tire and stay away from the tire
when filling it.
CAUTION
Securely install the sealant filling hose to the valve. If not,
sealant may flow backward,
possibly clogging the filling
hose.
7. Switch off the compressor.
8. Detach the hoses from the sealant
bottle connector and from the tire
valve.
Return the Tire Mobility Kit to its storage location in the vehicle.
What to do in an emergency
Do not attempt to drive your
vehicle if the tire pressure is
below 29 psi (200 kpa). This
could result in an accident due
to sudden tire failure.
6
6-21
What to do in an emergency
10. After driving approximately 4~6
miles (7~10 km or about
10 minutes), stop at a safe location.
OLMF064106
OFE068015
Distributing the sealant
9. Immediately drive approximately
4~6 miles (7~10 km or about 10
minutes) to evenly distribute the
sealant in the tire.
Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph
(80 km/h). If possible, do not fall
below a speed of 12 mph (20 km/h).
While driving, if you experience any
unusual vibration, ride disturbance or
noise, reduce your speed and drive
with caution until you can safely pull
off of the side of the road.
11. Connect the other end of the filling hose (3) directly into the tire
valve.
12. Plug the compressor power cord
into the vehicle power outlet.
6-22
OAEPH067042
- To increase the inflation pressure:
Switch on the compressor. To
check the current inflation pressure setting, briefly switch off
the compressor.
- To reduce the inflation pressure:
Press the button (9) on the
compressor.
i Information
The pressure gauge may show higher
than actual reading when the compressor is running. To get an accurate
tire pressure, the compressor needs to
be turned off.
CAUTION
When you use the Tire Mobility Kit
including sealant not approved by
HYUNDAI, the tire pressure sensors may be damaged by sealant.
The sealant on the tire pressure
sensor and wheel should be
removed when you replace the
tire with a new one and inspect
the tire pressure sensors at an
authorized dealer.
i Information
When reinstalling the repaired or
replaced tire and wheel on the vehicle,
tighten the wheel lug nut to 79~94
lbf·ft (11~13 kgf·m).
WARNING
What to do in an emergency
13. Adjust the tire inflation pressure
to the recommended tire inflation.
With the vehicle ON (
indicator ON), on, proceed as follows.
6
The tire inflation pressure must
be at least 32 psi (220 kPa). If it
is not, do not continue driving.
Call for road side service or
towing.
6-23
What to do in an emergency
TOWING
It is acceptable to tow the vehicle
with the rear wheels on the ground
(without dollies) and the front wheels
off the ground. If any of the loaded
wheels or suspension components
are damaged or the vehicle is being
towed with the front wheels on the
ground, use a towing dolly under the
front wheels.
When being towed by a commercial
tow truck and wheel dollies are not
used, the front of the vehicle should
always be lifted, not the rear.
Towing Service
NOTICE
• Do not tow the vehicle with the
front wheels on the ground as
this may cause damage to the
vehicle.
OFE068026
• Do not tow with sling-type
equipment. Use a wheel lift or
flatbed equipment.
OFE068017N
[A] : Dollies
If emergency towing is necessary,
have it done by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial
tow-truck service. Proper lifting and
towing procedures are necessary to
prevent damage to the vehicle. The
use of wheel dollies or flatbed is recommended.
6-24
OFE068025
WARNING
When towing your vehicle in an
emergency without wheel dollies:
1. Place the POWER button in the
ACC position.
2. Place the shift button in N
(Neutral).
3. Release the parking brake.
1. Open the liftgate, and remove the
towing hook from the tool case.
■ Front
2. Remove the hole cover by pressing the lower part of the cover on
the front or rear bumper.
3. Install the towing hook by turning it
clockwise into the hole until it is
fully secured.
4. Remove the towing hook and
install the cover after use.
OFE068018
■ Rear
6
CAUTION
Failure to place the shift button
in N (Neutral) when being towed
with the front wheels on the
ground can cause internal damage to the vehicle.
What to do in an emergency
If your vehicle is equipped with
a rollover sensor, place the
POWER button in the LOCK/
OFF or ACC position when the
vehicle is being towed. The side
impact and curtain air bag may
deploy if the sensor detects the
situation as a rollover.
Removable Towing Hook
OFE068019
6-25
What to do in an emergency
Emergency Towing
■ Front
OFE068018
■ Rear
OFE068019
If towing is necessary, have it done
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or
a commercial tow truck service.
6-26
If towing service is not available in an
emergency, your vehicle may be
temporarily towed using a cable or
chain secured to the emergency towing hook at the front (or rear) of the
vehicle.
Use extreme caution when towing
the vehicle with a cable or chain. A
driver must be in the vehicle to steer
it and operate the brakes.
Towing in this manner may be done
only on hard-surfaced roads for a
short distance and at low speeds.
Also, the wheels, axles, power train,
steering and brakes must all be in
good condition.
Always follow these emergency towing precautions:
• While depressing the brake pedal
shift to the N (Neutral) position and
turn the vehicle off. The POWER
button will be in the ACC position.
• Release the parking brake.
• Depress the brake pedal with more
force than normal since you will
have reduced braking performance.
• More steering effort will be
required because the power steering system will be disabled.
• Use a vehicle heavier than your
own to tow your vehicle.
• The drivers of both vehicles should
communicate with each other frequently.
• Before emergency towing, check
that the hook is not broken or damaged.
• Fasten the towing cable or chain
securely to the hook.
• Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady
and even force.
NOTICE
CAUTION
NOTICE
OFE068022
• Use a towing cable or chain less
than 16 feet (5 m) long. Attach a
white or red cloth (about 12 inch
(30 cm) wide) in the middle of the
cable or chain for easy visibility.
• Drive carefully so the towing cable
or chain remains tight during towing.
• Before towing, check the reduction
gear for fluid leaks under your vehicle. If the reduction gear is leaking,
flatbed equipment or a towing dolly
must be used.
To avoid damage to your vehicle
and vehicle components when
towing:
• Always pull straight ahead when
using the towing hooks. Do not
pull from the side or at a vertical
angle.
• Do not use the towing hooks to
pull a vehicle out of mud, sand
or other conditions from which
the vehicle cannot be driven out
under its own power.
• Limit the vehicle speed to
10 mph (15 km/h) and drive less
than 1 mile (1.5 km) when towing
to avoid serious damage to the
reduction gear.
6-27
What to do in an emergency
Accelerate or decelerate the vehicle in a slow and gradual manner
while maintaining tension on the
tow rope or chain to start or drive
the vehicle, otherwise tow hooks
and the vehicle may be damaged.
The driver must be in the vehicle for steering and braking
operations when the vehicle is
being towed. Passengers other
than the driver must not be in
the vehicle.
6
Maintenance
Fuel cell power module compartment.................7-3
Maintenance services ...........................................7-4
Owner's Responsibility.....................................................7-4
Owner Maintenance Precautions..................................7-4
Wiper blades .........................................................7-24
Blade Inspection ..............................................................7-24
Blade Replacement .........................................................7-24
12V battery ...........................................................7-27
Battery recharging .........................................................7-28
Reset Features.................................................................7-28
Scheduled maintenance services.........................7-7
Tires and wheels ..................................................7-29
Normal Maintenance Schedule ......................................7-8
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions ........7-10
Tire Care............................................................................7-29
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures...........7-30
Check Tire Inflation Pressure ......................................7-31
Tire Rotation.....................................................................7-32
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ............................7-33
Tire Replacement ............................................................7-33
Wheel Replacement ........................................................7-34
Tire Traction .....................................................................7-34
Tire Maintenance ............................................................7-34
Tire Sidewall Labeling ....................................................7-34
Tire Terminology and Definitions................................7-38
All Season Tires...............................................................7-42
Summer Tires ...................................................................7-42
Snow Tires ........................................................................7-42
Radial-Ply Tires ...............................................................7-42
Low Aspect Ratio Tires..................................................7-43
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.7-12
Device cooling coolant ........................................7-13
Checking the Coolant Level..........................................7-13
Changing Coolant ............................................................7-15
Stack cooling coolant..........................................7-16
Checking the Coolant Level..........................................7-16
Changing Coolant ............................................................7-18
Brake fluid ............................................................7-19
Checking the Brake Fluid Level...................................7-19
Washer fluid .........................................................7-20
Checking the Washer Fluid Level................................7-20
Air cleaner ............................................................7-20
Filter Replacement..........................................................7-20
Climate control air filter .....................................7-22
Filter Inspection...............................................................7-22
Maintenance
Owner maintenance schedule........................................7-6
Owner maintenance...............................................7-5
7
Fuses......................................................................7-45
Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement..........................7-46
Fuel cell power module compartment
Panel Fuse Replacement ...............................................7-47
Fuse/Relay Panel Description......................................7-49
Light bulbs.............................................................7-57
Headlight, front center lamp, turn signal lamp,
daytime running lamp, parking lamp, side marker
replacement ......................................................................7-58
Side Repeater Lamp Replacement ..............................7-58
Rear Combination Light Bulb Replacement ..............7-59
High mounted stop lamp ...............................................7-59
License Plate Light Bulb Replacement ......................7-60
Interior Light Bulb Replacement .................................7-60
Appearance care ..................................................7-62
Exterior Care ....................................................................7-62
Interior Care .....................................................................7-67
California perchlorate notice .............................7-70
7
FUEL CELL POWER MODULE COMPARTMENT
1. Brake fluid reservoir
2. Air cleaner
3. Fuse box
4. Windshield washer fluid reservoir
Maintenance
5. Device cooling coolant reservoir
6. Traction motor radiator cap
7. Stack cooling coolant reservoir
8. Fuel cell stack radiator cap
7
The actual fuel cell power module compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.
OFE071001N
7-3
Maintenance
MAINTENANCE SERVICES
You should exercise the utmost care
to prevent damage to your vehicle
and injury to yourself whenever performing any maintenance or inspection procedures.
Have your vehicle maintained and
repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer. An authorized HYUNDAI
dealer meets HYUNDAI's high service quality standards and receives
technical support from HYUNDAI in
order to provide you with a high level
of service satisfaction.
WARNING
High voltage caution
Do not disassemble or perform
maintenance on the fuel cell
system unless you are qualified. The fuel cell system can be
highly dangerous since there
are many high voltage parts
inside even if when power is off.
7-4
Owner's Responsibility
Maintenance service and record
retention are the owner's responsibility.
You should retain documents that
show proper maintenance has been
performed on your vehicle in accordance with the scheduled maintenance service charts shown on the
following pages. You need this information to establish your compliance
with the servicing and maintenance
requirements of your vehicle warranties.
Detailed warranty information is provided in your Owner's Handbook &
Warranty Information booklet.
Repairs and adjustments required as
a result of improper maintenance or
a lack of required maintenance are
not covered.
Owner Maintenance
Precautions
Inadequate, incomplete or insufficient servicing may result in operational problems with your vehicle that
could lead to vehicle damage, an
accident, or personal injury. This
chapter provides instructions only for
the maintenance items that are easy
to perform. Several procedures can
be done only by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer with special tools.
Your vehicle should not be modified
in any way. Such modifications may
adversely affect the performance,
safety or durability of your vehicle
and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limited warranties covering the vehicle.
Certain modifications may also be in
violation of regulations established
by the U.S. Department of
Transportation and other federal or
state agencies.
OWNER MAINTENANCE
NOTICE
Improper owner maintenance during the warranty period may affect
warranty coverage. For details,
read the separate Owner's
Handbook & Warranty Information
booklet provided with the vehicle.
If you're unsure about any service
or maintenance procedure, have it
done by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
WARNING
Maintenance
Performing maintenance work
on a vehicle can be dangerous.
If you lack sufficient knowledge
and experience or the proper
tools and equipment to do the
work, have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
ALWAYS follow these precautions for performing maintenance work:
• Park your vehicle on level
ground, shift to the P (Park)
position, apply the parking
brake, and place the POWER
button in the OFF position.
• Block the tires (front and
back) to prevent the vehicle
from moving.
Remove loose clothing or jewelry that can become entangled in moving parts.
• Keep flames, sparks, or smoking materials away from the
battery related parts.
The following lists are vehicle checks
and inspections that should be performed by the owner or an authorized HYUNDAI dealer at the frequencies indicated to help ensure safe,
dependable operation of your vehicle.
Any adverse conditions should be
brought to the attention of your dealer as soon as possible.
These Owner Maintenance vehicle
checks are generally not covered by
warranties and you may be charged
for labor, parts and lubricants used.
7
7-5
Maintenance
Owner maintenance schedule
When you stop for fuel:
• Check for both fuel cell stack and
Device cooling coolant level in
coolant reservoir.
• Check the windshield washer fluid
level.
• Look for low or under-inflated tires.
WARNING
Be careful when checking the
coolant level when the fuel cell
power module is hot. Scalding
hot coolant and steam may
blow out under pressure. This
could cause burns or other serious injury.
7-6
While operating your vehicle:
At least monthly:
• Check for vibrations in the steering
wheel. Notice if there is any
increased steering effort or looseness in the steering wheel, or
change in its straight-ahead position.
• Notice if your vehicle constantly
turns slightly or "pulls" to one side
when traveling on smooth, level
road.
• When stopping, listen and check
for unusual sounds, pulling to one
side, increased brake pedal travel
or "hard-to-push" brake pedal.
• If any slipping or changes in the
operation of your reduction gear
occurs, check the reduction gear
fluid level.
• Check the reduction gear P (Park)
function.
• Check the parking brake.
• Check for fluid leaks under your
vehicle (water dripping from the air
conditioning system during or after
use is normal).
• Check coolant level in the coolant
reservoir.
• Check the operation of all exterior
lights, including the brake lights,
turn signals and hazard warning
flashers.
• Check the inflation pressures of all
tires that are worn, show uneven
wear, or are damaged.
• Check for loose wheel lug nuts.
At least twice a year:
(for example, every Spring and
Fall)
• Check radiator, heater and air conditioning hoses for leaks or damage.
• Check windshield washer spray
and wiper operation. Clean wiper
blades with clean cloth dampened
with washer fluid.
• Check headlight alignment.
• Check the seat belts for wear and
function.
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES
At least once a year:
If your vehicle is operated under the above conditions, you should inspect,
replace or refill more frequently than the following Normal Maintenance
Schedule. After the periods or distance shown in the chart, continue to follow
the prescribed maintenance intervals.
7-7
Maintenance
• Clean body and door drain holes.
• Lubricate door hinges and hood
hinges.
• Lubricate door and hood locks and
latches.
• Lubricate door rubber weather
strips.
• Lubricate door checker.
• Check the air conditioning system.
• Inspect and lubricate reduction
gear linkage and controls.
• Check the brake fluid level.
Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where
none of the following conditions apply. If any of the following conditions apply,
you must follow the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions.
• Repeated driving short distance of less than 8 km (5 miles) in normal temperature or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing temperature
• Low speed driving for long distances
• Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads
• Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold
weather
• Driving in heavy dust condition
• Driving in heavy traffic area
• Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain road repeatedly
• Towing a trailer or using a camper, or roof rack
• Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use of vehicle towing
• Driving over 170 km/h (106 miles/h)
• Frequently driving in stop-and-go condition
7
Maintenance
Normal Maintenance Schedule
Maintenance Months
Intervals
Miles×1,000
Maintenance
Km×1,000
Item
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108
120
132
144
156
168
180
6
12
18
24
30
36
42
48
54
60
66
72
78
84
90
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
130
140
150
Hydrogen system
(Check the hydrogen leakage)
Inspect every 6,000 miles (10,000 km) or 24 months
Air cleaner filter
Replace every at 12,000 (20,000 km) miles
Device cooling coolant
At first, replace at 120,000 miles (200,000 km) or 10 years :
Thereafter, replace every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 24 months
Stack cooling coolant
Replace every at 36,000 miles (60,000 km) or 36 months
Ion filter
Replace every at 36,000 miles (60,000 km) or 36 months
Reduction gear
No check, No service required
Air conditioner refrigerant/
compressor
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake lines, hoses and connections
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake discs and pads
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Driveshaft and boots
Front suspension ball joints
I
I
I
I
I
I
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace
7-8
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Normal Maintenance Schedule (Cont.)
Maintenance Months
Intervals
Miles×1,000
Maintenance
Km×1,000
Item
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
108
120
132
144
156
168
180
6
12
18
24
30
36
42
48
54
60
66
72
78
84
90
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
130
140
150
Parking brake
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Steering gear rack, linkage and
boots
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Tire (pressure & tread wear)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Battery condition
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
R
R
Inspect every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 12 months,
Replace every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 48 months
Brake fluid
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.
R : Replace
Maintenance
Climate control air filter
7
7-9
Maintenance
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions
The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars normally used under severe driving conditions. Refer
to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals.
R : Replace I : Inspect and, after inspection, clean, adjust, repair or replace if necessary
Maintenance item
Maintenance
operation
Hydrogen system
(Check the hydrogen leakage)
I
Air cleaner filter
I
Device cooling coolant
R
Stack cooling coolant
R
Ion filter
R
Reduction gear fluid
R
Air conditioner refrigerant/compressor
I
Disc brakes and pads, calipers and rotors
I
7-10
Maintenance intervals
Driving condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, E, F, J, K, L
72,000 miles (120,000 km)
C, F, G, I, J
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
C, D, F, G, J, L
C, D, E
C, D, F, G, L
C, D, F, G, L
C, D, F, G, L
C, D, E, G, H
Maintenance item
Maintenance
operation
Driveshaft and boots
I
Front suspension ball joints
I
Parking brake
I
Steering gear rack, linkage and boots
I
Climate control air filter
R
Maintenance intervals
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Inspect more frequently
depending on the condition
Replace more frequently
depending on the condition
Driving condition
C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J
C, D, E, F, G
C, D, G, H
C, D, E, F, G
C, E
A - Repeatedly driving short distances of less than 5 miles
(8 km) in normal temperature or less than 10 miles (16 km)
in freezing temperature
B - Extensive low speed driving for long distances
C- Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or saltspread roads
D- Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in
very cold weather
E - Driving in sandy areas
F - Driving in heavy traffic area over 90°F (32°C)
G- Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain road
H- Towing a Trailer, or using a camper, or roof rack
I - Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle
towing
J - Driving over 106 mph (170 km/h)
K - Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions
7-11
Maintenance
Severe driving conditions
7
Maintenance
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Cooling System
Brake Fluid
Check cooling system components,
such as radiator, coolant reservoir,
hoses and connections for leakage
and damage. Replace any damaged
parts.
Check brake fluid level in the brake
fluid reservoir. The level should be
between the MIN and the MAX
marks on the side of the reservoir.
Use only hydraulic brake fluid conforming to DOT 3 or DOT 4 specification.
Coolant
The coolant should be changed at
the intervals specified in the maintenance schedule.
Brake Discs, Pads, Calipers
and Rotors
Reduction Gear Fluid
Check the pads for excessive wear,
discs for run out and wear, and
calipers for fluid leakage.
Inspect the reduction gear fluid
according to the maintenance schedule.
Suspension Mounting Bolts
Brake Hoses and Lines
Check the suspension connections
for looseness or damage. Retighten
to the specified torque.
Visually check for proper installation,
chafing, cracks, deterioration and
any leakage. Replace any deteriorated or damaged parts immediately.
7-12
Steering Gear Box, Linkage &
Boots/Lower Arm Ball Joint
With the vehicle stopped and the
vehicle off, check for excessive freeplay in the steering wheel. Check the
linkage for bends or damage. Check
the dust boots and ball joints for
deterioration, cracks, or damage.
Replace any damaged parts.
Drive Shafts and Boots
Check the drive shafts, boots and
clamps for cracks, deterioration, or
damage. Replace any damaged
parts and, if necessary, repack the
grease.
Air Conditioning Refrigerant
Check the air conditioning lines and
connections for leakage and damage.
DEVICE COOLING COOLANT
The high-pressure cooling system
has a reservoir filled with year-round
antifreeze coolant. The reservoir is
filled at the factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at
the beginning of the winter season
and before traveling to a colder climate.
Checking the Coolant Level
OFE078003
• When adding coolant, use only
distilled (deionized) water for your
vehicle and never mix hard water in
the coolant filled at the factory.
• An improper coolant mixture can
result in severe malfunction or
electric devices damage.
• Do not use alcohol or methanol
coolant or mix them with the specified coolant.
• Do not use a solution that contains
more than 60% antifreeze or less
than 35% antifreeze, which would
reduce the effectiveness of the
solution.
Maintenance
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen
or deteriorated hoses.
The coolant level should be filled
between the MAX and the MIN
marks on the rear side of the coolant
reservoir when the parts in the fuel
cell power module compartment is
cool.
If the coolant level is low, add enough
distilled (deionized) water to bring
the level to the MAX mark, but do not
overfill. If frequent additions are
required, you see an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer for a cooling system inspection.
Recommended coolant
7
7-13
Maintenance
For mixing percentage, refer to the
following table:
Ambient
Temperature
5°F (-15°C)
-13°F (-25°C)
-31°F (-35°C)
-49°F (-45°C)
Mixture Percentage
(volume)
Antifreeze
35
40
50
60
Water
65
60
50
40
OFE078004
i Information
If in doubt about the mix ratio, a 50%
water and 50% antifreeze mix is the
easiest to mix together as it will be the
same quantity of each. It is suitable to
use for most temperature ranges of
- 31°F and higher.
7-14
WARNING
Never remove the
radiator cap or the
drain plug while the
radiator is hot. Hot
coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure,
causing serious injury.
Turn the vehicle off and wait
until the parts in the fuel cell
power module compartment
cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the radiator
cap. Wrap a thick towel around
it, and turn it counterclockwise
slowly to the first stop. Step
back while the pressure is
released from the cooling system. When you are sure all the
pressure has been released,
press down on the cap, using a
thick towel, and continue turning counterclockwise to remove
it.
WARNING
The electric motor for
the cooling fan may
continue to operate
or start up when the
vehicle is not running
and can cause serious injury.
Keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the rotating fan
blades of the cooling fan.
Have coolant changed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to
the Maintenance Schedule at the
beginning of this chapter.
WARNING
Do not use coolant or antifreeze
in the washer fluid reservoir.
Coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Coolant may also cause damage to paint and body trim.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to parts in the
fuel cell power module compartment, put a thick towel around the
coolant cap before refilling the
coolant to prevent the coolant
from overflowing into parts in the
fuel cell power module compartment.
Maintenance
The electric motor for the cooling fan
is controlled by coolant temperature,
refrigerant pressure and vehicle
speed. As the coolant temperature
decreases, the electric motor will
automatically shut off. This is a normal condition.
Changing Coolant
7
7-15
Maintenance
STACK COOLING COOLANT
The high-pressure cooling system
has a reservoir filled with year-round
antifreeze coolant. The reservoir is
filled at the factory.
Check the antifreeze protection and
coolant level at least once a year, at
the beginning of the winter season
and before traveling to a colder climate.
Checking the Coolant Level
OFE078005
Check the condition and connections
of all cooling system hoses and
heater hoses. Replace any swollen
or deteriorated hoses.
When replacing any part of the cooling system there may be loss of
coolant. In that case, fill with an
exclusive coolant for the fuel cell.
When replacing the ion filter cartridge, replace the whole stack
coolant.
The coolant level should be filled
between F (MAX) and L (MIN) marks
on the side of the coolant reservoir
when the fuel cell power module is
cool.
7-16
If the stack cooling coolant level is
low, add enough exclusive coolant
for fuel cell stack to provide protection against freezing and corrosion in
the authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
In addition, whenever replacing the
ion filter cartridge, add enough exclusive coolant for fuel cell stack.
Stack cooling coolant
• When adding stack cooling
coolant, use only exclusive coolant
for fuel cell stack in authorized
HYUNDAI dealer and never mix
any water or liquid.
• An improper coolant mixture can
result in severe malfunction or
electric devices damage.
• If the vehicle is damaged by adding
unspecified liquid except exclusive
coolant for fuel cell stack, it will not
be covered by the warranty.
OFE078006
Never remove the
radiator cap or the
drain plug while the
radiator is hot. Hot
coolant and steam
may blow out under pressure,
causing serious injury.
Maintenance
WARNING
Turn the vehicle off and wait
until the parts in the fuel cell
power module compartment
cools down. Use extreme care
when removing the cap. Wrap a
thick towel around it, and turn it
counterclockwise slowly to the
first stop. Step back while the
pressure is released from the
cooling system. When you are
sure all the pressure has been
released, press down on the
cap, using a thick towel, and
continue turning counterclockwise to remove it.
7
7-17
Maintenance
WARNING
The electric motor for
the cooling fan may
continue to operate
or start up when the
vehicle is not running
and can cause serious injury.
Keep hands, clothing and tools
away from the rotating fan
blades of the cooling fan.
The electric motor for the cooling fan
is controlled by coolant temperature,
refrigerant pressure and vehicle
speed. As the coolant temperature
decreases, the electric motor will
automatically shut off. This is a normal condition.
7-18
Changing Coolant
For the fuel cell stack, an exclusive
coolant must be used . When changing the fuel cell stack coolant, have
that coolant be changed by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to the Maintenance Schedule at
the beginning of this chapter.
WARNING
Do not use coolant or antifreeze
in the washer fluid reservoir.
Coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause loss
of vehicle control resulting in an
accident.
Coolant may also cause damage to paint and body trim.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to parts in the
fuel cell power module compartment, put a thick towel around the
coolant cap before refilling the
coolant to prevent the coolant
from overflowing into parts in the
fuel cell power module compartment.
CAUTION
Do not mix-up the caps of
device cooling coolant and
stack cooling coolant because
the fluid material is different. If
the cap is mixed, the fuel cell
system may be damage.
Have you consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
BRAKE FLUID
Checking the Brake Fluid
Level
If the level is low, add the specified
brake fluid to the MAX level. The level
will fall with accumulated mileage.
This is a normal condition associated
with the wear of the brake linings. If
the fluid level is excessively low, have
the brake system checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
Check the fluid level in the reservoir
periodically. The fluid level should be
between MAX and MIN marks on the
side of the reservoir.
Before removing the reservoir cap
and adding brake fluid, clean the
area around the reservoir cap thoroughly to prevent brake fluid contamination.
WARNING
• Do not allow brake fluid to contact the vehicle’s body paint, as
it will result in paint damage.
• NEVER use brake fluid which
has been exposed to open air for
an extended time, as its quality
cannot be guaranteed. It should
be disposed of properly.
• Do not use the wrong type of
brake fluid. A few drops of mineral based oil such as engine oil,
in your brake system can damage brake system parts.
i Information
Use only the specified brake fluid
(refer to "Recommended Lubricants
and Capacities" in chapter 8).
Do not let brake fluid enter into
your eyes. If brake fluid gets in
your eyes, flush your eyes with
clean water for at least 15 minutes and get immediate medical
attention.
7-19
Maintenance
OFE078007
If the brake system requires frequent additions of fluid this
could indicate a leak in the
brake system. Have the vehicle
inspected by an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
NOTICE
7
Maintenance
WASHER FLUID
AIR CLEANER
Checking the Washer Fluid
Level
Filter Replacement
OFE078008
Check the fluid level in the washer
fluid reservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plain water may be used if
washer fluid is not available.
However, use washer solvent with
antifreeze characteristics in cold climates to prevent freezing.
7-20
WARNING
To prevent serious injury or
death, take the following safety
precautions when using washer
fluid:
• Do not use coolant or
antifreeze in the washer fluid
reservoir.
Coolant can severely obscure
visibility when sprayed on the
windshield and may cause
loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident or damage
to paint and body trim.
• Do not allow sparks or flame
to contact the washer fluid or
the washer fluid reservoir.
Washer fluid may contain
alcohol and can be flammable.
• Do not drink washer fluid and
avoid contact with skin.
Washer fluid is harmful to
humans and animals.
• Keep washer fluid away from
children and animals.
Faulty air cleaner filter has a direct
influence on reduction of the stack
output, etc. Replace the filter according to the maintenance schedule.
i Information
If the vehicle is operated in extremely
dusty or sandy areas, replace the air
cleaner filter more often than the
usual recommended intervals (refer to
"Maintenance Under Severe Usage
Conditions" in this chapter).
CAUTION
OFE078010
1. Loosen the air cleaner cover
attaching clips and open the
cover.
2. Wipe the inside of the air cleaner.
3. Replace the air cleaner filter.
4. Lock the cover with the cover
attaching clips.
5. Check that the cover is firmly
installed.
• Do not drive with the air cleaner filter removed. This will
result in excessive wear.
• When removing the air cleaner filter, be careful that dust or
dirt does not enter the air
intake, or damage may result.
• Use HYUNDAI genuine parts,
use of non-genuine parts
could damage the air flow
sensor.
7-21
Maintenance
OFE078009
7
Maintenance
CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER
Filter Inspection
The climate control air filter should
be replaced according to the
Maintenance Schedule. If the vehicle
is operated in severely air-polluted
cities or on dusty rough roads for a
long period, it should be inspected
more frequently and replaced earlier.
When you replace the climate control
air filter, replace it performing the following procedure, and be careful to
avoid damaging other components.
OFE078012
1. With the glove box open, remove
the stoppers on both sides to allow
the glove box to hang freely on the
hinges.
7-22
OFE078011
2. Remove the support rod (1).
NOTICE
Install a new climate control air filter in the correct direction with the
arrow symbol (↓) facing downwards. Otherwise, the climate control effects may decrease, possibly with a noise.
OHG075041
5. Replace the climate control air filter.
6. Reassemble in the reverse order
of disassembly.
Maintenance
OFE078013
3. Press and hold the lock (1) on left
side of the cover.
4. Pull out (2) the cover.
7
7-23
Maintenance
WIPER BLADES
Blade Inspection
Contamination of either the windshield or the wiper blades with foreign matter can reduce the effectiveness of the windshield wiper functionality. Common sources of contamination are insects, tree sap, and
hot wax treatments used by some
commercial car washes. If the blades
are not wiping properly, clean both
the window and the blades with a
clean cloth dampened with washer
fluid.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper
blades, arms or other components, do not:
• Use gasoline, kerosene, paint
thinner, or other solvents on or
near them.
• Attempt to move the wipers
manually.
• Use non-specified wiper blades.
7-24
i Information
Commercial hot waxes applied by
automatic car washes have been
known to make the windshield difficult to clean.
Front windshield wiper service
positions
Blade Replacement
When the wipers no longer clean
adequately, the blades may be worn
or cracked, and require replacement.
NOTICE
To prevent damage to the wiper
arms or other components, do not
attempt to move the wipers manually.
NOTICE
The use of a non-specified wiper
blade could result in wiper malfunction and failure.
OFE078038N
This vehicle has a "hidden" wiper
design which means that the wipers
cannot be lifted when they are in
their bottom resting position.
1. Within 20 seconds of turning off
the vehicle, lift and hold the wiper
lever up to the MIST position for
about 2 seconds until the wipers
move to the top wipe position.
2. At this time you can lift the wipers
off the windshield.
3. Gently put the wipers back down
onto the windshield.
4. Turn the wipers to any ON position
to return the wipers to the bottom
resting position.
Front windshield wiper blade
replacement
OLF074019
3. Install the new blade assembly in
the reverse order of removal.
4. Return the wiper arm on the windshield.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the wiper
arms or other components,
have an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer replace the wiper blade.
7-25
Maintenance
OLF074017
1. Raise the wiper arm.
OLF074018
2. Lift up the wiper blade clip. Then
pull down the blade assembly and
remove it.
7
Maintenance
Rear window wiper blade
replacement
OFE078016
1. Operate the rear windshield wiper
to make sure the blade is on lower
position. Then turn off the vehicle.
7-26
OFE078014
OFE078015
2. Raise the wiper arm (1) and pull
out the wiper blade assembly.
3. Install the new blade assembly by
inserting the center part into the
slot in the wiper arm until it clicks
into place.
4. Make sure the blade assembly is
installed firmly by trying to pull it
slightly.
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
or other components, we recommend that the wiper blades be
replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
12V BATTERY
The vehicle is not equipped with a
common 12V battery which requires
periodic replacement. The battery is
a lithium polymer type integrated into
the high voltage battery. Full discharge of the battery is prevented
through 12V battery protection system which can isolate the 12V battery.
WARNING
Always follow these instructions
when handling your vehicle's battery to prevent damage to your
battery:
• If you connect unauthorized
electronic devices to the battery,
the battery may be discharged.
Never
use
unauthorized
devices.
Maintenance
To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or
DEATH to you or bystanders,
always follow these precautions
when working near or handling
the battery:
Always read and follow
instructions
carefully
when handling a battery.
Wear eye protection
designed to protect the
eyes from acid splashes.
Keep all flames, sparks,
or smoking materials
away from the battery.
• NEVER attempt to recharge
the battery when the vehicle’s
battery cables are connected
to the battery.
• The electrical ignition system
works with high voltage.
NEVER touch these components with the vehicle ON
(
indicator ON) or when
the POWER button is in the
ON position.
NOTICE
7
7-27
Maintenance
Battery recharging
By RESET button
OFEQ019028L
To charge the discharged 12V battery, attempt charging by pressing
12V BATT RESET button. For more
details, refer to “If the 12 volt battery
is discharged” in chapter 6.
7-28
By jump starting
Reset Features
After a jump start from a good battery, drive the vehicle for 20-30 minutes before it is shutoff. The vehicle
may not restart if you shut it off
before the battery had a chance to
adequately recharge. See “Jump
Starting” in chapter 6 for more information on jump starting procedures.
Some items need to be reset after
the battery has been discharged or
the battery has been disconnected.
See chapter 3 for:
• Power Windows
• Trip Computer
• Climate Control System
• Clock
• Audio System
• Sunroof
• Driver Position Memory System
TIRES AND WHEELS
WARNING
Tire Care
For proper maintenance, safety, and
maximum fuel economy, you must
always maintain recommended tire
inflation pressures and stay within
the load limits and weight distribution
recommended for your vehicle.
Maintenance
Tire failure may cause loss of
vehicle control resulting in an
accident. To reduce risk of
SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH,
take the following precautions:
• Inspect your tires monthly for
proper inflation as well as
wear and damage.
• The recommended cold tire
pressure for your vehicle can
be found in this manual and
on the tire label located on the
driver's side center pillar.
Always use a tire pressure
gauge to measure tire pressure. Tires with too much or
too little pressure wear
unevenly causing poor handling.
• Replace tires that are worn,
show uneven wear, or are
damaged. Worn tires can
cause loss of braking effectiveness, steering) control, or
traction.
• ALWAYS replace tires with the
same size as each tire that
was originally supplied with
this vehicle. Using tires and
wheels other than the recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics, poor vehicle control, or
negatively affect your vehicle's Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS) resulting in a serious
accident.
7
7-29
Maintenance
Recommended Cold Tire
Inflation Pressures
OFE088003
All specifications (sizes and pressures) can be found on a label
attached to the driver’s side center
pillar.
7-30
All tire pressures should be checked
when the tires are cold. "Cold tires"
means the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours or driven
less than one mile (1.6 km).
Warm tires normally exceed recommended cold tire pressures by 4 to 6
psi (28 to 41 kPa). Do not release air
from warm tires to adjust the pressure or the tires will be under-inflated. For recommended inflation pressure, refer to "Tire and Wheels" in
chapter 8.
WARNING
Recommended pressures must
be maintained for the best ride,
vehicle handling, and minimum
tire wear.
Over-inflation or under-inflation
can reduce tire life, adversely
affect vehicle handling, and
lead to sudden tire failure that
could result in loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Severe under-inflation can lead
to severe heat build-up, causing
blowouts, tread separation and
other tire failures that can result
in the loss of vehicle control
resulting in an accident. This
risk is much higher on hot days
and when driving for long periods at high speeds.
CAUTION
• Under-inflation
Check your tires once a month or
more.
How to check
Use a good quality tire pressure
gauge to check tire pressure. You
can not tell if your tires are properly
inflated simply by looking at them.
Radial tires may look properly inflated when they are under-inflated.
Remove the valve cap from the tire
valve stem. Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a pressure
measurement. If the cold tire inflation
pressure matches the recommended
pressure on the tire and loading
information label, no further adjustment is necessary. If the pressure is
low, add air until you reach the recommended pressure. Make sure to
put the valve caps back on the valve
stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or
moisture could get into the valve
core and cause air leakage. If a valve
cap is missing, install a new one as
soon as possible.
If you overfill the tire, release air by
pushing on the metal stem in the
center of the tire valve. Recheck the
tire pressure with the tire gauge. Be
sure to put the valve caps back on
the valve stems. Without the valve
cap, dirt or moisture could get into
the valve core and cause air leakage.
If a valve cap is missing, install a new
one as soon as possible.
Maintenance
results in
excessive wear, poor handling
and reduced fuel economy.
Wheel deformation is also
possible. Keep your tire pressures at the proper levels. If a
tire frequently needs refilling,
have it checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
• Over-inflation produces a
harsh ride, excessive wear at
the center of the tire tread,
and a greater possibility of
damage from road hazards.
Check Tire Inflation Pressure
7
7-31
Maintenance
i Information
Tire Rotation
To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI
recommends that the tires be rotated
every 6,000 miles (10,000 km) or
sooner if irregular wear develops.
During rotation, check the tires for
correct balance.
When rotating tires, check for uneven
wear and damage. Abnormal wear is
usually caused by incorrect tire pressure, improper wheel alignment, outof-balance wheels, severe braking or
severe cornering. Look for bumps or
bulges in the tread or side of tire.
Replace the tire if you find either of
these conditions. Replace the tire if
fabric or cord is visible. After rotation,
be sure to bring the front and rear tire
pressures to specification and check
lug nut tightness (proper torque is
79~94 lbf·ft [11~13 kgf·m]).
7-32
ODH073802
Disc brake pads should be inspected
for wear whenever tires are rotated.
Tires that are asymmetrical or directional can only be installed on the
wheel in one direction. The outside
and inside of an asymmetrical tire is
not easily distinguishable. Pay careful
attention to the markings on the sidewalls of the tires, noting the "outside"
marking and also the rotating direction before installing them on the
vehicle.
WARNING
Do not mix bias ply and radial
ply tires under any circumstances. This may cause unusual handling characteristics that
may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Wheel Alignment and Tire
Balance
NOTICE
Improper wheel weights can damage your vehicle's aluminum
wheels. Use only approved wheel
weights.
WARNING
Tread wear indicator
OLMB073027
If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear
indicator will appear as a solid band
across the tread. This shows there is
less than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread
left on the tire. Replace the tire when
this happens.
Do not wait for the band to appear
across the entire tread before replacing the tire.
To reduce the risk of DEATH or
SERIOUS INJURY:
• Replace tires that are worn,
show uneven wear, or are
damaged. Worn tires can
cause loss of braking effectiveness, steering control, and
traction.
• Always replace tires with the
same size as each tire that
was originally supplied with
this vehicle. Using tires and
wheels other than the recommended sizes could cause
unusual handling characteristics, poor vehicle control, or
negatively affect your vehicle's Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS) resulting in a serious
accident.
7-33
Maintenance
The wheels on your vehicle were
aligned and balanced carefully at the
factory to give you the longest tire life
and best overall performance.
In most cases, you will not need to
have your wheels aligned again.
However, if you notice unusual tire
wear or your vehicle pulling one way
or the other, the alignment may need
to be reset.
If you notice your vehicle vibrating
when driving on a smooth road, your
wheels may need to be rebalanced.
Tire Replacement
7
Maintenance
• Tires degrade over time, even
when they are not being used.
Regardless of the remaining
tread, HYUNDAI recommends
that tires be replaced after six
(6) years of normal service.
• When replacing tires (or
wheels), it is recommended to
replace the two front or two
rear tires (or wheels) as a pair.
Replacing just one tire can
seriously affect your vehicle's
handling.
• Heat caused by hot climates
or frequent high loading conditions can accelerate the
aging process. Failure to follow this warning may cause
sudden tire failure, which
could lead to a loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
7-34
Wheel Replacement
Tire Maintenance
When replacing the metal wheels for
any reason, make sure the new
wheels are equivalent to the original
factory units in diameter, rim width
and offset.
In addition to proper inflation, correct
wheel alignment helps to decrease
tire wear. If you find a tire is worn
unevenly, have your dealer check the
wheel alignment.
When you have new tires installed,
make sure they are balanced. This
will increase vehicle ride comfort and
tire life. Additionally, a tire should
always be rebalanced if it is removed
from the wheel.
Tire Traction
Tire traction can be reduced if you
drive on worn tires, tires that are
improperly inflated or on slippery
road surfaces. Tires should be
replaced when tread wear indicators
appear. To reduce the possibility of
losing control, slow down whenever
there is rain, snow or ice on the road.
Tire Sidewall Labeling
This information identifies and
describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides
the tire identification number (TIN)
for safety standard certification. The
TIN can be used to identify the tire in
case of a recall.
1
5,6
7
4
2
3
1
OLMB073028
1. Manufacturer or brand name
2. Tire size designation
A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tire
size designation. You will need this
information when selecting replacement tires for your car. The following
explains what the letters and numbers in the tire size designation
mean.
225 - Tire width in millimeters.
60 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section
height as a percentage of its
width.
R - Tire construction code (Radial).
17 - Rim diameter in inches.
99 - Load Index, a numerical code
associated with the maximum
load the tire can carry.
H - Speed Rating Symbol. See the
speed rating chart in this section
for additional information.
Wheel size designation
Wheels are also marked with important information that you need if you
ever have to replace one. The following explains what the letters and
numbers in the wheel size designation mean.
Example wheel size designation:
7.0J x 17
7.0 - Rim width in inches.
J - Rim contour designation.
17 - Rim diameter in inches.
Maintenance
Manufacturer or brand name is
shown.
Example tire size designation:
(These numbers are provided as an
example only; your tire size designator could vary depending on your
vehicle.)
225/60 R17 99H
7
7-35
Maintenance
Tire speed ratings
The chart below lists many of the different speed ratings currently being
used for passenger car tires. The
speed rating is part of the tire size
designation on the sidewall of the
tire. This symbol corresponds to that
tire’s designed maximum safe operating speed.
Speed
Rating
Symbol
S
T
H
V
W
Y
7-36
Maximum Speed
112
118
130
149
168
186
mph
mph
mph
mph
mph
mph
(180
(190
(210
(240
(270
(300
km/h)
km/h)
km/h)
km/h)
km/h)
km/h)
3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire
Identification Number)
4. Tire ply composition and
material
Any tires that are over six years old,
based on the manufacturing date,
should be replaced by new ones. You
can find the manufacturing date on
the tire sidewall (possibly on the
inside of the wheel), displaying the
DOT Code. The DOT Code is a
series of numbers on a tire consisting of numbers and English letters.
The manufacturing date is designated by the last four digits (characters)
of the DOT code.
The number of layers or plies of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the
materials in the tire, which include
steel, nylon, polyester, and others.
The letter "R" means radial ply construction; the letter "D" means diagonal or bias ply construction; and the
letter "B" means belted-bias ply construction.
DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure. Refer
to the Tire and Loading Information
label for recommended inflation
pressure.
The front part of the DOT means a
plant code number, tire size and
tread pattern and the last four numbers indicate week and year manufactured.
For example:
DOT XXXX XXXX 1522 represents
that the tire was produced in the 15th
week of 2022.
5. Maximum permissible inflation pressure
6. Maximum load rating
This number indicates the maximum
load in kilograms and pounds that
can be carried by the tire. When
replacing the tires on the vehicle,
always use a tire that has the same
load rating as the factory installed
tire.
7. Uniform tire quality grading
Traction - AA, A, B & C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those
grades represent the tire's ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to
this tire is based on straightahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning,
or peak traction characteristics.
Maintenance
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
For example:
TREAD wear 200
TRACTION AA
TEMPERATURE A
Tread wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of
the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For example, a tire
graded 150 would wear one-and-ahalf times (1½) as well on the government course as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires
depends upon the actual conditions
of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm
due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in
road characteristics and climate.
These grades are molded on the
sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires.
The tires available as standard or
optional equipment on your vehicle
may vary with respect to grade.
7
7-37
Maintenance
Temperature - A, B & C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B and C representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can
cause the material of the tire to
degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to
sudden tire failure. Grade C
responds to a level of performance
which all passenger car tires must
meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109.
Grades B and A represent higher
levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
WARNING
The temperature grade for this
tire is established for a tire that
is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
under-inflation, over-inflation,
or excessive loading, either
separately or in combination,
can cause heat build-up and
possible sudden tire failure.
This may cause loss of vehicle
control resulting in an accident.
Tire Terminology and
Definitions
Air Pressure
The amount of air inside the tire
pressing outward on the tire. Air
pressure is expressed in pounds per
square inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).
Accessory Weight
This means the combined weight of
optional accessories. Some examples of optional accessories are
reduction gear, power seats, and air
conditioning.
Aspect Ratio
The relationship of a tire's height to
its width.
Belt
A rubber coated layer of cords that is
located between the plies and the
tread. Cords may be made from steel
or other reinforcing materials.
7-38
Bead
DOT Markings
Intended Outboard Sidewall
The tire bead contains steel wires
wrapped by steel cords that hold the
tire onto the rim.
The side of an asymmetrical tire, that
must always face outward when
mounted on a vehicle.
A pneumatic tire in which the plies
are laid at alternate angles less than
90 degrees to the centerline of the
tread.
A code molded into the sidewall of a
tire signifying that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of
Transportation motor vehicle safety
standards. The DOT code includes
the Tire Identification Number (TIN),
an alphanumeric designator which
can also identify the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand and date
of production.
Cold Tire Pressure
GVWR
The amount of air pressure in a tire,
measured in pounds per square inch
(psi) or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire
has built up heat from driving.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
A tire designated by its manufacturer
as primarily intended for use on lightweight trucks or multipurpose passenger vehicles.
GAWR FRT
Load ratings
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the
Front Axle.
The maximum load that a tire is rated
to carry for a given inflation pressure.
GAWR RR
Load Index
Gross Axle Weight Rating for the
Rear axle.
An assigned number ranging from 1
to 279 that corresponds to the load
carrying capacity of a tire.
Bias Ply Tire
This means the weight of a motor
vehicle with standard and optional
equipment including the maximum
capacity of fuel, oil and coolant, but
without passengers and cargo.
The metric unit for air pressure.
Light truck(LT) tire
Maintenance
Curb Weight
Kilopascal (kPa)
7
7-39
Maintenance
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Normal Occupant Weight
Pneumatic tire
The maximum air pressure to which
a cold tire may be inflated. The maximum air pressure is molded onto the
sidewall.
The number of occupants a vehicle
is designed to seat multiplied by 150
pounds (68 kg).
A mechanical device made of rubber,
chemicals, fabric and steel or other
materials, that, when mounted on an
automotive wheel provides the traction and contains the gas or fluid that
sustains the load.
Occupant Distribution
Maximum Load Rating
Designated seating positions.
The load rating for a tire at the maximum permissible inflation pressure
for that tire.
Outward Facing Sidewall
Maximum Loaded Vehicle
Weight
The sum of curb weight; accessory
weight; vehicle capacity weight; and
production options weight.
An asymmetrical tire has a particular
side that faces outward when mounted on a vehicle. The outward facing
sidewall bears white lettering or
bears manufacturer, brand, and/or
model name molding that is higher or
deeper than the same moldings on
the inner facing sidewall.
Passenger (P-Metric) tire
A tire used on passenger cars and
some light duty trucks and multipurpose vehicles.
Ply
A layer of rubber-coated parallel
cords.
7-40
Pneumatic options weight
The combined weight of installed
regular production options weighing
over 5 lb. (2.3 kg) in excess of the
standard items which they replace,
not previously considered in curb
weight or accessory weight, including heavy duty breaks, ride levelers,
roof rack, heavy duty battery, and
special trim.
Recommended Inflation
Pressure
Vehicle manufacturer's recommended tire inflation pressure as shown
on the tire placard.
Radial Ply Tire
Tread
A pneumatic tire in which the ply
cords that extend to the beads are
laid at 90 degrees to the centerline of
the tread.
The portion of a tire that comes into
contact with the road.
Treadwear Indicators
Sidewall
UTQGS
The portion of a tire between the
tread and the bead.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards is a tire information system that provides consumers with
ratings for a tire's traction, temperature and treadwear. Ratings are
determined by tire manufacturers
using government testing procedures. The ratings are molded into
the sidewall of the tire.
Speed Rating
An alphanumeric code assigned to a
tire indicating the maximum speed at
which a tire can operate.
Load on an individual tire due to curb
and accessory weight plus maximum
occupant and cargo weight.
Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire
Load on an individual tire that is
determined by distributing to each
axle its share of the curb weight,
accessory weight, and normal occupant weight and dividing by 2.
Vehicle Placard
A label permanently attached to a
vehicle showing the original equipment tire size and recommended
inflation pressure.
7
Traction
The friction between the tire and the
road surface. The amount of grip provided.
Maintenance
A metal support for a tire and upon
which the tire beads are seated.
Narrow bands, sometimes called
"wear bars", that show across the
tread of a tire when only 1/16 inch of
tread remains.
Rim
Vehicle Maximum Load on the
Tire
Vehicle Capacity Weight
The number of designated seating
positions multiplied by 150 lbs. (68
kg) plus the rated cargo and luggage
load.
7-41
Maintenance
All Season Tires
Snow Tires
Radial-Ply Tires
HYUNDAI specifies all season tires
on some models to provide good
performance for use all year round,
including snowy and icy road conditions. All season tires are identified
by ALL SEASON and/or M+S (Mud
and Snow) on the tire sidewall. Snow
tires have better snow traction than
all season tires and may be more
appropriate in some areas.
If you equip your car with snow tires,
they should be the same size and
have the same load capacity as the
original tires. Snow tires should be
installed on all four wheels; otherwise, poor handling may result. Snow
tires should carry 4 psi (28 kPa)
more air pressure than the pressure
recommended for the standard tires
on the tire label on the driver’s side of
the center pillar, or up to the maximum pressure shown on the tire
sidewall, whichever is less. Do not
drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h)
when your vehicle is equipped with
snow tires.
Radial-ply tires provide improved
tread life, road hazard resistance and
smoother high speed ride. The radial-ply tires used on this vehicle are of
belted construction, and are selected
to complement the ride and handling
characteristics of your vehicle.
Radial-ply tires have the same load
carrying capacity, as bias-ply or bias
belted tires of the same size, and use
the same recommended inflation
pressure. Mixing of radial-ply tires
with bias-ply or bias belted tires is
not recommended. Any combinations of radial-ply and bias-ply or bias
belted tires when used on the same
vehicle will seriously deteriorate
vehicle handling. The best rule to follow is: Identical pairs of radial-ply
tires should always be used as a set
for the front tires and a set for the
rear tires.
Summer Tires
HYUNDAI specifies summer tires on
some models to provide superior
performance on dry roads. Summer
tire performance is substantially
reduced in snow and ice. Summer
tires do not have the tire traction rating M+S (Mud and Snow) on the tire
side wall. If you plan to operate your
vehicle in snowy or icy conditions,
HYUNDAI recommends the use of
snow tires or all season tires on all
four wheels.
7-42
Longer wearing tires can be more
susceptible to irregular tread wear. It
is very important to follow the tire
rotation interval in this chapter to
achieve the tread life potential of
these tires. Cuts and punctures in
radial-ply tires are repairable only in
the tread area, because of sidewall
flexing. Consult your tire dealer for
radial-ply tire repairs.
WARNING
Low aspect ratio tires, the aspect
ratio is lower than 50, are provided
for sporty looks.
Because low aspect ratio tires are
optimized for handling and braking,
their sidewall is a little stiffer than a
standard tire. Also low aspect ratio
tires tend to be wider and consequently have a greater contact patch
with the road surface. In some
instances they may generate more
road noise compared with standard
tires.
CAUTION
Because the sidewall of a low
aspect ratio tire is shorter than
a standard tire, the rim of the
wheel and the tire itself is more
easily susceptible to damage.
Use caution when driving and
follow the guidelines below to
help minimize damage to the
wheel and tire:
- When driving on a rough road
or off road, drive cautiously
because tires and wheels may
be damaged. And after driving,
inspect tires and wheels.
- When passing over a pothole,
speed bump, manhole, or curb
stone, drive slowly so that the
tires and wheels are not damaged.
- If the tire is subjected to a
severe impact, have the tire
and wheel inspected by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
- Inspect the tire condition and
pressure every 1,800 miles
(3,000 km).
7-43
Maintenance
Do not mix bias ply and radial
ply tires under any circumstances. This may cause unusual handling characteristics that
may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.
Low Aspect Ratio Tires
7
Maintenance
CAUTION
• It is not easy to recognize tire
damage with your own eyes.
But if there is the slightest
hint of tire damage, have the
tire checked or replaced
because the tire damage may
cause air leakage from the
tire.
• If the tire is damaged by driving on a rough road, off road,
pothole, manhole, or curb
stone, it will not be covered by
the warranty.
7-44
FUSES
■ Blade type
Normal
Blown
■ Cartridge type
Normal
Blown
■ Multi fuse
Blown
OAEE076008
i Information
Three kinds of fuses are used: blade
type for lower amperage rating, cartridge type, and multi fuse for higher
amperage ratings.
WARNING
NEVER replace a fuse with anything but another fuse of the
same rating.
• A higher capacity fuse could
cause damage and possibly
cause a fire.
• Do not install a wire or aluminum foil instead of the
proper fuse - even as a temporary repair. It may cause
extensive wiring damage and
possibly a fire.
A vehicle's electrical system is protected from electrical overload damage by fuses.
This vehicle has 2 (or 3) fuse panels,
one located in the driver's side panel
bolster, the other in the fuel cell
power module compartment near the
battery.
7-45
Maintenance
Normal
If any of your vehicle’s lights, accessories, or controls do not work, check
the appropriate circuit fuse. If a fuse
has blown, the element inside the
fuse will be melted or broken.
If the electrical system does not
work, first check the driver's side
fuse panel. Before replacing a blown
fuse, turn the vehicle and all switches off, and then disconnect the negative battery cable. Always replace a
blown fuse with one of the same rating.
If the replacement fuse blows, this
indicates an electrical problem. Avoid
using the system involved and immediately consult an authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
7
Maintenance
NOTICE
Do not use a screwdriver or any
other metal object to remove
fuses because it may cause a
short circuit and damage the system.
Instrument Panel Fuse
Replacement
OFE078018
OFE078017
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches OFF.
3. Open the fuse panel cover.
4. Refer to the label on the inside of
the fuse panel cover to locate the
suspected fuse location.
7-46
5. Pull the suspected fuse straight
out. Use the removal tool provided
in the fuel cell power module compartment fuse panel.
6. Check the removed fuse; replace it
if it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in the instrument panel fuse
panels (or in the fuel cell power
module compartment fuse panel).
7. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly
in the clips. If it fits loosely, consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
In an emergency, if you do not have
a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same
rating from a circuit you may not
need for operating the vehicle.
If the headlights or other electrical
components do not work and the
fuses are OK, check the fuse panel
in the fuel cell power module compartment. If a fuse is blown, it must
be replaced with the same rating.
Fuel cell power module compartment Panel Fuse
Replacement
Blade / Cartridge type
4. Check the removed fuse; replace
it if it is blown. To remove or insert
the fuse, use the fuse puller in the
motor compartment fuse panel.
5. Push in a new fuse of the same
rating, and make sure it fits tightly
in the clips. If it fits loosely, consult
an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Maintenance
OFE078021
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Turn all other switches OFF.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tap and pulling up.
7
7-47
Maintenance
CAUTION
Multi fuse
i Information
If the multi fuse is blown, consult an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
After checking the fuse box in
the fuel cell power module compartment securely close the
fuse box cover inside the motor
compartment, until it clicks.
If the fuse box is not closed
properly, water may leak in side,
possibly causing a malfunction
with the electrical system.
OFE078022
If the multi fuse is blown, it must be
removed as follows:
1. Turn the vehicle off.
2. Disconnect the negative battery
connector located on the trunk.
3. Remove the fuse panel cover by
pressing the tab and pulling it up.
4. Remove the nuts shown in the picture above.
5. Replace the fuse with a new one
of the same rating.
6. Reinstall in the reverse order of
removal.
7-48
Fuse/Relay Panel Description
Instrument panel fuse panel
Maintenance
OFE078024
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relay name and capacity.
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your
vehicle; the information is accurate at
the time of printing. When you inspect
the fuse box on your vehicle, refer to
the fuse box label.
7
OFE078023N
7-49
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Fuse Rating
MEMORY1
10A
Power Tail Gate Module, A/C Control Module, A/C Control Panel
MODULE1
10A
ICM Relay Box (Outside Mirror Folding/Unfolding Relay), A/V & Navigation Head Unit (Hazard Lamp Switch),
Shift Selection Switch (SBW), Auto Light & Photo Sensor, Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror,
Instrument Cluster
TAIL GATE
OPEN
10A
Tail Gate Relay
P/WINDOW
RH
25A
Power Window RH Relay
P/WINDOW
LH
25A
Power Window LH Relay, Driver Safety Window Module
P/SEAT DRV
25A
Driver Seat Manual Switch
MODULE4
7.5A
IBU, Remote Control Smart Parking Assist Unit, VESS Unit, Electronic Parking Brake Switch,
Lane Keeping Assist Unit(Line), Blind-Spot Collision Warning Unit LH/RH, Crash Pad Switch,
PE Room Junction Block (Multipurpose Check Connector)
MODULE8
7.5A
Data Link Connector, Crash Pad Switch, Electro Chromic Mirror
S/HEATER RR
20A
Rear Seat Heater
HEATED
MIRROR
10A
Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror, A/C Control Panel
S/HEATER
FRT
20A
Front Air Ventilation/Seat Heater Seat Control Module
7-50
Protected Component
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Rating
Protected Component
AMP
25A
AMP
MULTI MEDIA
15A
A/V & Navigation Head Unit, Center Fascia Switch Panel
MODULE5
10A
Front Air Ventilation/Seat Heater Seat Control Module, AMP, A/V & Navigation Head Unit,
A/C Control Panel, PTC Heater, A/C Control Module, Electro Chromic Mirror, Rear Seat Heater
WIPER (RR)
15A
ICM Relay Box (Rear Wiper Relay), Rear Wiper Motor
DOOR LOCK
20A
Door Lock Relay, Door Unlock Relay, ICM Relay Box (Two Turn Door Unlock Relay)
IBU1
15A
IBU
BRAKE
SWITCH
10A
IBU, Stop Lamp Switch
P/SEAT PASS
25A
Passenger Seat Manual Switch
A/C
7.5A
A/C Control Module, Incar Temperature Sensor, A/C Control Panel,
Cluster Ionizer, A/C Compressor, PE Room Junction Block (Blower Relay)
AIR BAG2
10A
SRS Control Module
WASHER
15A
Multifunction Switch
Maintenance
Fuse Name
7
7-51
Maintenance
Instrument panel fuse panel
Fuse Name
Fuse Rating
MDPS
7.5A
MDPS Unit
MODULE7
7.5A
Front Air Ventilation/Seat Heater Seat Control Module, AC Inverter,
Rear Seat Heater, Surround View Monitor Unit, Rear Power Outlet
SUNROOF2
20A
Sunroof Unit
SUNROOF1
20A
Sunroof Unit
CLUSTER
7.5A
Instrument Cluster
MODULE3
7.5A
SCU, Shift Selection Switch (SBW), IDC, VPD Sensor, Stop Lamp Switch, HMU, BMS Control Module
START
7.5A
FCU, IBU
IBU2
7.5A
IBU
A/BAG IND
7.5A
Instrument Cluster, A/C Control Panel
MODULE6
7.5A
IBU
MODULE2
10A
BMS Control Module, Wireless Charger, USB Charger LH/RH, A/V & Navigation Head Unit,
Center Fascia Switch Panel, AMP, Surround View Monitor Unit, Power Outside Mirror Switch, IBU
AIR BAG1
15A
SRS Control Module, Passenger Occupant Detection Sensor
7-52
Protected Component
Fuel cell power module compartment fuse panel
Maintenance
OFE078025
Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you
can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relay name and capacity.
i Information
Not all fuse panel descriptions in this
manual may be applicable to your
vehicle; the information is accurate at
the time of printing. When you inspect
the fuse panel in your vehicle, refer to
the fuse panel label.
7
OFE078048N
7-53
Maintenance
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
Fuse Name
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
B+2
60A
ICU Junction Block (IPS Control Module, IPS1)
B+3
60A
ICU Junction Block (IPS Control Module)
COOLING
PE PUMP
40A
PE Room Coolant Pump (CPP)
EPB2
40A
Electronic Brake Control Module
IG2
40A
PE Room Junction Block (IG2 Relay)
EPB1
40A
Electronic Brake Control Module, PE Room Junction Block (Multipurpose Check Connector)
B+4
60A
ICU Junction Block (Fuse - SUNROOF1, SUNROOF2, AMP, P/SEAT DRV,
P/SEAT PASS, S/HEATER FRT, P/WINDOW LH, P/WINDOW RH, TAIL GATE OPEN)
IMEB
80A
Electronic Brake Control Module
BLOWER
50A
PE Room Junction Block (Blower Relay)
MDPS
80A
MDPS Unit
MULTI FUSE-1
MULTI FUSE-2
7-54
Motor compartment fuse panel
FUSE
Fuse Name
Fuse Rating
HVJB LV
15A
HV Junction Block
RCU
15A
Driver / Passenger Auto Flush Door Handle Module,
Rear Auto Flush Door Handle Module LH/RH
FUEL DOOR
OPEN
7.5A
ICM Relay Box (Fuel Filler Door Relay)
E-SHIFTER
40A
PE Room Junction Block (E-Shifter Relay)
INVERTER
30A
AC Inverter
REAR
HEATED
40A
PE Room Junction Block (Rear Heated Relay)
B+1
50A
ICU Junction Block ((Fuse - MODULE1, AIR BAG2, MODULE8,
S/HEATER RR, DOOR LOCK, IBU1, BRAKE SWITCH), Leak Current Autocut Relay)
POWER
TAIL GATE
30A
Power Tail Gate Module
Maintenance
Type
Circuit Protected
WIPER FRT
30A
Front Wiper Motor
7
COOLING
STACK PUMP
10A
Stack Coolant Pump (CSP)
INVERTER LV
7.5A
Inverter
7-55
Maintenance
Motor compartment fuse panel
Type
FUSE
7-56
Fuse Name
Fuse Rating
Circuit Protected
BHDC
7.5A
IDC
HMU1
10A
HMU
BATTERY
MANAGEMENT
10A
BMS Control Module
FUEL CELL
CONTROL UNIT
15A
FCU
BMS FAN
15A
PE Room Junction Block (BMS FAN Relay)
LIGHT BULBS
Consult an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer to replace most vehicle light
bulbs. It is difficult to replace vehicle
light bulbs because other parts of the
vehicle must be removed before you
can get to the bulb. This is especially
true for removing the headlight
assembly to get to the bulb(s).
Removing/installing the headlight
assembly can result in damage to
the vehicle.
i Information
• Prior to replacing a lamp, shift
to P (Park), apply the parking
brake, place the POWER button in the OFF position and
take the key with you when
leaving the vehicle to avoid
sudden movement of the vehicle and to prevent possible
electric shock.
• Be aware the bulbs may be
hot and may burn your fingers.
i Information
• A normally functioning lamp may
flicker momentarily to stabilize the
vehicle’s electrical control system.
However, if the lamp goes out after
flickering momentarily, or continues to flicker, have the vehicle be
checked
by
an
authorized
HYUNDAI dealer.
• The parking lamp may not turn on
when the parking lamp switch is
turned on, but the parking lamp
and headlight switch may turn on
when the headlight switch is turned
on. This may be caused by network
failure or vehicle electrical control
system malfunction. If this occurs,
have the vehicle be checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
Maintenance
The headlight and tail lamp lenses
could appear frosty if the vehicle is
washed after driving or the vehicle is
driven at night in wet weather. This
condition is caused by temperature
difference between the lamp inside
and outside and, it does not indicate a
problem with your vehicle. When
moisture condenses in the lamp, it will
be removed after driving with the
headlight on. The removable level
may differ depending on lamp size,
lamp position and environmental condition. However, if moisture is not
removed, have the vehicle is inspected
by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
WARNING
7
7-57
Maintenance
Headlight, front center lamp,
turn signal lamp, daytime running lamp, parking lamp,
side marker replacement
Your vehicle is equipped with LED
lamps. LED lamps do not have
replaceable bulbs. If the LED lamp
does not operate, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Side Repeater Lamp
Replacement
i Information
The headlight aiming should be
adjusted after an accident or after the
headlight assembly is reinstalled at an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
OFE078029
OFE078028N
(1) Headlight (Low/High)
(2) Front center lamp
(3) Turn signal/daytime
lamp/parking lamp
(4) Side marker
7-58
running
Your vehicle is equipped with LED
lamps. LED lamps do not have
replaceable bulbs. If the LED lamp
does not operate, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Rear Combination Light Bulb
Replacement
Stop lamp, tail lamp, turn signal
lamp, backup lamp and side
marker
High mounted stop lamp
Your vehicle is equipped with LED
lamps. LED lamps do not have
replaceable bulbs. If the LED lamp
does not operate, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
OFE078031
(1) Turn signal lamp/stop lamp
(2) Turn signal lamp/stop lamp
(3) Tail lamp
(4) Backup lamp
(5) Side marker
If the high mounted stop lamp does
not operate, have the vehicle
checked by an authorized HYUNDAI
dealer.
Maintenance
OFE078040N
7
7-59
Maintenance
License Plate Light Bulb
Replacement
Interior Light Bulb Replacement
Map lamp, room lamp and luggage compartment lamp
■ Map lamp
■ Room lamp (Type B)
OFE078032
OFE078033
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver,
gently pry the lens cover from the
lamp housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it
straight out.
3. Install a new bulb.
4. Reinstall in the reverse order.
■ Room lamp (Type A)
OFE078034
■ Luggage compartment lamp
OAEE076027
OFE078036
Your vehicle is equipped with LED lamps. LED lamps do not have replaceable bulbs. If the LED lamp does not operate, have the vehicle checked by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer.
7-60
Vanity mirror lamp and glove box lamp
■ Vanity mirror lamp
1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver,
gently pry the lens from the interior lamp housing.
2. Remove the bulb by pulling it
straight out.
WARNING
OFE078035
Prior to working on the Interior
Lights, ensure that the lamp is
off to avoid burning your fingers
or receiving an electric shock.
Maintenance
■ Glove box lamp
3. Install a new bulb in the socket.
4. Align the lens tabs with the interior lamp housing notches and snap
the lens into place.
7
NOTICE
Use care not to dirty or damage
lens, lens tab, and plastic housings.
OFE078037
7-61
Maintenance
APPEARANCE CARE
Exterior Care
Exterior general caution
Protecting your vehicle’s finish
Washing
It is very important to follow the label
directions when using any chemical
cleaner or polish. Read all warning
and caution statements that appear
on the label.
To help protect your vehicle’s finish
from rust and deterioration, wash it
thoroughly and frequently at least
once a month with lukewarm or cold
water.
If you use your vehicle for off-road
driving, you should wash it after each
off-road trip. Pay special attention to
the removal of any accumulation of
salt, dirt, mud, and other foreign
materials. Make sure the drain holes
in the lower edges of the doors and
rocker panels are kept clear and
clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial pollution and similar
deposits can damage your vehicle’s
finish if not removed immediately.
Even prompt washing with plain
water may not completely remove all
these deposits. A mild soap, safe for
use on painted surfaces, should be
used.
High-pressure washing
• When using high-pressure washers, make sure to maintain sufficient distance from the vehicle.
Insufficient clearance or excessive
pressure can lead to component
damage or water penetration.
• Do not spray the camera, sensors
or its surrounding area directly with
a high pressure washer. Shock
applied from high pressure water
may cause the device to not operate normally.
• Do not bring the nozzle tip close to
boots (rubber or plastic covers)or
connectors as they may be damaged if they come into contact with
high pressure water.
• Do not use any high-pressure nozzles, which induce either one-direct
water stream or water swirling.
7-62
After washing, rinse the vehicle thoroughly with lukewarm or cold water.
Do not allow soap to dry on the finish.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test
the brakes while driving slowly
to see if they have been affected
by water before getting on the
road. If braking performance is
impaired, dry the brakes by
applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward
speed.
NOTICE
OFE078045N
NOTICE
• Water washing in the fuel cell
power module compartment
including high pressure water
washing may cause the failure
of electrical circuits located in
the fuel cell power module compartment.
• Never allow water or other liquids
to come in contact with electrical/electronic components inside
the vehicle as this may damage
them.
Matte paint finish vehicle
Automatic car wash which uses
rotating brushes should not be
used as this can damage the surface of your vehicle. A steam
cleaner which washes the vehicle
surface at high temperature may
result the oil to adhere and leave
stains that is difficult to remove.
Use a soft cloth (for example,
microfiber towel or sponge) when
washing your vehicle and dry with
a microfiber towel. When you hand
wash your vehicle, you should not
use a cleaner that finishes with
wax. If the vehicle surface is too
dirty (sand, dirt, dust, contaminant, etc.), clean the surface with
water before washing the car.
7-63
Maintenance
• Do not use strong soap, chemical detergents or hot water, and
do not wash the vehicle in direct
sunlight or when the body of the
vehicle is warm.
• Be careful when washing the
side windows of your vehicle.
Especially, with high-pressure
water, water may leak through
the windows and wet the interior.
• To prevent damage to the plastic
parts, do not clean with chemical solvents or strong detergents.
NOTICE
7
Maintenance
Waxing
A good coat of wax provides a barrier between your paint and environmental contamination.
Keeping a good coat of wax on your
vehicle will help protect it.
Wax the vehicle when water will no
longer bead on the paint.
Always wash and dry the vehicle
before waxing. Use a good quality
liquid or paste wax, and follow the
manufacturer’s instructions. Wax all
metal trim to protect it and to maintain its luster.
Removing oil, tar, and similar materials with a spot remover will usually
strip the wax from the finish. Be sure
to re-wax these areas even if the rest
of the vehicle does not yet need waxing.
7-64
NOTICE
• Wiping dust or dirt off the body
with a dry cloth will scratch the
finish.
• Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or
caustic agents on chrome-plated or anodized aluminum parts.
This may result in damage to the
protective coating and cause
discoloration or paint deterioration.
Repairing your vehicle’s finish
Deep scratches or stone chips in the
painted surface must be repaired
promptly. Exposed metal will quickly
rust and may develop into a major
repair expense.
NOTICE
If your vehicle is damaged and
requires any metal repair or
replacement, be sure the body
shop applies anti-corrosion materials to the parts repaired or
replaced.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
Do not use any polish protector
such as a detergent, an abrasive
and a polish. In case wax is
applied, remove the wax immediately using a silicon remover and
if any tar or tar contaminant is on
the surface use a tar remover to
clean. However, be careful not to
apply too much pressure on the
painted area.
NOTICE
Matte paint finish vehicle
In case of matte paint finish vehicles, it is impossible to modify
only the damaged area and repair
of the whole part is necessary. If
the vehicle is damaged and painting is required, have your vehicle
maintained and repaired by an
authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Take
extreme care, as it is difficult to
restore the quality after the repair.
Bright-metal maintenance
Underbody maintenance
Corrosive materials used for ice and
snow removal and dust control may
collect on the underbody. If these
materials are not removed, accelerated rusting can occur on underbody
parts such as the fuel lines, frame,
floor pan and exhaust system, even
though they have been treated with
rust protection.
WARNING
After washing the vehicle, test
the brakes while driving slowly
to see if they have been affected
by water. If braking performance
is impaired, dry the brakes by
applying them lightly while
maintaining a slow forward
speed.
Aluminum wheel maintenance
The aluminum wheels are coated
with a clear protective finish.
NOTICE
• Do not use abrasive cleaner, polishing compound, solvent, or
wire brushes on aluminum
wheels.
• Clean the wheel when it has
cooled.
• Use only a mild soap or neutral
detergent, and rinse thoroughly
with water. Also, clean the
wheels after driving on salted
roads.
• Do not wash the wheels with
high-speed car wash brushes.
• Do not use any cleaners containing acid or alkaline detergents.
7-65
Maintenance
• To remove road tar and insects,
use a tar remover, not a scraper or
other sharp object.
• To protect the surfaces of brightmetal parts from corrosion, apply a
coating of wax or chrome preservative and rub to a high luster.
• During winter weather or in coastal
areas, cover the bright metal parts
with a heavier coating of wax or
preservative. If necessary, coat the
parts with non-corrosive petroleum
jelly or other protective compound.
Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbody and wheel openings with lukewarm or cold water once a month,
after off-road driving and at the end
of each winter. Pay special attention
to these areas because it is difficult
to see all the mud and dirt. It will do
more harm than good to wet down
the road grime without removing it.
The lower edges of doors, rocker
panels, and frame members have
drain holes that should not be
allowed to clog with dirt; trapped
water in these areas can cause rusting.
7
Maintenance
Corrosion protection
Protecting your vehicle from corrosion
By using the most advanced design
and construction practices to combat
corrosion, HYUNDAI produces cars
of the highest quality. However, this is
only part of the job. To achieve the
long-term corrosion resistance your
vehicle can deliver, the owner’s
cooperation and assistance is also
required.
Common causes of corrosion
The most common causes of corrosion on your vehicle are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture that is
allowed to accumulate underneath
the vehicle.
• Removal of paint or protective
coatings by stones, gravel, abrasion or minor scrapes and dents
which leave unprotected metal
exposed to corrosion.
7-66
High-corrosion areas
If you live in an area where your vehicle is regularly exposed to corrosive
materials, corrosion protection is
particularly important. Some of the
common causes of accelerated corrosion are road salts, dust control
chemicals, ocean air and industrial
pollution.
Moisture breeds corrosion
Moisture creates the conditions in
which corrosion is most likely to
occur. For example, corrosion is
accelerated by high humidity, particularly when temperatures are just
above freezing. In such conditions,
the corrosive material is kept in contact with the car surfaces by moisture
that is slow to evaporate.
Mud is particularly corrosive
because it is slow to dry and holds
moisture in contact with the vehicle.
Although the mud appears to be dry,
it can still retain the moisture and
promote corrosion.
High temperatures can also accelerate corrosion of parts that are not
properly ventilated so the moisture
can be dispersed. For all these reasons, it is particularly important to
keep your vehicle clean and free of
mud or accumulations of other materials. This applies not only to the visible surfaces but particularly to the
underside of the vehicle.
To help prevent corrosion
Keep your car clean
The best way to prevent corrosion is
to keep your vehicle clean and free
of corrosive materials. Attention to
the underside of the vehicle is particularly important.
• If you live in a high-corrosion area,
(where road salts are used, near
the ocean, areas with industrial
pollution, acid rain, etc.), you
should take extra care to prevent
corrosion. In winter, hose off the
underside of your vehicle at least
once a month and be sure to clean
the underside thoroughly when
winter is over.
Keep your garage dry
Don’t park your car in a damp, poorly ventilated garage. This creates a
favorable environment for corrosion.
This is particularly true if you wash
your vehicle in the garage or drive it
into the garage when it is still wet or
covered with snow, ice or mud. Even
a heated garage can contribute to
corrosion unless it is well ventilated
so moisture is dispersed.
Keep paint and trim in good condition
Scratches or chips in the finish
should be covered with "touch-up"
paint as soon as possible to reduce
the possibility of corrosion. If bare
metal is showing through, the attention of a qualified body and paint
shop is recommended.
Bird droppings are highly corrosive
and may damage painted surfaces in
just a few hours. Always remove bird
droppings as soon as possible.
Interior Care
Interior general precautions
Prevent caustic solutions such as
perfume and cosmetic oil, from contacting the interior parts because
they may cause damage or discoloration. If they do contact the interior
parts, wipe them off immediately.
See the instructions for the proper
way to clean vehicle interior surfaces.
NOTICE
• Never allow water or other liquids to come in contact with
electrical/electronic
components inside the vehicle as this
may damage them.
• When cleaning leather products
(steering wheel, seats etc.), use
neutral detergents or low alcohol content solutions. If you use
high alcohol content solutions
or acid/alkaline detergents, the
color of the leather may fade or
the surface may get stripped off.
7-67
Maintenance
• When cleaning underneath the
vehicle, pay particular attention to
the components under the fenders
and other areas that are hidden
from view. Do a thorough job; just
dampening the accumulated mud
rather than washing it away will
accelerate corrosion rather than
prevent it. Water under high pressure and steam are particularly
effective in removing accumulated
mud and corrosive materials.
• When cleaning lower door panels,
rocker panels and frame members,
be sure that drain holes are kept
open so that moisture can escape
and not be trapped inside to accelerate corrosion.
7
Maintenance
Cleaning the upholstery and
interior trim
Vehicle interior surfaces (if
equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from
interior surfaces with a whisk broom
or a vacuum cleaner.
If necessary, clean interior surfaces
with a mixture of warm water and
mild non-detergent cleaner (test all
cleaners on a concealed area before
use).
Fabric (if equipped)
Remove dust and loose dirt from fabric with a whisk broom or vacuum
cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solution recommended for upholstery or
carpets. Remove fresh spots immediately with a fabric spot cleaner. If
fresh spots do not receive immediate
attention, the fabric can be stained
and its color can be affected. Also, its
fire-resistant properties can be
reduced if the material is not properly maintained.
7-68
NOTICE
Using anything but recommended
cleaners and procedures may
affect the fabric's appearance and
fire-resistant properties.
Leather (if equipped)
• Feature of Seat Leather
- Leather is made from the outer
skin of an animal, which goes
through a special process to be
available for use. Since it is a natural object, each part differs in
thickness or density.
Wrinkles may appear as a natural
result of stretching and shrinking
depending on the temperature
and humidity.
- The seat is made of stretchable
fabric to improve comfort.
- The parts contacting the body are
curved and the side supporting
area is high which provides driving comfort and stability.
- Wrinkles may appear naturally
from usage. It is not a fault of the
products.
CAUTION
• Wrinkles or abrasions which
appear naturally from usage
are not covered by warranty.
• Belts with metallic accessories, zippers or keys inside
the back pocket may damage
the seat fabric.
• Make sure not to wet the seat.
It may change the nature of
natural leather.
• Jeans or clothes which could
bleach may contaminate the
surface of the seat covering
fabric.
• Cleaning the leather seats
- Remove all contaminations
instantly. Refer to instructions
below for removal of each contaminant.
- Cosmetic products (sunscreen,
foundation, etc.)
Apply cleansing cream on a cloth
and wipe the contaminate spot.
Wipe off the cream with a wet
cloth and remove water with a dry
cloth.
- Beverages (coffee, soft drink,
etc.)
Apply a small amount of neutral
detergent and wipe until contaminations do not smear.
- Oil
Remove oil instantly with
absorbable cloth and wipe with
stain remover used only for natural leather.
- Chewing gum
Harden the gum with ice and
remove gradually.
Cleaning the seat belt webbing
Clean the belt webbing with any mild
soap solution recommended for
cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow
the instructions provided with the
soap. Do not bleach or re-dye the
webbing because this may weaken
the seat belt.
Cleaning the interior window
glass
If the interior glass surfaces of the
vehicle become fogged (that is, covered with an oily, greasy or waxy
film), they should be cleaned with
glass cleaner. Follow the directions
on the glass cleaner container.
NOTICE
Do not scrape or scratch the
inside of the rear window. This
may result in damage to the rear
window defroster grid.
7-69
Maintenance
• Caring for the leather seats
- Vacuum the seat periodically to
remove dust and sand on the
seat. It will prevent abrasion or
damage of the leather and maintain its quality.
- Wipe the natural leather seat
cover often with dry or soft cloth.
- Use of proper leather protective
may prevent abrasion of the
cover and helps maintain the
color. Be sure to read the instructions and consult a specialist
when using leather coating or
protective agent.
- Light colored (beige, cream
beige) leather is easily contaminated and the stain is noticeable.
Clean the seats frequently.
- Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may
cause the surface to crack.
7
Maintenance
CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE NOTICE
Perchlorate Material-special handling may apply, See: https://dtsc.ca.gov/perchlorate
Notice to California Vehicle Dismantlers:
Perchlorate containing materials, such as air bag inflators, seatbelt pretensioners and keyless remote entry batteries,
must be disposed of according to Title 22 California Code of Regulations Section 67384.10 (a).
7-70
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
Specifications & Consumer information
Dimensions ..............................................................8-2
Bulb Wattage ..........................................................8-3
Tires and Wheels ...................................................8-4
Volume and Weight................................................8-5
Air Conditioning System........................................8-5
Recommended Lubricants and Capacities ..........8-6
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ...................8-7
Vehicle Certification Label....................................8-7
Tire Specification and Pressure Label................8-8
Motor Number ........................................................8-8
Consumer Information...........................................8-9
Reporting Safety Defects ...................................8-10
8
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
DIMENSIONS
Items
in (mm)
Overall length
183.86 (4,670)
Overall width
73.23 (1,860)
Overall height
Without roof side rails : 64.17 (1,630)
With roof side rails : 64.57 (1,640)
Front tread
Rear tread
Wheelbase
8-2
225/60 R17
63.70 (1,618)
245/45 R19
63.54 (1,614)
225/60 R17
64.13 (1,629)
245/45 R19
63.98 (1,625)
109.84 (2,790)
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
BULB WATTAGE
Front
Light Bulb
Headlight
Turn signal lamp
Front center lamp
Parking lamp
Daytime running lamp (DRL)
Side Repeater lamp (Outside mirror)
Side marker
Rear combination lamp
Rear
Interior
High mounted stop lamp
License plate lamp
Map lamp
Room lamp
Vanity mirror lamp
Luggage compartment lamp
Glove box lamp
Low/High
Stop
Tail
Turn signal
Back up
Side marker
Bulb Type
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
W5W
LED
LED
FESTOON
LED
FESTOON
Wattage
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
5
LED
LED
5
LED
5
8
8-3
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
TIRES AND WHEELS
Inflation Pressure kPa (psi)
Items
Full size tire
Tire Size
Wheel Size
225/60 R17
7.0J X 17
245/45 R19
7.5J X 19
Normal Load *
1
Maximum Load *
2
Front
Rear
Front
Rear
250 (36)
250 (36)
250 (36)
250 (36)
Wheel Lug Nut
Torque kgf•m
(lbf•ft, N•m)
11~13
(79~94, 07~127)
*1: Normal load : Up to 3 persons
*2: Maximum load : Up to 5 persons
If your vehicle is not equipped with a compact spare tire, your vehicle will be equipped with a Tire Mobility Kit.
NOTICE
• It is permissible to add 3 psi to the standard tire pressure specification if colder temperatures are expected soon.
Tires typically loose 1psi (7kPa) for every 12°F temperature drop. If extreme temperature variations are
expected, recheck your tire pressure as necessary to keep them properly inflated.
• An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above sea level. Thus, if you
plan to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures in advance. If necessary, inflate them to a proper level. (Air inflation per altitude : +2.4 psi/1 mile)
CAUTION
When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle.
Using tires of a different size can damage the drivetrain, cause driveability issues, and possibly cause
damage.
8-4
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
VOLUME AND WEIGHT
Luggage Volume
Gross Vehicle Weight
lbs. (kg)
5,159 (2,340)
cu ft (l)
Min.
Max.
16.28(461)
51.77 (1,466)
Weight of Volume
Classification
20.28±0.88 (575±25)
R-1234yf
4.59±0.35 (130±10)
POE
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Items
Refrigerant
oz. (g)
Compressor lubricant
oz. (cc)
Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.
8
8-5
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
To help achieve proper vehicle performance and durability, use only lubricants of the proper quality.
These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in your vehicle.
Lubricant
Volume
1.06 US qt (1 l)
Reduction gear fluid
Classification
GL4 75W/85, TGO-9
Fuel cell stack
Coolant
We recommend that you consult an authorized Hyundai dealer.
Traction motor
Brake fluid
Fuel
8-6
Amount required
SAE J1704 DOT-4LV,
FMVSS116 DOT-4,
ISO4925 CLASS-6
165.48 US qt. (156.6 l) Hydrogen (SAE J2719 or ISO 14687-2)
■ Frame number
VEHICLE CERTIFICATION
LABEL
■ VIN label (if equipped)
OFE088001
OFE088005L
The vehicle identification number
(VIN) is the number used in registering your car and in all legal matters
pertaining to its ownership, etc.
The number is punched on the floor
under the passenger seat. To check
the number, open the cover.
The VIN is also on a plate attached
to the top of the dashboard. The
number on the plate can easily be
seen through the windshield from
outside.
OFE088002
The vehicle certification label attached
on the driver's side center pillar gives
the Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN).
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN)
8
8-7
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
TIRE SPECIFICATION AND
PRESSURE LABEL
TRACTION MOTOR NUMBER
OFE088004N
OFE088003
The tires supplied on your new vehicle are chosen to provide the best
performance for normal driving.
The tire label located on the driver’s
side center pillar gives the tire pressures recommended for your car.
8-8
The motor number can be seen from
under the vehicle.
HYUNDAI Customer Care
P.O. Box 20850
Fountain Valley, CA 92728
800-633-5151
[email protected]
Hyundai’s Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through Friday,
between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST
and Saturday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English).
For Customer Care assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are available Monday through Friday between
6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
CONSUMER INFORMATION
This consumer information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued by the National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of Transportation. Your HYUNDAI dealer will help answer any questions
you may have as you read this information.
HYUNDAI motor vehicles are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed all applicable safety standards.
For your safety, however, we strongly urge you to read and follow all directions in this Owner’s Manual, particularly
the information under the headings "NOTICE", "CAUTION" and "WARNING".
If, after reading this manual, you have any questions regarding the operation of your vehicle, please contact the
Hyundai Customer Care Center:
8
8-9
Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying HYUNDAI
MOTOR AMERICA.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888- 327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov;
download the SaferCar mobile application;
or write to: Administrator, NHTSA
1200 New Jersey Ave, SE.,
West Building Washington, D.C. 20590.
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group
of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.
8-10
Index
I
Index
12V battery......................................................................7-27
Battery recharging ......................................................7-28
Reset Features ............................................................7-28
A
AC Inverter ...................................................................3-169
Accessing Your Vehicle ....................................................3-3
Smart Key.....................................................................3-3
Immobilizer System ...................................................3-10
Active Hood Lift System ................................................2-70
System activation .......................................................2-70
System limitation........................................................2-71
System malfunction....................................................2-72
Air Bag - Advanced Supplemental Restraint System.....2-47
Where Are the Air Bags? ...........................................2-49
How Does the Air Bag System Operate?...................2-52
What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates..................2-57
Occupant Classification System (OCS) .....................2-58
Why Didn't My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision?........2-60
SRS Care ....................................................................2-60
Additional Safety Precautions....................................2-60
Air Bag Warning Labels.............................................2-60
Why Didn't My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision?........2-63
SRS Care ....................................................................2-68
Additional Safety Precautions....................................2-69
Air Bag Warning Labels.............................................2-69
I-2
Air Bag Warning Labels .................................................2-69
Air cleaner.......................................................................7-20
Filter Replacement .....................................................7-20
Air Conditioning System ..................................................8-5
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ......................................5-29
Appearance care..............................................................7-62
Exterior Care ..............................................................7-62
Interior Care ...............................................................7-67
Auto Hold .......................................................................5-25
Automatic Climate Control System..............................3-149
Automatic Temperature Control Mode ....................3-150
Manual Temperature Control Mode.........................3-150
System Operation .....................................................3-156
System Maintenance ................................................3-158
B
Before Driving ..................................................................5-4
Before Entering the Vehicle .........................................5-4
Before Starting .............................................................5-4
Blind-Spot Collision Warning/
Blind-Spot Collision-avoidance Assist........................5-53
System Description ....................................................5-53
System Setting and Activation ...................................5-54
Warning and System Control .....................................5-57
Detecting Sensor (Front View Camera and
Rear Corner Radar) .................................................5-59
Limitations of the System ..........................................5-62
Blind-Spot View Monitor System ..................................5-77
Operating conditions ..................................................5-77
Blind-Spot View Monitor system warning ................5-78
Brake fluid ......................................................................7-19
Checking the Brake Fluid Level ................................7-19
Braking System...............................................................5-18
Power Brakes..............................................................5-18
Disc Brake Wear Indicator .........................................5-19
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) ................................5-19
Auto Hold ...................................................................5-25
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)..................................5-29
Electronic Stability Control (ESC).............................5-31
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) .......................5-34
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC).................................5-36
Good Braking Practices..............................................5-36
Bulb Wattage.....................................................................8-3
C
D
Declaration of conformity ............................................5-115
Device cooling coolant ...................................................7-13
Checking the Coolant Level.......................................7-13
Changing Coolant.......................................................7-15
Dimensions .......................................................................8-2
Disc Brake Wear Indicator..............................................5-19
Door Locks......................................................................3-11
Door unlocking from outside the vehicle...................3-11
Door locking from outside the vehicle.......................3-14
Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle .........3-14
Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features ..............3-17
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks ..............................3-18
Drive Mode Integrated Control System .........................5-37
Drive mode change alert ............................................5-38
ECO mode climate control.........................................5-38
I-3
Index
California perchlorate notice ..........................................7-70
Cargo Security Screen ..................................................3-176
Center Console Storage ................................................3-165
Child Restraint System (CRS) ........................................2-36
Children Always in the Rear ......................................2-36
Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS).................2-37
Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS) ................2-39
Child-Protector Rear Door Locks...................................3-18
Climate Control Additional Features ............................3-164
Automatic Ventilation...............................................3-164
Sunroof Inside Air Recirculation .............................3-164
Climate control air filter .................................................7-22
Filter Inspection..........................................................7-22
Clock .............................................................................3-171
Coat Hook .....................................................................3-172
Consumer Information......................................................8-9
Cup Holder....................................................................3-166
Customer Q&A Guide (FCEV).......................................H30
I
Index
Driver Assist System.....................................................3-107
Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/Forward)
System ...................................................................3-107
Rear View Monitor ...................................................3-111
Surround View Monitoring ......................................3-112
Driver Attention Warning (DAW) System......................5-94
System Setting and Activation ...................................5-94
Resetting the System ..................................................5-95
System Standby ..........................................................5-96
System Malfunction ...................................................5-96
E
Electric Power Steering (EPS)........................................3-20
Electronic Parking Brake (EPB).....................................5-19
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) .................................5-31
Emergency Fuel Filler Door Release..............................3-57
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.................7-12
Exterior Care...................................................................7-62
Exterior Features.............................................................3-42
Hood ...........................................................................3-42
Non-Powered Liftgate ................................................3-43
Power Liftgate ............................................................3-45
Smart Liftgate.............................................................3-51
Fuel Filler Door..........................................................3-55
Emergency Fuel Filler Door Release .........................3-57
I-4
Exterior Features...........................................................3-178
Roof Side Rails ........................................................3-178
Exterior Lights ................................................................3-91
Exterior Overview.............................................................1-2
F
Features of FCEV............................................................H10
How to Start the Vehicle.............................................H10
How to Stop the Vehicle .............................................H11
Virtual Engine Sound System.....................................H11
Fuel filler door ............................................................H12
Warning and indicator lights.......................................H15
LCD Display Messages ..............................................H16
FCEV mode ................................................................H21
When the high voltage battery is weak ......................H25
If the 12 volt battery is discharged .............................H25
Emergency while driving............................................H26
Floor Mat Anchor(s) .....................................................3-174
Forward Collision-avoidance Assist (FCA) System.......5-39
System Setting and Activation ...................................5-39
FCA Warning Message and System Control..............5-41
FCA Sensor (Front Radar/Front View Camera).........5-44
System Malfunction ...................................................5-46
Limitations of the System ..........................................5-47
Front Seats ........................................................................2-6
Front Windshield Washers ............................................3-104
Front Windshield Wipers ..............................................3-103
Fuel Cell Power Module Compartment............................1-6
Fuel cell power module compartment ..............................7-3
Fuel Filler Door ..............................................................3-55
Fuel cell stack....................................................................H4
Fuses ...............................................................................7-45
Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement ..........................7-46
Fuel cell power module compartment
Panel Fuse Replacement .........................................7-47
Fuse/Relay Panel Description ....................................7-49
G
Glove Box .....................................................................3-165
Good Braking Practices ..................................................5-36
H
If the 12 Volt Battery is Discharged .................................6-5
Before Jump Starting....................................................6-5
Jump Starting................................................................6-6
If the Vehicle Overheats....................................................6-9
If the Vehicle Will Not Start .............................................6-4
If You Have a Flat Tire (With Tire Mobility Kit)...........6-17
Important Safety Precautions............................................2-2
Always Wear Your Seat Belt ........................................2-2
Restrain All Children....................................................2-2
Air Bag Hazards ...........................................................2-2
Driver Distraction.........................................................2-2
Control Your Speed ......................................................2-3
Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition ..........................2-3
In Case of an Emergency While Driving .........................6-2
If an accident occurs.....................................................6-2
If a fire occurs ..............................................................6-3
Emergency venting of hydrogen gas............................6-3
If a submersion in water occurs ...................................6-3
If the vehicle stalls at a crossroad or crossing .............6-3
If you have a flat tire while driving .............................6-4
If the vehicle stalls while driving.................................6-4
Index
Hazard Warning Flasher ...................................................6-2
Head Restraints ...............................................................2-13
Heated Steering Wheel ...................................................3-22
High pressure hydrogen storage tanks ..............................H5
Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) .....................................5-36
Hood................................................................................3-42
Horn ................................................................................3-21
H20 OUT ........................................................................3-89
CSD (Cold Shut-Down) .............................................3-90
I
I
I-5
Index
Infotainment system..........................................................4-2
USB and iPod® port .....................................................4-2
Antenna ........................................................................4-2
Steering wheel audio controls ......................................4-3
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology..................................4-4
Audio/Video/Navigation system ..................................4-4
Inside Rearview Mirror...................................................3-23
Instrument Cluster...........................................................3-58
Instrument Cluster Control.........................................3-59
Gauges and Meters .....................................................3-59
Warning and Indicator Lights.....................................3-65
LCD Display Messages..............................................3-76
Instrument Panel Overview ..............................................1-5
Interior Care ....................................................................7-67
Interior Features ............................................................3-166
Cup Holder ...............................................................3-166
Sunvisor....................................................................3-167
Power Outlet.............................................................3-168
AC Inverter...............................................................3-169
USB Charger ............................................................3-171
Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System ..............3-171
Clock ........................................................................3-173
Coat Hook ................................................................3-174
Floor Mat Anchor(s).................................................3-174
Luggage Net Holder .................................................3-175
Cargo Security Screen..............................................3-176
Interior Overview..............................................................1-4
Introduction of FCEV .......................................................H2
I-6
L
Lane Following Assist (LFA) System ............................5-87
LFA operation.............................................................5-88
Warning message........................................................5-90
Limitations of the system ...........................................5-92
Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) System ..............................5-79
LKA System Operation ..............................................5-80
Warning Light and Message.......................................5-83
Limitations of the System ..........................................5-85
LKA System Function Change ..................................5-86
LCD Display ...................................................................3-81
LCD Display Control .................................................3-81
LCD Display Modes ..................................................3-82
LCD Display Messages (FCEV).....................................H16
Leading Vehicle Departure Alert ..................................5-116
System Setting and Activation .................................5-116
Light bulbs ......................................................................7-57
Headlight, front center lamp, turn signal lamp,
daytime running lamp, parking lamp,
side marker replacement .........................................7-58
Side Repeater Lamp Replacement .............................7-58
Rear Combination Light Bulb Replacement..............7-59
High mounted stop lamp ............................................7-59
License Plate Light Bulb Replacement......................7-60
Interior Light Bulb Replacement ...............................7-60
Lighting...........................................................................3-91
Exterior Lights............................................................3-91
Welcome System ......................................................3-101
Luggage Net Holder .....................................................3-174
M
Maintenance services ........................................................7-4
Owner's Responsibility.................................................7-4
Owner Maintenance Precautions..................................7-4
Mirrors ............................................................................3-23
Inside Rearview Mirror ..............................................3-23
Side View Mirrors ......................................................3-31
Motor Number ..................................................................8-8
N
Non-Powered Liftgate.....................................................3-43
O
Paddle Shifter (Regenerative Braking Control) .............5-17
Parking Distance Warning (Reverse/Forward)
System .......................................................................3-107
Power Brakes ..................................................................5-18
Power Button ....................................................................5-6
POWER Button Positions ............................................5-7
Starting the Vehicle ......................................................5-9
Turning Off the Vehicle..............................................5-10
Power Liftgate.................................................................3-45
Power Outlet .................................................................3-168
R
Rear Cross-traffic Collision Warning (RCCW)/
Rear Cross-traffic Collision-avoidance Assist
(RCCA)........................................................................5-67
System Description ....................................................5-67
System Setting and Activation ...................................5-68
Warning and System Control .....................................5-69
Limitations of the System ..........................................5-73
Index
Occupant Classification System (OCS)..........................2-58
Owner maintenance ..........................................................7-5
Owner maintenance schedule.......................................7-6
P
I
I-7
Index
Rear Seats .......................................................................2-10
Rear View Monitor........................................................3-111
Rear Window Wiper and Washer..................................3-106
Recommended Lubricants and Capacities........................8-6
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover ..................................5-121
Reduction Gear ...............................................................5-11
Reduction Gear Operation..........................................5-11
Parking........................................................................5-13
LCD Display Messages..............................................5-13
Good Driving Practices ..............................................5-16
Remote Smart Parking Assist (RSPA) ..........................3-115
Operating Condition .................................................3-116
Non-operating Condition..........................................3-117
Limitations of the System ........................................3-118
How the System Works (Smart Parking) .................3-122
How the System Works (Remote Smart Parking)....3-129
How the System Works (Smart Exit) .......................3-133
How the System Works
(Remote Moving Forward/Backward)..................3-140
Additional Instructions (Messages)..........................3-145
Turn signal Showing Vehicle Status while System
in Activation..........................................................3-146
Smart Key Showing Vehicle Status while System
in Activation..........................................................3-147
Link with other Systems ..........................................3-148
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................8-10
Roof Side Rails .............................................................3-178
I-8
S
Scheduled maintenance services.......................................7-7
Normal Maintenance Schedule ....................................7-8
Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions...........7-10
Seat Belt Restraint System .............................................2-24
Seat Belt Warning Light .................................................2-22
Seat Belts ........................................................................2-21
Seat Belt Safety Precautions ......................................2-21
Seat Belt Warning Light.............................................2-22
Seat Belt Restraint System .........................................2-24
Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions ....................2-32
Care of Seat Belts.......................................................2-35
Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats .........................2-17
Seats ..................................................................................2-4
Safety Precautions ........................................................2-5
Front Seats....................................................................2-6
Rear Seats ...................................................................2-10
Head Restraints ..........................................................2-13
Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats.....................2-17
Side View Mirrors...........................................................3-31
Smart Cruise Control With Stop & Go System..............5-98
Smart Cruise Control Switch .....................................5-99
To Adjust the Sensitivity of Smart Cruise Control ..5-100
To Convert to Cruise Control Mode ........................5-100
Smart Cruise Control Speed.....................................5-101
Sunroof............................................................................3-37
Automatic Reversal ....................................................3-39
Sunshade.....................................................................3-37
Sunroof Open Warning...............................................3-41
Slide open/close..........................................................3-39
Tilt Open/Close ..........................................................3-38
Resetting the sunroof..................................................3-41
Sunvisor ........................................................................3-166
Surround View Monitoring ...........................................3-112
T
The components of FCEV.................................................H3
FCEV system module ...................................................H4
High pressure hydrogen storage tanks..........................H5
Battery system ..............................................................H5
Theft-Alarm System .......................................................3-19
Tilt Steering/Telescope Steering .....................................3-21
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) .....................6-11
Check Tire Pressure....................................................6-11
Tire Pressure Monitoring System...............................6-12
Low Tire Pressure Telltale..........................................6-13
Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position
Indicator ..................................................................6-13
TPMS Malfunction Indicator .....................................6-14
Changing a Tire with TPMS ......................................6-15
Tire Specification and Pressure Label ..............................8-8
I-9
Index
Smart Cruise Control Vehicle-to-Vehicle Distance..5-105
Sensor to Detect Distance to the Vehicle Ahead......5-108
Limitations of the System ........................................5-110
Smart Key .........................................................................3-3
Smart Liftgate .................................................................3-51
Snow Tires ......................................................................7-42
Special Driving Conditions...........................................5-118
Hazardous Driving Conditions.................................5-118
Rocking the Vehicle..................................................5-118
Smooth Cornering ....................................................5-119
Driving at Night........................................................5-119
Driving in the Rain...................................................5-119
Driving in Flooded Areas .........................................5-120
Highway Driving......................................................5-120
Reducing the Risk of a Rollover..............................5-121
Stack cooling coolant......................................................7-16
Checking the Coolant Level.......................................7-16
Changing Coolant.......................................................7-18
Steering Wheel................................................................3-20
Horn............................................................................3-22
Heated Steering Wheel...............................................3-22
Motor Driven Power Steering (MDPS) .....................3-20
Tilt Steering/Telescope Steering.................................3-21
Storage Compartment ...................................................3-165
Center Console Storage............................................3-165
Glove Box ................................................................3-165
I
Index
Tires and wheels ......................................................7-29, 8-4
Tire Care.....................................................................7-29
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures.............7-30
Check Tire Inflation Pressure.....................................7-31
Tire Rotation...............................................................7-32
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ...........................7-33
Tire Replacement........................................................7-33
Wheel Replacement....................................................7-34
Tire Traction ...............................................................7-34
Tire Maintenance........................................................7-34
Tire Sidewall Labeling ...............................................7-34
Tire Terminology and Definitions..............................7-38
All Season Tires .........................................................7-42
Summer Tires .............................................................7-42
Snow Tires..................................................................7-42
Radial-Ply Tires..........................................................7-42
Low Aspect Ratio Tires..............................................7-43
Towing ............................................................................6-24
Towing Service...........................................................6-24
Removable Towing Hook...........................................6-25
Emergency Towing.....................................................6-26
Trailer Towing...............................................................5-131
Trip Computer.................................................................3-85
I-10
U
USB Charger.................................................................3-171
V
Vehicle Certification Label ...............................................8-7
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)...............................8-7
Vehicle Load Limit .......................................................5-126
Tire Loading Information Label...............................5-126
Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)............................5-34
Volume and Weight...........................................................8-5
W
Washer fluid ....................................................................7-20
Checking the Washer Fluid Level ..............................7-20
Welcome System...........................................................3-101
Windows .........................................................................3-33
Power Windows..........................................................3-34
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging .........................3-160
Auto Defogging System (Additional Feature
with Automatic Temperature Control System) .....3-162
Rear Window Defroster............................................3-163
Winter Driving ..............................................................5-122
Snow or Icy Conditions............................................5-122
Winter Precautions ...................................................5-124
Wiper blades ...................................................................7-24
Blade Inspection .........................................................7-24
Blade Replacement.....................................................7-24
Wipers and Washers......................................................3-103
Front Windshield Wipers..........................................3-103
Front Windshield Washers........................................3-105
Rear Window Wiper and Washer .............................3-106
Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System...................3-171
Index
I
I-11
■
PM50-EU29B
(�Oi I □ I�)
For clean future, Hyundai Motor Company
uses environmentally friendly paper to
produce owner's manual.